1208e4f615e578f89ede34bf13a07ad17a4549f9
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 Initial support for the FreeBSD/riscv target and native configuration
550 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
551 Computer Laboratory (Department of Computer Science and Technology)
552 under DARPA contract HR0011-18-C-0016 ("ECATS"), as part of the DARPA
553 SSITH research programme.
554
555 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
556 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
557 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
558 Stafford Horne.
559
560 @node Sample Session
561 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
562
563 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
564 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
565 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
566
567 @iftex
568 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
569 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
570 @end iftex
571
572 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
573 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
574
575 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
576 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
577 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
578 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
579 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
580 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
581 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
582 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
583 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
584
585 @smallexample
586 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
587 $ @b{./m4}
588 @b{define(foo,0000)}
589
590 @b{foo}
591 0000
592 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
593
594 @b{bar}
595 0000
596 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
597
598 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
599 @b{baz}
600 @b{Ctrl-d}
601 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
602 @end smallexample
603
604 @noindent
605 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
606
607 @smallexample
608 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
609 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
610 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
611 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
612 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
613 the conditions.
614 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
615 for details.
616
617 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
618 (@value{GDBP})
619 @end smallexample
620
621 @noindent
622 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
623 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
624 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
625 that examples fit in this manual.
626
627 @smallexample
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
633 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
634 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
635 @code{break} command.
636
637 @smallexample
638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
639 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
644 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
645 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
649 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
650 @b{define(foo,0000)}
651
652 @b{foo}
653 0000
654 @end smallexample
655
656 @noindent
657 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
658 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
659 context where it stops.
660
661 @smallexample
662 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
663
664 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
665 at builtin.c:879
666 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
671 the next line of the current function.
672
673 @smallexample
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
676 : nil,
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
681 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
682 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
683 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
684
685 @smallexample
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
687 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
688 at input.c:530
689 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
690 @end smallexample
691
692 @noindent
693 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
694 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
695 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
696 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
697 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
698 stack frame for each active subroutine.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
702 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
703 at input.c:530
704 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
705 at builtin.c:882
706 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
707 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
708 at macro.c:71
709 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
710 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
711 @end smallexample
712
713 @noindent
714 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
715 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
716 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
717
718 @smallexample
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
720 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
722 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
723 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
725 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
726 : xstrdup(rq);
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
728 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
729 @end smallexample
730
731 @noindent
732 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
733 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
734 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
735 (@code{print}) to see their values.
736
737 @smallexample
738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
739 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
741 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
742 @end smallexample
743
744 @noindent
745 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
746 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
747 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
748
749 @smallexample
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
751 533 xfree(rquote);
752 534
753 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
754 : xstrdup (lq);
755 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
756 : xstrdup (rq);
757 537
758 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
759 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
760 540 @}
761 541
762 542 void
763 @end smallexample
764
765 @noindent
766 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
767 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
768
769 @smallexample
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
771 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
773 540 @}
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
775 $3 = 9
776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
777 $4 = 7
778 @end smallexample
779
780 @noindent
781 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
782 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
783 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
784 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
785 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
786 assignments.
787
788 @smallexample
789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
790 $5 = 7
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
792 $6 = 9
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
797 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
798 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
799 example that caused trouble initially:
800
801 @smallexample
802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
803 Continuing.
804
805 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
806
807 baz
808 0000
809 @end smallexample
810
811 @noindent
812 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
813 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
814 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
815
816 @smallexample
817 @b{Ctrl-d}
818 Program exited normally.
819 @end smallexample
820
821 @noindent
822 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
823 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
824 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
825
826 @smallexample
827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 @node Invocation
831 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
832
833 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
834 The essentials are:
835 @itemize @bullet
836 @item
837 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
838 @item
839 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
840 @end itemize
841
842 @menu
843 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
844 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
845 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
846 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
847 @end menu
848
849 @node Invoking GDB
850 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
851
852 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
853 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
854
855 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
856 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
857
858 The command-line options described here are designed
859 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
860 options may effectively be unavailable.
861
862 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
863 specifying an executable program:
864
865 @smallexample
866 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
867 @end smallexample
868
869 @noindent
870 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
871 specified:
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
875 @end smallexample
876
877 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument or use option
878 @code{-p}, if you want to debug a running process:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
882 @value{GDBP} -p 1234
883 @end smallexample
884
885 @noindent
886 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234}. With option @option{-p} you
887 can omit the @var{program} filename.
888
889 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
890 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
891 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
892 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
893 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
894
895 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
896 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
897 option processing.
898 @smallexample
899 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
900 @end smallexample
901 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
902 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
903
904 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
905 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
906 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
907
908 @smallexample
909 @value{GDBP} --silent
910 @end smallexample
911
912 @noindent
913 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
914 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
915
916 @noindent
917 Type
918
919 @smallexample
920 @value{GDBP} -help
921 @end smallexample
922
923 @noindent
924 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
925 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
926
927 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
928 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
929 @samp{-x} option is used.
930
931
932 @menu
933 * File Options:: Choosing files
934 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
935 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
936 @end menu
937
938 @node File Options
939 @subsection Choosing Files
940
941 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
942 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
943 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
944 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
945 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
946 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
947 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
948 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
949 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
950 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
951 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
952 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
953 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
954
955 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
956 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
957 argument and ignore it.
958
959 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
960 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
961 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
962 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
963 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
964
965 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
966 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
967 @c it.
968
969 @table @code
970 @item -symbols @var{file}
971 @itemx -s @var{file}
972 @cindex @code{--symbols}
973 @cindex @code{-s}
974 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
975
976 @item -exec @var{file}
977 @itemx -e @var{file}
978 @cindex @code{--exec}
979 @cindex @code{-e}
980 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
981 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
982
983 @item -se @var{file}
984 @cindex @code{--se}
985 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
986 file.
987
988 @item -core @var{file}
989 @itemx -c @var{file}
990 @cindex @code{--core}
991 @cindex @code{-c}
992 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
993
994 @item -pid @var{number}
995 @itemx -p @var{number}
996 @cindex @code{--pid}
997 @cindex @code{-p}
998 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
999
1000 @item -command @var{file}
1001 @itemx -x @var{file}
1002 @cindex @code{--command}
1003 @cindex @code{-x}
1004 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
1005 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
1006 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1007
1008 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1009 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1010 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1011 @cindex @code{-ex}
1012 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1013
1014 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1015 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1016
1017 @smallexample
1018 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1019 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1020 @end smallexample
1021
1022 @item -init-command @var{file}
1023 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1024 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1025 @cindex @code{-ix}
1026 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1027 after loading gdbinit files).
1028 @xref{Startup}.
1029
1030 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1031 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1032 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1033 @cindex @code{-iex}
1034 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1035 after loading gdbinit files).
1036 @xref{Startup}.
1037
1038 @item -directory @var{directory}
1039 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1040 @cindex @code{--directory}
1041 @cindex @code{-d}
1042 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1043
1044 @item -r
1045 @itemx -readnow
1046 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1047 @cindex @code{-r}
1048 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1049 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1050 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1051
1052 @item --readnever
1053 @anchor{--readnever}
1054 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1055 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1056 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1057 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1058 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1059 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1060 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1061 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1062 @end table
1063
1064 @node Mode Options
1065 @subsection Choosing Modes
1066
1067 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1068 batch mode or quiet mode.
1069
1070 @table @code
1071 @anchor{-nx}
1072 @item -nx
1073 @itemx -n
1074 @cindex @code{--nx}
1075 @cindex @code{-n}
1076 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1077 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1078
1079 @table @code
1080 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1081 This is the system-wide init file.
1082 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1083 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1084 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1085 have been processed.
1086 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1087 This is the init file in your home directory.
1088 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1089 command options have been processed.
1090 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1091 This is the init file in the current directory.
1092 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1093 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1094 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1095 @end table
1096
1097 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1098 For documentation on how to write command files,
1099 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1100
1101 @anchor{-nh}
1102 @item -nh
1103 @cindex @code{--nh}
1104 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1105 in your home directory.
1106 @xref{Startup}.
1107
1108 @item -quiet
1109 @itemx -silent
1110 @itemx -q
1111 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1112 @cindex @code{--silent}
1113 @cindex @code{-q}
1114 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1115 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1116
1117 @item -batch
1118 @cindex @code{--batch}
1119 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1120 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1121 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1122 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1123 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1124 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1125 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1126
1127 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1128 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1129 make this more useful, the message
1130
1131 @smallexample
1132 Program exited normally.
1133 @end smallexample
1134
1135 @noindent
1136 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1137 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1138 mode.
1139
1140 @item -batch-silent
1141 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1142 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1143 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1144 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1145 for an interactive session.
1146
1147 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1148 messages, for example.
1149
1150 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1151 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1152
1153 @item -return-child-result
1154 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1155 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1156 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1157
1158 @itemize @bullet
1159 @item
1160 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1161 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1162 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1163 @item
1164 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1165 @item
1166 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1167 the exit code will be -1.
1168 @end itemize
1169
1170 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1171 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1172 interface.
1173
1174 @item -nowindows
1175 @itemx -nw
1176 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1177 @cindex @code{-nw}
1178 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1179 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1180 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1181
1182 @item -windows
1183 @itemx -w
1184 @cindex @code{--windows}
1185 @cindex @code{-w}
1186 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1187 used if possible.
1188
1189 @item -cd @var{directory}
1190 @cindex @code{--cd}
1191 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1192 instead of the current directory.
1193
1194 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1195 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1196 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1197 @cindex @code{-D}
1198 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1199 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1200 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1201
1202 @item -fullname
1203 @itemx -f
1204 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1205 @cindex @code{-f}
1206 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1207 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1208 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1209 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1210 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1211 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1212 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1213 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1214 frame.
1215
1216 @item -annotate @var{level}
1217 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1218 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1219 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1220 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1221 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1222 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1223 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1224 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1225 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1226
1227 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1228 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1229
1230 @item --args
1231 @cindex @code{--args}
1232 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1233 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1234 This option stops option processing.
1235
1236 @item -baud @var{bps}
1237 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1238 @cindex @code{--baud}
1239 @cindex @code{-b}
1240 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1241 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1242
1243 @item -l @var{timeout}
1244 @cindex @code{-l}
1245 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1246 for remote debugging.
1247
1248 @item -tty @var{device}
1249 @itemx -t @var{device}
1250 @cindex @code{--tty}
1251 @cindex @code{-t}
1252 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1253 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1254
1255 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1256 @item -tui
1257 @cindex @code{--tui}
1258 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1259 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1260 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1261 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1262 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1263 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1264
1265 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1266 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1267 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1268 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1269 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1270 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1271
1272 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi3}) causes
1273 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} version 3 (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1274 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 9.1. @sc{gdb/mi}
1275 version 2 (@code{mi2}), included in @value{GDBN} 6.0 and version 1 (@code{mi1}),
1276 included in @value{GDBN} 5.3, are also available. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi}
1277 interfaces are no longer supported.
1278
1279 @item -write
1280 @cindex @code{--write}
1281 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1282 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1283 (@pxref{Patching}).
1284
1285 @item -statistics
1286 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1287 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1288 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1289
1290 @item -version
1291 @cindex @code{--version}
1292 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1293 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1294
1295 @item -configuration
1296 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1297 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1298 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1299 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1300
1301 @end table
1302
1303 @node Startup
1304 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1305 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1306
1307 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1308
1309 @enumerate
1310 @item
1311 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1312 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1313
1314 @item
1315 @cindex init file
1316 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1317 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1318 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1319 that file.
1320
1321 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1322 @item
1323 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1324 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1325 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1326 that file.
1327
1328 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1329 @item
1330 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1331 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1332 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1333 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1334 gets loaded.
1335
1336 @item
1337 Processes command line options and operands.
1338
1339 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1340 @item
1341 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1342 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1343 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1344 This is only done if the current directory is
1345 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1346 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1347 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1348 @value{GDBN}.
1349
1350 @item
1351 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1352 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1353 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1354 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1355
1356 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1357 you must do something like the following:
1358
1359 @smallexample
1360 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1361 @end smallexample
1362
1363 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1364 off too late.
1365
1366 @item
1367 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1368 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1369 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1370
1371 @item
1372 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1373 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1374 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1375 @end enumerate
1376
1377 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1378 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1379 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1380 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1381 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1382 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1383
1384 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1385 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1386
1387 @cindex init file name
1388 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1389 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1390 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1391 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1392 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1393 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1394 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1395 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1396
1397
1398 @node Quitting GDB
1399 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1400 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1401 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1402
1403 @table @code
1404 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1405 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1406 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1407 @itemx q
1408 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1409 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1410 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1411 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1412 error code.
1413 @end table
1414
1415 @cindex interrupt
1416 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1417 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1418 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1419 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1420 until a time when it is safe.
1421
1422 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1423 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1424 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1425
1426 @node Shell Commands
1427 @section Shell Commands
1428
1429 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1430 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1431 just use the @code{shell} command.
1432
1433 @table @code
1434 @kindex shell
1435 @kindex !
1436 @cindex shell escape
1437 @item shell @var{command-string}
1438 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1439 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1440 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1441 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1442 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1443 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1444 @end table
1445
1446 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1447 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1448 @value{GDBN}:
1449
1450 @table @code
1451 @kindex make
1452 @cindex calling make
1453 @item make @var{make-args}
1454 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1455 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1456 @end table
1457
1458 @table @code
1459 @kindex pipe
1460 @kindex |
1461 @cindex send the output of a gdb command to a shell command
1462 @anchor{pipe}
1463 @item pipe [@var{command}] | @var{shell_command}
1464 @itemx | [@var{command}] | @var{shell_command}
1465 @itemx pipe -d @var{delim} @var{command} @var{delim} @var{shell_command}
1466 @itemx | -d @var{delim} @var{command} @var{delim} @var{shell_command}
1467 Executes @var{command} and sends its output to @var{shell_command}.
1468 Note that no space is needed around @code{|}.
1469 If no @var{command} is provided, the last command executed is repeated.
1470
1471 In case the @var{command} contains a @code{|}, the option @code{-d @var{delim}}
1472 can be used to specify an alternate delimiter string @var{delim} that separates
1473 the @var{command} from the @var{shell_command}.
1474
1475 Example:
1476 @smallexample
1477 @group
1478 (gdb) p var
1479 $1 = @{
1480 black = 144,
1481 red = 233,
1482 green = 377,
1483 blue = 610,
1484 white = 987
1485 @}
1486 @end group
1487 @group
1488 (gdb) pipe p var|wc
1489 7 19 80
1490 (gdb) |p var|wc -l
1491 7
1492 @end group
1493 @group
1494 (gdb) p /x var
1495 $4 = @{
1496 black = 0x90,
1497 red = 0xe9,
1498 green = 0x179,
1499 blue = 0x262,
1500 white = 0x3db
1501 @}
1502 (gdb) ||grep red
1503 red => 0xe9,
1504 @end group
1505 @group
1506 (gdb) | -d ! echo this contains a | char\n ! sed -e 's/|/PIPE/'
1507 this contains a PIPE char
1508 (gdb) | -d xxx echo this contains a | char!\n xxx sed -e 's/|/PIPE/'
1509 this contains a PIPE char!
1510 (gdb)
1511 @end group
1512 @end smallexample
1513 @end table
1514
1515 The convenience variables @code{$_shell_exitcode} and @code{$_shell_exitsignal}
1516 can be used to examine the exit status of the last shell command launched
1517 by @code{shell}, @code{make}, @code{pipe} and @code{|}.
1518 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}.
1519
1520 @node Logging Output
1521 @section Logging Output
1522 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1523 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1524
1525 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1526 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1527
1528 @table @code
1529 @kindex set logging
1530 @item set logging on
1531 Enable logging.
1532 @item set logging off
1533 Disable logging.
1534 @cindex logging file name
1535 @item set logging file @var{file}
1536 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1537 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1538 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1539 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1540 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1541 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1542 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1543 @item set logging debugredirect [on|off]
1544 By default, @value{GDBN} debug output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1545 Set @code{debugredirect} if you want debug output to go only to the log file.
1546 @kindex show logging
1547 @item show logging
1548 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1549 @end table
1550
1551 You can also redirect the output of a @value{GDBN} command to a
1552 shell command. @xref{pipe}.
1553 @node Commands
1554 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1555
1556 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1557 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1558 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1559 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1560 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1561
1562 @menu
1563 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1564 * Command Settings:: How to change default behavior of commands
1565 * Completion:: Command completion
1566 * Command Options:: Command options
1567 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1568 @end menu
1569
1570 @node Command Syntax
1571 @section Command Syntax
1572
1573 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1574 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1575 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1576 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1577 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1578 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1579
1580 @cindex abbreviation
1581 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1582 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1583 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1584 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1585 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1586 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1587 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1588
1589 @cindex repeating commands
1590 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1591 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1592 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1593 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1594 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1595 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1596 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1597
1598 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1599 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1600 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1601
1602 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1603 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1604 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1605 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1606 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1607
1608 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1609 @cindex comment
1610 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1611 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1612 Files,,Command Files}).
1613
1614 @cindex repeating command sequences
1615 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1616 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1617 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1618 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1619 for editing.
1620
1621
1622 @node Command Settings
1623 @section Command Settings
1624 @cindex default behavior of commands, changing
1625 @cindex default settings, changing
1626
1627 Many commands change their behavior according to command-specific
1628 variables or settings. These settings can be changed with the
1629 @code{set} subcommands. For example, the @code{print} command
1630 (@pxref{Data, ,Examining Data}) prints arrays differently depending on
1631 settings changeable with the commands @code{set print elements
1632 NUMBER-OF-ELEMENTS} and @code{set print array-indexes}, among others.
1633
1634 You can change these settings to your preference in the gdbinit files
1635 loaded at @value{GDBN} startup. @xref{Startup}.
1636
1637 The settings can also be changed interactively during the debugging
1638 session. For example, to change the limit of array elements to print,
1639 you can do the following:
1640 @smallexample
1641 (@value{GDBN}) set print elements 10
1642 (@value{GDBN}) print some_array
1643 $1 = @{0, 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90...@}
1644 @end smallexample
1645
1646 The above @code{set print elements 10} command changes the number of
1647 elements to print from the default of 200 to 10. If you only intend
1648 this limit of 10 to be used for printing @code{some_array}, then you
1649 must restore the limit back to 200, with @code{set print elements
1650 200}.
1651
1652 Some commands allow overriding settings with command options. For
1653 example, the @code{print} command supports a number of options that
1654 allow overriding relevant global print settings as set by @code{set
1655 print} subcommands. @xref{print options}. The example above could be
1656 rewritten as:
1657 @smallexample
1658 (@value{GDBN}) print -elements 10 -- some_array
1659 $1 = @{0, 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90...@}
1660 @end smallexample
1661
1662 Alternatively, you can use the @code{with} command to change a setting
1663 temporarily, for the duration of a command invocation.
1664
1665 @table @code
1666 @kindex with command
1667 @kindex w @r{(@code{with})}
1668 @cindex settings
1669 @cindex temporarily change settings
1670 @item with @var{setting} [@var{value}] [-- @var{command}]
1671 @itemx w @var{setting} [@var{value}] [-- @var{command}]
1672 Temporarily set @var{setting} to @var{value} for the duration of
1673 @var{command}.
1674
1675 @var{setting} is any setting you can change with the @code{set}
1676 subcommands. @var{value} is the value to assign to @code{setting}
1677 while running @code{command}.
1678
1679 If no @var{command} is provided, the last command executed is
1680 repeated.
1681
1682 If a @var{command} is provided, it must be preceded by a double dash
1683 (@code{--}) separator. This is required because some settings accept
1684 free-form arguments, such as expressions or filenames.
1685
1686 For example, the command
1687 @smallexample
1688 (@value{GDBN}) with print array on -- print some_array
1689 @end smallexample
1690 @noindent
1691 is equivalent to the following 3 commands:
1692 @smallexample
1693 (@value{GDBN}) set print array on
1694 (@value{GDBN}) print some_array
1695 (@value{GDBN}) set print array off
1696 @end smallexample
1697
1698 The @code{with} command is particularly useful when you want to
1699 override a setting while running user-defined commands, or commands
1700 defined in Python or Guile. @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
1701
1702 @smallexample
1703 (@value{GDBN}) with print pretty on -- my_complex_command
1704 @end smallexample
1705
1706 To change several settings for the same command, you can nest
1707 @code{with} commands. For example, @code{with language ada -- with
1708 print elements 10} temporarily changes the language to Ada and sets a
1709 limit of 10 elements to print for arrays and strings.
1710
1711 @end table
1712
1713 @node Completion
1714 @section Command Completion
1715
1716 @cindex completion
1717 @cindex word completion
1718 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1719 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1720 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1721 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, command options, and the names of symbols
1722 in your program.
1723
1724 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1725 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1726 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1727 enter it). For example, if you type
1728
1729 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1730 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1731 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1732 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1733 @smallexample
1734 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1735 @end smallexample
1736
1737 @noindent
1738 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1739 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1740
1741 @smallexample
1742 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1743 @end smallexample
1744
1745 @noindent
1746 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1747 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1748 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1749 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1750 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1751 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1752
1753 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1754 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1755 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1756 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1757 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1758 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1759 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1760 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1761 example:
1762
1763 @smallexample
1764 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1765 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1766 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1767 make_abs_section make_function_type
1768 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1769 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1770 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1771 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1772 @end smallexample
1773
1774 @noindent
1775 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1776 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1777 command.
1778
1779 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1780 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1781 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1782 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1783 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1784
1785 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1786 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1787 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1788
1789 @smallexample
1790 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1791 main
1792 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1793 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1794 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1799
1800 @table @code
1801 @kindex set max-completions
1802 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1803 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1804 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1805 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1806 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1807 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1808 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1809 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1810 completion slow.
1811 @kindex show max-completions
1812 @item show max-completions
1813 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1814 during completion.
1815 @end table
1816
1817 @cindex quotes in commands
1818 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1819 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1820 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1821 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1822 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1823 @value{GDBN} commands.
1824
1825 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1826 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1827 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1828 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1829 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1830 Operators}).
1831
1832 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1833 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1834 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1835 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1836 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1837 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1838 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1839 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1840 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1841
1842 @smallexample
1843 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1844 func<int>() func<float>()
1845 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1846 @end smallexample
1847
1848 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1849 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1850 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1851 function:
1852
1853 @smallexample
1854 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1855 func<int>() func<float>()
1856 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1857 @end smallexample
1858
1859 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1860 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1861 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1862 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1863 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1864 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1865
1866 @smallexample
1867 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1868 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1869 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1870 bubble(double)
1871 @end smallexample
1872
1873 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1874 require quoting.
1875
1876 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1877 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1878 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1879 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1880
1881 @cindex completion of structure field names
1882 @cindex structure field name completion
1883 @cindex completion of union field names
1884 @cindex union field name completion
1885 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1886 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1887 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1888 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1889 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1890 left-hand-side:
1891
1892 @smallexample
1893 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1894 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1895 to_data to_isatty to_write
1896 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1897 to_flush to_read
1898 @end smallexample
1899
1900 @noindent
1901 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1902 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1903 follows:
1904
1905 @smallexample
1906 struct ui_file
1907 @{
1908 int *magic;
1909 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1910 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1911 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1912 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1913 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1914 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1915 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1916 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1917 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1918 void *to_data;
1919 @}
1920 @end smallexample
1921
1922 @node Command Options
1923 @section Command options
1924
1925 @cindex command options
1926 Some commands accept options starting with a leading dash. For
1927 example, @code{print -pretty}. Similarly to command names, you can
1928 abbreviate a @value{GDBN} option to the first few letters of the
1929 option name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous, and you can also use
1930 the @key{TAB} key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word
1931 in an option (or to show you the alternatives available, if there is
1932 more than one possibility).
1933
1934 @cindex command options, raw input
1935 Some commands take raw input as argument. For example, the print
1936 command processes arbitrary expressions in any of the languages
1937 supported by @value{GDBN}. With such commands, because raw input may
1938 start with a leading dash that would be confused with an option or any
1939 of its abbreviations, e.g.@: @code{print -r} (short for @code{print
1940 -raw} or printing negative @code{r}?), if you specify any command
1941 option, then you must use a double-dash (@code{--}) delimiter to
1942 indicate the end of options.
1943
1944 @cindex command options, boolean
1945
1946 Some options are described as accepting an argument which can be
1947 either @code{on} or @code{off}. These are known as @dfn{boolean
1948 options}. Similarly to boolean settings commands---@code{on} and
1949 @code{off} are the typical values, but any of @code{1}, @code{yes} and
1950 @code{enable} can also be used as ``true'' value, and any of @code{0},
1951 @code{no} and @code{disable} can also be used as ``false'' value. You
1952 can also omit a ``true'' value, as it is implied by default.
1953
1954 For example, these are equivalent:
1955
1956 @smallexample
1957 (@value{GDBP}) print -object on -pretty off -element unlimited -- *myptr
1958 (@value{GDBP}) p -o -p 0 -e u -- *myptr
1959 @end smallexample
1960
1961 You can discover the set of options some command accepts by completing
1962 on @code{-} after the command name. For example:
1963
1964 @smallexample
1965 (@value{GDBP}) print -@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1966 -address -max-depth -repeats -vtbl
1967 -array -null-stop -static-members
1968 -array-indexes -object -symbol
1969 -elements -pretty -union
1970 @end smallexample
1971
1972 Completion will in some cases guide you with a suggestion of what kind
1973 of argument an option expects. For example:
1974
1975 @smallexample
1976 (@value{GDBP}) print -elements @key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1977 NUMBER unlimited
1978 @end smallexample
1979
1980 Here, the option expects a number (e.g., @code{100}), not literal
1981 @code{NUMBER}. Such metasyntactical arguments are always presented in
1982 uppercase.
1983
1984 (For more on using the @code{print} command, see @ref{Data, ,Examining
1985 Data}.)
1986
1987 @node Help
1988 @section Getting Help
1989 @cindex online documentation
1990 @kindex help
1991
1992 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1993 using the command @code{help}.
1994
1995 @table @code
1996 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1997 @item help
1998 @itemx h
1999 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
2000 display a short list of named classes of commands:
2001
2002 @smallexample
2003 (@value{GDBP}) help
2004 List of classes of commands:
2005
2006 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
2007 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2008 data -- Examining data
2009 files -- Specifying and examining files
2010 internals -- Maintenance commands
2011 obscure -- Obscure features
2012 running -- Running the program
2013 stack -- Examining the stack
2014 status -- Status inquiries
2015 support -- Support facilities
2016 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
2017 stopping the program
2018 user-defined -- User-defined commands
2019
2020 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
2021 commands in that class.
2022 Type "help" followed by command name for full
2023 documentation.
2024 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
2025 (@value{GDBP})
2026 @end smallexample
2027 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
2028
2029 @item help @var{class}
2030 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
2031 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
2032 help display for the class @code{status}:
2033
2034 @smallexample
2035 (@value{GDBP}) help status
2036 Status inquiries.
2037
2038 List of commands:
2039
2040 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
2041 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
2042 info -- Generic command for showing things
2043 about the program being debugged
2044 show -- Generic command for showing things
2045 about the debugger
2046
2047 Type "help" followed by command name for full
2048 documentation.
2049 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
2050 (@value{GDBP})
2051 @end smallexample
2052
2053 @item help @var{command}
2054 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
2055 short paragraph on how to use that command.
2056
2057 @kindex apropos
2058 @item apropos [-v] @var{regexp}
2059 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
2060 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
2061 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. The optional flag @samp{-v},
2062 which stands for @samp{verbose}, indicates to output the full documentation
2063 of the matching commands and highlight the parts of the documentation
2064 matching @var{regexp}. For example:
2065
2066 @smallexample
2067 apropos alias
2068 @end smallexample
2069
2070 @noindent
2071 results in:
2072
2073 @smallexample
2074 @group
2075 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
2076 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
2077 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
2078 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
2079 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
2080 @end group
2081 @end smallexample
2082
2083 @noindent
2084 while
2085
2086 @smallexample
2087 apropos -v cut.*thread apply
2088 @end smallexample
2089
2090 @noindent
2091 results in the below output, where @samp{cut for 'thread apply}
2092 is highlighted if styling is enabled.
2093
2094 @smallexample
2095 @group
2096 taas -- Apply a command to all threads (ignoring errors
2097 and empty output).
2098 Usage: taas COMMAND
2099 shortcut for 'thread apply all -s COMMAND'
2100
2101 tfaas -- Apply a command to all frames of all threads
2102 (ignoring errors and empty output).
2103 Usage: tfaas COMMAND
2104 shortcut for 'thread apply all -s frame apply all -s COMMAND'
2105 @end group
2106 @end smallexample
2107
2108 @kindex complete
2109 @item complete @var{args}
2110 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
2111 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
2112 command you want completed. For example:
2113
2114 @smallexample
2115 complete i
2116 @end smallexample
2117
2118 @noindent results in:
2119
2120 @smallexample
2121 @group
2122 if
2123 ignore
2124 info
2125 inspect
2126 @end group
2127 @end smallexample
2128
2129 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
2130 @end table
2131
2132 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
2133 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
2134 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
2135 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
2136 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
2137 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
2138 Index}.
2139
2140 @c @group
2141 @table @code
2142 @kindex info
2143 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
2144 @item info
2145 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
2146 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
2147 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
2148 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
2149 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
2150 @w{@code{help info}}.
2151
2152 @kindex set
2153 @item set
2154 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
2155 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
2156 @code{set prompt $}.
2157
2158 @kindex show
2159 @item show
2160 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
2161 @value{GDBN} itself.
2162 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
2163 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
2164 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
2165 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
2166
2167 @kindex info set
2168 To display all the settable parameters and their current
2169 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
2170 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
2171 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
2172 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
2173 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
2174 @end table
2175 @c @end group
2176
2177 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
2178 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
2179
2180 @table @code
2181 @kindex show version
2182 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
2183 @item show version
2184 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2185 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
2186 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
2187 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
2188 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
2189 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
2190 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2191 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
2192 @value{GDBN}.
2193
2194 @kindex show copying
2195 @kindex info copying
2196 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
2197 @item show copying
2198 @itemx info copying
2199 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
2200
2201 @kindex show warranty
2202 @kindex info warranty
2203 @item show warranty
2204 @itemx info warranty
2205 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
2206 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2207
2208 @kindex show configuration
2209 @item show configuration
2210 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
2211 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
2212 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
2213 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
2214 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
2215 your report.
2216
2217 @end table
2218
2219 @node Running
2220 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
2221
2222 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
2223 debugging information when you compile it.
2224
2225 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
2226 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
2227 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
2228 kill a child process.
2229
2230 @menu
2231 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
2232 * Starting:: Starting your program
2233 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
2234 * Environment:: Your program's environment
2235
2236 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
2237 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
2238 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
2239 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
2240
2241 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
2242 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
2243 * Forks:: Debugging forks
2244 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
2245 @end menu
2246
2247 @node Compilation
2248 @section Compiling for Debugging
2249
2250 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
2251 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
2252 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
2253 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
2254 and addresses in the executable code.
2255
2256 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
2257 the compiler.
2258
2259 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
2260 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2261 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2262 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2263 executables containing debugging information.
2264
2265 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2266 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2267 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2268 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2269 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2270
2271 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2272 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2273 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2274
2275 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2276 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2277 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2278 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2279 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2280 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2281
2282 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2283 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2284 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2285
2286 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2287 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2288 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2289 format in @value{GDBN}.
2290
2291 @need 2000
2292 @node Starting
2293 @section Starting your Program
2294 @cindex starting
2295 @cindex running
2296
2297 @table @code
2298 @kindex run
2299 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2300 @item run
2301 @itemx r
2302 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2303 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2304 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2305 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2306 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2307
2308 @end table
2309
2310 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2311 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2312 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2313 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2314 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2315 message like this one:
2316
2317 @smallexample
2318 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2319 Try "help target" or "continue".
2320 @end smallexample
2321
2322 @noindent
2323 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2324 first (@pxref{load}).
2325
2326 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2327 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2328 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2329 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2330 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2331 divided into four categories:
2332
2333 @table @asis
2334 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2335 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2336 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2337 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2338 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2339 the arguments.
2340 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2341 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2342 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2343 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2344 below for details).
2345
2346 @item The @emph{environment.}
2347 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2348 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2349 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2350 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2351
2352 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2353 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2354 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2355 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2356 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2357 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2358 Directory}.
2359
2360 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2361 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2362 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2363 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2364 set a different device for your program.
2365 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2366
2367 @cindex pipes
2368 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2369 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2370 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2371 wrong program.
2372 @end table
2373
2374 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2375 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2376 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2377 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2378 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2379
2380 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2381 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2382 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2383 your current breakpoints.
2384
2385 @table @code
2386 @kindex start
2387 @item start
2388 @cindex run to main procedure
2389 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2390 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2391 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2392 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2393 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2394 procedure, depending on the language used.
2395
2396 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2397 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2398 the @samp{run} command.
2399
2400 @cindex elaboration phase
2401 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2402 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2403 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2404 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2405 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2406 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2407 will remain to halt execution.
2408
2409 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2410 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2411 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2412 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2413 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2414
2415 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2416 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2417 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2418 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2419 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2420 use the @code{starti} command.
2421
2422 @kindex starti
2423 @item starti
2424 @cindex run to first instruction
2425 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2426 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2427 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2428 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2429 the start of the elaboration phase.
2430
2431 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2432 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2433 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2434 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2435 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2436 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2437 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2438 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2439 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2440 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2441 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2442 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2443
2444 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2445 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2446 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2447 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2448
2449 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2450 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2451 environment:
2452
2453 @smallexample
2454 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2455 (@value{GDBP}) run
2456 @end smallexample
2457
2458 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2459 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2460
2461 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2462 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2463 @item set startup-with-shell
2464 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2465 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2466 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2467 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2468 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2469 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2470 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2471 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2472 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2473 startup failures such as:
2474
2475 @smallexample
2476 (@value{GDBP}) run
2477 Starting program: ./a.out
2478 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2483 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2484 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2485 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2486 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2487 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2488
2489 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2490 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2491 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2492 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2493 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2494 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2495
2496 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2497 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2498 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2499 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2500 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2501 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2502
2503 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2504 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2505 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2506
2507 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2508 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2509
2510 @smallexample
2511 (@value{GDBP}) run
2512 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2513 @end smallexample
2514
2515 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2516 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2517
2518 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2519 @code{target native} command. For example,
2520
2521 @smallexample
2522 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2523 (@value{GDBP}) run
2524 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2525 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2526 (@value{GDBP}) run
2527 Starting program: ./a.out
2528 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2529 @end smallexample
2530
2531 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2532 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2533 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2534 disconnect.
2535
2536 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2537 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2538 proc}, @code{info os}.
2539
2540 @kindex set disable-randomization
2541 @item set disable-randomization
2542 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2543 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2544 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2545 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2546 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2547
2548 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2549 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2550
2551 @smallexample
2552 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2553 @end smallexample
2554
2555 @item set disable-randomization off
2556 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2557 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2558 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2559 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2560 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2561 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2562
2563 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2564 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2565 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2566 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2567 a code at its expected addresses.
2568
2569 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2570 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2571 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2572 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2573 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2574 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2575 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2576 a randomly chosen address.
2577
2578 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2579 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2580 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2581 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2582 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2583
2584 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2585 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2586
2587 @item show disable-randomization
2588 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2589 the virtual address space of the started program.
2590
2591 @end table
2592
2593 @node Arguments
2594 @section Your Program's Arguments
2595
2596 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2597 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2598 @code{run} command.
2599 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2600 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2601 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2602 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2603 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2604
2605 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2606 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2607 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2608 the program, not by the shell.
2609
2610 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2611 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2612
2613 @table @code
2614 @kindex set args
2615 @item set args
2616 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2617 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2618 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2619 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2620 it again without arguments.
2621
2622 @kindex show args
2623 @item show args
2624 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2625 @end table
2626
2627 @node Environment
2628 @section Your Program's Environment
2629
2630 @cindex environment (of your program)
2631 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2632 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2633 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2634 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2635 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2636 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2637 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2638
2639 @table @code
2640 @kindex path
2641 @item path @var{directory}
2642 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2643 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2644 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2645 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2646 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2647 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2648 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2649
2650 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2651 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2652 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2653 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2654 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2655 @var{directory} to the search path.
2656 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2657 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2658
2659 @kindex show paths
2660 @item show paths
2661 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2662 environment variable).
2663
2664 @kindex show environment
2665 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2666 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2667 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2668 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2669 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2670
2671 @kindex set environment
2672 @anchor{set environment}
2673 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2674 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2675 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2676 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2677 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2678 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2679 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2680 null value.
2681 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2682 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2683
2684 For example, this command:
2685
2686 @smallexample
2687 set env USER = foo
2688 @end smallexample
2689
2690 @noindent
2691 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2692 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2693 are not actually required.)
2694
2695 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2696 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2697 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2698 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2699 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2700
2701 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2702 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2703 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2704
2705 @kindex unset environment
2706 @anchor{unset environment}
2707 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2708 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2709 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2710 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2711 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2712
2713 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2714 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2715 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2716 @end table
2717
2718 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2719 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2720 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2721 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2722 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2723 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2724 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2725 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2726 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2727 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2728
2729 @node Working Directory
2730 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2731
2732 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2733 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2734 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2735 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2736 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2737 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2738 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2739 debugging.
2740
2741 @table @code
2742 @kindex set cwd
2743 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2744 @anchor{set cwd command}
2745 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2746 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2747 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2748 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2749 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2750 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2751 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2752 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2753 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2754 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2755 fallback.
2756
2757 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2758 the @code{cd} command.
2759 @xref{cd command}.
2760
2761 @kindex show cwd
2762 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2763 @item show cwd
2764 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2765 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2766 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2767
2768 @kindex cd
2769 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2770 @anchor{cd command}
2771 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2772 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2773 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2774
2775 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2776 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2777 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2778 @xref{set cwd command}.
2779
2780 @kindex pwd
2781 @item pwd
2782 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2783 @end table
2784
2785 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2786 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2787 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2788 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2789 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2790 current working directory of the debuggee.
2791
2792 @node Input/Output
2793 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2794
2795 @cindex redirection
2796 @cindex i/o
2797 @cindex terminal
2798 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2799 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2800 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2801 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2802 running your program.
2803
2804 @table @code
2805 @kindex info terminal
2806 @item info terminal
2807 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2808 program is using.
2809 @end table
2810
2811 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2812 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2813
2814 @smallexample
2815 run > outfile
2816 @end smallexample
2817
2818 @noindent
2819 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2820
2821 @kindex tty
2822 @cindex controlling terminal
2823 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2824 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2825 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2826 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2827 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2828
2829 @smallexample
2830 tty /dev/ttyb
2831 @end smallexample
2832
2833 @noindent
2834 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2835 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2836 that as their controlling terminal.
2837
2838 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2839 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2840 terminal.
2841
2842 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2843 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2844 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2845 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2846
2847 @cindex inferior tty
2848 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2849 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2850 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2851 program.
2852
2853 @table @code
2854 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2855 @kindex set inferior-tty
2856 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2857 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2858 @value{GDBN}.
2859
2860 @item show inferior-tty
2861 @kindex show inferior-tty
2862 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2863 @end table
2864
2865 @node Attach
2866 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2867 @kindex attach
2868 @cindex attach
2869
2870 @table @code
2871 @item attach @var{process-id}
2872 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2873 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2874 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2875 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2876 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2877
2878 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2879 executing the command.
2880 @end table
2881
2882 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2883 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2884 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2885 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2886
2887 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2888 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2889 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2890 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2891 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2892 Specify Files}.
2893
2894 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2895 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2896 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2897 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2898 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2899 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2900 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2901
2902 @table @code
2903 @kindex detach
2904 @item detach
2905 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2906 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2907 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2908 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2909 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2910 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2911 executing the command.
2912 @end table
2913
2914 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2915 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2916 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2917 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2918 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2919 Messages}).
2920
2921 @node Kill Process
2922 @section Killing the Child Process
2923
2924 @table @code
2925 @kindex kill
2926 @item kill
2927 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2928 @end table
2929
2930 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2931 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2932 is running.
2933
2934 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2935 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2936 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2937 outside the debugger.
2938
2939 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2940 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2941 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2942 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2943 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2944 breakpoint settings).
2945
2946 @node Inferiors and Programs
2947 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2948
2949 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2950 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2951 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2952 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2953 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2954 from multiple executables.
2955
2956 @cindex inferior
2957 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2958 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2959 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2960 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2961 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2962 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2963 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2964 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2965 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2966 threads running in it.
2967
2968 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2969 inferiors}}:
2970
2971 @table @code
2972 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2973 @item info inferiors
2974 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2975 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2976 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2977 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2978
2979 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2980
2981 @enumerate
2982 @item
2983 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2984
2985 @item
2986 the target system's inferior identifier
2987
2988 @item
2989 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2990
2991 @end enumerate
2992
2993 @noindent
2994 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2995 indicates the current inferior.
2996
2997 For example,
2998 @end table
2999 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3000
3001 @smallexample
3002 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3003 Num Description Executable
3004 2 process 2307 hello
3005 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
3006 @end smallexample
3007
3008 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
3009
3010 @table @code
3011 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
3012 @item inferior @var{infno}
3013 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
3014 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
3015 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
3016 @end table
3017
3018 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
3019 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
3020 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
3021 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
3022 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
3023 information on convenience variables.
3024
3025 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
3026 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
3027 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
3028 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
3029 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
3030 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
3031
3032 @table @code
3033 @kindex add-inferior
3034 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
3035 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
3036 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
3037 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
3038 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
3039 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
3040
3041 @kindex clone-inferior
3042 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
3043 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
3044 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
3045 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
3046 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
3047
3048 @smallexample
3049 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3050 Num Description Executable
3051 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
3052 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
3053 Added inferior 2.
3054 1 inferiors added.
3055 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3056 Num Description Executable
3057 2 <null> helloworld
3058 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
3059 @end smallexample
3060
3061 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
3062
3063 @kindex remove-inferiors
3064 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3065 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
3066 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
3067 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
3068
3069 @end table
3070
3071 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
3072 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
3073 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
3074 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
3075
3076 @table @code
3077 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3078 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
3079 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
3080 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
3081 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
3082 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
3083
3084 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3085 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3086 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
3087 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
3088 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
3089 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
3090 @end table
3091
3092 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
3093 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
3094 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
3095 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
3096
3097
3098 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
3099 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
3100
3101 @table @code
3102 @kindex set print inferior-events
3103 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
3104 @item set print inferior-events
3105 @itemx set print inferior-events on
3106 @itemx set print inferior-events off
3107 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
3108 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
3109 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
3110 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
3111
3112 @kindex show print inferior-events
3113 @item show print inferior-events
3114 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
3115 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
3116 @end table
3117
3118 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
3119 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
3120 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
3121
3122
3123 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
3124 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
3125 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
3126 info program-spaces}} command.
3127
3128 @table @code
3129 @kindex maint info program-spaces
3130 @item maint info program-spaces
3131 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
3132 @value{GDBN}.
3133
3134 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
3135
3136 @enumerate
3137 @item
3138 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3139
3140 @item
3141 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
3142 the @code{file} command.
3143
3144 @end enumerate
3145
3146 @noindent
3147 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
3148 indicates the current program space.
3149
3150 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
3151 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
3152 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
3153
3154 @smallexample
3155 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
3156 Id Executable
3157 * 1 hello
3158 2 goodbye
3159 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
3160 @end smallexample
3161
3162 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
3163 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
3164 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
3165 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
3166 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
3167
3168 @smallexample
3169 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
3170 Id Executable
3171 * 1 vfork-test
3172 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
3173 @end smallexample
3174
3175 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
3176 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
3177 @end table
3178
3179 @node Threads
3180 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
3181
3182 @cindex threads of execution
3183 @cindex multiple threads
3184 @cindex switching threads
3185 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
3186 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
3187 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
3188 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
3189 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
3190 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
3191 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
3192
3193 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
3194 programs:
3195
3196 @itemize @bullet
3197 @item automatic notification of new threads
3198 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
3199 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
3200 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
3201 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
3202 @item thread-specific breakpoints
3203 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
3204 messages on thread start and exit.
3205 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
3206 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
3207 isn't compatible with the program.
3208 @end itemize
3209
3210 @cindex focus of debugging
3211 @cindex current thread
3212 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
3213 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
3214 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
3215 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
3216 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
3217
3218 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
3219 @cindex thread identifier (system)
3220 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
3221 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
3222 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
3223 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
3224 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
3225 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
3226 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
3227 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
3228
3229 @smallexample
3230 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
3231 @end smallexample
3232
3233 @noindent
3234 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
3235 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
3236 further qualifier.
3237
3238 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
3239 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
3240 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
3241 @c program?
3242 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
3243 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
3244 @c threads ab initio?
3245
3246 @anchor{thread numbers}
3247 @cindex thread number, per inferior
3248 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
3249 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
3250 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
3251 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
3252 between threads of different inferiors.
3253
3254 @cindex qualified thread ID
3255 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
3256 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
3257 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
3258 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
3259 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
3260 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3261 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3262 inferior.
3263
3264 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3265 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3266 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3267 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3268
3269 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3270 @cindex thread ID lists
3271 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3272 argument. A list element can be:
3273
3274 @enumerate
3275 @item
3276 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3277 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3278 @samp{1}.
3279
3280 @item
3281 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3282 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3283 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3284
3285 @item
3286 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3287 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3288 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3289 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3290 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3291
3292 @end enumerate
3293
3294 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3295 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3296 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3297 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3298 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3299 7.1}.
3300
3301
3302 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3303 @cindex global thread number
3304 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3305 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3306 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3307 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3308 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3309 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3310
3311 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3312 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3313 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3314
3315 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3316 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3317 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3318 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3319 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3320 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3321 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3322 general information on convenience variables.
3323
3324 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3325 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3326 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3327
3328 @smallexample
3329 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3330 @end smallexample
3331
3332 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3333
3334 @smallexample
3335 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3336 @end smallexample
3337
3338 @table @code
3339 @kindex info threads
3340 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3341
3342 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3343 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3344 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3345 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3346
3347 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3348
3349 @enumerate
3350 @item
3351 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3352
3353 @item
3354 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3355 option was specified
3356
3357 @item
3358 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3359
3360 @item
3361 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3362 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3363 program itself.
3364
3365 @item
3366 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3367 @end enumerate
3368
3369 @noindent
3370 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3371 indicates the current thread.
3372
3373 For example,
3374 @end table
3375 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3376
3377 @smallexample
3378 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3379 Id Target Id Frame
3380 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3381 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3382 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3383 at threadtest.c:68
3384 @end smallexample
3385
3386 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3387 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3388 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3389
3390 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3391 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3392
3393 @smallexample
3394 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3395 Id GId Target Id Frame
3396 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3397 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3398 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3399 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3400 @end smallexample
3401
3402 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3403 Solaris-specific command:
3404
3405 @table @code
3406 @item maint info sol-threads
3407 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3408 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3409 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3410 @end table
3411
3412 @table @code
3413 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3414 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3415 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3416 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3417 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3418 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3419
3420 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3421 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3422
3423 @smallexample
3424 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3425 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3426 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3427 8 printf ("hello\n");
3428 @end smallexample
3429
3430 @noindent
3431 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3432 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3433 threads.
3434
3435 @anchor{thread apply all}
3436 @kindex thread apply
3437 @cindex apply command to several threads
3438 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3439 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3440 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3441 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3442 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3443 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3444 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3445 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3446
3447 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3448 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3449 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3450 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3451 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3452
3453 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3454 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3455 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3456 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3457
3458 @table @code
3459 @item -c
3460 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3461 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3462 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3463 @item -s
3464 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3465 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3466 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3467 are not printed.
3468 @item -q
3469 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3470 information.
3471 @end table
3472
3473 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3474
3475 @kindex taas
3476 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3477 @item taas [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}
3478 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}}.
3479 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3480
3481 The @code{taas} command accepts the same options as the @code{thread
3482 apply all} command. @xref{thread apply all}.
3483
3484 @kindex tfaas
3485 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3486 @item tfaas [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}
3487 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s -- frame apply all -s [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}}.
3488 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3489 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3490 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3491 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3492 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3493 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3494 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3495
3496 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3497 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3498 is, using:
3499 @smallexample
3500 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3501 @end smallexample
3502
3503 The @code{tfaas} command accepts the same options as the @code{frame
3504 apply} command. @xref{frame apply}.
3505
3506 @kindex thread name
3507 @cindex name a thread
3508 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3509 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3510 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3511 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3512
3513 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3514 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3515 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3516 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3517 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3518
3519 @kindex thread find
3520 @cindex search for a thread
3521 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3522 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3523 matches the supplied regular expression.
3524
3525 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3526 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3527 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3528 is the LWP id.
3529
3530 @smallexample
3531 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3532 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3533 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3534 Id Target Id Frame
3535 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3536 @end smallexample
3537
3538 @kindex set print thread-events
3539 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3540 @item set print thread-events
3541 @itemx set print thread-events on
3542 @itemx set print thread-events off
3543 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3544 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3545 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3546 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3547 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3548
3549 @kindex show print thread-events
3550 @item show print thread-events
3551 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3552 have started and exited.
3553 @end table
3554
3555 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3556 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3557 programs with multiple threads.
3558
3559 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3560 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3561
3562 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3563 @table @code
3564 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3565 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3566 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3567 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3568 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3569 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3570 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3571 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3572 macro.
3573
3574 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3575 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3576 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3577 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3578 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3579 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3580
3581 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3582 refers to the default system directories that are
3583 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3584 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3585 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3586
3587 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3588 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3589 was loaded in the inferior process.
3590
3591 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3592 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3593 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3594 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3595 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3596 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3597 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3598
3599 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3600 only on some platforms.
3601
3602 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3603 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3604 Display current libthread_db search path.
3605
3606 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3607 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3608 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3609 @item set debug libthread-db
3610 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3611 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3612 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3613 @end table
3614
3615 @node Forks
3616 @section Debugging Forks
3617
3618 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3619 @cindex multiple processes
3620 @cindex processes, multiple
3621 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3622 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3623 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3624 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3625 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3626 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3627 will cause it to terminate.
3628
3629 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3630 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3631 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3632 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3633 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3634 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3635 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3636 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3637 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3638 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3639
3640 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3641 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3642 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3643 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3644
3645 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3646 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3647 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3648
3649 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3650 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3651
3652 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3653 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3654
3655 @table @code
3656 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3657 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3658 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3659 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3660 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3661
3662 @table @code
3663 @item parent
3664 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3665 unimpeded. This is the default.
3666
3667 @item child
3668 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3669 unimpeded.
3670
3671 @end table
3672
3673 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3674 @item show follow-fork-mode
3675 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3676 @end table
3677
3678 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3679 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3680 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3681
3682 @table @code
3683 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3684 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3685 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3686 retain debugger control over them both.
3687
3688 @table @code
3689 @item on
3690 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3691 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3692 independently. This is the default.
3693
3694 @item off
3695 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3696 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3697 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3698 is held suspended.
3699
3700 @end table
3701
3702 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3703 @item show detach-on-fork
3704 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3705 @end table
3706
3707 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3708 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3709 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3710 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3711 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3712 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3713
3714 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3715 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3716 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3717 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3718 and Programs}.
3719
3720 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3721 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3722 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3723 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3724 the child process's @code{main}.
3725
3726 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3727 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3728
3729 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3730 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3731 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3732 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3733 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3734 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3735 command.
3736
3737 @table @code
3738 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3739 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3740
3741 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3742 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3743
3744 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3745
3746 @table @code
3747 @item new
3748 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3749 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3750 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3751 original inferior.
3752
3753 For example:
3754
3755 @smallexample
3756 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3757 (gdb) info inferior
3758 Id Description Executable
3759 * 1 <null> prog1
3760 (@value{GDBP}) run
3761 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3762 Program exited normally.
3763 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3764 Id Description Executable
3765 1 <null> prog1
3766 * 2 <null> prog2
3767 @end smallexample
3768
3769 @item same
3770 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3771 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3772 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3773 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3774 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3775
3776 For example:
3777
3778 @smallexample
3779 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3780 Id Description Executable
3781 * 1 <null> prog1
3782 (@value{GDBP}) run
3783 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3784 Program exited normally.
3785 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3786 Id Description Executable
3787 * 1 <null> prog2
3788 @end smallexample
3789
3790 @end table
3791 @end table
3792
3793 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3794 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3795
3796 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3797 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3798 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3799
3800 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3801 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3802
3803 @cindex checkpoint
3804 @cindex restart
3805 @cindex bookmark
3806 @cindex snapshot of a process
3807 @cindex rewind program state
3808
3809 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3810 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3811 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3812 later.
3813
3814 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3815 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3816 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3817 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3818 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3819
3820 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3821 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3822 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3823 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3824 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3825 start again from there.
3826
3827 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3828 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3829
3830 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3831
3832 @table @code
3833 @kindex checkpoint
3834 @item checkpoint
3835 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3836 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3837 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3838
3839 @kindex info checkpoints
3840 @item info checkpoints
3841 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3842 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3843 listed:
3844
3845 @table @code
3846 @item Checkpoint ID
3847 @item Process ID
3848 @item Code Address
3849 @item Source line, or label
3850 @end table
3851
3852 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3853 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3854 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3855 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3856 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3857 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3858 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3859
3860 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3861 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3862 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3863 the debugger.
3864
3865 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3866 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3867 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3868
3869 @end table
3870
3871 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3872 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3873 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3874 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3875 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3876 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3877 previously read data can be read again.
3878
3879 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3880 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3881 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3882 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3883 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3884 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3885
3886 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3887 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3888 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3889 different execution path this time.
3890
3891 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3892 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3893 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3894 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3895 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3896 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3897 potentially pose a problem.
3898
3899 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3900
3901 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3902 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3903 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3904 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3905 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3906 next.
3907
3908 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3909 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3910 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3911 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3912 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3913
3914 @node Stopping
3915 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3916
3917 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3918 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3919 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3920
3921 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3922 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3923 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3924 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3925 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3926 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3927 explicitly request this information at any time.
3928
3929 @table @code
3930 @kindex info program
3931 @item info program
3932 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3933 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3934 @end table
3935
3936 @menu
3937 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3938 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3939 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3940 Skipping over functions and files
3941 * Signals:: Signals
3942 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3943 @end menu
3944
3945 @node Breakpoints
3946 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3947
3948 @cindex breakpoints
3949 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3950 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3951 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3952 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3953 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3954 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3955 program.
3956
3957 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3958 the executable is run.
3959
3960 @cindex watchpoints
3961 @cindex data breakpoints
3962 @cindex memory tracing
3963 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3964 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3965 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3966 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3967 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3968 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3969 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3970 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3971 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3972 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3973 same commands.
3974
3975 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3976 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3977 Automatic Display}.
3978
3979 @cindex catchpoints
3980 @cindex breakpoint on events
3981 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3982 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3983 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3984 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3985 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3986 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3987 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3988
3989 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3990 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3991 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3992 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3993 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3994 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3995 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3996 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3997 enable it again.
3998
3999 @cindex breakpoint ranges
4000 @cindex breakpoint lists
4001 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
4002 @cindex lists of breakpoints
4003 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
4004 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
4005 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
4006 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
4007 are operated on.
4008
4009 @menu
4010 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
4011 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
4012 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
4013 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
4014 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
4015 * Conditions:: Break conditions
4016 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
4017 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
4018 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
4019 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
4020 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4021 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4022 @end menu
4023
4024 @node Set Breaks
4025 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
4026
4027 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
4028 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
4029 @c
4030 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
4031
4032 @kindex break
4033 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
4034 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
4035 @cindex latest breakpoint
4036 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
4037 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
4038 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
4039 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
4040 convenience variables.
4041
4042 @table @code
4043 @item break @var{location}
4044 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
4045 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
4046 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
4047 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
4048 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
4049
4050 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
4051 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
4052 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
4053 that situation.
4054
4055 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
4056 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
4057 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
4058
4059 @item break
4060 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
4061 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
4062 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
4063 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
4064 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
4065 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
4066 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
4067 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
4068 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
4069 inside loops.
4070
4071 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
4072 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
4073 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
4074 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
4075 existed when your program stopped.
4076
4077 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
4078 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
4079 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
4080 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
4081 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
4082 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
4083 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
4084
4085 @kindex tbreak
4086 @item tbreak @var{args}
4087 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
4088 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
4089 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
4090 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
4091
4092 @kindex hbreak
4093 @cindex hardware breakpoints
4094 @item hbreak @var{args}
4095 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
4096 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
4097 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
4098 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
4099 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
4100 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
4101 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
4102 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
4103 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
4104 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
4105 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
4106 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
4107 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
4108 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
4109 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
4110 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4111 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4112 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4113
4114 @kindex thbreak
4115 @item thbreak @var{args}
4116 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
4117 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
4118 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
4119 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
4120 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
4121 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
4122 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
4123 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
4124
4125 @kindex rbreak
4126 @cindex regular expression
4127 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
4128 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
4129 @item rbreak @var{regex}
4130 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
4131 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
4132 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
4133 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
4134 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
4135 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
4136
4137 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
4138 to print the list of all breakpoints it sets according to the
4139 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
4140 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
4141 language of the breakpoint's function, other values mean to use
4142 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
4143
4144 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
4145 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
4146 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
4147 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
4148 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
4149 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
4150
4151 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
4152 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
4153 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
4154 classes.
4155
4156 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
4157 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
4158 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
4159
4160 @smallexample
4161 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
4162 @end smallexample
4163
4164 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
4165 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
4166 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
4167 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
4168 every function in a given file:
4169
4170 @smallexample
4171 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
4172 @end smallexample
4173
4174 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
4175 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
4176
4177 @kindex info breakpoints
4178 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
4179 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4180 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4181 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
4182 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
4183 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
4184 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
4185
4186 @table @emph
4187 @item Breakpoint Numbers
4188 @item Type
4189 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
4190 @item Disposition
4191 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
4192 @item Enabled or Disabled
4193 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
4194 that are not enabled.
4195 @item Address
4196 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
4197 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
4198 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
4199 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
4200 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
4201 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
4202 @item What
4203 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
4204 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
4205 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
4206 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
4207 @end table
4208
4209 @noindent
4210 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
4211 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
4212 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
4213 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
4214 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
4215 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
4216
4217 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
4218 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
4219 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
4220 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
4221
4222 @noindent
4223 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
4224 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
4225 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
4226 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
4227 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
4228
4229 @noindent
4230 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
4231 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
4232 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
4233 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
4234 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
4235 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
4236
4237 @noindent
4238 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
4239 @code{info break} also displays that count.
4240
4241 @end table
4242
4243 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
4244 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
4245 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
4246 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4247
4248 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
4249 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
4250 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
4251 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
4252
4253 @itemize @bullet
4254 @item
4255 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
4256
4257 @item
4258 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
4259 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
4260
4261 @item
4262 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
4263 correspond to any number of instantiations.
4264
4265 @item
4266 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
4267 several places where that function is inlined.
4268 @end itemize
4269
4270 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
4271 the relevant locations.
4272
4273 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4274 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4275 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4276 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4277 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4278 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4279 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4280
4281 For example:
4282
4283 @smallexample
4284 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4285 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4286 stop only if i==1
4287 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4288 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4289 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4290 @end smallexample
4291
4292 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4293 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4294 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4295 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4296 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4297 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4298 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4299 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4300 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4301 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4302 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4303
4304 @cindex pending breakpoints
4305 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4306 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4307 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4308 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4309 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4310 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4311 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4312 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4313 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4314 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4315 is not yet resolved.
4316
4317 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4318 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4319 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4320 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4321 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4322 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4323
4324 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4325 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4326 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4327 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4328
4329 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4330 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4331 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4332
4333 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4334 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4335 address specification to an address:
4336
4337 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4338 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4339 @table @code
4340 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4341 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4342 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4343
4344 @item set breakpoint pending on
4345 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4346 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4347
4348 @item set breakpoint pending off
4349 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4350 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4351 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4352
4353 @item show breakpoint pending
4354 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4355 @end table
4356
4357 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4358 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4359 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4360
4361 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4362 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4363 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4364 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4365 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4366 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4367 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4368 breakpoints.
4369
4370 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4371
4372 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4373 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4374 @table @code
4375 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4376 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4377 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4378 breakpoint must be used.
4379
4380 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4381 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4382 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4383 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4384 @end table
4385
4386 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4387 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4388 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4389 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4390 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4391 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4392 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4393 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4394 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4395
4396 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4397 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4398 @table @code
4399 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4400 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4401 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4402 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4403
4404 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4405 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4406 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4407 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4408 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4409 @end table
4410
4411 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4412 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4413 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4414
4415 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4416 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4417
4418 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4419
4420 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4421 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4422 @table @code
4423 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4424 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4425 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4426 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4427 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4428
4429 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4430 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4431 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4432 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4433 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4434 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4435 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4436 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4437 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4438 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4439 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4440 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4441 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4442
4443 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4444 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4445 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4446 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4447 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4448 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4449 @end table
4450
4451
4452 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4453 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4454 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4455 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4456 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4457 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4458 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4459 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4460
4461
4462 @node Set Watchpoints
4463 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4464
4465 @cindex setting watchpoints
4466 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4467 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4468 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4469 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4470 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4471
4472 @itemize @bullet
4473 @item
4474 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4475
4476 @item
4477 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4478 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4479 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4480
4481 @item
4482 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4483 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4484 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4485 @end itemize
4486
4487 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4488 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4489 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4490 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4491 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4492 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4493 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4494 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4495 the expression changes.
4496
4497 @cindex software watchpoints
4498 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4499 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4500 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4501 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4502 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4503 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4504 culprit.)
4505
4506 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4507 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4508 slow down the running of your program.
4509
4510 @table @code
4511 @kindex watch
4512 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4513 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4514 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4515 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4516 to watch the value of a single variable:
4517
4518 @smallexample
4519 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4520 @end smallexample
4521
4522 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4523 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4524 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4525 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4526 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4527 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4528
4529 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4530 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4531 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4532 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4533 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4534 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4535 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4536 error.
4537
4538 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4539 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4540 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4541 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4542 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4543 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4544 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4545 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4546 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4547 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4548 Examples:
4549
4550 @smallexample
4551 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4552 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4553 @end smallexample
4554
4555 @kindex rwatch
4556 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4557 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4558 by the program.
4559
4560 @kindex awatch
4561 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4562 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4563 or written into by the program.
4564
4565 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4566 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4567 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4568 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4569 @end table
4570
4571 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4572 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4573 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4574 a never-changing value:
4575
4576 @smallexample
4577 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4578 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4579 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4580 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4581 @end smallexample
4582
4583 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4584 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4585 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4586 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4587 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4588 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4589
4590 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4591 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4592 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4593 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4594 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4595 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4596 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4597 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4598
4599 @table @code
4600 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4601 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4602 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4603
4604 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4605 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4606 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4607 @end table
4608
4609 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4610 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4611 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4612
4613 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4614
4615 @smallexample
4616 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4617 @end smallexample
4618
4619 @noindent
4620 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4621
4622 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4623 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4624 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4625 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4626 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4627 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4628 will print a message like this:
4629
4630 @smallexample
4631 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4632 @end smallexample
4633
4634 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4635 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4636 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4637 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4638 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4639 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4640 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4641 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4642
4643 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4644 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4645 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4646 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4647 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4648 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4649
4650 @smallexample
4651 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4652 @end smallexample
4653
4654 @noindent
4655 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4656
4657 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4658 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4659 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4660 expression with separately allocated resources.
4661
4662 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4663 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4664 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4665
4666 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4667 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4668 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4669 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4670 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4671 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4672 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4673 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4674 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4675
4676 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4677 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4678 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4679 watched expression from every thread.
4680
4681 @quotation
4682 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4683 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4684 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4685 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4686 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4687 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4688 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4689 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4690 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4691 @end quotation
4692
4693 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4694
4695 @node Set Catchpoints
4696 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4697 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4698 @cindex exception handlers
4699 @cindex event handling
4700
4701 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4702 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4703 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4704
4705 @table @code
4706 @kindex catch
4707 @item catch @var{event}
4708 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4709
4710 @table @code
4711 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4712 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4713 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4714 @kindex catch throw
4715 @kindex catch rethrow
4716 @kindex catch catch
4717 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4718 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4719
4720 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4721 regular expression will be caught.
4722
4723 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4724 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4725 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4726 exception being thrown.
4727
4728 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4729 @value{GDBN}:
4730
4731 @itemize @bullet
4732 @item
4733 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4734 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4735 supported.
4736
4737 @item
4738 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4739 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4740 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4741 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4742 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4743 built.
4744
4745 @item
4746 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4747 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4748
4749 @item
4750 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4751 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4752 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4753 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4754
4755 @item
4756 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4757 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4758 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4759 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4760 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4761 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4762 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4763 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4764 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4765
4766 @item
4767 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4768
4769 @item
4770 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4771 @end itemize
4772
4773 @item exception @r{[}@var{name}@r{]}
4774 @kindex catch exception
4775 @cindex Ada exception catching
4776 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4777 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4778 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4779 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4780 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4781
4782 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4783 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4784 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4785 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4786 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4787 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4788 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4789 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4790
4791 @vindex $_ada_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4792 The convenience variable @code{$_ada_exception} holds the address of
4793 the exception being thrown. This can be useful when setting a
4794 condition for such a catchpoint.
4795
4796 @item exception unhandled
4797 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4798 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program. The
4799 convenience variable @code{$_ada_exception} is set as for @code{catch
4800 exception}.
4801
4802 @item handlers @r{[}@var{name}@r{]}
4803 @kindex catch handlers
4804 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4805 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4806 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4807 specified at the end of the command
4808 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4809 only when this specific exception is handled.
4810 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4811
4812 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4813 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4814 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4815 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4816 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4817 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4818 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4819 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4820 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4821
4822 The convenience variable @code{$_ada_exception} is set as for
4823 @code{catch exception}.
4824
4825 @item assert
4826 @kindex catch assert
4827 A failed Ada assertion. Note that the convenience variable
4828 @code{$_ada_exception} is @emph{not} set by this catchpoint.
4829
4830 @item exec
4831 @kindex catch exec
4832 @cindex break on fork/exec
4833 A call to @code{exec}.
4834
4835 @anchor{catch syscall}
4836 @item syscall
4837 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4838 @kindex catch syscall
4839 @cindex break on a system call.
4840 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4841 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4842 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4843 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4844 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4845 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4846 will be caught.
4847
4848 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4849 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4850 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4851 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4852
4853 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4854 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4855 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4856 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4857
4858 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4859 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4860 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4861 available choices.
4862
4863 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4864 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4865 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4866 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4867 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4868 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4869 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4870 behind the OS upgrades).
4871
4872 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4873 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4874 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4875 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4876 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4877 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4878 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4879 syscall groups available on your environment.
4880
4881 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4882 arguments to it:
4883
4884 @smallexample
4885 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4886 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4887 (@value{GDBP}) r
4888 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4889
4890 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4891 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4892 (@value{GDBP}) c
4893 Continuing.
4894
4895 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4896 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4897 (@value{GDBP})
4898 @end smallexample
4899
4900 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4901
4902 @smallexample
4903 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4904 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4905 (@value{GDBP}) r
4906 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4907
4908 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4909 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4910 (@value{GDBP}) c
4911 Continuing.
4912
4913 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4914 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4915 (@value{GDBP})
4916 @end smallexample
4917
4918 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4919 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4920 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4921
4922 @smallexample
4923 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4924 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4925 (@value{GDBP}) r
4926 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4927
4928 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4929 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4930 (@value{GDBP}) c
4931 Continuing.
4932
4933 Program exited normally.
4934 (@value{GDBP})
4935 @end smallexample
4936
4937 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4938
4939 @smallexample
4940 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4941 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4942 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4943 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4944 (@value{GDBP}) r
4945 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4946
4947 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4948 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4949
4950 (@value{GDBP}) c
4951 Continuing.
4952 @end smallexample
4953
4954 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4955 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4956 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4957 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4958
4959 @smallexample
4960 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4961 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4962 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4963 (@value{GDBP})
4964 @end smallexample
4965
4966 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4967 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4968 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4969 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4970 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4971 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4972
4973 @smallexample
4974 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4975 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4976 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4977 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4978 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4979 (@value{GDBP})
4980 @end smallexample
4981
4982 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4983
4984 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4985 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4986
4987 @smallexample
4988 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4989 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4990 @end smallexample
4991
4992 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4993
4994 @item fork
4995 @kindex catch fork
4996 A call to @code{fork}.
4997
4998 @item vfork
4999 @kindex catch vfork
5000 A call to @code{vfork}.
5001
5002 @item load @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
5003 @itemx unload @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
5004 @kindex catch load
5005 @kindex catch unload
5006 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
5007 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
5008 matches one of the affected libraries.
5009
5010 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5011 @kindex catch signal
5012 The delivery of a signal.
5013
5014 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
5015 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
5016 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
5017
5018 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
5019 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
5020 signal names.
5021
5022 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
5023 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
5024 will be caught.
5025
5026 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
5027 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
5028 catchpoint.
5029
5030 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
5031 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
5032 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
5033 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
5034 commands.
5035
5036 @end table
5037
5038 @item tcatch @var{event}
5039 @kindex tcatch
5040 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
5041 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
5042
5043 @end table
5044
5045 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
5046
5047
5048 @node Delete Breaks
5049 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
5050
5051 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
5052 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
5053 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
5054 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
5055 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
5056 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
5057
5058 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
5059 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
5060 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
5061 their breakpoint numbers.
5062
5063 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
5064 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
5065 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
5066
5067 @table @code
5068 @kindex clear
5069 @item clear
5070 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
5071 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
5072 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
5073 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
5074
5075 @item clear @var{location}
5076 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
5077 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
5078 most useful ones are listed below:
5079
5080 @table @code
5081 @item clear @var{function}
5082 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
5083 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
5084
5085 @item clear @var{linenum}
5086 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5087 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
5088 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
5089 @end table
5090
5091 @cindex delete breakpoints
5092 @kindex delete
5093 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
5094 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5095 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
5096 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
5097 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
5098 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
5099 @end table
5100
5101 @node Disabling
5102 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
5103
5104 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
5105 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
5106 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
5107 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
5108 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
5109
5110 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
5111 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
5112 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
5113 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
5114 do not know which numbers to use.
5115
5116 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
5117 affects all of its locations.
5118
5119 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
5120 different states of enablement:
5121
5122 @itemize @bullet
5123 @item
5124 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
5125 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
5126 @item
5127 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
5128 @item
5129 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
5130 disabled.
5131 @item
5132 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
5133 N times, then becomes disabled.
5134 @item
5135 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
5136 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
5137 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
5138 @end itemize
5139
5140 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
5141 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
5142
5143 @table @code
5144 @kindex disable
5145 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
5146 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5147 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
5148 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
5149 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
5150 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
5151 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
5152
5153 @kindex enable
5154 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5155 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
5156 become effective once again in stopping your program.
5157
5158 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
5159 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
5160 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
5161
5162 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
5163 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
5164 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
5165 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
5166 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
5167 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
5168 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
5169
5170 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
5171 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
5172 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
5173 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
5174 @end table
5175
5176 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
5177 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
5178 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
5179 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
5180 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
5181 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
5182 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
5183 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
5184 Stepping}.)
5185
5186 @node Conditions
5187 @subsection Break Conditions
5188 @cindex conditional breakpoints
5189 @cindex breakpoint conditions
5190
5191 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5192 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
5193 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
5194 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
5195 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
5196 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
5197 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
5198 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
5199
5200 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
5201 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
5202 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
5203 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
5204 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
5205
5206 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
5207 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
5208 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
5209 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
5210 one.
5211
5212 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
5213 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
5214 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
5215 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
5216 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
5217 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
5218 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
5219 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
5220 conditions for the
5221 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
5222 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
5223
5224 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
5225 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
5226 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
5227 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
5228 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
5229 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
5230
5231 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
5232 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
5233 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
5234 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
5235 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
5236
5237 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
5238 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
5239 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
5240 with the @code{condition} command.
5241
5242 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
5243 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
5244 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
5245 catchpoint.
5246
5247 @table @code
5248 @kindex condition
5249 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
5250 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
5251 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
5252 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
5253 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
5254 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
5255 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
5256 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
5257 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
5258 prints an error message:
5259
5260 @smallexample
5261 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5262 @end smallexample
5263
5264 @noindent
5265 @value{GDBN} does
5266 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
5267 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
5268 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5269
5270 @item condition @var{bnum}
5271 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
5272 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
5273 @end table
5274
5275 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
5276 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
5277 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
5278 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
5279 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
5280 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
5281 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
5282 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
5283 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
5284 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
5285 your program reaches it.
5286
5287 @table @code
5288 @kindex ignore
5289 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5290 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5291 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5292 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5293 takes no action.
5294
5295 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5296 a count of zero.
5297
5298 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5299 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5300 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5301 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5302
5303 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5304 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5305 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5306
5307 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5308 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5309 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5310 Variables}.
5311 @end table
5312
5313 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5314
5315
5316 @node Break Commands
5317 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5318
5319 @cindex breakpoint commands
5320 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5321 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5322 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5323 enable other breakpoints.
5324
5325 @table @code
5326 @kindex commands
5327 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5328 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5329 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5330 @itemx end
5331 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5332 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5333 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5334
5335 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5336 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5337
5338 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5339 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5340 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5341 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5342 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5343 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5344 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5345 Expressions}).
5346 @end table
5347
5348 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5349 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5350
5351 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5352 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5353 that resumes execution.
5354
5355 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5356 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5357 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5358 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5359 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5360
5361 @kindex silent
5362 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5363 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5364 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5365 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5366 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5367 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5368
5369 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5370 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5371 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5372
5373 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5374 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5375
5376 @smallexample
5377 break foo if x>0
5378 commands
5379 silent
5380 printf "x is %d\n",x
5381 cont
5382 end
5383 @end smallexample
5384
5385 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5386 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5387 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5388 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5389 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5390 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5391 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5392
5393 @smallexample
5394 break 403
5395 commands
5396 silent
5397 set x = y + 4
5398 cont
5399 end
5400 @end smallexample
5401
5402 @node Dynamic Printf
5403 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5404
5405 @cindex dynamic printf
5406 @cindex dprintf
5407 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5408 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5409 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5410 having to recompile it.
5411
5412 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5413 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5414 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5415 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5416 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5417 redirects to files and so forth.
5418
5419 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5420 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5421 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5422 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5423 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5424 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5425 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5426
5427 @table @code
5428 @kindex dprintf
5429 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5430 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5431 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5432 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5433
5434 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5435 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5436 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5437 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5438 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5439 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5440
5441 @table @code
5442 @item gdb
5443 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5444 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5445
5446 @item call
5447 @kindex dprintf-style call
5448 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5449 @code{printf}).
5450
5451 @item agent
5452 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5453 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5454 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5455 support running commands on the target.
5456 @end table
5457
5458 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5459 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5460 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5461 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5462 command.
5463
5464 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5465 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5466 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5467 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5468 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5469 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5470
5471 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5472 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5473 you could do the following:
5474
5475 @example
5476 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5477 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5478 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5479 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5480 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5481 (gdb) info break
5482 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5483 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5484 continue
5485 (gdb)
5486 @end example
5487
5488 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5489 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5490 the variable settings.
5491
5492 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5493 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5494 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5495 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5496 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5497 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5498
5499 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5500 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5501 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5502
5503 @end table
5504
5505 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5506 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5507 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5508 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5509 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5510 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5511
5512 @node Save Breakpoints
5513 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5514
5515 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5516 breakpoints}} command.
5517
5518 @table @code
5519 @kindex save breakpoints
5520 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5521 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5522 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5523 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5524 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5525 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5526 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5527 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5528 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5529 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5530 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5531 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5532 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5533 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5534 that can no longer be recreated.
5535 @end table
5536
5537 @node Static Probe Points
5538 @subsection Static Probe Points
5539
5540 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5541 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5542 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5543 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5544 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5545
5546 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5547 ELF-compatible systems:
5548
5549 @itemize @bullet
5550
5551 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5552 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5553 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5554 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5555 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5556 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5557 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5558 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5559
5560 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5561 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5562 C@t{++} languages.
5563 @end itemize
5564
5565 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5566 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5567 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5568 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5569 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5570 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5571 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5572 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5573 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5574
5575 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5576 probes}, with optional arguments:
5577
5578 @table @code
5579 @kindex info probes
5580 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5581 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5582 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5583 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5584
5585 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5586 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5587 probes from all providers are listed.
5588
5589 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5590 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5591 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5592
5593 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5594 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5595 given, all object files are considered.
5596
5597 @item info probes all
5598 List the available static probes, from all types.
5599 @end table
5600
5601 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5602 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5603 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5604 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5605 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5606
5607 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5608 commands, with optional arguments:
5609
5610 @table @code
5611 @kindex enable probes
5612 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5613 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5614 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5615 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5616
5617 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5618 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5619 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5620
5621 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5622 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5623 given, all object files are considered.
5624
5625 @kindex disable probes
5626 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5627 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5628 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5629 @end table
5630
5631 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5632 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5633 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5634 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5635 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5636 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5637 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5638 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5639 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5640 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5641 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5642 at the current probe point.
5643
5644 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5645 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5646 an error message.
5647
5648
5649 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5650 @node Error in Breakpoints
5651 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5652
5653 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5654 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5655
5656 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5657 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5658 @smallexample
5659 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5660 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5661 @end smallexample
5662
5663 @noindent
5664 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5665 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5666 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5667
5668 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5669 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5670
5671 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5672 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5673 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5674
5675 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5676 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5677 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5678 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5679
5680 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5681 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5682 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5683 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5684 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5685 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5686 first in the bundle.
5687
5688 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5689 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5690 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5691 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5692 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5693 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5694 is hit.
5695
5696 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5697 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5698
5699 @smallexample
5700 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5701 @end smallexample
5702
5703 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5704 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5705 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5706 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5707 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5708 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5709 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5710 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5711
5712 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5713 adjusted breakpoints:
5714
5715 @smallexample
5716 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5717 to 0x00010410.
5718 @end smallexample
5719
5720 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5721 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5722 frequently than expected.
5723
5724 @node Continuing and Stepping
5725 @section Continuing and Stepping
5726
5727 @cindex stepping
5728 @cindex continuing
5729 @cindex resuming execution
5730 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5731 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5732 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5733 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5734 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5735 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5736 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5737 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5738 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5739 handlers}).)
5740
5741 @table @code
5742 @kindex continue
5743 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5744 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5745 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5746 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5747 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5748 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5749 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5750 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5751 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5752 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5753
5754 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5755 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5756 @code{continue} is ignored.
5757
5758 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5759 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5760 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5761 @code{continue}.
5762 @end table
5763
5764 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5765 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5766 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5767 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5768
5769 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5770 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5771 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5772 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5773 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5774 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5775
5776 @table @code
5777 @kindex step
5778 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5779 @item step
5780 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5781 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5782 abbreviated @code{s}.
5783
5784 @quotation
5785 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5786 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5787 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5788 @c distinction here.
5789 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5790 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5791 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5792 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5793 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5794 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5795 below.
5796 @end quotation
5797
5798 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5799 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5800 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5801 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5802 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5803 called within the line.
5804
5805 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5806 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5807 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5808 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5809 was any debugging information about the routine.
5810
5811 @item step @var{count}
5812 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5813 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5814 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5815
5816 @kindex next
5817 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5818 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5819 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5820 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5821 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5822 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5823 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5824 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5825
5826 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5827
5828
5829 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5830 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5831 @c
5832 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5833 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5834 @c function are executed without stopping.
5835
5836 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5837 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5838 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5839
5840 @kindex set step-mode
5841 @item set step-mode
5842 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5843 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5844 @itemx set step-mode on
5845 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5846 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5847 information rather than stepping over it.
5848
5849 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5850 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5851 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5852
5853 @item set step-mode off
5854 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5855 debug information. This is the default.
5856
5857 @item show step-mode
5858 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5859 source line debug information.
5860
5861 @kindex finish
5862 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5863 @item finish
5864 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5865 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5866 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5867
5868 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5869 ,Returning from a Function}).
5870
5871 @kindex set print finish
5872 @kindex show print finish
5873 @item set print finish @r{[}on|off@r{]}
5874 @itemx show print finish
5875 By default the @code{finish} command will show the value that is
5876 returned by the function. This can be disabled using @code{set print
5877 finish off}. When disabled, the value is still entered into the value
5878 history (@pxref{Value History}), but not displayed.
5879
5880 @kindex until
5881 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5882 @cindex run until specified location
5883 @item until
5884 @itemx u
5885 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5886 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5887 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5888 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5889 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5890 than the address of the jump.
5891
5892 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5893 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5894 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5895 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5896 through the next iteration.
5897
5898 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5899 stack frame.
5900
5901 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5902 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5903 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5904 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5905 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5906
5907 @smallexample
5908 (@value{GDBP}) f
5909 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5910 206 expand_input();
5911 (@value{GDBP}) until
5912 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5913 @end smallexample
5914
5915 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5916 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5917 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5918 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5919 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5920 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5921 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5922
5923 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5924 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5925 argument.
5926
5927 @item until @var{location}
5928 @itemx u @var{location}
5929 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5930 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5931 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5932 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5933 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5934 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5935 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5936 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5937 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5938 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5939 invocations have returned.
5940
5941 @smallexample
5942 94 int factorial (int value)
5943 95 @{
5944 96 if (value > 1) @{
5945 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5946 98 @}
5947 99 return (value);
5948 100 @}
5949 @end smallexample
5950
5951
5952 @kindex advance @var{location}
5953 @item advance @var{location}
5954 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5955 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5956 @ref{Specify Location}.
5957 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5958 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5959 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5960 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5961
5962
5963 @kindex stepi
5964 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5965 @item stepi
5966 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5967 @itemx si
5968 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5969
5970 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5971 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5972 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5973 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5974
5975 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5976
5977 @need 750
5978 @kindex nexti
5979 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5980 @item nexti
5981 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5982 @itemx ni
5983 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5984 proceed until the function returns.
5985
5986 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5987
5988 @end table
5989
5990 @anchor{range stepping}
5991 @cindex range stepping
5992 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5993 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5994 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5995 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5996 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5997 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5998 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5999 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
6000 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
6001 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
6002 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
6003 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
6004 if necessary:
6005
6006 @table @code
6007 @kindex set range-stepping
6008 @kindex show range-stepping
6009 @item set range-stepping
6010 @itemx show range-stepping
6011 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
6012
6013 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
6014 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
6015 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
6016 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
6017 default is @code{on}.
6018
6019 @end table
6020
6021 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
6022 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
6023 @cindex skipping over functions and files
6024
6025 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
6026 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
6027 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
6028 a particular file when stepping.
6029
6030 For example, consider the following C function:
6031
6032 @smallexample
6033 101 int func()
6034 102 @{
6035 103 foo(boring());
6036 104 bar(boring());
6037 105 @}
6038 @end smallexample
6039
6040 @noindent
6041 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
6042 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
6043 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
6044 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
6045
6046 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
6047 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
6048 is called from many places.
6049
6050 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
6051 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
6052 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
6053 @code{foo}.
6054
6055 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
6056 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
6057 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
6058
6059 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
6060 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
6061 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
6062 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
6063 the underlying system.
6064 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
6065 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
6066
6067 @table @code
6068 @kindex skip
6069 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
6070 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
6071 that specify what to skip.
6072 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
6073
6074 @table @code
6075 @item -file @var{file}
6076 @itemx -fi @var{file}
6077 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
6078
6079 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
6080 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
6081 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
6082 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
6083 over when stepping.
6084
6085 @smallexample
6086 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
6087 @end smallexample
6088
6089 @item -function @var{linespec}
6090 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
6091 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
6092 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
6093 @xref{Specify Location}.
6094
6095 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
6096 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
6097 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
6098 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
6099
6100 This form is useful for complex function names.
6101 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
6102 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
6103 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
6104 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
6105 regular expression makes this easier.
6106
6107 @smallexample
6108 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
6109 @end smallexample
6110
6111 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
6112 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
6113
6114 @smallexample
6115 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
6116 @end smallexample
6117 @end table
6118
6119 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
6120 will be skipped.
6121
6122 @kindex skip function
6123 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
6124 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
6125 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
6126 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
6127
6128 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
6129 will be skipped.
6130
6131 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
6132 @kbd{skip function file}.)
6133
6134 @kindex skip file
6135 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
6136 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
6137 will be skipped over when stepping.
6138
6139 @smallexample
6140 (gdb) skip file boring.c
6141 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
6142 @end smallexample
6143
6144 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
6145 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
6146 @end table
6147
6148 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
6149 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
6150
6151 @table @code
6152 @kindex info skip
6153 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6154 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
6155 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
6156 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
6157
6158 @table @emph
6159 @item Identifier
6160 A number identifying this skip.
6161 @item Enabled or Disabled
6162 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
6163 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
6164 @item Glob
6165 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
6166 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
6167 @item File
6168 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
6169 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
6170 @item RE
6171 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
6172 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
6173 @item Function
6174 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
6175 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
6176 @end table
6177
6178 @kindex skip delete
6179 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6180 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
6181 skips.
6182
6183 @kindex skip enable
6184 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6185 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
6186 skips.
6187
6188 @kindex skip disable
6189 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6190 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
6191 skips.
6192
6193 @kindex set debug skip
6194 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
6195 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
6196
6197 @kindex show debug skip
6198 @item show debug skip
6199 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
6200
6201 @end table
6202
6203 @node Signals
6204 @section Signals
6205 @cindex signals
6206
6207 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
6208 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
6209 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
6210 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
6211 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
6212 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
6213 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
6214 requested an alarm).
6215
6216 @cindex fatal signals
6217 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
6218 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
6219 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
6220 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
6221 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
6222 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
6223
6224 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
6225 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
6226 signal.
6227
6228 @cindex handling signals
6229 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
6230 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
6231 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
6232 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
6233 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
6234
6235 @table @code
6236 @kindex info signals
6237 @kindex info handle
6238 @item info signals
6239 @itemx info handle
6240 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
6241 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
6242 the defined types of signals.
6243
6244 @item info signals @var{sig}
6245 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
6246
6247 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
6248
6249 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
6250 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
6251 for details about this command.
6252
6253 @kindex handle
6254 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
6255 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
6256 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
6257 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
6258 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
6259 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
6260 say what change to make.
6261 @end table
6262
6263 @c @group
6264 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
6265 Their full names are:
6266
6267 @table @code
6268 @item nostop
6269 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
6270 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
6271
6272 @item stop
6273 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
6274 the @code{print} keyword as well.
6275
6276 @item print
6277 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
6278
6279 @item noprint
6280 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
6281 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
6282
6283 @item pass
6284 @itemx noignore
6285 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
6286 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
6287 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
6288
6289 @item nopass
6290 @itemx ignore
6291 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
6292 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
6293 @end table
6294 @c @end group
6295
6296 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6297 program until you
6298 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6299 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6300 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6301 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6302 program sees that signal when you continue.
6303
6304 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6305 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6306 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6307 erroneous signals.
6308
6309 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6310 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6311 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6312 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6313 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6314 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6315 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6316 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6317 Program a Signal}.
6318
6319 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6320 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6321
6322 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6323 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6324 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6325 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6326 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6327 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6328 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6329 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6330 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6331 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6332 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6333 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6334 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6335
6336 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6337
6338 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6339 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6340 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6341 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6342
6343 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6344 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6345 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6346 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6347
6348 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6349 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6350
6351 @smallexample
6352 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6353 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6354 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6355 (@value{GDBP}) c
6356 Continuing.
6357
6358 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6359 main () sigusr1.c:28
6360 28 p = 0;
6361 (@value{GDBP}) si
6362 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6363 9 @{
6364 @end smallexample
6365
6366 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6367 program to receive the signal first:
6368
6369 @smallexample
6370 (@value{GDBP}) n
6371 28 p = 0;
6372 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6373 (@value{GDBP}) si
6374 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6375 9 @{
6376 (@value{GDBP})
6377 @end smallexample
6378
6379 @cindex extra signal information
6380 @anchor{extra signal information}
6381
6382 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6383 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6384 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6385 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6386 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6387 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6388 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6389 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6390 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6391 system header.
6392
6393 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6394 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6395
6396 @smallexample
6397 @group
6398 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6399 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6400 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6401 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6402 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6403 type = struct @{
6404 int si_signo;
6405 int si_errno;
6406 int si_code;
6407 union @{
6408 int _pad[28];
6409 struct @{...@} _kill;
6410 struct @{...@} _timer;
6411 struct @{...@} _rt;
6412 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6413 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6414 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6415 @} _sifields;
6416 @}
6417 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6418 type = struct @{
6419 void *si_addr;
6420 @}
6421 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6422 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6423 @end group
6424 @end smallexample
6425
6426 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6427
6428 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6429 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6430 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6431 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6432 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6433 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6434 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6435 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6436 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6437 information is displayed.
6438
6439 The usual output of a segfault is:
6440 @smallexample
6441 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6442 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6443 68 value = *(p + len);
6444 @end smallexample
6445
6446 While a bound violation is presented as:
6447 @smallexample
6448 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6449 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6450 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6451 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6452 68 value = *(p + len);
6453 @end smallexample
6454
6455 @node Thread Stops
6456 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6457
6458 @cindex stopped threads
6459 @cindex threads, stopped
6460
6461 @cindex continuing threads
6462 @cindex threads, continuing
6463
6464 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6465 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6466 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6467 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6468 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6469 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6470 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6471 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6472 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6473
6474 @menu
6475 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6476 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6477 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6478 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6479 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6480 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6481 @end menu
6482
6483 @node All-Stop Mode
6484 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6485
6486 @cindex all-stop mode
6487
6488 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6489 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6490 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6491 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6492 underfoot.
6493
6494 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6495 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6496 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6497
6498 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6499 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6500 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6501 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6502 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6503 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6504 stops.
6505
6506 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6507 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6508 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6509 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6510
6511 @cindex automatic thread selection
6512 @cindex switching threads automatically
6513 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6514 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6515 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6516 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6517 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6518 thread.
6519
6520 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6521 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6522
6523 @table @code
6524 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6525 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6526 @cindex lock scheduler
6527 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6528 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6529 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6530 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6531 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6532 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6533 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6534 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6535 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6536 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6537 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6538 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6539 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6540 @code{on} in replay mode.
6541
6542 @item show scheduler-locking
6543 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6544 @end table
6545
6546 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6547 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6548 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6549 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6550 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6551 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6552 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6553 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6554 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6555 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6556 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6557 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6558 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6559 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6560
6561 @table @code
6562 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6563 @item set schedule-multiple
6564 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6565 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6566 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6567 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6568 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6569 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6570
6571 @item show schedule-multiple
6572 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6573 multiple processes.
6574 @end table
6575
6576 @node Non-Stop Mode
6577 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6578
6579 @cindex non-stop mode
6580
6581 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6582 @c with more details.
6583
6584 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6585 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6586 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6587 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6588 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6589 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6590
6591 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6592 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6593 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6594 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6595 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6596 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6597 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6598 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6599 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6600 independently and simultaneously.
6601
6602 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6603 or attach to your program:
6604
6605 @smallexample
6606 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6607 set pagination off
6608
6609 # Finally, turn it on!
6610 set non-stop on
6611 @end smallexample
6612
6613 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6614
6615 @table @code
6616 @kindex set non-stop
6617 @item set non-stop on
6618 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6619 @item set non-stop off
6620 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6621 @kindex show non-stop
6622 @item show non-stop
6623 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6624 @end table
6625
6626 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6627 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6628 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6629 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6630 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6631 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6632 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6633 default.
6634
6635 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6636 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6637 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6638
6639 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6640 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6641 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6642 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6643 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6644
6645 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6646 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6647 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6648 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6649 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6650
6651 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6652
6653 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6654 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6655 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6656 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6657 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6658 previously current thread.
6659
6660 @node Background Execution
6661 @subsection Background Execution
6662
6663 @cindex foreground execution
6664 @cindex background execution
6665 @cindex asynchronous execution
6666 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6667
6668 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6669 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6670 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6671 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6672 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6673 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6674
6675 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6676 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6677
6678 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6679 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6680 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6681 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6682 are:
6683
6684 @table @code
6685 @kindex run&
6686 @item run
6687 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6688
6689 @item attach
6690 @kindex attach&
6691 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6692
6693 @item step
6694 @kindex step&
6695 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6696
6697 @item stepi
6698 @kindex stepi&
6699 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6700
6701 @item next
6702 @kindex next&
6703 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6704
6705 @item nexti
6706 @kindex nexti&
6707 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6708
6709 @item continue
6710 @kindex continue&
6711 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6712
6713 @item finish
6714 @kindex finish&
6715 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6716
6717 @item until
6718 @kindex until&
6719 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6720
6721 @end table
6722
6723 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6724 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6725 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6726 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6727 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6728 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6729
6730 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6731 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6732
6733 @table @code
6734 @kindex interrupt
6735 @item interrupt
6736 @itemx interrupt -a
6737
6738 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6739 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6740 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6741 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6742 @end table
6743
6744 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6745 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6746
6747 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6748 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6749 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6750
6751 @table @code
6752 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6753 @cindex thread breakpoints
6754 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6755 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6756 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6757 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6758 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6759 specify some source line.
6760
6761 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6762 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6763 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6764 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6765 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6766
6767 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6768 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6769 program.
6770
6771 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6772 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6773 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6774
6775 @smallexample
6776 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6777 @end smallexample
6778
6779 @end table
6780
6781 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6782 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6783 thread list. For example:
6784
6785 @smallexample
6786 (@value{GDBP}) c
6787 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6788 @end smallexample
6789
6790 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6791 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6792 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6793 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6794 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6795 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6796 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6797 command.
6798
6799 @node Interrupted System Calls
6800 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6801
6802 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6803 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6804 @cindex premature return from system calls
6805 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6806 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6807 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6808 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6809 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6810 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6811 stop execution.
6812
6813 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6814 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6815 style anyways.
6816
6817 For example, do not write code like this:
6818
6819 @smallexample
6820 sleep (10);
6821 @end smallexample
6822
6823 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6824 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6825
6826 Instead, write this:
6827
6828 @smallexample
6829 int unslept = 10;
6830 while (unslept > 0)
6831 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6832 @end smallexample
6833
6834 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6835 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6836 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6837 @value{GDBN}.
6838
6839 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6840 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6841 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6842 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6843
6844 @node Observer Mode
6845 @subsection Observer Mode
6846
6847 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6848 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6849 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6850 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6851 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6852
6853 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6854 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6855 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6856 mode.
6857
6858 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6859 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6860 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6861 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6862 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6863
6864 @table @code
6865
6866 @kindex observer
6867 @item set observer on
6868 @itemx set observer off
6869 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6870 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6871 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6872 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6873
6874 @item show observer
6875 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6876
6877 @kindex may-write-registers
6878 @item set may-write-registers on
6879 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6880 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6881 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6882 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6883
6884 @item show may-write-registers
6885 Show the current permission to write registers.
6886
6887 @kindex may-write-memory
6888 @item set may-write-memory on
6889 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6890 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6891 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6892 defaults to @code{on}.
6893
6894 @item show may-write-memory
6895 Show the current permission to write memory.
6896
6897 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6898 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6899 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6900 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6901 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6902 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6903
6904 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6905 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6906
6907 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6908 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6909 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6910 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6911 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6912 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6913 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6914
6915 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6916 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6917
6918 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6919 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6920 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6921 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6922 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6923 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6924 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6925
6926 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6927 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6928
6929 @kindex may-interrupt
6930 @item set may-interrupt on
6931 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6932 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6933 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6934 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6935 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6936
6937 @item show may-interrupt
6938 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6939
6940 @end table
6941
6942 @node Reverse Execution
6943 @chapter Running programs backward
6944 @cindex reverse execution
6945 @cindex running programs backward
6946
6947 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6948 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6949 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6950 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6951
6952 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6953 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6954 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6955 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6956 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6957 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6958
6959 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6960 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6961 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6962 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6963 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6964 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6965 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6966 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6967 prior values@footnote{
6968 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6969 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6970 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6971
6972 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6973 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6974 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6975 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6976 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6977 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6978 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6979 }.
6980
6981 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} has built-in support for reverse
6982 execution, activated with the @code{record} or @code{record btrace}
6983 commands. @xref{Process Record and Replay}. Some remote targets,
6984 typically full system emulators, support reverse execution directly
6985 without requiring any special command.
6986
6987 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6988 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6989
6990 @table @code
6991 @kindex reverse-continue
6992 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6993 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6994 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6995 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6996 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6997 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6998 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6999
7000 @kindex reverse-step
7001 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
7002 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7003 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
7004 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
7005
7006 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
7007 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
7008 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
7009 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
7010 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
7011 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
7012
7013 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
7014 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
7015
7016 @kindex reverse-stepi
7017 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
7018 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7019 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
7020 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
7021 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
7022 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
7023 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
7024
7025 @kindex reverse-next
7026 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
7027 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7028 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
7029 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
7030 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
7031 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
7032 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
7033 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
7034 line of a function back to its return to its caller
7035 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
7036
7037 @kindex reverse-nexti
7038 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
7039 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7040 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
7041 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
7042 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
7043 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
7044 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
7045 frame) is reached.
7046
7047 @kindex reverse-finish
7048 @item reverse-finish
7049 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
7050 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
7051 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
7052 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
7053
7054 @kindex set exec-direction
7055 @item set exec-direction
7056 Set the direction of target execution.
7057 @item set exec-direction reverse
7058 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
7059 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
7060 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
7061 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
7062 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
7063 @item set exec-direction forward
7064 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
7065 This is the default.
7066 @end table
7067
7068
7069 @node Process Record and Replay
7070 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
7071 @cindex process record and replay
7072 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
7073
7074 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
7075 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
7076 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
7077
7078 @cindex replay mode
7079 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
7080 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
7081 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
7082 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
7083 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
7084 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
7085 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
7086 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
7087 execution log.
7088
7089 @cindex record mode
7090 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
7091 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
7092 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
7093 for future replay.
7094
7095 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
7096 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
7097 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
7098 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
7099 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
7100 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
7101
7102 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
7103 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
7104 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
7105 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
7106
7107 Currently, process record and replay is supported on ARM, Aarch64,
7108 Moxie, PowerPC, PowerPC64, S/390, and x86 (i386/amd64) running
7109 GNU/Linux. Process record and replay can be used both when native
7110 debugging, and when remote debugging via @code{gdbserver}.
7111
7112 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
7113 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
7114
7115 @table @code
7116 @kindex target record
7117 @kindex target record-full
7118 @kindex target record-btrace
7119 @kindex record
7120 @kindex record full
7121 @kindex record btrace
7122 @kindex record btrace bts
7123 @kindex record btrace pt
7124 @kindex record bts
7125 @kindex record pt
7126 @kindex rec
7127 @kindex rec full
7128 @kindex rec btrace
7129 @kindex rec btrace bts
7130 @kindex rec btrace pt
7131 @kindex rec bts
7132 @kindex rec pt
7133 @item record @var{method}
7134 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
7135 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
7136 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
7137 recording methods are available:
7138
7139 @table @code
7140 @item full
7141 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
7142 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
7143 execution.
7144
7145 @item btrace @var{format}
7146 Hardware-supported instruction recording, supported on Intel
7147 processors. This method does not record data. Further, the data is
7148 collected in a ring buffer so old data will be overwritten when the
7149 buffer is full. It allows limited reverse execution. Variables and
7150 registers are not available during reverse execution. In remote
7151 debugging, recording continues on disconnect. Recorded data can be
7152 inspected after reconnecting. The recording may be stopped using
7153 @code{record stop}.
7154
7155 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
7156 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
7157 formats are available:
7158
7159 @table @code
7160 @item bts
7161 @cindex branch trace store
7162 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
7163 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
7164 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
7165
7166 @item pt
7167 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
7168 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
7169 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
7170 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
7171
7172 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
7173 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
7174 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
7175
7176 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
7177 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
7178 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
7179 buffer-size with care.
7180 @end table
7181
7182 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
7183 @end table
7184
7185 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
7186 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
7187 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
7188 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
7189
7190 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
7191 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
7192 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
7193 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
7194 doesn't support displaced stepping.
7195
7196 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
7197 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
7198 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
7199 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
7200 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
7201 does not support these two modes.
7202
7203 @kindex record stop
7204 @kindex rec s
7205 @item record stop
7206 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
7207 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
7208 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
7209
7210 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
7211 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
7212 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
7213 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
7214 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
7215
7216 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
7217 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
7218 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
7219 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
7220 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
7221
7222 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
7223 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
7224
7225 @kindex record goto
7226 @item record goto
7227 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
7228 ways to specify the location to go to:
7229
7230 @table @code
7231 @item record goto begin
7232 @itemx record goto start
7233 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
7234
7235 @item record goto end
7236 Go to the end of the execution log.
7237
7238 @item record goto @var{n}
7239 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
7240 @end table
7241
7242 @kindex record save
7243 @item record save @var{filename}
7244 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
7245 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
7246 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
7247
7248 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7249
7250 @kindex record restore
7251 @item record restore @var{filename}
7252 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
7253 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
7254
7255 @kindex set record full
7256 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
7257 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
7258 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
7259 recording method. Default value is 200000.
7260
7261 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
7262 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
7263 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
7264 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
7265 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
7266 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
7267 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
7268 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
7269
7270 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
7271 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
7272 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
7273
7274 @kindex show record full
7275 @item show record full insn-number-max
7276 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
7277 recording method.
7278
7279 @item set record full stop-at-limit
7280 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
7281 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
7282 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
7283 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
7284 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
7285 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
7286 oldest one to be deleted.
7287
7288 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
7289 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
7290
7291 @item show record full stop-at-limit
7292 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
7293
7294 @item set record full memory-query
7295 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
7296 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
7297 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
7298 case.
7299
7300 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
7301 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
7302 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
7303 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
7304 results.
7305
7306 @item show record full memory-query
7307 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7308
7309 @kindex set record btrace
7310 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7311 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7312 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7313 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7314 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7315 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7316 You can use the following command for that:
7317
7318 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7319 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7320 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7321 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7322 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7323 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7324 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7325 position.
7326
7327 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7328 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7329 errata when decoding the trace.
7330
7331 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7332 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7333 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7334 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7335 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7336 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7337 which the trace was recorded.
7338
7339 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7340 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7341 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7342 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7343 disable the workarounds.
7344
7345 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7346 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7347 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7348 (default).
7349
7350 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7351 identifiers are currently supported:
7352
7353 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7354
7355 @item @code{intel}
7356 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7357
7358 @end multitable
7359
7360 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7361 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7362
7363 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7364 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7365 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7366
7367 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7368 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7369 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7370 supports.
7371
7372 @smallexample
7373 (gdb) info record
7374 Active record target: record-btrace
7375 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7376 Buffer size: 16kB.
7377 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7378 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7379 (gdb) info record
7380 Active record target: record-btrace
7381 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7382 Buffer size: 16kB.
7383 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7384 @end smallexample
7385
7386 @kindex show record btrace
7387 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7388 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7389
7390 @item show record btrace cpu
7391 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7392 workarounds.
7393
7394 @kindex set record btrace bts
7395 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7396 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7397 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7398 format. Default is 64KB.
7399
7400 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7401 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7402 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7403 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7404 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7405 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7406 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7407
7408 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7409 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7410
7411 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7412 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7413
7414 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7415 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7416 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7417
7418 @kindex set record btrace pt
7419 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7420 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7421 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7422 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7423
7424 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7425 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7426 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7427 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7428 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7429 actual buffer size for each thread.
7430
7431 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7432 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7433
7434 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7435 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7436
7437 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7438 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7439 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7440
7441 @kindex info record
7442 @item info record
7443 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7444 method:
7445
7446 @table @code
7447 @item full
7448 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7449 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7450
7451 @itemize @bullet
7452 @item
7453 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7454 @item
7455 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7456 @item
7457 Highest recorded instruction number.
7458 @item
7459 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7460 @item
7461 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7462 @item
7463 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7464 @end itemize
7465
7466 @item btrace
7467 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7468
7469 @itemize @bullet
7470 @item
7471 Recording format.
7472 @item
7473 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7474 @item
7475 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7476 instructions.
7477 @item
7478 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7479 @end itemize
7480
7481 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7482 @itemize @bullet
7483 @item
7484 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7485 @end itemize
7486
7487 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7488 @itemize @bullet
7489 @item
7490 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7491 @end itemize
7492 @end table
7493
7494 @kindex record delete
7495 @kindex rec del
7496 @item record delete
7497 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7498 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7499 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7500 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7501
7502 @kindex record instruction-history
7503 @kindex rec instruction-history
7504 @item record instruction-history
7505 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7506 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7507 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7508 are printed in execution order.
7509
7510 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7511 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7512 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7513
7514 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7515 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7516 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7517 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7518 @code{/p} modifier.
7519
7520 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7521 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7522 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7523
7524 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7525 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7526
7527 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7528 disassemble:
7529
7530 @table @code
7531 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7532 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7533 @var{insn}.
7534
7535 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7536 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7537 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7538 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7539 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7540 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7541
7542 @item record instruction-history
7543 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7544
7545 @item record instruction-history -
7546 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7547
7548 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7549 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7550 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7551 number @var{end} is included.
7552 @end table
7553
7554 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7555
7556 @kindex set record
7557 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7558 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7559 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7560 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7561 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7562
7563 @kindex show record
7564 @item show record instruction-history-size
7565 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7566 instruction-history} command.
7567
7568 @kindex record function-call-history
7569 @kindex rec function-call-history
7570 @item record function-call-history
7571 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7572 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7573 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7574 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7575 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7576 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7577 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7578 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7579 given together.
7580
7581 @smallexample
7582 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7583 1 void foo (void)
7584 2 @{
7585 3 @}
7586 4
7587 5 void bar (void)
7588 6 @{
7589 7 ...
7590 8 foo ();
7591 9 ...
7592 10 @}
7593 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7594 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7595 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7596 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7597 @end smallexample
7598
7599 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7600 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7601 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7602 to print:
7603
7604 @table @code
7605 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7606 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7607
7608 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7609 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7610 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7611 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7612 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7613
7614 @item record function-call-history
7615 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7616
7617 @item record function-call-history -
7618 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7619
7620 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7621 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7622 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7623 @end table
7624
7625 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7626
7627 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7628 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7629 Define how many lines to print in the
7630 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7631 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7632
7633 @item show record function-call-history-size
7634 Show how many lines to print in the
7635 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7636 @end table
7637
7638
7639 @node Stack
7640 @chapter Examining the Stack
7641
7642 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7643 stopped and how it got there.
7644
7645 @cindex call stack
7646 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7647 is generated.
7648 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7649 the arguments of the call,
7650 and the local variables of the function being called.
7651 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7652 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7653 stack}.
7654
7655 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7656 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7657
7658 @cindex selected frame
7659 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7660 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7661 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7662 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7663 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7664 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7665
7666 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7667 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7668 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7669
7670 @menu
7671 * Frames:: Stack frames
7672 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7673 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7674 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7675 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7676 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7677
7678 @end menu
7679
7680 @node Frames
7681 @section Stack Frames
7682
7683 @cindex frame, definition
7684 @cindex stack frame
7685 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7686 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7687 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7688 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7689 which the function is executing.
7690
7691 @cindex initial frame
7692 @cindex outermost frame
7693 @cindex innermost frame
7694 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7695 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7696 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7697 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7698 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7699 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7700 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7701 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7702
7703 @cindex frame pointer
7704 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7705 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7706 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7707 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7708 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7709 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7710
7711 @cindex frame level
7712 @cindex frame number
7713 @value{GDBN} labels each existing stack frame with a @dfn{level}, a
7714 number that is zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that
7715 called it, and so on upward. These level numbers give you a way of
7716 designating stack frames in @value{GDBN} commands. The terms
7717 @dfn{frame number} and @dfn{frame level} can be used interchangeably to
7718 describe this number.
7719
7720 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7721 @c underflow problems.
7722 @cindex frameless execution
7723 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7724 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7725 @smallexample
7726 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7727 @end smallexample
7728 generates functions without a frame.)
7729 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7730 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7731 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7732 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7733 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7734 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7735 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7736
7737 @node Backtrace
7738 @section Backtraces
7739
7740 @cindex traceback
7741 @cindex call stack traces
7742 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7743 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7744 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7745 stack.
7746
7747 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7748 @kindex backtrace
7749 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7750 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7751 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7752 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7753 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7754 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7755
7756 @table @code
7757 @item backtrace [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{qualifier}]@dots{} [@var{count}]
7758 @itemx bt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{qualifier}]@dots{} [@var{count}]
7759 Print the backtrace of the entire stack.
7760
7761 The optional @var{count} can be one of the following:
7762
7763 @table @code
7764 @item @var{n}
7765 @itemx @var{n}
7766 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7767 number.
7768
7769 @item -@var{n}
7770 @itemx -@var{n}
7771 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7772 number.
7773 @end table
7774
7775 Options:
7776
7777 @table @code
7778 @item -full
7779 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7780 with the optional @var{count} to limit the number of frames shown.
7781
7782 @item -no-filters
7783 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7784 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7785 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7786 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7787 support.
7788
7789 @item -hide
7790 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7791 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7792 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{-hide}
7793 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7794 @end table
7795
7796 The @code{backtrace} command also supports a number of options that
7797 allow overriding relevant global print settings as set by @code{set
7798 backtrace} and @code{set print} subcommands:
7799
7800 @table @code
7801 @item -past-main [@code{on}|@code{off}]
7802 Set whether backtraces should continue past @code{main}. Related setting:
7803 @ref{set backtrace past-main}.
7804
7805 @item -past-entry [@code{on}|@code{off}]
7806 Set whether backtraces should continue past the entry point of a program.
7807 Related setting: @ref{set backtrace past-entry}.
7808
7809 @item -entry-values @code{no}|@code{only}|@code{preferred}|@code{if-needed}|@code{both}|@code{compact}|@code{default}
7810 Set printing of function arguments at function entry.
7811 Related setting: @ref{set print entry-values}.
7812
7813 @item -frame-arguments @code{all}|@code{scalars}|@code{none}
7814 Set printing of non-scalar frame arguments.
7815 Related setting: @ref{set print frame-arguments}.
7816
7817 @item -raw-frame-arguments [@code{on}|@code{off}]
7818 Set whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
7819 Related setting: @ref{set print raw-frame-arguments}.
7820
7821 @item -frame-info @code{auto}|@code{source-line}|@code{location}|@code{source-and-location}|@code{location-and-address}|@code{short-location}
7822 Set printing of frame information.
7823 Related setting: @ref{set print frame-info}.
7824 @end table
7825
7826 The optional @var{qualifier} is maintained for backward compatibility.
7827 It can be one of the following:
7828
7829 @table @code
7830 @item full
7831 Equivalent to the @code{-full} option.
7832
7833 @item no-filters
7834 Equivalent to the @code{-no-filters} option.
7835
7836 @item hide
7837 Equivalent to the @code{-hide} option.
7838 @end table
7839
7840 @end table
7841
7842 @kindex where
7843 @kindex info stack
7844 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7845 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7846
7847 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7848 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7849 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7850 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7851 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7852 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7853 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7854 multi-threaded program.
7855
7856 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7857 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7858 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7859 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7860 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7861 line number.
7862
7863 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7864 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7865
7866 @smallexample
7867 @group
7868 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7869 at builtin.c:993
7870 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7871 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7872 at macro.c:71
7873 (More stack frames follow...)
7874 @end group
7875 @end smallexample
7876
7877 @noindent
7878 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7879 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7880 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7881
7882 @noindent
7883 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7884 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7885 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7886 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7887 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7888 The command @kbd{set print frame-info} (@pxref{Print Settings}) controls
7889 what frame information is printed.
7890
7891 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7892 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7893 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7894 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7895 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7896 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7897 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7898 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7899 such a backtrace might look like:
7900
7901 @smallexample
7902 @group
7903 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7904 at builtin.c:993
7905 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7906 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7907 at macro.c:71
7908 (More stack frames follow...)
7909 @end group
7910 @end smallexample
7911
7912 @noindent
7913 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7914 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7915
7916 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7917 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7918 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7919
7920 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7921 @cindex program entry point
7922 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7923 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7924 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7925 @code{main}@footnote{
7926 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7927 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7928 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7929 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7930 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7931 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7932
7933 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7934 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7935
7936 @table @code
7937 @item set backtrace past-main
7938 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7939 @anchor{set backtrace past-main}
7940 @kindex set backtrace
7941 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7942
7943 @item set backtrace past-main off
7944 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7945 default.
7946
7947 @item show backtrace past-main
7948 @kindex show backtrace
7949 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7950
7951 @item set backtrace past-entry
7952 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7953 @anchor{set backtrace past-entry}
7954 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7955 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7956 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7957
7958 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7959 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7960 application. This is the default.
7961
7962 @item show backtrace past-entry
7963 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7964
7965 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7966 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7967 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7968 @anchor{set backtrace limit}
7969 @cindex backtrace limit
7970 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7971 or zero means unlimited levels.
7972
7973 @item show backtrace limit
7974 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7975 @end table
7976
7977 You can control how file names are displayed.
7978
7979 @table @code
7980 @item set filename-display
7981 @itemx set filename-display relative
7982 @cindex filename-display
7983 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7984
7985 @item set filename-display basename
7986 Display only basename of a filename.
7987
7988 @item set filename-display absolute
7989 Display an absolute filename.
7990
7991 @item show filename-display
7992 Show the current way to display filenames.
7993 @end table
7994
7995 @node Selection
7996 @section Selecting a Frame
7997
7998 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7999 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
8000 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
8001 of the stack frame just selected.
8002
8003 @table @code
8004 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
8005 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
8006 @item frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8007 @item f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8008 The @command{frame} command allows different stack frames to be
8009 selected. The @var{frame-selection-spec} can be any of the following:
8010
8011 @table @code
8012 @kindex frame level
8013 @item @var{num}
8014 @item level @var{num}
8015 Select frame level @var{num}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
8016 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
8017 innermost one, and so on. The highest level frame is usually the one
8018 for @code{main}.
8019
8020 As this is the most common method of navigating the frame stack, the
8021 string @command{level} can be omitted. For example, the following two
8022 commands are equivalent:
8023
8024 @smallexample
8025 (@value{GDBP}) frame 3
8026 (@value{GDBP}) frame level 3
8027 @end smallexample
8028
8029 @kindex frame address
8030 @item address @var{stack-address}
8031 Select the frame with stack address @var{stack-address}. The
8032 @var{stack-address} for a frame can be seen in the output of
8033 @command{info frame}, for example:
8034
8035 @smallexample
8036 (gdb) info frame
8037 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
8038 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
8039 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
8040 source language c++.
8041 Arglist at unknown address.
8042 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
8043 @end smallexample
8044
8045 The @var{stack-address} for this frame is @code{0x7fffffffda30} as
8046 indicated by the line:
8047
8048 @smallexample
8049 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
8050 @end smallexample
8051
8052 @kindex frame function
8053 @item function @var{function-name}
8054 Select the stack frame for function @var{function-name}. If there are
8055 multiple stack frames for function @var{function-name} then the inner
8056 most stack frame is selected.
8057
8058 @kindex frame view
8059 @item view @var{stack-address} @r{[} @var{pc-addr} @r{]}
8060 View a frame that is not part of @value{GDBN}'s backtrace. The frame
8061 viewed has stack address @var{stack-addr}, and optionally, a program
8062 counter address of @var{pc-addr}.
8063
8064 This is useful mainly if the chaining of stack frames has been
8065 damaged by a bug, making it impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign
8066 numbers properly to all frames. In addition, this can be useful
8067 when your program has multiple stacks and switches between them.
8068
8069 When viewing a frame outside the current backtrace using
8070 @command{frame view} then you can always return to the original
8071 stack using one of the previous stack frame selection instructions,
8072 for example @command{frame level 0}.
8073
8074 @end table
8075
8076 @kindex up
8077 @item up @var{n}
8078 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
8079 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
8080 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
8081
8082 @kindex down
8083 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
8084 @item down @var{n}
8085 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
8086 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
8087 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
8088 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
8089 @end table
8090
8091 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
8092 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
8093 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
8094 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
8095
8096 @need 1000
8097 For example:
8098
8099 @smallexample
8100 @group
8101 (@value{GDBP}) up
8102 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
8103 at env.c:10
8104 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
8105 @end group
8106 @end smallexample
8107
8108 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
8109 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
8110 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
8111 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
8112 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
8113 for details.
8114
8115 @table @code
8116 @kindex select-frame
8117 @item select-frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8118 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
8119 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
8120 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
8121 output might be unnecessary and distracting. The
8122 @var{frame-selection-spec} is as for the @command{frame} command
8123 described in @ref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
8124
8125 @kindex down-silently
8126 @kindex up-silently
8127 @item up-silently @var{n}
8128 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
8129 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
8130 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
8131 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
8132 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
8133 distracting.
8134 @end table
8135
8136 @node Frame Info
8137 @section Information About a Frame
8138
8139 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
8140 stack frame.
8141
8142 @table @code
8143 @item frame
8144 @itemx f
8145 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
8146 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
8147 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
8148 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
8149 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
8150
8151 @kindex info frame
8152 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
8153 @item info frame
8154 @itemx info f
8155 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
8156 including:
8157
8158 @itemize @bullet
8159 @item
8160 the address of the frame
8161 @item
8162 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
8163 @item
8164 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
8165 @item
8166 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
8167 @item
8168 the address of the frame's arguments
8169 @item
8170 the address of the frame's local variables
8171 @item
8172 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
8173 @item
8174 which registers were saved in the frame
8175 @end itemize
8176
8177 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
8178 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
8179 the usual conventions.
8180
8181 @item info frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8182 @itemx info f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8183 Print a verbose description of the frame selected by
8184 @var{frame-selection-spec}. The @var{frame-selection-spec} is the
8185 same as for the @command{frame} command (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting
8186 a Frame}). The selected frame remains unchanged by this command.
8187
8188 @kindex info args
8189 @item info args [-q]
8190 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
8191
8192 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
8193 printing header information and messages explaining why no argument
8194 have been printed.
8195
8196 @item info args [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
8197 Like @kbd{info args}, but only print the arguments selected
8198 with the provided regexp(s).
8199
8200 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose names
8201 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
8202
8203 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose
8204 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
8205 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
8206 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
8207 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
8208 of special characters or quotes.
8209
8210 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
8211 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
8212 @var{type_regexp}.
8213
8214 @item info locals [-q]
8215 @kindex info locals
8216 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
8217 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
8218 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
8219
8220 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
8221 printing header information and messages explaining why no local variables
8222 have been printed.
8223
8224 @item info locals [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
8225 Like @kbd{info locals}, but only print the local variables selected
8226 with the provided regexp(s).
8227
8228 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose names
8229 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
8230
8231 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose
8232 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
8233 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
8234 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
8235 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
8236 of special characters or quotes.
8237
8238 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a local variable
8239 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
8240 @var{type_regexp}.
8241
8242 The command @kbd{info locals -q -t @var{type_regexp}} can usefully be
8243 combined with the commands @kbd{frame apply} and @kbd{thread apply}.
8244 For example, your program might use Resource Acquisition Is
8245 Initialization types (RAII) such as @code{lock_something_t}: each
8246 local variable of type @code{lock_something_t} automatically places a
8247 lock that is destroyed when the variable goes out of scope. You can
8248 then list all acquired locks in your program by doing
8249 @smallexample
8250 thread apply all -s frame apply all -s info locals -q -t lock_something_t
8251 @end smallexample
8252 @noindent
8253 or the equivalent shorter form
8254 @smallexample
8255 tfaas i lo -q -t lock_something_t
8256 @end smallexample
8257
8258 @end table
8259
8260 @node Frame Apply
8261 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
8262 @anchor{frame apply}
8263 @kindex frame apply
8264 @cindex apply command to several frames
8265 @table @code
8266 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}
8267 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
8268 @var{command} to one or more frames.
8269
8270 @table @code
8271 @item @code{all}
8272 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
8273
8274 @item @var{count}
8275 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
8276 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
8277
8278 @item @var{-count}
8279 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
8280 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
8281
8282 @item @code{level}
8283 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
8284 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
8285 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
8286 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
8287 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
8288 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
8289
8290 @end table
8291
8292 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
8293 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
8294 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}.
8295 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
8296
8297 The @code{frame apply} command also supports a number of options that
8298 allow overriding relevant @code{set backtrace} settings:
8299
8300 @table @code
8301 @item -past-main [@code{on}|@code{off}]
8302 Whether backtraces should continue past @code{main}.
8303 Related setting: @ref{set backtrace past-main}.
8304
8305 @item -past-entry [@code{on}|@code{off}]
8306 Whether backtraces should continue past the entry point of a program.
8307 Related setting: @ref{set backtrace past-entry}.
8308 @end table
8309
8310 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
8311 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
8312 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
8313 following options can be used to fine-tune these behaviors:
8314
8315 @table @code
8316 @item -c
8317 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
8318 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
8319 @code{frame apply} then continues.
8320 @item -s
8321 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
8322 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
8323 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
8324 are not printed.
8325 @item -q
8326 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
8327 information.
8328 @end table
8329
8330 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
8331 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
8332 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
8333 @code{#1 main} frame.
8334
8335 @smallexample
8336 @group
8337 (gdb) frame apply all p j
8338 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8339 No symbol "j" in current context.
8340 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
8341 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8342 No symbol "j" in current context.
8343 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8344 $1 = 5
8345 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
8346 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8347 $2 = 5
8348 (gdb)
8349 @end group
8350 @end smallexample
8351
8352 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
8353 information before the command output:
8354
8355 @smallexample
8356 @group
8357 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
8358 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8359 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8360 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8361 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8362 (gdb)
8363 @end group
8364 @end smallexample
8365
8366 If the flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
8367 @smallexample
8368 @group
8369 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
8370 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8371 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8372 (gdb)
8373 @end group
8374 @end smallexample
8375
8376 @end table
8377
8378 @table @code
8379
8380 @kindex faas
8381 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
8382 @item faas @var{command}
8383 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
8384 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
8385
8386 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
8387 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
8388 is, using:
8389 @smallexample
8390 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
8391 @end smallexample
8392
8393 The @code{faas} command accepts the same options as the @code{frame
8394 apply} command. @xref{frame apply}.
8395
8396 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
8397 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
8398 @end table
8399
8400
8401 @node Frame Filter Management
8402 @section Management of Frame Filters.
8403 @cindex managing frame filters
8404
8405 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
8406 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
8407
8408 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
8409 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
8410
8411 @table @code
8412 @kindex info frame-filter
8413 @item info frame-filter
8414 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
8415 their name, priority and enabled status.
8416
8417 @kindex disable frame-filter
8418 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
8419 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8420 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8421 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8422 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8423 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8424 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
8425 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
8426 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8427 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
8428 may be enabled again later.
8429
8430 @kindex enable frame-filter
8431 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8432 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8433 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8434 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8435 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8436 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
8437 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
8438 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8439 @var{filter-dictionary}.
8440
8441 Example:
8442
8443 @smallexample
8444 (gdb) info frame-filter
8445
8446 global frame-filters:
8447 Priority Enabled Name
8448 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8449 100 Yes Reverse
8450
8451 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8452 Priority Enabled Name
8453 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8454
8455 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8456 Priority Enabled Name
8457 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
8458
8459 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
8460 (gdb) info frame-filter
8461
8462 global frame-filters:
8463 Priority Enabled Name
8464 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8465 100 Yes Reverse
8466
8467 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8468 Priority Enabled Name
8469 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8470
8471 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8472 Priority Enabled Name
8473 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8474
8475 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
8476 (gdb) info frame-filter
8477
8478 global frame-filters:
8479 Priority Enabled Name
8480 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8481 100 Yes Reverse
8482
8483 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8484 Priority Enabled Name
8485 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8486
8487 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8488 Priority Enabled Name
8489 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8490 @end smallexample
8491
8492 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8493 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8494 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8495 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8496 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8497 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8498 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8499
8500 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8501 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8502 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8503 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8504 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8505 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8506 dictionary resides.
8507
8508 Example:
8509
8510 @smallexample
8511 (gdb) info frame-filter
8512
8513 global frame-filters:
8514 Priority Enabled Name
8515 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8516 100 Yes Reverse
8517
8518 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8519 Priority Enabled Name
8520 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8521
8522 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8523 Priority Enabled Name
8524 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8525
8526 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8527 (gdb) info frame-filter
8528
8529 global frame-filters:
8530 Priority Enabled Name
8531 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8532 50 Yes Reverse
8533
8534 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8535 Priority Enabled Name
8536 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8537
8538 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8539 Priority Enabled Name
8540 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8541 @end smallexample
8542 @end table
8543
8544 @node Source
8545 @chapter Examining Source Files
8546
8547 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8548 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8549 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8550 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8551 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8552 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8553 source files by explicit command.
8554
8555 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8556 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8557 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8558
8559 @menu
8560 * List:: Printing source lines
8561 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8562 * Edit:: Editing source files
8563 * Search:: Searching source files
8564 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8565 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8566 @end menu
8567
8568 @node List
8569 @section Printing Source Lines
8570
8571 @kindex list
8572 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8573 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8574 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8575 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8576 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8577
8578 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8579
8580 @table @code
8581 @item list @var{linenum}
8582 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8583 current source file.
8584
8585 @item list @var{function}
8586 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8587 @var{function}.
8588
8589 @item list
8590 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8591 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8592 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8593 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8594 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8595
8596 @item list -
8597 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8598 @end table
8599
8600 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8601 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8602 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8603
8604 @table @code
8605 @kindex set listsize
8606 @item set listsize @var{count}
8607 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8608 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8609 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8610 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8611
8612 @kindex show listsize
8613 @item show listsize
8614 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8615 @end table
8616
8617 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8618 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8619 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8620 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8621 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8622
8623 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8624 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8625 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8626 to specify some source line.
8627
8628 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8629
8630 @table @code
8631 @item list @var{location}
8632 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8633
8634 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8635 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8636 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8637 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8638 the same source file as the first location.
8639
8640 @item list ,@var{last}
8641 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8642
8643 @item list @var{first},
8644 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8645
8646 @item list +
8647 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8648
8649 @item list -
8650 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8651
8652 @item list
8653 As described in the preceding table.
8654 @end table
8655
8656 @node Specify Location
8657 @section Specifying a Location
8658 @cindex specifying location
8659 @cindex location
8660 @cindex source location
8661
8662 @menu
8663 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8664 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8665 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8666 @end menu
8667
8668 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8669 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8670 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8671 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8672 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8673
8674 @node Linespec Locations
8675 @subsection Linespec Locations
8676 @cindex linespec locations
8677
8678 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8679 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8680 specifying a linespec:
8681
8682 @table @code
8683 @item @var{linenum}
8684 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8685
8686 @item -@var{offset}
8687 @itemx +@var{offset}
8688 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8689 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8690 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8691 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8692 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8693 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8694 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8695 linespec.
8696
8697 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8698 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8699 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8700 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8701 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8702 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8703 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8704
8705 @item @var{function}
8706 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8707 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8708
8709 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8710 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8711 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8712 means in all packages.
8713
8714 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8715 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8716 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8717
8718 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8719 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8720 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8721 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8722
8723 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8724
8725 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8726 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8727
8728 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8729 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8730 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8731 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8732 functions in different source files.
8733
8734 @item @var{label}
8735 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8736 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8737 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8738 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8739
8740 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8741 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8742 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8743 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8744 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8745 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8746
8747 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8748 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8749 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8750 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8751 each one of those probes.
8752 @end table
8753
8754 @node Explicit Locations
8755 @subsection Explicit Locations
8756 @cindex explicit locations
8757
8758 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8759 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8760
8761 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8762 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8763 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8764 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8765 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8766
8767 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8768 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8769 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8770 the symbol table to know.
8771
8772 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8773 following table:
8774
8775 @table @code
8776 @item -source @var{filename}
8777 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8778 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8779 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8780 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8781 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8782
8783 @item -function @var{function}
8784 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8785 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8786 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8787 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8788
8789 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8790 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8791 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8792 means in all packages.
8793
8794 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8795 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8796 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8797 breakpoint on both symbols.
8798
8799 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8800
8801 @item -qualified
8802
8803 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8804 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8805
8806 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8807 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8808 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8809
8810 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8811 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8812 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8813
8814 @item -label @var{label}
8815 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8816 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8817 selected stack frame.
8818
8819 @item -line @var{number}
8820 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8821 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8822 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8823 relative to the current line.
8824 @end table
8825
8826 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8827 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8828
8829 @node Address Locations
8830 @subsection Address Locations
8831 @cindex address locations
8832
8833 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8834 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8835
8836 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8837 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8838 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8839 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8840 source files.
8841
8842 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8843 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8844 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8845 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8846 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8847 of @var{address}:
8848
8849 @table @code
8850 @item @var{expression}
8851 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8852
8853 @item @var{funcaddr}
8854 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8855 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8856 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8857 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8858 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8859 (although the Pascal form also works).
8860
8861 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8862 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8863
8864 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8865 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8866 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8867 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8868 functions with identical names in different source files.
8869 @end table
8870
8871 @node Edit
8872 @section Editing Source Files
8873 @cindex editing source files
8874
8875 @kindex edit
8876 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8877 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8878 The editing program of your choice
8879 is invoked with the current line set to
8880 the active line in the program.
8881 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8882 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8883
8884 @table @code
8885 @item edit @var{location}
8886 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8887 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8888 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8889 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8890 command most commonly used:
8891
8892 @table @code
8893 @item edit @var{number}
8894 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8895
8896 @item edit @var{function}
8897 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8898 @end table
8899
8900 @end table
8901
8902 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8903 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8904 @footnote{
8905 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8906 following command-line syntax:
8907 @smallexample
8908 ex +@var{number} file
8909 @end smallexample
8910 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8911 the file where to start editing.}.
8912 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8913 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8914 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8915 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8916 @smallexample
8917 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8918 export EDITOR
8919 gdb @dots{}
8920 @end smallexample
8921 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8922 @smallexample
8923 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8924 gdb @dots{}
8925 @end smallexample
8926
8927 @node Search
8928 @section Searching Source Files
8929 @cindex searching source files
8930
8931 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8932 regular expression.
8933
8934 @table @code
8935 @kindex search
8936 @kindex forward-search
8937 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8938 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8939 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8940 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8941 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8942 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8943 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8944 @code{fo}.
8945
8946 @kindex reverse-search
8947 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8948 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8949 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8950 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8951 this command as @code{rev}.
8952 @end table
8953
8954 @node Source Path
8955 @section Specifying Source Directories
8956
8957 @cindex source path
8958 @cindex directories for source files
8959 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8960 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8961 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8962 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8963 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8964 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8965 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8966
8967 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8968 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, does not record a compilation
8969 directory, and the @dfn{source path} is @file{/mnt/cross}.
8970 @value{GDBN} would look for the source file in the following
8971 locations:
8972
8973 @enumerate
8974
8975 @item @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
8976 @item @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
8977 @item @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}
8978
8979 @end enumerate
8980
8981 If the source file is not present at any of the above locations then
8982 an error is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8983 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8984 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8985 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8986 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8987 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8988
8989 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8990 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above,
8991 except that non-absolute file names are not looked up literally. If
8992 the @dfn{source path} is @file{/mnt/cross}, the source file is
8993 recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, and no compilation directory is
8994 recorded, then @value{GDBN} will search in the following locations:
8995
8996 @enumerate
8997
8998 @item @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}
8999 @item @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}
9000
9001 @end enumerate
9002
9003 @kindex cdir
9004 @kindex cwd
9005 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
9006 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
9007 @cindex compilation directory
9008 @cindex current directory
9009 @cindex working directory
9010 @cindex directory, current
9011 @cindex directory, compilation
9012 The @dfn{source path} will always include two special entries
9013 @samp{$cdir} and @samp{$cwd}, these refer to the compilation directory
9014 (if one is recorded) and the current working directory respectively.
9015
9016 @samp{$cdir} causes @value{GDBN} to search within the compilation
9017 directory, if one is recorded in the debug information. If no
9018 compilation directory is recorded in the debug information then
9019 @samp{$cdir} is ignored.
9020
9021 @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former tracks the
9022 current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
9023 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
9024 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
9025
9026 If a compilation directory is recorded in the debug information, and
9027 @value{GDBN} has not found the source file after the first search
9028 using @dfn{source path}, then @value{GDBN} will combine the
9029 compilation directory and the filename, and then search for the source
9030 file again using the @dfn{source path}.
9031
9032 For example, if the executable records the source file as
9033 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, the compilation directory is
9034 recorded as @file{/project/build}, and the @dfn{source path} is
9035 @file{/mnt/cross:$cdir:$cwd} while the current working directory of
9036 the @value{GDBN} session is @file{/home/user}, then @value{GDBN} will
9037 search for the source file in the following loctions:
9038
9039 @enumerate
9040
9041 @item @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9042 @item @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9043 @item @file{/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9044 @item @file{/home/user/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9045 @item @file{/mnt/cross/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9046 @item @file{/project/build/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9047 @item @file{/home/user/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9048 @item @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}
9049 @item @file{/project/build/foo.c}
9050 @item @file{/home/user/foo.c}
9051
9052 @end enumerate
9053
9054 If the file name in the previous example had been recorded in the
9055 executable as a relative path rather than an absolute path, then the
9056 first look up would not have occurred, but all of the remaining steps
9057 would be similar.
9058
9059 When searching for source files on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where
9060 absolute paths start with a drive letter (e.g.
9061 @file{C:/project/foo.c}), @value{GDBN} will remove the drive letter
9062 from the file name before appending it to a search directory from
9063 @dfn{source path}; for instance if the executable references the
9064 source file @file{C:/project/foo.c} and @dfn{source path} is set to
9065 @file{D:/mnt/cross}, then @value{GDBN} will search in the following
9066 locations for the source file:
9067
9068 @enumerate
9069
9070 @item @file{C:/project/foo.c}
9071 @item @file{D:/mnt/cross/project/foo.c}
9072 @item @file{D:/mnt/cross/foo.c}
9073
9074 @end enumerate
9075
9076 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
9077 source files.
9078
9079 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
9080 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
9081 each line is in the file.
9082
9083 @kindex directory
9084 @kindex dir
9085 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{$cdir}
9086 and @samp{$cwd}, in that order.
9087 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
9088
9089 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
9090 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
9091
9092 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
9093 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
9094 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
9095 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
9096 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
9097 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
9098 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
9099 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
9100 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
9101 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
9102 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
9103 name to look up the sources.
9104
9105 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
9106 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
9107 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
9108 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
9109 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
9110 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
9111 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
9112 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
9113
9114 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
9115 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
9116 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
9117 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
9118 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
9119 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
9120 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
9121
9122 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
9123 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
9124 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
9125 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
9126 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
9127 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
9128 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
9129 command.
9130
9131 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
9132 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
9133 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
9134 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
9135 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
9136 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
9137 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
9138
9139 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
9140 @cindex default source path substitution
9141 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
9142 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
9143 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
9144 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
9145 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
9146 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
9147 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
9148 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
9149 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
9150 together.
9151
9152 @table @code
9153 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
9154 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
9155 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
9156 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
9157 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
9158 part of absolute file names) or
9159 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
9160 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
9161
9162 The special strings @samp{$cdir} (to refer to the compilation
9163 directory, if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} (to refer to the
9164 current working directory) can also be included in the list of
9165 directories @var{dirname}. Though these will already be in the source
9166 path they will be moved forward in the list so @value{GDBN} searches
9167 them sooner.
9168
9169 @item directory
9170 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
9171
9172 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
9173 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
9174
9175 @item set directories @var{path-list}
9176 @kindex set directories
9177 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
9178 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
9179
9180 @item show directories
9181 @kindex show directories
9182 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
9183
9184 @anchor{set substitute-path}
9185 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
9186 @kindex set substitute-path
9187 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
9188 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
9189 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
9190
9191 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
9192 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
9193
9194 @smallexample
9195 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
9196 @end smallexample
9197
9198 @noindent
9199 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
9200 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
9201 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
9202
9203 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
9204 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
9205 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
9206 the substitution.
9207
9208 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
9209
9210 @smallexample
9211 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
9212 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
9213 @end smallexample
9214
9215 @noindent
9216 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
9217 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
9218 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
9219 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
9220
9221
9222 @item unset substitute-path [path]
9223 @kindex unset substitute-path
9224 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
9225 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
9226 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
9227
9228 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
9229
9230 @item show substitute-path [path]
9231 @kindex show substitute-path
9232 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
9233 which would rewrite that path, if any.
9234
9235 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
9236 rules.
9237
9238 @end table
9239
9240 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
9241 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
9242 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
9243
9244 @enumerate
9245 @item
9246 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
9247
9248 @item
9249 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
9250 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
9251 directories in one command.
9252 @end enumerate
9253
9254 @node Machine Code
9255 @section Source and Machine Code
9256 @cindex source line and its code address
9257
9258 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
9259 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
9260 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
9261 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
9262 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
9263 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
9264 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
9265 well as hex.
9266
9267 @table @code
9268 @kindex info line
9269 @item info line
9270 @itemx info line @var{location}
9271 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
9272 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
9273 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
9274 information about the current source line is printed.
9275 @end table
9276
9277 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
9278 the object code for the first line of function
9279 @code{m4_changequote}:
9280
9281 @smallexample
9282 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
9283 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
9284 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
9285 @end smallexample
9286
9287 @noindent
9288 @cindex code address and its source line
9289 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
9290 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
9291 @smallexample
9292 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
9293 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
9294 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
9295 @end smallexample
9296
9297 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
9298 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
9299 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
9300 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
9301 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
9302 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
9303 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
9304 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9305 Variables}).
9306
9307 @cindex info line, repeated calls
9308 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
9309 specifying a location will display information about the next source
9310 line.
9311
9312 @table @code
9313 @kindex disassemble
9314 @cindex assembly instructions
9315 @cindex instructions, assembly
9316 @cindex machine instructions
9317 @cindex listing machine instructions
9318 @item disassemble
9319 @itemx disassemble /m
9320 @itemx disassemble /s
9321 @itemx disassemble /r
9322 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
9323 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
9324 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
9325 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
9326 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
9327 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
9328 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
9329 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
9330 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
9331 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
9332
9333 @table @code
9334 @item @var{start},@var{end}
9335 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
9336 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
9337 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
9338 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
9339 @end table
9340
9341 @noindent
9342 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
9343 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
9344
9345 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
9346 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
9347
9348 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
9349 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
9350 @end table
9351
9352 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
9353 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
9354
9355 @smallexample
9356 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
9357 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
9358 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
9359 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
9360 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
9361 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
9362 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
9363 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
9364 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
9365 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
9366 End of assembler dump.
9367 @end smallexample
9368
9369 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
9370 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
9371 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
9372
9373 @smallexample
9374 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
9375 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9376 5 @{
9377 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
9378 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
9379 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
9380 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
9381 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
9382
9383 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
9384 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
9385 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
9386
9387 7 return 0;
9388 8 @}
9389 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
9390 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
9391 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
9392
9393 End of assembler dump.
9394 @end smallexample
9395
9396 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
9397 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
9398 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
9399 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
9400 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
9401 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
9402 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
9403 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
9404 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
9405
9406 @file{foo.h}:
9407
9408 @smallexample
9409 int
9410 foo (int a)
9411 @{
9412 if (a < 0)
9413 return a * 2;
9414 if (a == 0)
9415 return 1;
9416 return a + 10;
9417 @}
9418 @end smallexample
9419
9420 @file{foo.c}:
9421
9422 @smallexample
9423 #include "foo.h"
9424 volatile int x, y;
9425 int
9426 main ()
9427 @{
9428 x = foo (y);
9429 return 0;
9430 @}
9431 @end smallexample
9432
9433 @smallexample
9434 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
9435 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9436 5 @{
9437
9438 6 x = foo (y);
9439 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9440 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9441
9442 7 return 0;
9443 8 @}
9444 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9445 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9446 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9447 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9448
9449 End of assembler dump.
9450 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
9451 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9452 foo.c:
9453 5 @{
9454 6 x = foo (y);
9455 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9456
9457 foo.h:
9458 4 if (a < 0)
9459 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
9460 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
9461
9462 6 if (a == 0)
9463 7 return 1;
9464 8 return a + 10;
9465 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
9466 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
9467 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
9468 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
9469
9470 foo.c:
9471 6 x = foo (y);
9472 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9473
9474 7 return 0;
9475 8 @}
9476 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9477 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9478
9479 foo.h:
9480 5 return a * 2;
9481 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9482 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9483 End of assembler dump.
9484 @end smallexample
9485
9486 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
9487
9488 @smallexample
9489 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
9490 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
9491 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
9492 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
9493 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
9494 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
9495 End of assembler dump.
9496 @end smallexample
9497
9498 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
9499 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
9500 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
9501 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
9502
9503 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
9504 mnemonics or other syntax.
9505
9506 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
9507 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
9508 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
9509 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
9510 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
9511
9512 @table @code
9513 @kindex set disassembler-options
9514 @cindex disassembler options
9515 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
9516 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
9517 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
9518 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
9519 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
9520 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
9521 The default value is the empty string.
9522
9523 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
9524 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
9525 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
9526 and S/390.
9527
9528 @kindex show disassembler-options
9529 @item show disassembler-options
9530 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
9531 @end table
9532
9533 @table @code
9534 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
9535 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
9536 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
9537 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
9538 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
9539 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
9540
9541 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
9542 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
9543 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
9544 assemblers for x86-based targets.
9545
9546 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
9547 @item show disassembly-flavor
9548 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
9549 @end table
9550
9551 @table @code
9552 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
9553 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
9554 @item set disassemble-next-line
9555 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
9556 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
9557 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
9558 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
9559 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
9560 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
9561 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
9562 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
9563 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
9564 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
9565 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
9566 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
9567 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
9568 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
9569 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
9570 instruction.
9571 @end table
9572
9573
9574 @node Data
9575 @chapter Examining Data
9576
9577 @cindex printing data
9578 @cindex examining data
9579 @kindex print
9580 @kindex inspect
9581 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9582 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9583 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9584 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9585 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9586 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9587
9588 @table @code
9589 @item print [[@var{options}] --] @var{expr}
9590 @itemx print [[@var{options}] --] /@var{f} @var{expr}
9591 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9592 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9593 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9594 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9595 Formats}.
9596
9597 @anchor{print options}
9598 The @code{print} command supports a number of options that allow
9599 overriding relevant global print settings as set by @code{set print}
9600 subcommands:
9601
9602 @table @code
9603 @item -address [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9604 Set printing of addresses.
9605 Related setting: @ref{set print address}.
9606
9607 @item -array [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9608 Pretty formatting of arrays.
9609 Related setting: @ref{set print array}.
9610
9611 @item -array-indexes [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9612 Set printing of array indexes.
9613 Related setting: @ref{set print array-indexes}.
9614
9615 @item -elements @var{number-of-elements}|@code{unlimited}
9616 Set limit on string chars or array elements to print. The value
9617 @code{unlimited} causes there to be no limit. Related setting:
9618 @ref{set print elements}.
9619
9620 @item -max-depth @var{depth}|@code{unlimited}
9621 Set the threshold after which nested structures are replaced with
9622 ellipsis. Related setting: @ref{set print max-depth}.
9623
9624 @item -null-stop [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9625 Set printing of char arrays to stop at first null char. Related
9626 setting: @ref{set print null-stop}.
9627
9628 @item -object [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9629 Set printing C@t{++} virtual function tables. Related setting:
9630 @ref{set print object}.
9631
9632 @item -pretty [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9633 Set pretty formatting of structures. Related setting: @ref{set print
9634 pretty}.
9635
9636 @item -repeats @var{number-of-repeats}|@code{unlimited}
9637 Set threshold for repeated print elements. @code{unlimited} causes
9638 all elements to be individually printed. Related setting: @ref{set
9639 print repeats}.
9640
9641 @item -static-members [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9642 Set printing C@t{++} static members. Related setting: @ref{set print
9643 static-members}.
9644
9645 @item -symbol [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9646 Set printing of symbol names when printing pointers. Related setting:
9647 @ref{set print symbol}.
9648
9649 @item -union [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9650 Set printing of unions interior to structures. Related setting:
9651 @ref{set print union}.
9652
9653 @item -vtbl [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9654 Set printing of C++ virtual function tables. Related setting:
9655 @ref{set print vtbl}.
9656 @end table
9657
9658 Because the @code{print} command accepts arbitrary expressions which
9659 may look like options (including abbreviations), if you specify any
9660 command option, then you must use a double dash (@code{--}) to mark
9661 the end of option processing.
9662
9663 For example, this prints the value of the @code{-r} expression:
9664
9665 @smallexample
9666 (@value{GDBP}) print -r
9667 @end smallexample
9668
9669 While this repeats the last value in the value history (see below)
9670 with the @code{-raw} option in effect:
9671
9672 @smallexample
9673 (@value{GDBP}) print -r --
9674 @end smallexample
9675
9676 Here is an example including both on option and an expression:
9677
9678 @smallexample
9679 @group
9680 (@value{GDBP}) print -pretty -- *myptr
9681 $1 = @{
9682 next = 0x0,
9683 flags = @{
9684 sweet = 1,
9685 sour = 1
9686 @},
9687 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9688 @}
9689 @end group
9690 @end smallexample
9691
9692 @item print [@var{options}]
9693 @itemx print [@var{options}] /@var{f}
9694 @cindex reprint the last value
9695 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9696 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9697 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9698 @end table
9699
9700 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9701 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9702 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9703
9704 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9705 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9706 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9707 Table}.
9708
9709 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9710 @kindex explore
9711 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9712 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9713 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9714 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9715 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9716 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9717 embedded in the higher level data types.
9718
9719 @table @code
9720 @item explore @var{arg}
9721 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9722 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9723 @end table
9724
9725 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9726 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9727 C program as
9728
9729 @smallexample
9730 struct SimpleStruct
9731 @{
9732 int i;
9733 double d;
9734 @};
9735
9736 struct ComplexStruct
9737 @{
9738 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9739 int arr[10];
9740 @};
9741 @end smallexample
9742
9743 @noindent
9744 followed by variable declarations as
9745
9746 @smallexample
9747 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9748 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9749 @end smallexample
9750
9751 @noindent
9752 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9753 @code{explore} command as follows.
9754
9755 @smallexample
9756 (gdb) explore cs
9757 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9758 the following fields:
9759
9760 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9761 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9762
9763 Enter the field number of choice:
9764 @end smallexample
9765
9766 @noindent
9767 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9768 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9769 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9770 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9771 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9772 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9773 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9774 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9775
9776 @smallexample
9777 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9778 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9779 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9780 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9781
9782 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9783 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9784
9785 Press enter to return to parent value:
9786 @end smallexample
9787
9788 @noindent
9789 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9790 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9791 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9792 to explore.
9793
9794 @smallexample
9795 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9796 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9797
9798 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9799
9800 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9801
9802 Press enter to return to parent value:
9803 @end smallexample
9804
9805 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9806 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9807 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9808 level data structure).
9809
9810 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9811 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9812 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9813 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9814 same example as above, your can explore the type
9815 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9816 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9817
9818 @smallexample
9819 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9820 @end smallexample
9821
9822 @noindent
9823 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9824 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9825 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9826 example.
9827
9828 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9829 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9830 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9831 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9832 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9833
9834 @table @code
9835 @item explore value @var{expr}
9836 @cindex explore value
9837 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9838 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9839 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9840 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9841 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9842
9843 @item explore type @var{arg}
9844 @cindex explore type
9845 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9846 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9847 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9848 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9849 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9850 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9851 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9852 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9853 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9854 @end table
9855
9856 @menu
9857 * Expressions:: Expressions
9858 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9859 * Variables:: Program variables
9860 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9861 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9862 * Memory:: Examining memory
9863 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9864 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9865 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9866 * Value History:: Value history
9867 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9868 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9869 * Registers:: Registers
9870 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9871 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9872 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9873 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9874 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9875 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9876 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9877 character set than GDB does
9878 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9879 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9880 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9881 @end menu
9882
9883 @node Expressions
9884 @section Expressions
9885
9886 @cindex expressions
9887 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9888 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9889 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9890 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9891 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9892 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9893 @ref{Compilation}.
9894
9895 @cindex arrays in expressions
9896 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9897 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9898 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9899 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9900 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9901 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9902
9903 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9904 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9905 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9906 languages.
9907
9908 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9909 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9910
9911 @cindex casts, in expressions
9912 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9913 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9914 at that address in memory.
9915 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9916
9917 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9918 to programming languages:
9919
9920 @table @code
9921 @item @@
9922 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9923 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9924
9925 @item ::
9926 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9927 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9928
9929 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9930 @cindex type casting memory
9931 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9932 @cindex casts, to view memory
9933 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9934 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9935 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9936 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9937 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9938 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9939 @end table
9940
9941 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9942 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9943 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9944
9945 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9946 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9947 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9948 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9949 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9950 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9951 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9952
9953 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9954 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9955 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9956 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9957 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9958 as well.
9959
9960 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9961 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9962 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9963 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9964 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9965 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9966 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9967 choices.
9968
9969 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9970 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9971 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9972
9973 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9974 @smallexample
9975 @group
9976 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9977 [0] cancel
9978 [1] all
9979 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9980 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9981 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9982 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9983 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9984 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9985 > 2 4 6
9986 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9987 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9988 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9989 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9990 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9991 breakpoints.
9992 (@value{GDBP})
9993 @end group
9994 @end smallexample
9995
9996 @table @code
9997 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9998 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9999 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
10000
10001 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
10002 is ambiguous.
10003
10004 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
10005 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
10006 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
10007 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
10008 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
10009 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
10010 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
10011 in the use of the menu.
10012
10013 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
10014 when an ambiguity is detected.
10015
10016 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
10017 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
10018
10019 @kindex show multiple-symbols
10020 @item show multiple-symbols
10021 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
10022 @end table
10023
10024 @node Variables
10025 @section Program Variables
10026
10027 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
10028 in your program.
10029
10030 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
10031 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
10032
10033 @itemize @bullet
10034 @item
10035 global (or file-static)
10036 @end itemize
10037
10038 @noindent or
10039
10040 @itemize @bullet
10041 @item
10042 visible according to the scope rules of the
10043 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
10044 @end itemize
10045
10046 @noindent This means that in the function
10047
10048 @smallexample
10049 foo (a)
10050 int a;
10051 @{
10052 bar (a);
10053 @{
10054 int b = test ();
10055 bar (b);
10056 @}
10057 @}
10058 @end smallexample
10059
10060 @noindent
10061 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
10062 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
10063 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
10064 the block where @code{b} is declared.
10065
10066 @cindex variable name conflict
10067 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
10068 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
10069 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
10070 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
10071 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
10072 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
10073 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
10074
10075 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
10076 @ifnotinfo
10077 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
10078 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
10079 @end ifnotinfo
10080 @smallexample
10081 @var{file}::@var{variable}
10082 @var{function}::@var{variable}
10083 @end smallexample
10084
10085 @noindent
10086 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
10087 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
10088 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
10089 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
10090
10091 @smallexample
10092 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
10093 @end smallexample
10094
10095 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
10096 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
10097 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
10098 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
10099 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
10100
10101 @smallexample
10102 void
10103 foo (int a)
10104 @{
10105 if (a < 10)
10106 bar (a);
10107 else
10108 process (a); /* Stop here */
10109 @}
10110
10111 int
10112 bar (int a)
10113 @{
10114 foo (a + 5);
10115 @}
10116 @end smallexample
10117
10118 @noindent
10119 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
10120 here is what you might see
10121 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
10122
10123 @smallexample
10124 (@value{GDBP}) p a
10125 $1 = 10
10126 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
10127 $2 = 5
10128 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
10129 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
10130 (@value{GDBP}) p a
10131 $3 = 5
10132 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
10133 $4 = 0
10134 @end smallexample
10135
10136 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
10137 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
10138 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
10139 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
10140 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
10141
10142 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
10143 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
10144 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
10145 @code{some_global}.
10146
10147 @smallexample
10148 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
10149 $1 = 23
10150 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
10151 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
10152 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
10153 $2 = 27
10154 @end smallexample
10155
10156 @cindex wrong values
10157 @cindex variable values, wrong
10158 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
10159 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
10160 @quotation
10161 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
10162 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
10163 scope, and just before exit.
10164 @end quotation
10165 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
10166 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
10167 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
10168 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
10169 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
10170 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
10171 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
10172 variable definitions may be gone.
10173
10174 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
10175 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
10176 when compiling.
10177
10178 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
10179 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
10180 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
10181 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
10182 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
10183 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
10184 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
10185
10186 @smallexample
10187 No symbol "foo" in current context.
10188 @end smallexample
10189
10190 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
10191 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
10192 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
10193 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
10194 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
10195
10196 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
10197 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
10198 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
10199 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
10200
10201 @cindex no debug info variables
10202 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
10203 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
10204 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
10205 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
10206 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
10207 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
10208 example, in a C program:
10209
10210 @smallexample
10211 (@value{GDBP}) p var
10212 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
10213 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
10214 $1 = 3.14
10215 @end smallexample
10216
10217 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
10218 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
10219 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
10220 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
10221 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
10222
10223 @smallexample
10224 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
10225 29 i++;
10226 (gdb) next
10227 30 e (i);
10228 (gdb) print i
10229 $1 = 31
10230 (gdb) print i@@entry
10231 $2 = 30
10232 @end smallexample
10233
10234 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
10235 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
10236 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
10237 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
10238 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
10239 For program code
10240
10241 @smallexample
10242 char var0[] = "A";
10243 signed char var1[] = "A";
10244 @end smallexample
10245
10246 You get during debugging
10247 @smallexample
10248 (gdb) print var0
10249 $1 = "A"
10250 (gdb) print var1
10251 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
10252 @end smallexample
10253
10254 @node Arrays
10255 @section Artificial Arrays
10256
10257 @cindex artificial array
10258 @cindex arrays
10259 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
10260 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
10261 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
10262 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
10263 program.
10264
10265 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
10266 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
10267 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
10268 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
10269 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
10270 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
10271 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
10272 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
10273 example. If a program says
10274
10275 @smallexample
10276 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
10277 @end smallexample
10278
10279 @noindent
10280 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
10281
10282 @smallexample
10283 p *array@@len
10284 @end smallexample
10285
10286 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
10287 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
10288 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
10289 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
10290 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
10291
10292 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
10293 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
10294 The value need not be in memory:
10295 @smallexample
10296 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
10297 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
10298 @end smallexample
10299
10300 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
10301 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
10302 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
10303 @smallexample
10304 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
10305 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
10306 @end smallexample
10307
10308 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
10309 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
10310 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
10311 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
10312 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
10313 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
10314 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
10315 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
10316 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
10317 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
10318
10319 @smallexample
10320 set $i = 0
10321 p dtab[$i++]->fv
10322 @key{RET}
10323 @key{RET}
10324 @dots{}
10325 @end smallexample
10326
10327 @node Output Formats
10328 @section Output Formats
10329
10330 @cindex formatted output
10331 @cindex output formats
10332 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
10333 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
10334 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
10335 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
10336 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
10337
10338 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
10339 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
10340 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
10341 letters supported are:
10342
10343 @table @code
10344 @item x
10345 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
10346 hexadecimal.
10347
10348 @item d
10349 Print as integer in signed decimal.
10350
10351 @item u
10352 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
10353
10354 @item o
10355 Print as integer in octal.
10356
10357 @item t
10358 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
10359 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
10360 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
10361 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
10362
10363 @item a
10364 @cindex unknown address, locating
10365 @cindex locate address
10366 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
10367 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
10368 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
10369
10370 @smallexample
10371 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
10372 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
10373 @end smallexample
10374
10375 @noindent
10376 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
10377 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
10378
10379 @item c
10380 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
10381 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
10382 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
10383 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
10384
10385 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
10386 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
10387 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
10388 data.
10389
10390 @item f
10391 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
10392 using typical floating point syntax.
10393
10394 @item s
10395 @cindex printing strings
10396 @cindex printing byte arrays
10397 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
10398 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
10399 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
10400 natural types.
10401
10402 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
10403 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
10404 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
10405 array.
10406
10407 @item z
10408 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
10409 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
10410 to the size of the integer type.
10411
10412 @item r
10413 @cindex raw printing
10414 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
10415 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
10416 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
10417 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
10418 pretty-printer which might exist.
10419 @end table
10420
10421 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
10422
10423 @smallexample
10424 p/x $pc
10425 @end smallexample
10426
10427 @noindent
10428 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
10429 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
10430
10431 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
10432 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
10433 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
10434
10435 @node Memory
10436 @section Examining Memory
10437
10438 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
10439 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
10440
10441 @cindex examining memory
10442 @table @code
10443 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
10444 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
10445 @itemx x @var{addr}
10446 @itemx x
10447 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
10448 @end table
10449
10450 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
10451 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
10452 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
10453 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
10454 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
10455
10456 @table @r
10457 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
10458 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
10459 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
10460 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
10461 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
10462 @c 4.1.2.
10463
10464 @item @var{f}, the display format
10465 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
10466 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
10467 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
10468 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
10469 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
10470
10471 @item @var{u}, the unit size
10472 The unit size is any of
10473
10474 @table @code
10475 @item b
10476 Bytes.
10477 @item h
10478 Halfwords (two bytes).
10479 @item w
10480 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
10481 @item g
10482 Giant words (eight bytes).
10483 @end table
10484
10485 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
10486 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
10487 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
10488 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
10489 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
10490 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
10491 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
10492 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
10493 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
10494 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
10495 be altered.
10496
10497 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
10498 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
10499 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
10500 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
10501 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
10502 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
10503 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
10504 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
10505 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
10506 a value from memory).
10507 @end table
10508
10509 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
10510 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
10511 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
10512 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
10513 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
10514
10515 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
10516 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
10517 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
10518
10519 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
10520 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
10521 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
10522 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
10523 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
10524
10525 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
10526 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
10527 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
10528 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
10529 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
10530 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
10531 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
10532 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
10533 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
10534
10535 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
10536 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
10537 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
10538 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
10539 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
10540 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
10541
10542 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
10543 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
10544 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
10545 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
10546 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
10547 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
10548 for successive uses of @code{x}.
10549
10550 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
10551 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
10552
10553 @smallexample
10554 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
10555 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
10556 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
10557 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
10558 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
10559 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
10560 @end smallexample
10561
10562 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
10563 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
10564 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
10565 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
10566 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
10567 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
10568 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
10569 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
10570 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
10571
10572 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
10573 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
10574 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
10575
10576 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
10577 @cindex addressable memory unit
10578 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
10579 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
10580 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
10581 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
10582 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
10583 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
10584 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
10585 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
10586 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
10587
10588 @cindex remote memory comparison
10589 @cindex target memory comparison
10590 @cindex verify remote memory image
10591 @cindex verify target memory image
10592 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
10593 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
10594 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
10595 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
10596 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
10597 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
10598
10599 @table @code
10600 @kindex compare-sections
10601 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
10602 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
10603 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
10604 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
10605 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
10606 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
10607
10608 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
10609 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
10610 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
10611 @end table
10612
10613 @node Auto Display
10614 @section Automatic Display
10615 @cindex automatic display
10616 @cindex display of expressions
10617
10618 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
10619 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
10620 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
10621 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
10622 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
10623 The automatic display looks like this:
10624
10625 @smallexample
10626 2: foo = 38
10627 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
10628 @end smallexample
10629
10630 @noindent
10631 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
10632 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
10633 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
10634 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
10635 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
10636 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
10637
10638 @table @code
10639 @kindex display
10640 @item display @var{expr}
10641 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
10642 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10643
10644 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10645
10646 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
10647 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
10648 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
10649 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
10650 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
10651
10652 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
10653 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
10654 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
10655 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
10656 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
10657 @end table
10658
10659 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
10660 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
10661 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10662
10663 @table @code
10664 @kindex delete display
10665 @kindex undisplay
10666 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10667 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10668 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10669 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10670 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10671 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10672 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10673
10674 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10675 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10676
10677 @kindex disable display
10678 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10679 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10680 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10681 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10682 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10683 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10684 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10685 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10686
10687 @kindex enable display
10688 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10689 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10690 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10691 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10692 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10693 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10694 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10695
10696 @item display
10697 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10698 done when your program stops.
10699
10700 @kindex info display
10701 @item info display
10702 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10703 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10704 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10705 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10706 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10707 @end table
10708
10709 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10710 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10711 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10712 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10713 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10714 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10715 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10716 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10717 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10718 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10719 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10720
10721 @node Print Settings
10722 @section Print Settings
10723
10724 @cindex format options
10725 @cindex print settings
10726 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10727 and symbols are printed.
10728
10729 @noindent
10730 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10731
10732 @table @code
10733 @kindex set print
10734 @anchor{set print address}
10735 @item set print address
10736 @itemx set print address on
10737 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10738 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10739 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10740 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10741 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10742 @code{set print address on}:
10743
10744 @smallexample
10745 @group
10746 (@value{GDBP}) f
10747 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10748 at input.c:530
10749 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10750 @end group
10751 @end smallexample
10752
10753 @item set print address off
10754 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10755 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10756
10757 @smallexample
10758 @group
10759 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10760 (@value{GDBP}) f
10761 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10762 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10763 @end group
10764 @end smallexample
10765
10766 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10767 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10768 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10769 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10770
10771 @kindex show print
10772 @item show print address
10773 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10774 @end table
10775
10776 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10777 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10778 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10779 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10780 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10781 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10782 it prints a symbolic address:
10783
10784 @table @code
10785 @item set print symbol-filename on
10786 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10787 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10788 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10789 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10790
10791 @item set print symbol-filename off
10792 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10793 default.
10794
10795 @item show print symbol-filename
10796 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10797 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10798 @end table
10799
10800 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10801 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10802 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10803
10804 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10805 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10806
10807 @table @code
10808 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10809 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10810 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10811 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10812 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10813 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10814 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10815 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10816
10817 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10818 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10819 symbolic address.
10820 @end table
10821
10822 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10823 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10824 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10825 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10826 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10827 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10828 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10829 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10830
10831 @smallexample
10832 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10833 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10834 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10835 @end smallexample
10836
10837 @quotation
10838 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10839 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10840 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10841 @end quotation
10842
10843 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10844 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10845
10846 @anchor{set print symbol}
10847 @table @code
10848 @item set print symbol on
10849 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10850 one exists.
10851
10852 @item set print symbol off
10853 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10854 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10855 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10856
10857 @item show print symbol
10858 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10859 address.
10860 @end table
10861
10862 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10863
10864 @table @code
10865 @anchor{set print array}
10866 @item set print array
10867 @itemx set print array on
10868 @cindex pretty print arrays
10869 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10870 but uses more space. The default is off.
10871
10872 @item set print array off
10873 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10874
10875 @item show print array
10876 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10877 arrays.
10878
10879 @cindex print array indexes
10880 @anchor{set print array-indexes}
10881 @item set print array-indexes
10882 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10883 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10884 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10885 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10886
10887 @item set print array-indexes off
10888 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10889
10890 @item show print array-indexes
10891 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10892 arrays.
10893
10894 @anchor{set print elements}
10895 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10896 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10897 @cindex number of array elements to print
10898 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10899 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10900 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10901 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10902 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10903 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10904 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10905 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10906
10907 @item show print elements
10908 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10909 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10910
10911 @anchor{set print frame-arguments}
10912 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10913 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10914 @cindex printing frame argument values
10915 @cindex print all frame argument values
10916 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10917 @cindex do not print frame arguments
10918 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10919 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10920 values are:
10921
10922 @table @code
10923 @item all
10924 The values of all arguments are printed.
10925
10926 @item scalars
10927 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10928 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10929 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10930 only scalar arguments are shown:
10931
10932 @smallexample
10933 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10934 at frame-args.c:23
10935 @end smallexample
10936
10937 @item none
10938 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10939 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10940
10941 @smallexample
10942 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10943 at frame-args.c:23
10944 @end smallexample
10945
10946 @item presence
10947 Only the presence of arguments is indicated by @code{@dots{}}.
10948 The @code{@dots{}} are not printed for function without any arguments.
10949 None of the argument names and values are printed.
10950 In this case, the example above now becomes:
10951
10952 @smallexample
10953 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (@dots{}) at frame-args.c:23
10954 @end smallexample
10955
10956 @end table
10957
10958 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10959 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10960 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10961 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10962 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10963 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10964 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10965 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10966 to @code{scalars} (the default), @code{none} or @code{presence} avoids
10967 this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10968
10969 @item show print frame-arguments
10970 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10971
10972 @anchor{set print raw-frame-arguments}
10973 @item set print raw-frame-arguments on
10974 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10975
10976 @item set print raw-frame-arguments off
10977 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10978 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10979 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10980 This is the default.
10981
10982 @item show print raw-frame-arguments
10983 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10984
10985 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10986 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10987 @kindex set print entry-values
10988 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10989 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10990 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10991 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10992 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10993
10994 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10995 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10996 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10997 @code{no} setting.
10998
10999 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11000 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
11001 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11002 this information.
11003
11004 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
11005
11006 @table @code
11007 @item no
11008 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
11009 point.
11010 @smallexample
11011 #0 equal (val=5)
11012 #0 different (val=6)
11013 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
11014 #0 born (val=10)
11015 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
11016 @end smallexample
11017
11018 @item only
11019 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
11020 values are never printed.
11021 @smallexample
11022 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
11023 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
11024 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
11025 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11026 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11027 @end smallexample
11028
11029 @item preferred
11030 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
11031 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
11032 value for such parameter.
11033 @smallexample
11034 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
11035 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
11036 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
11037 #0 born (val=10)
11038 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11039 @end smallexample
11040
11041 @item if-needed
11042 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
11043 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
11044 parameter.
11045 @smallexample
11046 #0 equal (val=5)
11047 #0 different (val=6)
11048 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
11049 #0 born (val=10)
11050 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
11051 @end smallexample
11052
11053 @item both
11054 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
11055 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
11056 optimizations.
11057 @smallexample
11058 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
11059 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
11060 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
11061 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11062 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11063 @end smallexample
11064
11065 @item compact
11066 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
11067 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
11068 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
11069 values are known and identical, print the shortened
11070 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
11071 @smallexample
11072 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
11073 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
11074 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
11075 #0 born (val=10)
11076 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
11077 @end smallexample
11078
11079 @item default
11080 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
11081 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
11082 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
11083 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
11084 @smallexample
11085 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
11086 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
11087 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
11088 #0 born (val=10)
11089 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
11090 @end smallexample
11091 @end table
11092
11093 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
11094 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
11095
11096 @item show print entry-values
11097 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
11098 entry.
11099
11100 @anchor{set print frame-info}
11101 @item set print frame-info @var{value}
11102 @kindex set print frame-info
11103 @cindex printing frame information
11104 @cindex frame information, printing
11105 This command allows to control the information printed when
11106 the debugger prints a frame. See @ref{Frames}, @ref{Backtrace},
11107 for a general explanation about frames and frame information.
11108 Note that some other settings (such as @code{set print frame-arguments}
11109 and @code{set print address}) are also influencing if and how some frame
11110 information is displayed. In particular, the frame program counter is never
11111 printed if @code{set print address} is off.
11112
11113 The possible values for @code{set print frame-info} are:
11114 @table @code
11115 @item short-location
11116 Print the frame level, the program counter (if not at the
11117 beginning of the location source line), the function, the function
11118 arguments.
11119 @item location
11120 Same as @code{short-location} but also print the source file and source line
11121 number.
11122 @item location-and-address
11123 Same as @code{location} but print the program counter even if located at the
11124 beginning of the location source line.
11125 @item source-line
11126 Print the program counter (if not at the beginning of the location
11127 source line), the line number and the source line.
11128 @item source-and-location
11129 Print what @code{location} and @code{source-line} are printing.
11130 @item auto
11131 The information printed for a frame is decided automatically
11132 by the @value{GDBN} command that prints a frame.
11133 For example, @code{frame} prints the information printed by
11134 @code{source-and-location} while @code{stepi} will switch between
11135 @code{source-line} and @code{source-and-location} depending on the program
11136 counter.
11137 The default value is @code{auto}.
11138 @end table
11139
11140 @anchor{set print repeats}
11141 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
11142 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
11143 @cindex repeated array elements
11144 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
11145 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
11146 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
11147 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
11148 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
11149 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
11150 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
11151 is 10.
11152
11153 @item show print repeats
11154 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
11155 elements.
11156
11157 @anchor{set print max-depth}
11158 @item set print max-depth @var{depth}
11159 @item set print max-depth unlimited
11160 @cindex printing nested structures
11161 Set the threshold after which nested structures are replaced with
11162 ellipsis, this can make visualising deeply nested structures easier.
11163
11164 For example, given this C code
11165
11166 @smallexample
11167 typedef struct s1 @{ int a; @} s1;
11168 typedef struct s2 @{ s1 b; @} s2;
11169 typedef struct s3 @{ s2 c; @} s3;
11170 typedef struct s4 @{ s3 d; @} s4;
11171
11172 s4 var = @{ @{ @{ @{ 3 @} @} @} @};
11173 @end smallexample
11174
11175 The following table shows how different values of @var{depth} will
11176 effect how @code{var} is printed by @value{GDBN}:
11177
11178 @multitable @columnfractions .3 .7
11179 @headitem @var{depth} setting @tab Result of @samp{p var}
11180 @item unlimited
11181 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}@}@}}
11182 @item @code{0}
11183 @tab @code{$1 = @{...@}}
11184 @item @code{1}
11185 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{...@}@}}
11186 @item @code{2}
11187 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{...@}@}@}}
11188 @item @code{3}
11189 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{...@}@}@}@}}
11190 @item @code{4}
11191 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}@}@}}
11192 @end multitable
11193
11194 To see the contents of structures that have been hidden the user can
11195 either increase the print max-depth, or they can print the elements of
11196 the structure that are visible, for example
11197
11198 @smallexample
11199 (gdb) set print max-depth 2
11200 (gdb) p var
11201 $1 = @{d = @{c = @{...@}@}@}
11202 (gdb) p var.d
11203 $2 = @{c = @{b = @{...@}@}@}
11204 (gdb) p var.d.c
11205 $3 = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}
11206 @end smallexample
11207
11208 The pattern used to replace nested structures varies based on
11209 language, for most languages @code{@{...@}} is used, but Fortran uses
11210 @code{(...)}.
11211
11212 @item show print max-depth
11213 Display the current threshold after which nested structures are
11214 replaces with ellipsis.
11215
11216 @anchor{set print null-stop}
11217 @item set print null-stop
11218 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
11219 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
11220 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
11221 contain only short strings.
11222 The default is off.
11223
11224 @item show print null-stop
11225 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
11226 @sc{null} character.
11227
11228 @anchor{set print pretty}
11229 @item set print pretty on
11230 @cindex print structures in indented form
11231 @cindex indentation in structure display
11232 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
11233 per line, like this:
11234
11235 @smallexample
11236 @group
11237 $1 = @{
11238 next = 0x0,
11239 flags = @{
11240 sweet = 1,
11241 sour = 1
11242 @},
11243 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
11244 @}
11245 @end group
11246 @end smallexample
11247
11248 @item set print pretty off
11249 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
11250
11251 @smallexample
11252 @group
11253 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
11254 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
11255 @end group
11256 @end smallexample
11257
11258 @noindent
11259 This is the default format.
11260
11261 @item show print pretty
11262 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
11263
11264 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
11265 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
11266 @cindex octal escapes in strings
11267 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
11268 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
11269 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
11270 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
11271 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
11272
11273 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
11274 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
11275 international character sets, and is the default.
11276
11277 @item show print sevenbit-strings
11278 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
11279
11280 @anchor{set print union}
11281 @item set print union on
11282 @cindex unions in structures, printing
11283 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
11284 and other unions. This is the default setting.
11285
11286 @item set print union off
11287 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
11288 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
11289 instead.
11290
11291 @item show print union
11292 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
11293 structures and other unions.
11294
11295 For example, given the declarations
11296
11297 @smallexample
11298 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
11299 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
11300 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
11301 Bug_forms;
11302
11303 struct thing @{
11304 Species it;
11305 union @{
11306 Tree_forms tree;
11307 Bug_forms bug;
11308 @} form;
11309 @};
11310
11311 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
11312 @end smallexample
11313
11314 @noindent
11315 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
11316
11317 @smallexample
11318 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
11319 @end smallexample
11320
11321 @noindent
11322 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
11323
11324 @smallexample
11325 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
11326 @end smallexample
11327
11328 @noindent
11329 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
11330 and in Pascal.
11331 @end table
11332
11333 @need 1000
11334 @noindent
11335 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
11336
11337 @table @code
11338 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
11339 @item set print demangle
11340 @itemx set print demangle on
11341 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
11342 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
11343 linkage. The default is on.
11344
11345 @item show print demangle
11346 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
11347
11348 @item set print asm-demangle
11349 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
11350 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
11351 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
11352 The default is off.
11353
11354 @item show print asm-demangle
11355 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
11356 or demangled form.
11357
11358 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
11359 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
11360 @kindex set demangle-style
11361 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
11362 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to represent
11363 C@t{++} names. If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible
11364 formats. The default value is @var{auto}, which lets @value{GDBN} choose a
11365 decoding style by inspecting your program.
11366
11367 @item show demangle-style
11368 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
11369
11370 @anchor{set print object}
11371 @item set print object
11372 @itemx set print object on
11373 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
11374 @cindex display derived types
11375 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
11376 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
11377 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
11378 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
11379 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
11380 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
11381 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
11382
11383 @item set print object off
11384 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
11385 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
11386
11387 @item show print object
11388 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
11389
11390 @anchor{set print static-members}
11391 @item set print static-members
11392 @itemx set print static-members on
11393 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
11394 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
11395
11396 @item set print static-members off
11397 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
11398
11399 @item show print static-members
11400 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
11401
11402 @item set print pascal_static-members
11403 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
11404 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
11405 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
11406 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
11407
11408 @item set print pascal_static-members off
11409 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
11410
11411 @item show print pascal_static-members
11412 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
11413
11414 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
11415 @anchor{set print vtbl}
11416 @item set print vtbl
11417 @itemx set print vtbl on
11418 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
11419 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
11420 @cindex VTBL display
11421 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
11422 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
11423 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
11424
11425 @item set print vtbl off
11426 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
11427
11428 @item show print vtbl
11429 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
11430 @end table
11431
11432 @node Pretty Printing
11433 @section Pretty Printing
11434
11435 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
11436 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
11437 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
11438
11439 @menu
11440 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
11441 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
11442 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
11443 @end menu
11444
11445 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
11446 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
11447
11448 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
11449 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
11450 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
11451
11452 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
11453 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
11454 pretty-printers with their names.
11455 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
11456 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
11457 Each such subprinter has its own name.
11458 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
11459
11460 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
11461 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
11462 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
11463 do anything special.
11464
11465 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
11466
11467 @itemize @bullet
11468 @item
11469 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
11470 all inferiors.
11471
11472 @item
11473 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
11474 when debugging that program.
11475 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
11476
11477 @item
11478 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
11479 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
11480 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
11481 @end itemize
11482
11483 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
11484 pretty-printers are selected,
11485
11486 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
11487 for new types.
11488
11489 @node Pretty-Printer Example
11490 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
11491
11492 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
11493
11494 @smallexample
11495 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11496 $1 = @{
11497 static npos = 4294967295,
11498 _M_dataplus = @{
11499 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
11500 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
11501 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
11502 @},
11503 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
11504 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
11505 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
11506 @}
11507 @}
11508 @end smallexample
11509
11510 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
11511
11512 @smallexample
11513 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11514 $2 = "abcd"
11515 @end smallexample
11516
11517 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
11518 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
11519 @cindex pretty-printer commands
11520
11521 @table @code
11522 @kindex info pretty-printer
11523 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
11524 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
11525 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
11526
11527 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
11528 whose pretty-printers to list.
11529 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
11530 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
11531 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
11532 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
11533 looks up a printer from these three objects.
11534
11535 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
11536 to list.
11537
11538 @kindex disable pretty-printer
11539 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
11540 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
11541 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
11542
11543 @kindex enable pretty-printer
11544 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
11545 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
11546 @end table
11547
11548 Example:
11549
11550 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
11551 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
11552 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
11553 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
11554
11555 @smallexample
11556 (gdb) info pretty-printer
11557 library1.so:
11558 foo
11559 library2.so:
11560 bar
11561 bar1
11562 bar2
11563 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
11564 library2.so:
11565 bar
11566 bar1
11567 bar2
11568 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
11569 1 printer disabled
11570 2 of 3 printers enabled
11571 (gdb) info pretty-printer
11572 library1.so:
11573 foo [disabled]
11574 library2.so:
11575 bar
11576 bar1
11577 bar2
11578 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
11579 1 printer disabled
11580 1 of 3 printers enabled
11581 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
11582 library1.so:
11583 foo [disabled]
11584 library2.so:
11585 bar
11586 bar1 [disabled]
11587 bar2
11588 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
11589 1 printer disabled
11590 0 of 3 printers enabled
11591 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
11592 library1.so:
11593 foo [disabled]
11594 library2.so:
11595 bar [disabled]
11596 bar1 [disabled]
11597 bar2
11598 @end smallexample
11599
11600 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
11601 as can each individual subprinter.
11602
11603 @node Value History
11604 @section Value History
11605
11606 @cindex value history
11607 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
11608 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
11609 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
11610 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
11611 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
11612 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
11613 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
11614 symbol table.
11615
11616 @cindex @code{$}
11617 @cindex @code{$$}
11618 @cindex history number
11619 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
11620 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
11621 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
11622 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
11623 history number.
11624
11625 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
11626 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
11627 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
11628 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
11629 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
11630 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
11631 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
11632
11633 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
11634 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
11635
11636 @smallexample
11637 p *$
11638 @end smallexample
11639
11640 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
11641 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
11642
11643 @smallexample
11644 p *$.next
11645 @end smallexample
11646
11647 @noindent
11648 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
11649 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
11650
11651 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
11652 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
11653
11654 @smallexample
11655 print x
11656 set x=5
11657 @end smallexample
11658
11659 @noindent
11660 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
11661 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
11662
11663 @table @code
11664 @kindex show values
11665 @item show values
11666 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
11667 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
11668 values} does not change the history.
11669
11670 @item show values @var{n}
11671 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
11672
11673 @item show values +
11674 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
11675 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
11676 @end table
11677
11678 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
11679 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
11680
11681 @node Convenience Vars
11682 @section Convenience Variables
11683
11684 @cindex convenience variables
11685 @cindex user-defined variables
11686 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
11687 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
11688 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
11689 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
11690 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
11691
11692 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
11693 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
11694 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
11695 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
11696 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
11697
11698 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
11699 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
11700 For example:
11701
11702 @smallexample
11703 set $foo = *object_ptr
11704 @end smallexample
11705
11706 @noindent
11707 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
11708 @code{object_ptr}.
11709
11710 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
11711 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
11712 value with another assignment at any time.
11713
11714 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
11715 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
11716 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
11717 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
11718
11719 @table @code
11720 @kindex show convenience
11721 @cindex show all user variables and functions
11722 @item show convenience
11723 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
11724 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
11725 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
11726
11727 @kindex init-if-undefined
11728 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
11729 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
11730 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
11731 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
11732 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
11733 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
11734 override default values used in a command script.
11735
11736 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
11737 any side-effects do not occur.
11738 @end table
11739
11740 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
11741 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
11742 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
11743
11744 @smallexample
11745 set $i = 0
11746 print bar[$i++]->contents
11747 @end smallexample
11748
11749 @noindent
11750 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
11751
11752 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
11753 values likely to be useful.
11754
11755 @table @code
11756 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
11757 @item $_
11758 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
11759 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
11760 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
11761 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
11762 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
11763 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
11764 to the type of @code{$__}.
11765
11766 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
11767 @item $__
11768 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
11769 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
11770 to match the format in which the data was printed.
11771
11772 @item $_exitcode
11773 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11774 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
11775 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
11776 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11777
11778 @item $_exitsignal
11779 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11780 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11781 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11782 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11783
11784 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11785 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11786 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11787 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11788 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11789
11790 @smallexample
11791 #include <signal.h>
11792
11793 int
11794 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11795 @{
11796 raise (SIGALRM);
11797 return 0;
11798 @}
11799 @end smallexample
11800
11801 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11802 or signalled would be:
11803
11804 @smallexample
11805 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11806 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11807 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11808 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11809 >echo The program has exited\n
11810 >else
11811 >echo The program has signalled\n
11812 >end
11813 >end
11814 (@value{GDBP}) run
11815 Starting program:
11816
11817 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11818 The program no longer exists.
11819 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11820 The program has signalled
11821 @end smallexample
11822
11823 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11824 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11825 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11826 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11827
11828 @smallexample
11829 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11830 The program has exited
11831 @end smallexample
11832
11833 @item $_exception
11834 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11835 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11836
11837 @item $_ada_exception
11838 The variable @code{$_ada_exception} is set to the address of the
11839 exception being caught or thrown at an Ada exception-related
11840 catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11841
11842 @item $_probe_argc
11843 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11844 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11845
11846 @item $_sdata
11847 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11848 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11849 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11850 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11851 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11852
11853 @item $_siginfo
11854 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11855 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11856 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11857 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11858 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11859
11860 @item $_tlb
11861 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11862 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11863 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11864 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11865 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11866 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11867
11868 @item $_inferior
11869 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11870 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11871
11872 @item $_thread
11873 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11874
11875 @item $_gthread
11876 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11877
11878 @item $_gdb_major
11879 @itemx $_gdb_minor
11880 @vindex $_gdb_major@r{, convenience variable}
11881 @vindex $_gdb_minor@r{, convenience variable}
11882 The major and minor version numbers of the running @value{GDBN}.
11883 Development snapshots and pretest versions have their minor version
11884 incremented by one; thus, @value{GDBN} pretest 9.11.90 will produce
11885 the value 12 for @code{$_gdb_minor}. These variables allow you to
11886 write scripts that work with different versions of @value{GDBN}
11887 without errors caused by features unavailable in some of those
11888 versions.
11889
11890 @item $_shell_exitcode
11891 @itemx $_shell_exitsignal
11892 @vindex $_shell_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11893 @vindex $_shell_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11894 @cindex shell command, exit code
11895 @cindex shell command, exit signal
11896 @cindex exit status of shell commands
11897 @value{GDBN} commands such as @code{shell} and @code{|} are launching
11898 shell commands. When a launched command terminates, @value{GDBN}
11899 automatically maintains the variables @code{$_shell_exitcode}
11900 and @code{$_shell_exitsignal} according to the exit status of the last
11901 launched command. These variables are set and used similarly to
11902 the variables @code{$_exitcode} and @code{$_exitsignal}.
11903
11904 @end table
11905
11906 @node Convenience Funs
11907 @section Convenience Functions
11908
11909 @cindex convenience functions
11910 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11911 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11912 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11913 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11914 @value{GDBN}.
11915
11916 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11917 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11918
11919 @table @code
11920
11921 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11922 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11923 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11924 returns zero.
11925
11926 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11927 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11928 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11929 it is @code{void}:
11930
11931 @smallexample
11932 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11933 $1 = void
11934 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11935 $2 = 1
11936 (@value{GDBP}) run
11937 Starting program: ./a.out
11938 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11939 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11940 $3 = 0
11941 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11942 $4 = 0
11943 @end smallexample
11944
11945 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11946 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11947 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11948 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11949 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11950 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11951 anymore.
11952
11953 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11954 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11955
11956 @smallexample
11957 void
11958 foo (void)
11959 @{
11960 @}
11961 @end smallexample
11962
11963 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11964
11965 @smallexample
11966 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11967 $1 = void
11968 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11969 $2 = 1
11970 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11971 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11972 $3 = void
11973 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11974 $4 = 1
11975 @end smallexample
11976
11977 @end table
11978
11979 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11980 @code{Python} support.
11981
11982 @table @code
11983
11984 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11985 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11986 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11987 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11988 Otherwise it returns zero.
11989
11990 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11991 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11992 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11993 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11994 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11995 regular expression support.
11996
11997 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11998 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11999 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
12000 Otherwise it returns zero.
12001
12002 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
12003 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
12004 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
12005
12006 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
12007 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
12008 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
12009 Otherwise it returns zero.
12010
12011 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
12012 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
12013 The default is 1.
12014
12015 Example:
12016
12017 @smallexample
12018 (gdb) backtrace
12019 #0 bottom_func ()
12020 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
12021 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
12022 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
12023 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
12024 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
12025 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
12026 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
12027 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
12028 $1 = 1
12029 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
12030 $1 = 1
12031 @end smallexample
12032
12033 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
12034 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
12035 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
12036 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
12037
12038 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
12039 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
12040 The default is 1.
12041
12042 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
12043 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
12044 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
12045 Otherwise it returns zero.
12046
12047 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
12048 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
12049 The default is 1.
12050
12051 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
12052 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
12053 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
12054 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
12055
12056 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
12057 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
12058 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
12059 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
12060
12061 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
12062 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
12063 The default is 1.
12064
12065 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
12066 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
12067 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
12068 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
12069
12070 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
12071 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
12072 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
12073
12074 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
12075 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
12076 an enumerated type:
12077
12078 @smallexample
12079 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
12080 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
12081 @end smallexample
12082
12083 @item $_cimag(@var{value})
12084 @itemx $_creal(@var{value})
12085 @findex $_cimag@r{, convenience function}
12086 @findex $_creal@r{, convenience function}
12087 Return the imaginary (@code{$_cimag}) or real (@code{$_creal}) part of
12088 the complex number @var{value}.
12089
12090 The type of the imaginary or real part depends on the type of the
12091 complex number, e.g., using @code{$_cimag} on a @code{float complex}
12092 will return an imaginary part of type @code{float}.
12093
12094 @end table
12095
12096 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
12097 convenience functions.
12098
12099 @table @code
12100 @item help function
12101 @kindex help function
12102 @cindex show all convenience functions
12103 Print a list of all convenience functions.
12104 @end table
12105
12106 @node Registers
12107 @section Registers
12108
12109 @cindex registers
12110 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
12111 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
12112 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
12113 your machine.
12114
12115 @table @code
12116 @kindex info registers
12117 @item info registers
12118 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
12119 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
12120
12121 @kindex info all-registers
12122 @cindex floating point registers
12123 @item info all-registers
12124 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
12125 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
12126
12127 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
12128 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
12129 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
12130 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
12131
12132 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
12133 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
12134 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
12135 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
12136 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
12137 @end table
12138
12139 @anchor{standard registers}
12140 @cindex stack pointer register
12141 @cindex program counter register
12142 @cindex process status register
12143 @cindex frame pointer register
12144 @cindex standard registers
12145 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
12146 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
12147 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
12148 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
12149 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
12150 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
12151 register that contains the processor status. For example,
12152 you could print the program counter in hex with
12153
12154 @smallexample
12155 p/x $pc
12156 @end smallexample
12157
12158 @noindent
12159 or print the instruction to be executed next with
12160
12161 @smallexample
12162 x/i $pc
12163 @end smallexample
12164
12165 @noindent
12166 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
12167 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
12168 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
12169 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
12170 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
12171 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
12172 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
12173
12174 @smallexample
12175 set $sp += 4
12176 @end smallexample
12177
12178 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
12179 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
12180 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
12181 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
12182 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
12183 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
12184 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
12185
12186 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
12187 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
12188 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
12189 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
12190 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
12191 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
12192 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
12193
12194 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
12195 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
12196 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
12197 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
12198 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
12199 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
12200 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
12201 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
12202 prints the data in both formats.
12203
12204 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
12205 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
12206 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
12207 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
12208 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
12209 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
12210 registers in @code{struct} notation:
12211
12212 @smallexample
12213 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
12214 $1 = @{
12215 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
12216 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
12217 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
12218 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
12219 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
12220 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
12221 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
12222 @}
12223 @end smallexample
12224
12225 @noindent
12226 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
12227 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
12228 value to a @code{struct} member:
12229
12230 @smallexample
12231 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
12232 @end smallexample
12233
12234 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
12235 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
12236 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
12237 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
12238 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
12239 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
12240
12241 @cindex caller-saved registers
12242 @cindex call-clobbered registers
12243 @cindex volatile registers
12244 @cindex <not saved> values
12245 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
12246 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
12247 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
12248 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
12249 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
12250 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
12251 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
12252 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
12253 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
12254 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
12255 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
12256 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
12257 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
12258 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
12259 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
12260 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
12261 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
12262 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
12263 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
12264 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
12265 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
12266 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
12267 represent the value the register had just before the call.
12268
12269 @node Floating Point Hardware
12270 @section Floating Point Hardware
12271 @cindex floating point
12272
12273 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
12274 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
12275
12276 @table @code
12277 @kindex info float
12278 @item info float
12279 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
12280 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
12281 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
12282 the ARM and x86 machines.
12283 @end table
12284
12285 @node Vector Unit
12286 @section Vector Unit
12287 @cindex vector unit
12288
12289 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
12290 more information about the status of the vector unit.
12291
12292 @table @code
12293 @kindex info vector
12294 @item info vector
12295 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
12296 layout vary depending on the hardware.
12297 @end table
12298
12299 @node OS Information
12300 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
12301 @cindex OS information
12302
12303 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
12304 you debug your program.
12305
12306 @cindex auxiliary vector
12307 @cindex vector, auxiliary
12308 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
12309 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
12310 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
12311 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
12312 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
12313 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
12314 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
12315 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
12316 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
12317 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
12318 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
12319
12320 @table @code
12321 @kindex info auxv
12322 @item info auxv
12323 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
12324 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
12325 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
12326 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
12327 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
12328 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
12329 an unrecognized tag.
12330 @end table
12331
12332 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
12333 information and show it to you. The types of information available
12334 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
12335 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
12336 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
12337 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
12338 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
12339
12340 @table @code
12341 @kindex info os
12342 @item info os @var{infotype}
12343
12344 Display OS information of the requested type.
12345
12346 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
12347
12348 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
12349 @table @code
12350 @kindex info os cpus
12351 @item cpus
12352 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
12353 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
12354 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
12355 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
12356 kernel initialization.
12357
12358 @kindex info os files
12359 @item files
12360 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
12361 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
12362 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
12363 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
12364
12365 @kindex info os modules
12366 @item modules
12367 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
12368 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
12369 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
12370 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
12371 in memory.
12372
12373 @kindex info os msg
12374 @item msg
12375 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
12376 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
12377 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
12378 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
12379 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
12380 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
12381 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
12382 the message queue was last changed.
12383
12384 @kindex info os processes
12385 @item processes
12386 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
12387 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
12388 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
12389 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
12390 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
12391 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
12392
12393 @kindex info os procgroups
12394 @item procgroups
12395 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
12396 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
12397 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
12398 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
12399 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
12400 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
12401 and the process group leader is listed first.
12402
12403 @kindex info os semaphores
12404 @item semaphores
12405 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
12406 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
12407 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
12408 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
12409 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
12410
12411 @kindex info os shm
12412 @item shm
12413 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
12414 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
12415 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
12416 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
12417 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
12418 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
12419 attached to, detach from, and changed.
12420
12421 @kindex info os sockets
12422 @item sockets
12423 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
12424 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
12425 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
12426 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
12427 connection.
12428
12429 @kindex info os threads
12430 @item threads
12431 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
12432 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
12433 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
12434 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
12435 process is not listed.
12436 @end table
12437
12438 @item info os
12439 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
12440 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
12441 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
12442 types, this command will report an error.
12443 @end table
12444
12445 @node Memory Region Attributes
12446 @section Memory Region Attributes
12447 @cindex memory region attributes
12448
12449 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
12450 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
12451 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
12452 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
12453 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
12454 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
12455 user can override the fetched regions.
12456
12457 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
12458 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
12459 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
12460 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
12461 all memory.
12462
12463 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
12464 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
12465
12466 @table @code
12467 @kindex mem
12468 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
12469 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
12470 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
12471 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
12472 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
12473 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
12474
12475 @item mem auto
12476 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
12477 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
12478
12479 @kindex delete mem
12480 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
12481 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
12482 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
12483
12484 @kindex disable mem
12485 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
12486 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
12487 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
12488 It may be enabled again later.
12489
12490 @kindex enable mem
12491 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
12492 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
12493
12494 @kindex info mem
12495 @item info mem
12496 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
12497 for each region:
12498
12499 @table @emph
12500 @item Memory Region Number
12501 @item Enabled or Disabled.
12502 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
12503 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
12504
12505 @item Lo Address
12506 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
12507
12508 @item Hi Address
12509 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
12510
12511 @item Attributes
12512 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
12513 @end table
12514 @end table
12515
12516
12517 @subsection Attributes
12518
12519 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
12520 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
12521 write accesses to a memory region.
12522
12523 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
12524 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
12525 etc.@: from accessing memory.
12526
12527 @table @code
12528 @item ro
12529 Memory is read only.
12530 @item wo
12531 Memory is write only.
12532 @item rw
12533 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
12534 @end table
12535
12536 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
12537 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
12538 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
12539 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
12540 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
12541
12542 @table @code
12543 @item 8
12544 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
12545 @item 16
12546 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
12547 @item 32
12548 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
12549 @item 64
12550 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
12551 @end table
12552
12553 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
12554 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
12555 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
12556 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
12557 @c
12558 @c @table @code
12559 @c @item hwbreak
12560 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
12561 @c @item swbreak (default)
12562 @c @end table
12563
12564 @subsubsection Data Cache
12565 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
12566 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
12567 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
12568 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
12569 registers.
12570
12571 @table @code
12572 @item cache
12573 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
12574 @item nocache
12575 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
12576 @end table
12577
12578 @subsection Memory Access Checking
12579 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
12580 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
12581 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
12582 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
12583
12584 @table @code
12585 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
12586 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
12587 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
12588 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
12589 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
12590 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
12591 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
12592 The default value is @code{on}.
12593 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
12594 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
12595 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
12596 @end table
12597
12598
12599 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
12600 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
12601 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
12602 @c
12603 @c @table @code
12604 @c @item verify
12605 @c @item noverify (default)
12606 @c @end table
12607
12608 @node Dump/Restore Files
12609 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
12610 @cindex dump/restore files
12611 @cindex append data to a file
12612 @cindex dump data to a file
12613 @cindex restore data from a file
12614
12615 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
12616 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
12617 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
12618 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
12619 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
12620 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
12621 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
12622
12623 @table @code
12624
12625 @kindex dump
12626 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
12627 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
12628 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
12629 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
12630
12631 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
12632 @table @code
12633 @item binary
12634 Raw binary form.
12635 @item ihex
12636 Intel hex format.
12637 @item srec
12638 Motorola S-record format.
12639 @item tekhex
12640 Tektronix Hex format.
12641 @item verilog
12642 Verilog Hex format.
12643 @end table
12644
12645 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
12646 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
12647 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
12648 form.
12649
12650 @kindex append
12651 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
12652 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
12653 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
12654 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
12655 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
12656
12657 @kindex restore
12658 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
12659 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
12660 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
12661 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
12662 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
12663
12664 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
12665 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
12666 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
12667 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
12668 from that location.
12669
12670 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
12671 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
12672 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
12673 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
12674
12675 @end table
12676
12677 @node Core File Generation
12678 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
12679 @cindex dump core from inferior
12680
12681 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
12682 image of a running process and its process status (register values
12683 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
12684 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
12685 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
12686 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
12687 the post-mortem debugging mode.
12688
12689 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
12690 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
12691 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
12692
12693 @table @code
12694 @kindex gcore
12695 @kindex generate-core-file
12696 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
12697 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
12698 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
12699 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
12700 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
12701 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
12702
12703 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
12704 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
12705
12706 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
12707 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
12708 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
12709 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
12710 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
12711
12712 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
12713 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
12714 @item set use-coredump-filter on
12715 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
12716 Enable or disable the use of the file
12717 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
12718 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
12719 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
12720 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
12721
12722 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
12723 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
12724 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
12725 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
12726 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
12727 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
12728 about the bits that can be set in the
12729 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
12730 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
12731
12732 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
12733 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
12734 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
12735 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
12736 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
12737 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
12738 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
12739 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
12740
12741 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
12742 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
12743 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
12744 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
12745 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
12746 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
12747 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
12748
12749 The default value is @code{off}.
12750 @end table
12751
12752 @node Character Sets
12753 @section Character Sets
12754 @cindex character sets
12755 @cindex charset
12756 @cindex translating between character sets
12757 @cindex host character set
12758 @cindex target character set
12759
12760 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
12761 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
12762 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
12763 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
12764 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
12765 @dfn{target character set}.
12766
12767 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
12768 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
12769 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
12770 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
12771 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
12772 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
12773 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
12774 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
12775 character and string literals in expressions.
12776
12777 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
12778 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
12779 target-charset} command, described below.
12780
12781 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
12782 support:
12783
12784 @table @code
12785 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
12786 @kindex set target-charset
12787 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
12788 list of supported target character sets, type
12789 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12790
12791 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
12792 @kindex set host-charset
12793 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
12794
12795 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
12796 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
12797 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
12798 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
12799 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
12800
12801 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
12802 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12803 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
12804
12805 @item set charset @var{charset}
12806 @kindex set charset
12807 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
12808 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12809 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
12810 for both host and target.
12811
12812 @item show charset
12813 @kindex show charset
12814 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
12815
12816 @item show host-charset
12817 @kindex show host-charset
12818 Show the name of the current host character set.
12819
12820 @item show target-charset
12821 @kindex show target-charset
12822 Show the name of the current target character set.
12823
12824 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12825 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12826 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12827 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12828 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12829 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12830
12831 @item show target-wide-charset
12832 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12833 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12834 @end table
12835
12836 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12837 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12838 @file{charset-test.c}:
12839
12840 @smallexample
12841 #include <stdio.h>
12842
12843 char ascii_hello[]
12844 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12845 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12846 char ibm1047_hello[]
12847 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12848 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12849
12850 main ()
12851 @{
12852 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12853 @}
12854 @end smallexample
12855
12856 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12857 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12858 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12859
12860 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12861
12862 @smallexample
12863 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12864 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12865 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12866 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12867 @dots{}
12868 (@value{GDBP})
12869 @end smallexample
12870
12871 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12872 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12873 strings:
12874
12875 @smallexample
12876 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12877 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12878 (@value{GDBP})
12879 @end smallexample
12880
12881 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12882 initial character set:
12883 @smallexample
12884 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12885 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12886 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12887 (@value{GDBP})
12888 @end smallexample
12889
12890 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12891 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12892 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12893 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12894 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12895
12896 @smallexample
12897 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12898 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12899 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12900 $2 = 72 'H'
12901 (@value{GDBP})
12902 @end smallexample
12903
12904 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12905 literals you use in expressions:
12906
12907 @smallexample
12908 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12909 $3 = 43 '+'
12910 (@value{GDBP})
12911 @end smallexample
12912
12913 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12914 character.
12915
12916 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12917 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12918 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12919
12920 @smallexample
12921 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12922 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12923 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12924 $5 = 200 '\310'
12925 (@value{GDBP})
12926 @end smallexample
12927
12928 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12929 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12930
12931 @smallexample
12932 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12933 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12934 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12935 @end smallexample
12936
12937 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12938 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12939 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12940 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12941 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12942
12943 @smallexample
12944 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12945 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12946 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12947 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12948 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12949 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12950 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12951 $7 = 72 '\110'
12952 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12953 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12954 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12955 $9 = 200 'H'
12956 (@value{GDBP})
12957 @end smallexample
12958
12959 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12960 string literals you use in expressions:
12961
12962 @smallexample
12963 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12964 $10 = 78 '+'
12965 (@value{GDBP})
12966 @end smallexample
12967
12968 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12969 character.
12970
12971 @node Caching Target Data
12972 @section Caching Data of Targets
12973 @cindex caching data of targets
12974
12975 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12976 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12977 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12978 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12979 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12980 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12981 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12982 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12983 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12984 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12985 is executing.
12986 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12987 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12988 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12989 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12990 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12991 in the code segment.
12992 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12993 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12994
12995 @table @code
12996 @kindex set remotecache
12997 @item set remotecache on
12998 @itemx set remotecache off
12999 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
13000 with old scripts.
13001
13002 @kindex show remotecache
13003 @item show remotecache
13004 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
13005
13006 @kindex set stack-cache
13007 @item set stack-cache on
13008 @itemx set stack-cache off
13009 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
13010 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
13011
13012 @kindex show stack-cache
13013 @item show stack-cache
13014 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
13015
13016 @kindex set code-cache
13017 @item set code-cache on
13018 @itemx set code-cache off
13019 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
13020 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
13021 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
13022
13023 @kindex show code-cache
13024 @item show code-cache
13025 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
13026 accesses.
13027
13028 @kindex info dcache
13029 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
13030 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
13031 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
13032 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
13033 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
13034 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
13035
13036 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
13037 printed in hex.
13038
13039 @item set dcache size @var{size}
13040 @cindex dcache size
13041 @kindex set dcache size
13042 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
13043
13044 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
13045 @cindex dcache line-size
13046 @kindex set dcache line-size
13047 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
13048 Must be a power of 2.
13049
13050 @item show dcache size
13051 @kindex show dcache size
13052 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
13053
13054 @item show dcache line-size
13055 @kindex show dcache line-size
13056 Show default size of dcache lines.
13057
13058 @end table
13059
13060 @node Searching Memory
13061 @section Search Memory
13062 @cindex searching memory
13063
13064 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
13065 @code{find} command.
13066
13067 @table @code
13068 @kindex find
13069 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
13070 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
13071 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
13072 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
13073 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
13074 @end table
13075
13076 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
13077 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
13078
13079 @table @r
13080 @item @var{s}, search query size
13081 The size of each search query value.
13082
13083 @table @code
13084 @item b
13085 bytes
13086 @item h
13087 halfwords (two bytes)
13088 @item w
13089 words (four bytes)
13090 @item g
13091 giant words (eight bytes)
13092 @end table
13093
13094 All values are interpreted in the current language.
13095 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
13096 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
13097 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
13098 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
13099
13100 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
13101 value's type in the current language.
13102 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
13103 pattern as a mixture of types.
13104 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
13105 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
13106 which is typically four bytes.
13107
13108 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
13109 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
13110 @end table
13111
13112 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
13113 (@code{"}).
13114 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
13115 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
13116
13117 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
13118 number of matches found.
13119
13120 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
13121 @samp{$_}.
13122 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
13123
13124 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
13125
13126 @smallexample
13127 void
13128 hello ()
13129 @{
13130 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
13131 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
13132 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
13133 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
13134 printf ("%s\n", hello);
13135 @}
13136 @end smallexample
13137
13138 @noindent
13139 you get during debugging:
13140
13141 @smallexample
13142 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
13143 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
13144 1 pattern found
13145 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
13146 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
13147 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
13148 2 patterns found.
13149 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
13150 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
13151 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
13152 2 patterns found.
13153 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
13154 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
13155 1 pattern found
13156 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
13157 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
13158 1 pattern found
13159 (gdb) print $numfound
13160 $1 = 1
13161 (gdb) print $_
13162 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
13163 @end smallexample
13164
13165 @node Value Sizes
13166 @section Value Sizes
13167
13168 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
13169 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
13170 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
13171 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
13172 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
13173
13174 @table @code
13175 @kindex set max-value-size
13176 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
13177 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
13178 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
13179 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
13180 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
13181
13182 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
13183 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
13184
13185 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
13186 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
13187 currently 16 bytes.
13188
13189 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
13190 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
13191 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
13192 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
13193 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
13194 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
13195 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
13196 size is less than @var{bytes}.
13197
13198 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
13199
13200 @kindex show max-value-size
13201 @item show max-value-size
13202 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
13203 allocate for the contents of a value.
13204 @end table
13205
13206 @node Optimized Code
13207 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
13208 @cindex optimized code, debugging
13209 @cindex debugging optimized code
13210
13211 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
13212 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
13213 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
13214 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
13215 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
13216 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
13217 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
13218
13219 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
13220 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
13221 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
13222 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
13223
13224 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
13225 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
13226 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
13227 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
13228 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
13229 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
13230
13231 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
13232 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
13233 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
13234 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
13235 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
13236
13237 @menu
13238 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
13239 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
13240 @end menu
13241
13242 @node Inline Functions
13243 @section Inline Functions
13244 @cindex inline functions, debugging
13245
13246 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
13247 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
13248 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
13249 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
13250 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
13251 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
13252 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
13253 @code{info frame} command.
13254
13255 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
13256 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
13257 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
13258 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
13259 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
13260 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
13261 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
13262 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
13263 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
13264 local variables in the caller.
13265
13266 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
13267 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
13268 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
13269 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
13270 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
13271 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
13272 instructions are executed.
13273
13274 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
13275 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
13276 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
13277 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
13278
13279 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
13280 function calls are the same as normal calls:
13281
13282 @itemize @bullet
13283 @item
13284 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
13285 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
13286 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
13287 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
13288 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
13289 or inside the inlined function instead.
13290
13291 @item
13292 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
13293 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
13294 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
13295 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
13296
13297 @end itemize
13298
13299 @node Tail Call Frames
13300 @section Tail Call Frames
13301 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
13302
13303 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
13304 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
13305 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
13306 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
13307 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
13308
13309 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
13310 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
13311 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
13312 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
13313 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
13314 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
13315 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
13316
13317 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
13318 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
13319 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
13320 this information.
13321
13322 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
13323 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
13324
13325 @smallexample
13326 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
13327 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
13328 (gdb) info frame
13329 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
13330 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
13331 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
13332 source language c++.
13333 Arglist at unknown address.
13334 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
13335 @end smallexample
13336
13337 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
13338 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
13339 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
13340 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
13341 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
13342 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
13343
13344 @table @code
13345 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
13346 @item set debug entry-values
13347 @kindex set debug entry-values
13348 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
13349 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
13350 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
13351 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
13352 result.
13353
13354 @item show debug entry-values
13355 @kindex show debug entry-values
13356 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
13357 values at function entry and tail calls.
13358 @end table
13359
13360 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
13361 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
13362 reference by variable @code{x}):
13363
13364 @smallexample
13365 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
13366 void (*x) (void) = c;
13367 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
13368 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
13369 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
13370
13371 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
13372 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
13373 a () at t.c:3
13374 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
13375 (gdb) bt
13376 #0 a () at t.c:3
13377 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
13378 @end smallexample
13379
13380 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
13381
13382 @smallexample
13383 int i;
13384 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
13385 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
13386 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
13387 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
13388 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
13389 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
13390 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
13391 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
13392
13393 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
13394 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
13395 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
13396 (gdb) bt
13397 #0 f () at t.c:2
13398 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
13399 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
13400 @end smallexample
13401
13402 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
13403 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
13404
13405 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
13406 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
13407 @set ARROW @click{}
13408 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
13409 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
13410 @end ifset
13411 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
13412 @set ARROW ->
13413 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
13414 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
13415 @end ifclear
13416
13417 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
13418 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
13419 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
13420
13421 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
13422 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
13423 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
13424 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
13425 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
13426 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
13427
13428 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
13429 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
13430 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
13431 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
13432 omitted.
13433
13434 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
13435 entry may fail:
13436
13437 @smallexample
13438 int v;
13439 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
13440 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
13441 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
13442 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
13443 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
13444 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
13445
13446 (gdb) bt
13447 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
13448 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
13449 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
13450 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
13451 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
13452 @end smallexample
13453
13454 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
13455 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
13456 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
13457 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
13458 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
13459
13460 @node Macros
13461 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
13462
13463 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
13464 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
13465 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
13466 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
13467 where it was defined.
13468
13469 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
13470 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
13471 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
13472 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
13473
13474 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
13475 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
13476 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
13477 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
13478 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
13479 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
13480 see @ref{List}.
13481
13482 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
13483 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
13484 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
13485
13486 @table @code
13487
13488 @kindex macro expand
13489 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
13490 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
13491 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
13492 @item macro expand @var{expression}
13493 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
13494 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
13495 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
13496 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
13497 it can be any string of tokens.
13498
13499 @kindex macro exp1
13500 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
13501 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
13502 @cindex expand macro once
13503 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
13504 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
13505 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
13506 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
13507 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
13508 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
13509 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
13510 can be any string of tokens.
13511
13512 @kindex info macro
13513 @cindex macro definition, showing
13514 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
13515 @cindex macros, from debug info
13516 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
13517 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
13518 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
13519 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
13520 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
13521 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
13522
13523 @kindex info macros
13524 @item info macros @var{location}
13525 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
13526 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
13527 command-line where those definitions were established.
13528
13529 @kindex macro define
13530 @cindex user-defined macros
13531 @cindex defining macros interactively
13532 @cindex macros, user-defined
13533 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
13534 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
13535 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
13536 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
13537 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
13538 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
13539 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
13540 @var{arglist}.
13541
13542 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
13543 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
13544 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
13545 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
13546 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
13547
13548 @kindex macro undef
13549 @item macro undef @var{macro}
13550 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
13551 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
13552 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
13553 in the program being debugged.
13554
13555 @kindex macro list
13556 @item macro list
13557 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
13558 @end table
13559
13560 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
13561 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
13562 show our source files:
13563
13564 @smallexample
13565 $ cat sample.c
13566 #include <stdio.h>
13567 #include "sample.h"
13568
13569 #define M 42
13570 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
13571
13572 main ()
13573 @{
13574 #define N 28
13575 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
13576 #undef N
13577 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
13578 #define N 1729
13579 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
13580 @}
13581 $ cat sample.h
13582 #define Q <
13583 $
13584 @end smallexample
13585
13586 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
13587 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
13588 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
13589 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
13590 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
13591 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
13592 information.
13593
13594 @smallexample
13595 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
13596 $
13597 @end smallexample
13598
13599 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
13600
13601 @smallexample
13602 $ gdb -nw sample
13603 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
13604 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13605 GDB is free software, @dots{}
13606 (@value{GDBP})
13607 @end smallexample
13608
13609 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
13610 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
13611 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
13612
13613 @smallexample
13614 (@value{GDBP}) list main
13615 3
13616 4 #define M 42
13617 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
13618 6
13619 7 main ()
13620 8 @{
13621 9 #define N 28
13622 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
13623 11 #undef N
13624 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
13625 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
13626 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
13627 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
13628 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
13629 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
13630 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
13631 #define Q <
13632 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
13633 expands to: (42 + 1)
13634 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
13635 expands to: once (M + 1)
13636 (@value{GDBP})
13637 @end smallexample
13638
13639 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
13640 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
13641 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
13642 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
13643
13644 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
13645 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
13646
13647 @smallexample
13648 (@value{GDBP}) break main
13649 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
13650 (@value{GDBP}) run
13651 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
13652
13653 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
13654 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
13655 (@value{GDBP})
13656 @end smallexample
13657
13658 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
13659
13660 @smallexample
13661 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
13662 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
13663 #define N 28
13664 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
13665 expands to: 28 < 42
13666 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
13667 $1 = 1
13668 (@value{GDBP})
13669 @end smallexample
13670
13671 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
13672 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
13673 thereof) in force at each point:
13674
13675 @smallexample
13676 (@value{GDBP}) next
13677 Hello, world!
13678 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
13679 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
13680 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
13681 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
13682 (@value{GDBP}) next
13683 We're so creative.
13684 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
13685 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
13686 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
13687 #define N 1729
13688 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
13689 expands to: 1729 < 42
13690 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
13691 $2 = 0
13692 (@value{GDBP})
13693 @end smallexample
13694
13695 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
13696 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
13697 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
13698 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
13699
13700 @smallexample
13701 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
13702 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
13703 -D__STDC__=1
13704 (@value{GDBP})
13705 @end smallexample
13706
13707
13708 @node Tracepoints
13709 @chapter Tracepoints
13710 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
13711 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
13712
13713 @cindex tracepoints
13714 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
13715 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
13716 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
13717 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
13718 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
13719 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
13720 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
13721
13722 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
13723 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
13724 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
13725 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
13726 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
13727 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
13728 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
13729 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
13730 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
13731 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
13732 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
13733
13734 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
13735 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
13736 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
13737 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
13738 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
13739 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
13740 Packets}.
13741
13742 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
13743 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
13744 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
13745
13746 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
13747
13748 @menu
13749 * Set Tracepoints::
13750 * Analyze Collected Data::
13751 * Tracepoint Variables::
13752 * Trace Files::
13753 @end menu
13754
13755 @node Set Tracepoints
13756 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
13757
13758 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
13759 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
13760 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
13761 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
13762 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
13763 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
13764 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
13765
13766 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
13767 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
13768 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
13769 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
13770 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
13771 tracepoint was hit.
13772
13773 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
13774 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
13775 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
13776 either.
13777
13778 @cindex fast tracepoints
13779 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
13780 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
13781 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
13782
13783 @cindex static tracepoints
13784 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
13785 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
13786 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
13787 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
13788 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
13789 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
13790 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
13791 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
13792 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
13793 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
13794 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
13795 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
13796 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
13797 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
13798 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
13799 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
13800 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
13801 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
13802 static tracepoint marker.
13803
13804 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
13805 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
13806
13807 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
13808 conditions and actions.
13809
13810 @menu
13811 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
13812 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
13813 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
13814 * Tracepoint Conditions::
13815 * Trace State Variables::
13816 * Tracepoint Actions::
13817 * Listing Tracepoints::
13818 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13819 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13820 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13821 @end menu
13822
13823 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13824 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13825
13826 @table @code
13827 @cindex set tracepoint
13828 @kindex trace
13829 @item trace @var{location}
13830 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13831 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13832 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13833 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13834 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13835 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13836 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13837 in tracing}).
13838 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13839 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13840 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13841 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13842 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13843 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13844 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13845 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13846 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13847 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13848 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13849 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13850
13851 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13852
13853 @smallexample
13854 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13855
13856 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13857
13858 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13859
13860 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13861
13862 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13863 @end smallexample
13864
13865 @noindent
13866 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13867
13868 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13869 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13870 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13871 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13872 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13873 information on tracepoint conditions.
13874
13875 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13876 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13877 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13878 @kindex ftrace
13879 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13880 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13881 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13882 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13883 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13884 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13885 message.
13886
13887 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13888 @code{trace}.
13889
13890 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13891 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13892 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13893 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13894 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13895 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13896 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13897 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13898
13899 @example
13900 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13901 @end example
13902
13903 @noindent
13904 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13905 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13906
13907 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13908 @cindex set static tracepoint
13909 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13910 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13911 @kindex strace
13912 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13913 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13914 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13915 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13916 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13917
13918 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13919 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13920 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13921 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13922 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13923 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13924 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13925 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13926 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13927 tracing engine:
13928
13929 @smallexample
13930 main ()
13931 @{
13932 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13933 @}
13934 @end smallexample
13935
13936 @noindent
13937 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13938 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13939
13940 @smallexample
13941 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13942 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13943 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13944 Data: "str %s"
13945 [etc...]
13946 @end smallexample
13947
13948 @noindent
13949 so you may probe the marker above with:
13950
13951 @smallexample
13952 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13953 @end smallexample
13954
13955 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13956 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13957 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13958 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13959 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13960 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13961 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13962 the @samp{Data:} field.
13963
13964 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13965 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13966 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13967
13968 @vindex $tpnum
13969 @cindex last tracepoint number
13970 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13971 @cindex tracepoint number
13972 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13973 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13974
13975 @kindex delete tracepoint
13976 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13977 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13978 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13979 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13980 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13981
13982 Examples:
13983
13984 @smallexample
13985 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13986
13987 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13988 @end smallexample
13989
13990 @noindent
13991 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13992 @end table
13993
13994 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13995 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13996
13997 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13998
13999 @table @code
14000 @kindex disable tracepoint
14001 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
14002 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
14003 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
14004 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
14005 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
14006 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
14007 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
14008 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
14009 next trace experiment.
14010
14011 @kindex enable tracepoint
14012 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
14013 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
14014 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
14015 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
14016 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
14017 next time a trace experiment is run.
14018 @end table
14019
14020 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
14021 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
14022
14023 @table @code
14024 @kindex passcount
14025 @cindex tracepoint pass count
14026 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
14027 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
14028 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
14029 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
14030 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
14031 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
14032 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
14033 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
14034 user.
14035
14036 Examples:
14037
14038 @smallexample
14039 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
14040 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
14041
14042 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
14043 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
14044 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
14045 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
14046 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
14047 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
14048 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
14049 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
14050 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
14051 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
14052 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
14053 @end smallexample
14054 @end table
14055
14056 @node Tracepoint Conditions
14057 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
14058 @cindex conditional tracepoints
14059 @cindex tracepoint conditions
14060
14061 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
14062 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
14063 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
14064 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
14065 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
14066 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
14067 is true.
14068
14069 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
14070 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
14071 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
14072 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
14073 just as with breakpoints.
14074
14075 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
14076 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
14077 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
14078 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
14079 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
14080 accesses, and so forth.
14081
14082 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
14083 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
14084 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
14085 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
14086 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
14087 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
14088 search through.
14089
14090 @smallexample
14091 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
14092 @end smallexample
14093
14094 @node Trace State Variables
14095 @subsection Trace State Variables
14096 @cindex trace state variables
14097
14098 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
14099 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
14100 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
14101 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
14102 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
14103 integers.
14104
14105 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
14106 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
14107 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
14108 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
14109
14110 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
14111 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
14112 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
14113 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
14114 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
14115 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
14116 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
14117 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
14118 variable with the same name.
14119
14120 @table @code
14121
14122 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
14123 @kindex tvariable
14124 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
14125 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
14126 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
14127 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
14128 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
14129 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
14130 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
14131 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
14132 value. The default initial value is 0.
14133
14134 @item info tvariables
14135 @kindex info tvariables
14136 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
14137 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
14138 currently running.
14139
14140 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
14141 @kindex delete tvariable
14142 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
14143 are specified.
14144
14145 @end table
14146
14147 @node Tracepoint Actions
14148 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
14149
14150 @table @code
14151 @kindex actions
14152 @cindex tracepoint actions
14153 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
14154 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
14155 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
14156 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
14157 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
14158 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
14159 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
14160 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
14161 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
14162 @code{while-stepping}.
14163
14164 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
14165 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
14166 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
14167
14168 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
14169 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
14170 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
14171
14172 @smallexample
14173 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
14174
14175 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
14176
14177 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
14178 @end smallexample
14179
14180 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
14181 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
14182 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
14183 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
14184 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
14185 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
14186 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
14187 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
14188
14189 @smallexample
14190 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
14191 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14192 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
14193 > collect bar,baz
14194 > collect $regs
14195 > while-stepping 12
14196 > collect $pc, arr[i]
14197 > end
14198 end
14199 @end smallexample
14200
14201 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
14202 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
14203 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
14204 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
14205 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
14206 special arguments are supported:
14207
14208 @table @code
14209 @item $regs
14210 Collect all registers.
14211
14212 @item $args
14213 Collect all function arguments.
14214
14215 @item $locals
14216 Collect all local variables.
14217
14218 @item $_ret
14219 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
14220 of a backtrace.
14221
14222 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
14223 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
14224 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
14225 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
14226 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
14227 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
14228
14229 @item $_probe_argc
14230 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
14231 tracepoint is located.
14232 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
14233
14234 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
14235 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
14236 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
14237 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
14238
14239 @item $_sdata
14240 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
14241 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
14242 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
14243 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
14244 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
14245 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
14246 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
14247 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
14248 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
14249
14250 @smallexample
14251 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
14252 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
14253 @end smallexample
14254
14255 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
14256 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
14257 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
14258 @value{GDBN}.
14259 @end table
14260
14261 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
14262 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
14263 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
14264
14265 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
14266 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
14267 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
14268 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
14269 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
14270 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
14271 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
14272 @samp{mystr}.
14273
14274 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
14275 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
14276
14277 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
14278 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
14279 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
14280 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
14281 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
14282 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
14283 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
14284 action were used.
14285
14286 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
14287 @item while-stepping @var{n}
14288 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
14289 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
14290 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
14291 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
14292
14293 @smallexample
14294 > while-stepping 12
14295 > collect $regs, myglobal
14296 > end
14297 >
14298 @end smallexample
14299
14300 @noindent
14301 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
14302 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
14303 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
14304 @code{stepping}.
14305
14306 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
14307 @kindex set default-collect
14308 @cindex default collection action
14309 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
14310 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
14311 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
14312 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
14313 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
14314 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
14315
14316 @item show default-collect
14317 @kindex show default-collect
14318 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
14319 tracepoint hit.
14320
14321 @end table
14322
14323 @node Listing Tracepoints
14324 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
14325
14326 @table @code
14327 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
14328 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
14329 @cindex information about tracepoints
14330 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
14331 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
14332 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
14333 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
14334 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
14335 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
14336
14337 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
14338 tracing:
14339
14340 @itemize @bullet
14341 @item
14342 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
14343
14344 @item
14345 the state about installed on target of each location
14346 @end itemize
14347
14348 @smallexample
14349 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
14350 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
14351 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
14352 while-stepping 20
14353 collect globfoo, $regs
14354 end
14355 collect globfoo2
14356 end
14357 pass count 1200
14358 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
14359 collect $eip
14360 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
14361 installed on target
14362 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
14363 installed on target
14364 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
14365 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
14366 not installed on target
14367 (@value{GDBP})
14368 @end smallexample
14369
14370 @noindent
14371 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
14372 @end table
14373
14374 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
14375 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
14376
14377 @table @code
14378 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
14379 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
14380 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
14381 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
14382 program.
14383
14384 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
14385
14386 @table @emph
14387 @item Count
14388 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
14389 stable identifier.
14390 @item ID
14391 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
14392 @item Enabled or Disabled
14393 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
14394 that are not enabled.
14395 @item Address
14396 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
14397 @item What
14398 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
14399 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
14400 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
14401 will be left blank.
14402 @end table
14403
14404 @noindent
14405 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
14406
14407 @table @emph
14408 @item Data
14409 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
14410 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
14411 marker call.
14412 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
14413 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
14414 @end table
14415
14416 @smallexample
14417 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
14418 Cnt ID Enb Address What
14419 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
14420 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
14421 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
14422 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
14423 Data: str %s
14424 (@value{GDBP})
14425 @end smallexample
14426 @end table
14427
14428 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
14429 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
14430
14431 @table @code
14432 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
14433 @cindex start a new trace experiment
14434 @cindex collected data discarded
14435 @item tstart
14436 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
14437 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
14438 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
14439 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
14440 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
14441 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
14442 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
14443 information, and so forth.
14444
14445 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
14446 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
14447 @item tstop
14448 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
14449 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
14450 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
14451 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
14452 needs to be stopped quickly.
14453
14454 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
14455 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
14456 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
14457
14458 @kindex tstatus
14459 @cindex status of trace data collection
14460 @cindex trace experiment, status of
14461 @item tstatus
14462 This command displays the status of the current trace data
14463 collection.
14464 @end table
14465
14466 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
14467
14468 @smallexample
14469 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
14470 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14471 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
14472 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
14473 > while-stepping 11
14474 > collect $regs
14475 > end
14476 > end
14477 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14478 [time passes @dots{}]
14479 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
14480 @end smallexample
14481
14482 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
14483 @cindex disconnected tracing
14484 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
14485 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
14486 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
14487 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
14488 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
14489 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
14490 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
14491 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
14492
14493 @table @code
14494 @item set disconnected-tracing on
14495 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
14496 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
14497 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
14498 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
14499 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
14500 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
14501 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
14502
14503 @item show disconnected-tracing
14504 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
14505 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
14506
14507 @end table
14508
14509 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
14510 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
14511 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
14512 it will continue after reconnection.
14513
14514 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
14515 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
14516 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
14517 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
14518 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
14519 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
14520 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
14521 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
14522 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
14523 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
14524
14525 @cindex circular trace buffer
14526 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
14527 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
14528 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
14529 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
14530 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
14531 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
14532 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
14533 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
14534 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
14535 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
14536 the next run.
14537
14538 @table @code
14539 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
14540 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
14541 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
14542 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
14543 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
14544 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
14545 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
14546
14547 @item show circular-trace-buffer
14548 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
14549 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
14550 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
14551 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
14552 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
14553
14554 @end table
14555
14556 @table @code
14557 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
14558 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
14559 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
14560 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
14561 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
14562 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
14563 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
14564 likes. This is also the default.
14565
14566 @item show trace-buffer-size
14567 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
14568 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
14569 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
14570 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
14571 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
14572 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
14573 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
14574 @end table
14575
14576 @table @code
14577 @item set trace-user @var{text}
14578 @kindex set trace-user
14579
14580 @item show trace-user
14581 @kindex show trace-user
14582
14583 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
14584 @kindex set trace-notes
14585 Set the trace run's notes.
14586
14587 @item show trace-notes
14588 @kindex show trace-notes
14589 Show the trace run's notes.
14590
14591 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
14592 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
14593 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
14594 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
14595 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
14596
14597 @item show trace-stop-notes
14598 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
14599 Show the trace run's stop notes.
14600
14601 @end table
14602
14603 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
14604 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
14605
14606 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
14607 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
14608 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
14609 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
14610 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
14611 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
14612 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
14613 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
14614 mentioned here.
14615
14616 @itemize @bullet
14617
14618 @item
14619 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
14620 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
14621 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
14622 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
14623 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
14624 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
14625 cannot be collected either.
14626
14627 @item
14628 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
14629 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
14630 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
14631 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
14632 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
14633 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
14634 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
14635 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
14636 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
14637 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
14638
14639 @item
14640 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
14641 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
14642 in a misleading way.
14643
14644 @item
14645 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
14646 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
14647 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
14648 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
14649 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
14650 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
14651 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
14652 by @code{ptr}.
14653
14654 @item
14655 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
14656 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
14657 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
14658 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
14659 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
14660 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
14661 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
14662 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
14663 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
14664 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
14665 invalid address.
14666
14667 @item
14668 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
14669 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
14670 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
14671 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
14672 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
14673 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
14674 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
14675 it to zero.
14676
14677 @end itemize
14678
14679 @node Analyze Collected Data
14680 @section Using the Collected Data
14681
14682 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
14683 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
14684 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
14685 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
14686 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
14687 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
14688 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
14689 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
14690 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
14691 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
14692 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
14693 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
14694 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
14695 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
14696 the buffer will fail.
14697
14698 @menu
14699 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
14700 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
14701 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
14702 @end menu
14703
14704 @node tfind
14705 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
14706
14707 @kindex tfind
14708 @cindex select trace snapshot
14709 @cindex find trace snapshot
14710 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
14711 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
14712 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
14713 snapshot is selected.
14714
14715 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
14716
14717 @table @code
14718 @item tfind start
14719 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
14720 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
14721
14722 @item tfind none
14723 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
14724
14725 @item tfind end
14726 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
14727
14728 @item tfind
14729 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
14730 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
14731
14732 @item tfind -
14733 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
14734 retracing earlier steps.
14735
14736 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
14737 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
14738 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
14739 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
14740 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
14741
14742 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
14743 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
14744 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
14745 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
14746 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
14747
14748 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14749 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
14750 addresses (exclusive).
14751
14752 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14753 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
14754 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
14755
14756 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
14757 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
14758 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
14759 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
14760 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
14761 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
14762 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
14763 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
14764 @end table
14765
14766 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
14767 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
14768 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
14769 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
14770 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
14771 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
14772 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
14773 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
14774 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
14775 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
14776 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
14777 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
14778 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
14779 tracepoint as the current one.
14780
14781 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
14782 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
14783 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
14784 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
14785 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
14786
14787 @smallexample
14788 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14790 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
14791 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
14792 > tfind
14793 > end
14794
14795 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
14796 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
14797 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
14798 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
14799 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
14800 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
14801 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
14802 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
14803 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
14804 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
14805 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
14806 @end smallexample
14807
14808 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
14809 the buffer:
14810
14811 @smallexample
14812 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14813 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14814 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
14815 > tfind line
14816 > end
14817
14818 Frame 0, X = 1
14819 Frame 7, X = 2
14820 Frame 13, X = 255
14821 @end smallexample
14822
14823 @node tdump
14824 @subsection @code{tdump}
14825 @kindex tdump
14826 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14827 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14828
14829 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14830 the current trace snapshot.
14831
14832 @smallexample
14833 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14834 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14835 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14836 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14837 > end
14838
14839 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14840
14841 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14842 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14843 at gdb_test.c:444
14844 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14845
14846 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14847 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14848 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14849 d1 0x18 24
14850 d2 0x80 128
14851 d3 0x33 51
14852 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14853 d5 0x22 34
14854 d6 0xe0 224
14855 d7 0x380035 3670069
14856 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14857 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14858 a2 0x100 256
14859 a3 0x322000 3284992
14860 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14861 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14862 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14863 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14864 ps 0x0 0
14865 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14866 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14867 fpstatus 0x0 0
14868 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14869 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14870 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14871 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14872 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14873 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14874 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14875 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14876 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14877
14878 (@value{GDBP})
14879 @end smallexample
14880
14881 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14882 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14883 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14884 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14885
14886 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14887 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14888 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14889 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14890 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14891 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14892 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14893 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14894 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14895 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14896
14897 @node save tracepoints
14898 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14899 @kindex save tracepoints
14900 @kindex save-tracepoints
14901 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14902
14903 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14904 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14905 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14906 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14907 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14908 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14909
14910 @node Tracepoint Variables
14911 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14912 @cindex tracepoint variables
14913 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14914
14915 @table @code
14916 @vindex $trace_frame
14917 @item (int) $trace_frame
14918 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14919 snapshot is selected.
14920
14921 @vindex $tracepoint
14922 @item (int) $tracepoint
14923 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14924
14925 @vindex $trace_line
14926 @item (int) $trace_line
14927 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14928
14929 @vindex $trace_file
14930 @item (char []) $trace_file
14931 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14932
14933 @vindex $trace_func
14934 @item (char []) $trace_func
14935 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14936 @end table
14937
14938 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14939 use @code{output} instead.
14940
14941 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14942 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14943 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14944 which are managed by the target.
14945
14946 @smallexample
14947 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14948
14949 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14950 > output $trace_file
14951 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14952 > tfind
14953 > end
14954 @end smallexample
14955
14956 @node Trace Files
14957 @section Using Trace Files
14958 @cindex trace files
14959
14960 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14961 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14962 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14963 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14964 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14965
14966 @table @code
14967
14968 @kindex tsave
14969 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14970 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14971 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14972 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14973 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14974 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14975 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14976 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14977 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14978 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14979 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14980 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14981 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14982 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14983 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14984
14985 @kindex target tfile
14986 @kindex tfile
14987 @kindex target ctf
14988 @kindex ctf
14989 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14990 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14991 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14992 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14993 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14994 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14995 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14996 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14997 the host.
14998
14999 @smallexample
15000 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
15001 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
15002 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
15003 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
15004 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
15005 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
15006 i = 0
15007 a = 0
15008 b = 1 '\001'
15009 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
15010 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
15011 (@value{GDBP}) p b
15012 $1 = 1
15013 @end smallexample
15014
15015 @end table
15016
15017 @node Overlays
15018 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
15019 @cindex overlays
15020
15021 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
15022 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
15023 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
15024 use overlays.
15025
15026 @menu
15027 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
15028 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
15029 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
15030 mapped by asking the inferior.
15031 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
15032 @end menu
15033
15034 @node How Overlays Work
15035 @section How Overlays Work
15036 @cindex mapped overlays
15037 @cindex unmapped overlays
15038 @cindex load address, overlay's
15039 @cindex mapped address
15040 @cindex overlay area
15041
15042 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
15043 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
15044 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
15045 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
15046 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
15047
15048 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
15049 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
15050 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
15051 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
15052 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
15053 largest overlay as well.
15054
15055 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
15056 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
15057 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
15058 there.
15059
15060 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
15061 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
15062 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
15063
15064 @smallexample
15065 @group
15066 Data Instruction Larger
15067 Address Space Address Space Address Space
15068 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
15069 | | | | | |
15070 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
15071 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
15072 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
15073 | and heap | | | | | |
15074 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
15075 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
15076 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
15077 | | | | | |
15078 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
15079 address | | | | | |
15080 | overlay | <-' | | |
15081 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
15082 | | <---. | | load address
15083 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
15084 | | | |
15085 +-----------+ | |
15086 +-----------+
15087 | |
15088 +-----------+
15089
15090 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
15091 @end group
15092 @end smallexample
15093
15094 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
15095 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
15096 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
15097 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
15098 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
15099 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
15100 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
15101 program and the overlay area.
15102
15103 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
15104 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
15105 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
15106 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
15107 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
15108 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
15109 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
15110
15111 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
15112 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
15113 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
15114
15115 @itemize @bullet
15116
15117 @item
15118 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
15119 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
15120 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
15121 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
15122
15123 @item
15124 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
15125 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
15126 your program's performance.
15127
15128 @item
15129 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
15130 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
15131 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
15132 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
15133 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
15134 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
15135 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
15136
15137 @item
15138 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
15139 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
15140 instruction and data spaces.
15141
15142 @end itemize
15143
15144 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
15145 improved in many ways:
15146
15147 @itemize @bullet
15148
15149 @item
15150 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
15151 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
15152 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
15153 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
15154 area in the usual way.
15155
15156 @item
15157 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
15158 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
15159
15160 @item
15161 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
15162 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
15163 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
15164 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
15165 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
15166 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
15167 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
15168
15169 @end itemize
15170
15171
15172 @node Overlay Commands
15173 @section Overlay Commands
15174
15175 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
15176 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
15177 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
15178 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
15179 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
15180 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
15181
15182 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
15183 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
15184
15185 @table @code
15186 @item overlay off
15187 @kindex overlay
15188 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
15189 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
15190 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
15191 overlay support is disabled.
15192
15193 @item overlay manual
15194 @cindex manual overlay debugging
15195 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
15196 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
15197 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
15198 commands described below.
15199
15200 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
15201 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
15202 @cindex map an overlay
15203 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
15204 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
15205 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
15206 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
15207 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
15208 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
15209
15210 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
15211 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
15212 @cindex unmap an overlay
15213 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
15214 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
15215 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
15216 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
15217
15218 @item overlay auto
15219 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
15220 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
15221 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
15222 Overlay Debugging}.
15223
15224 @item overlay load-target
15225 @itemx overlay load
15226 @cindex reloading the overlay table
15227 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
15228 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
15229 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
15230 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
15231 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
15232
15233 @item overlay list-overlays
15234 @itemx overlay list
15235 @cindex listing mapped overlays
15236 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
15237 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
15238
15239 @end table
15240
15241 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
15242 of the function the address falls in:
15243
15244 @smallexample
15245 (@value{GDBP}) print main
15246 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
15247 @end smallexample
15248 @noindent
15249 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
15250 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
15251 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
15252 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
15253
15254 @smallexample
15255 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
15256 No sections are mapped.
15257 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
15258 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
15259 @end smallexample
15260 @noindent
15261 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
15262 name normally:
15263
15264 @smallexample
15265 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
15266 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
15267 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
15268 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
15269 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
15270 @end smallexample
15271
15272 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
15273 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
15274 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
15275 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
15276 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
15277
15278 @itemize @bullet
15279 @item
15280 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
15281 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
15282 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
15283 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
15284 @item
15285 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
15286 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
15287 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
15288 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
15289 breakpoints properly.
15290 @end itemize
15291
15292
15293 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
15294 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
15295 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
15296
15297 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
15298 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
15299 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
15300 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
15301 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
15302 current state of the overlays.
15303
15304 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
15305 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
15306
15307 @table @asis
15308
15309 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
15310 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
15311
15312 @smallexample
15313 struct
15314 @{
15315 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
15316 unsigned long vma;
15317
15318 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
15319 unsigned long size;
15320
15321 /* The overlay's load address. */
15322 unsigned long lma;
15323
15324 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
15325 zero otherwise. */
15326 unsigned long mapped;
15327 @}
15328 @end smallexample
15329
15330 @item @code{_novlys}:
15331 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
15332 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
15333
15334 @end table
15335
15336 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
15337 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
15338 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
15339 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
15340 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
15341 currently mapped.
15342
15343 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
15344 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
15345 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
15346 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
15347 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
15348 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
15349 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
15350 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
15351 are not being executed.
15352
15353 @node Overlay Sample Program
15354 @section Overlay Sample Program
15355 @cindex overlay example program
15356
15357 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
15358 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
15359 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
15360 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
15361 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
15362 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
15363 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
15364
15365 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
15366 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
15367 suite. The program consists of the following files from
15368 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
15369
15370 @table @file
15371 @item overlays.c
15372 The main program file.
15373 @item ovlymgr.c
15374 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
15375 @item foo.c
15376 @itemx bar.c
15377 @itemx baz.c
15378 @itemx grbx.c
15379 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
15380 @item d10v.ld
15381 @itemx m32r.ld
15382 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
15383 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
15384 @end table
15385
15386 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
15387 cross-compiler like this:
15388
15389 @smallexample
15390 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
15391 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
15392 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
15393 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
15394 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
15395 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
15396 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
15397 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
15398 @end smallexample
15399
15400 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
15401 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
15402 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
15403
15404
15405 @node Languages
15406 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
15407 @cindex languages
15408
15409 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
15410 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
15411 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
15412 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
15413 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
15414 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
15415
15416 @cindex working language
15417 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
15418 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
15419 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
15420 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
15421 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
15422 language}.
15423
15424 @menu
15425 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
15426 * Show:: Displaying the language
15427 * Checks:: Type and range checks
15428 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
15429 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
15430 @end menu
15431
15432 @node Setting
15433 @section Switching Between Source Languages
15434
15435 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
15436 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
15437 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
15438 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
15439 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
15440 are printed, etc.
15441
15442 In addition to the working language, every source file that
15443 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
15444 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
15445 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
15446 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
15447 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
15448 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
15449 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
15450 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
15451 Displaying the Language}.
15452
15453 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
15454 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
15455 another language. In that case, make the
15456 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
15457 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
15458 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
15459
15460 @menu
15461 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
15462 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
15463 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
15464 @end menu
15465
15466 @node Filenames
15467 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
15468
15469 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
15470 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
15471
15472 @table @file
15473 @item .ada
15474 @itemx .ads
15475 @itemx .adb
15476 @itemx .a
15477 Ada source file.
15478
15479 @item .c
15480 C source file
15481
15482 @item .C
15483 @itemx .cc
15484 @itemx .cp
15485 @itemx .cpp
15486 @itemx .cxx
15487 @itemx .c++
15488 C@t{++} source file
15489
15490 @item .d
15491 D source file
15492
15493 @item .m
15494 Objective-C source file
15495
15496 @item .f
15497 @itemx .F
15498 Fortran source file
15499
15500 @item .mod
15501 Modula-2 source file
15502
15503 @item .s
15504 @itemx .S
15505 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
15506 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
15507 @end table
15508
15509 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
15510 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
15511
15512 @node Manually
15513 @subsection Setting the Working Language
15514
15515 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
15516 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
15517 your program.
15518
15519 @kindex set language
15520 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
15521 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
15522 a language, such as
15523 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
15524 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
15525
15526 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
15527 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
15528 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
15529 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
15530 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
15531 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
15532 command such as:
15533
15534 @smallexample
15535 print a = b + c
15536 @end smallexample
15537
15538 @noindent
15539 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
15540 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
15541 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
15542 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
15543
15544 @node Automatically
15545 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
15546
15547 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
15548 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
15549 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
15550 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
15551 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
15552 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
15553 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
15554 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
15555 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
15556
15557 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
15558 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
15559 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
15560 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
15561 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
15562
15563 @node Show
15564 @section Displaying the Language
15565
15566 The following commands help you find out which language is the
15567 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
15568
15569 @table @code
15570 @item show language
15571 @anchor{show language}
15572 @kindex show language
15573 Display the current working language. This is the
15574 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
15575 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
15576
15577 @item info frame
15578 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
15579 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
15580 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
15581 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
15582 information listed here.
15583
15584 @item info source
15585 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
15586 Display the source language of this source file.
15587 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
15588 information listed here.
15589 @end table
15590
15591 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
15592 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
15593 with a language explicitly:
15594
15595 @table @code
15596 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
15597 @kindex set extension-language
15598 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
15599 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
15600
15601 @item info extensions
15602 @kindex info extensions
15603 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
15604 @end table
15605
15606 @node Checks
15607 @section Type and Range Checking
15608
15609 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
15610 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
15611 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
15612 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
15613 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
15614 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
15615 errors when your program is running.
15616
15617 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
15618 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
15619 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
15620 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
15621
15622 @menu
15623 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
15624 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
15625 @end menu
15626
15627 @cindex type checking
15628 @cindex checks, type
15629 @node Type Checking
15630 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
15631
15632 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
15633 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
15634 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
15635 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
15636
15637 @smallexample
15638 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
15639
15640 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
15641 $1 = 2
15642 @exdent but
15643 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
15644 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
15645 @end smallexample
15646
15647 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
15648 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
15649
15650 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
15651 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
15652 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
15653 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
15654 expressions like the second example above.
15655
15656 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
15657 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
15658 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
15659 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
15660 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
15661 little sense to evaluate anyway.
15662
15663 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
15664
15665 @kindex set check type
15666 @kindex show check type
15667 @table @code
15668 @item set check type on
15669 @itemx set check type off
15670 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
15671 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
15672 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
15673
15674 @item show check type
15675 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
15676 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
15677 @end table
15678
15679 @cindex range checking
15680 @cindex checks, range
15681 @node Range Checking
15682 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
15683
15684 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
15685 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
15686 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
15687 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
15688 not exceed the bounds of the array.
15689
15690 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
15691 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
15692 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
15693 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
15694
15695 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
15696 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
15697 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
15698 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
15699 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
15700 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
15701
15702 @smallexample
15703 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
15704 @end smallexample
15705
15706 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
15707 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
15708 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
15709
15710 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
15711
15712 @kindex set check range
15713 @kindex show check range
15714 @table @code
15715 @item set check range auto
15716 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
15717 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
15718 each language.
15719
15720 @item set check range on
15721 @itemx set check range off
15722 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
15723 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
15724 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
15725 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
15726
15727 @item set check range warn
15728 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
15729 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
15730 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
15731 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
15732 systems).
15733
15734 @item show range
15735 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
15736 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
15737 @end table
15738
15739 @node Supported Languages
15740 @section Supported Languages
15741
15742 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
15743 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
15744 @c This is false ...
15745 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
15746 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
15747 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
15748 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
15749 language.
15750
15751 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
15752 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
15753 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
15754 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
15755 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
15756 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
15757 language reference or tutorial.
15758
15759 @menu
15760 * C:: C and C@t{++}
15761 * D:: D
15762 * Go:: Go
15763 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
15764 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
15765 * Fortran:: Fortran
15766 * Pascal:: Pascal
15767 * Rust:: Rust
15768 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
15769 * Ada:: Ada
15770 @end menu
15771
15772 @node C
15773 @subsection C and C@t{++}
15774
15775 @cindex C and C@t{++}
15776 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
15777
15778 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
15779 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
15780 together.
15781
15782 @cindex C@t{++}
15783 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
15784 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
15785 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
15786 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
15787 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
15788 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
15789 compiler (@code{aCC}).
15790
15791 @menu
15792 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
15793 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
15794 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
15795 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
15796 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
15797 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
15798 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
15799 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
15800 @end menu
15801
15802 @node C Operators
15803 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
15804
15805 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
15806
15807 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15808 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15809 often defined on groups of types.
15810
15811 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
15812
15813 @itemize @bullet
15814
15815 @item
15816 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
15817 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
15818
15819 @item
15820 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15821 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15822
15823 @item
15824 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15825
15826 @item
15827 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15828
15829 @end itemize
15830
15831 @noindent
15832 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15833 in order of increasing precedence:
15834
15835 @table @code
15836 @item ,
15837 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15838 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15839 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15840
15841 @item =
15842 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15843 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15844
15845 @item @var{op}=
15846 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15847 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15848 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15849 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15850 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15851
15852 @item ?:
15853 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15854 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15855 should be of an integral type.
15856
15857 @item ||
15858 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15859
15860 @item &&
15861 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15862
15863 @item |
15864 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15865
15866 @item ^
15867 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15868
15869 @item &
15870 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15871
15872 @item ==@r{, }!=
15873 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15874 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15875
15876 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15877 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15878 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15879 and non-zero for true.
15880
15881 @item <<@r{, }>>
15882 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15883
15884 @item @@
15885 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15886
15887 @item +@r{, }-
15888 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15889 pointer types.
15890
15891 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15892 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15893 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15894 integral types.
15895
15896 @item ++@r{, }--
15897 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15898 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15899 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15900 operation takes place.
15901
15902 @item *
15903 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15904 @code{++}.
15905
15906 @item &
15907 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15908
15909 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15910 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15911 to examine the address
15912 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15913 stored.
15914
15915 @item -
15916 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15917 precedence as @code{++}.
15918
15919 @item !
15920 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15921 @code{++}.
15922
15923 @item ~
15924 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15925 @code{++}.
15926
15927
15928 @item .@r{, }->
15929 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15930 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15931 pointer based on the stored type information.
15932 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15933
15934 @item .*@r{, }->*
15935 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15936
15937 @item []
15938 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15939 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15940
15941 @item ()
15942 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15943
15944 @item ::
15945 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15946 and @code{class} types.
15947
15948 @item ::
15949 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15950 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15951 above.
15952 @end table
15953
15954 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15955 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15956 predefined meaning.
15957
15958 @node C Constants
15959 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15960
15961 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15962
15963 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15964 following ways:
15965
15966 @itemize @bullet
15967 @item
15968 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15969 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15970 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15971 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15972 @code{long} value.
15973
15974 @item
15975 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15976 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15977 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15978 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15979 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15980 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15981 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15982 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15983 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15984 constant.
15985
15986 @item
15987 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15988 integral equivalents.
15989
15990 @item
15991 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15992 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15993 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15994 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15995 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15996 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15997 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15998 @samp{\n} for newline.
15999
16000 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
16001 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
16002 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
16003 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
16004
16005 @item
16006 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
16007 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
16008 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
16009 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
16010 characters.
16011
16012 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
16013 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
16014 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
16015
16016 @item
16017 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
16018 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
16019
16020 @item
16021 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
16022 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
16023 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
16024 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
16025 @end itemize
16026
16027 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
16028 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
16029
16030 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
16031 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
16032
16033 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
16034 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
16035 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
16036 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
16037 @quotation
16038 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
16039 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
16040 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
16041 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
16042 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
16043 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
16044 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
16045 code. @xref{Compilation}.
16046 @end quotation
16047
16048 @enumerate
16049
16050 @cindex member functions
16051 @item
16052 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
16053
16054 @smallexample
16055 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
16056 @end smallexample
16057
16058 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
16059 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
16060 @item
16061 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
16062 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
16063 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
16064 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
16065 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
16066
16067 @cindex call overloaded functions
16068 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
16069 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
16070 @item
16071 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
16072 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
16073 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
16074 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
16075 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
16076 default arguments.
16077
16078 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
16079 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
16080 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
16081 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
16082 number of function arguments.
16083
16084 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
16085 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
16086 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
16087
16088 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
16089 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
16090 @smallexample
16091 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
16092 @end smallexample
16093
16094 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
16095 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
16096
16097 @cindex reference declarations
16098 @item
16099 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
16100 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
16101 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
16102
16103 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
16104 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
16105 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
16106 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
16107 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
16108
16109 @item
16110 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
16111 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
16112 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
16113 necessary, for example in an expression like
16114 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
16115 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
16116 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
16117
16118 @item
16119 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
16120 specification.
16121 @end enumerate
16122
16123 @node C Defaults
16124 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
16125
16126 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
16127
16128 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
16129 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
16130 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16131 selects the working language.
16132
16133 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
16134 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
16135 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
16136 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
16137 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
16138 for further details.
16139
16140 @node C Checks
16141 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
16142
16143 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
16144
16145 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
16146 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
16147 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
16148 constants to pointers.
16149
16150 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
16151 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
16152 that is not itself an array.
16153
16154 @node Debugging C
16155 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
16156
16157 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
16158 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
16159 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
16160 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
16161
16162 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
16163 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
16164 ,Expressions}.
16165
16166 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
16167 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
16168
16169 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
16170
16171 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
16172 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
16173
16174 @table @code
16175 @cindex break in overloaded functions
16176 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
16177 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
16178 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
16179 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
16180 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
16181
16182 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
16183 @item rbreak @var{regex}
16184 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
16185 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
16186 classes.
16187 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16188
16189 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
16190 @item catch throw
16191 @itemx catch rethrow
16192 @itemx catch catch
16193 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
16194 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
16195
16196 @cindex inheritance
16197 @item ptype @var{typename}
16198 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
16199 @var{typename}.
16200 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
16201
16202 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
16203 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
16204 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
16205 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
16206 multiple inheritance is in use.
16207
16208 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
16209 @item demangle @var{name}
16210 Demangle @var{name}.
16211 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
16212
16213 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
16214 @item set print demangle
16215 @itemx show print demangle
16216 @itemx set print asm-demangle
16217 @itemx show print asm-demangle
16218 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
16219 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
16220 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
16221
16222 @item set print object
16223 @itemx show print object
16224 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
16225 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
16226
16227 @item set print vtbl
16228 @itemx show print vtbl
16229 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
16230 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
16231 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
16232 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
16233
16234 @kindex set overload-resolution
16235 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
16236 @item set overload-resolution on
16237 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
16238 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
16239 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
16240 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
16241 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
16242 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
16243
16244 @item set overload-resolution off
16245 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
16246 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
16247 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
16248 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
16249 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
16250 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
16251 argument types.
16252
16253 @kindex show overload-resolution
16254 @item show overload-resolution
16255 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
16256
16257 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
16258 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
16259 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
16260 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
16261 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
16262 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
16263 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
16264
16265 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
16266
16267 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
16268 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
16269 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
16270 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
16271 for more detail.
16272
16273 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
16274 function that returns a std::string:
16275
16276 @smallexample
16277 std::string function(int);
16278 @end smallexample
16279
16280 @noindent
16281 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
16282 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
16283
16284 @smallexample
16285 function[abi:cxx11](int)
16286 @end smallexample
16287
16288 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
16289 tag. For example:
16290
16291 @smallexample
16292 (gdb) b function(int)
16293 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
16294 (gdb) info breakpoints
16295 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
16296 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
16297 at main.cc:10
16298 @end smallexample
16299
16300 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
16301 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
16302 name, like:
16303
16304 @smallexample
16305 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
16306 @end smallexample
16307 @end table
16308
16309 @node Decimal Floating Point
16310 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
16311 @cindex decimal floating point format
16312
16313 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
16314 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
16315 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
16316 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
16317
16318 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
16319 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
16320 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
16321 configured target.
16322
16323 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
16324 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
16325 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
16326
16327 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
16328 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
16329 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
16330
16331 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
16332 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
16333 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
16334
16335 @node D
16336 @subsection D
16337
16338 @cindex D
16339 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
16340 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
16341 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
16342
16343 @node Go
16344 @subsection Go
16345
16346 @cindex Go (programming language)
16347 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
16348 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
16349
16350 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
16351
16352 @table @code
16353 @cindex current Go package
16354 @item The current Go package
16355 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
16356 specifying global variables and functions.
16357
16358 For example, given the program:
16359
16360 @example
16361 package main
16362 var myglob = "Shall we?"
16363 func main () @{
16364 // ...
16365 @}
16366 @end example
16367
16368 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
16369
16370 @example
16371 (gdb) p myglob
16372 (gdb) p main.myglob
16373 @end example
16374
16375 @cindex builtin Go types
16376 @item Builtin Go types
16377 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
16378 as a string.
16379
16380 @cindex builtin Go functions
16381 @item Builtin Go functions
16382 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
16383 function and handles it internally.
16384
16385 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
16386 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
16387 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
16388 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
16389 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
16390 @end table
16391
16392 @node Objective-C
16393 @subsection Objective-C
16394
16395 @cindex Objective-C
16396 This section provides information about some commands and command
16397 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
16398 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
16399 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
16400
16401 @menu
16402 * Method Names in Commands::
16403 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
16404 @end menu
16405
16406 @node Method Names in Commands
16407 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
16408
16409 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
16410 names as line specifications:
16411
16412 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
16413 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
16414 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
16415 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
16416 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
16417 @itemize
16418 @item @code{clear}
16419 @item @code{break}
16420 @item @code{info line}
16421 @item @code{jump}
16422 @item @code{list}
16423 @end itemize
16424
16425 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
16426
16427 @smallexample
16428 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
16429 @end smallexample
16430
16431 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
16432 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
16433 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
16434 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
16435 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
16436 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
16437 debugged, enter:
16438
16439 @smallexample
16440 break -[Fruit create]
16441 @end smallexample
16442
16443 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
16444 enter:
16445
16446 @smallexample
16447 list +[NSText initialize]
16448 @end smallexample
16449
16450 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
16451 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
16452 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
16453 is also possible to specify just a method name:
16454
16455 @smallexample
16456 break create
16457 @end smallexample
16458
16459 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
16460 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
16461 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
16462 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
16463 none apply.
16464
16465 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
16466 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
16467
16468 @smallexample
16469 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
16470 @end smallexample
16471
16472 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
16473 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
16474 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
16475 @kindex print-object
16476 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
16477
16478 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
16479
16480 @smallexample
16481 print -[@var{object} hash]
16482 @end smallexample
16483
16484 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
16485 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
16486 @noindent
16487 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
16488 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
16489 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
16490 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
16491 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
16492 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
16493
16494 @node OpenCL C
16495 @subsection OpenCL C
16496
16497 @cindex OpenCL C
16498 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
16499
16500 @menu
16501 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
16502 * OpenCL C Expressions::
16503 * OpenCL C Operators::
16504 @end menu
16505
16506 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
16507 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
16508
16509 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
16510 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
16511 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
16512 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
16513 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
16514
16515 @node OpenCL C Expressions
16516 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
16517
16518 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
16519 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
16520 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
16521 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
16522
16523 @node OpenCL C Operators
16524 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
16525
16526 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
16527 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
16528 vector data types.
16529
16530 @node Fortran
16531 @subsection Fortran
16532 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
16533
16534 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
16535 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
16536
16537 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
16538 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
16539 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
16540 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
16541 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
16542 underscore.
16543
16544 @menu
16545 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
16546 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
16547 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
16548 @end menu
16549
16550 @node Fortran Operators
16551 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
16552
16553 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
16554
16555 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
16556 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
16557 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
16558
16559 @table @code
16560 @item **
16561 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
16562 of the second one.
16563
16564 @item :
16565 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
16566 represent a section of array.
16567
16568 @item %
16569 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
16570 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
16571 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
16572 union type.
16573 @item ::
16574 The scope operator. Normally used to access variables in modules or
16575 to set breakpoints on subroutines nested in modules or in other
16576 subroutines (internal subroutines).
16577 @end table
16578
16579 @node Fortran Defaults
16580 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
16581
16582 @cindex Fortran Defaults
16583
16584 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
16585 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
16586 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
16587 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
16588
16589 @node Special Fortran Commands
16590 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
16591
16592 @cindex Special Fortran commands
16593
16594 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
16595 such as displaying common blocks.
16596
16597 @table @code
16598 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
16599 @kindex info common
16600 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
16601 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
16602 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
16603 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
16604 printed.
16605 @end table
16606
16607 @node Pascal
16608 @subsection Pascal
16609
16610 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
16611 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
16612 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
16613 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
16614 syntax.
16615
16616 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
16617 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
16618 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
16619
16620 @node Rust
16621 @subsection Rust
16622
16623 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
16624 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
16625 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
16626 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
16627
16628 @itemize @bullet
16629 @item
16630 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
16631 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
16632 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
16633
16634 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
16635 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
16636 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
16637 @samp{B}.
16638
16639 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
16640 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
16641
16642 @item
16643 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
16644 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
16645 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
16646 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
16647 @samp{K::x::y}.
16648
16649 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
16650 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
16651 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
16652 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
16653 scope.
16654
16655 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
16656 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
16657
16658 @item
16659 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
16660 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
16661
16662 @item
16663 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
16664
16665 @item
16666 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
16667 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
16668 never be destroyed.
16669
16670 @item
16671 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
16672 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
16673 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
16674
16675 @item
16676 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
16677 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
16678 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
16679 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
16680 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
16681 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
16682 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
16683 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
16684
16685 @item
16686 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
16687 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
16688 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
16689 @itemize @bullet
16690
16691 @item
16692 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
16693
16694 @item
16695 Operator overloading is not implemented.
16696
16697 @item
16698 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
16699 type names.
16700
16701 @item
16702 The type @code{Self} is not available.
16703
16704 @item
16705 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
16706 available in the crate.
16707 @end itemize
16708 @end itemize
16709
16710 @node Modula-2
16711 @subsection Modula-2
16712
16713 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
16714
16715 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
16716 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
16717 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
16718 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16719 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
16720 table.
16721
16722 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
16723 @menu
16724 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
16725 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
16726 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
16727 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
16728 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
16729 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
16730 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
16731 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16732 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16733 @end menu
16734
16735 @node M2 Operators
16736 @subsubsection Operators
16737 @cindex Modula-2 operators
16738
16739 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
16740 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
16741 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
16742 following definitions hold:
16743
16744 @itemize @bullet
16745
16746 @item
16747 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
16748 their subranges.
16749
16750 @item
16751 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
16752
16753 @item
16754 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
16755
16756 @item
16757 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
16758 @var{type}}.
16759
16760 @item
16761 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
16762
16763 @item
16764 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
16765
16766 @item
16767 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
16768 @end itemize
16769
16770 @noindent
16771 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
16772 increasing precedence:
16773
16774 @table @code
16775 @item ,
16776 Function argument or array index separator.
16777
16778 @item :=
16779 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
16780 @var{value}.
16781
16782 @item <@r{, }>
16783 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
16784 types.
16785
16786 @item <=@r{, }>=
16787 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
16788 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
16789 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
16790
16791 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
16792 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
16793 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
16794 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
16795 comment character.
16796
16797 @item IN
16798 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
16799 Same precedence as @code{<}.
16800
16801 @item OR
16802 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16803
16804 @item AND@r{, }&
16805 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16806
16807 @item @@
16808 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
16809
16810 @item +@r{, }-
16811 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
16812 and difference on set types.
16813
16814 @item *
16815 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
16816 on set types.
16817
16818 @item /
16819 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
16820 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
16821
16822 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16823 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16824 precedence as @code{*}.
16825
16826 @item -
16827 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16828
16829 @item ^
16830 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16831
16832 @item NOT
16833 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16834 @code{^}.
16835
16836 @item .
16837 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16838 precedence as @code{^}.
16839
16840 @item []
16841 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16842
16843 @item ()
16844 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16845 as @code{^}.
16846
16847 @item ::@r{, }.
16848 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16849 @end table
16850
16851 @quotation
16852 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16853 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16854 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16855 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16856 @end quotation
16857
16858
16859 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16860 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16861 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16862
16863 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16864 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16865
16866 @table @var
16867
16868 @item a
16869 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16870
16871 @item c
16872 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16873
16874 @item i
16875 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16876
16877 @item m
16878 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16879 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16880 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16881
16882 @item n
16883 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16884
16885 @item r
16886 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16887
16888 @item t
16889 represents a type.
16890
16891 @item v
16892 represents a variable.
16893
16894 @item x
16895 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16896 explanation of the function for details.
16897 @end table
16898
16899 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16900
16901 @table @code
16902 @item ABS(@var{n})
16903 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16904
16905 @item CAP(@var{c})
16906 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16907 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16908
16909 @item CHR(@var{i})
16910 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16911
16912 @item DEC(@var{v})
16913 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16914
16915 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16916 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16917 new value.
16918
16919 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16920 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16921 set.
16922
16923 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16924 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16925
16926 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16927 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16928
16929 @item INC(@var{v})
16930 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16931
16932 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16933 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16934 new value.
16935
16936 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16937 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16938 there. Returns the new set.
16939
16940 @item MAX(@var{t})
16941 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16942
16943 @item MIN(@var{t})
16944 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16945
16946 @item ODD(@var{i})
16947 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16948
16949 @item ORD(@var{x})
16950 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16951 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16952 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16953 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16954
16955 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16956 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16957 variable or a type.
16958
16959 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16960 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16961
16962 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16963 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16964 variable or a type.
16965
16966 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16967 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16968 @end table
16969
16970 @quotation
16971 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16972 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16973 an error.
16974 @end quotation
16975
16976 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16977 @node M2 Constants
16978 @subsubsection Constants
16979
16980 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16981 ways:
16982
16983 @itemize @bullet
16984
16985 @item
16986 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16987 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16988 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16989 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16990
16991 @item
16992 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16993 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16994 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16995 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16996 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16997 digits.
16998
16999 @item
17000 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
17001 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
17002 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
17003 followed by a @samp{C}.
17004
17005 @item
17006 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
17007 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
17008 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
17009 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
17010 sequences.
17011
17012 @item
17013 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
17014
17015 @item
17016 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
17017 @code{FALSE}.
17018
17019 @item
17020 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
17021
17022 @item
17023 Set constants are not yet supported.
17024 @end itemize
17025
17026 @node M2 Types
17027 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
17028 @cindex Modula-2 types
17029
17030 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
17031 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
17032 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
17033 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
17034 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
17035 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
17036
17037 The first example contains the following section of code:
17038
17039 @smallexample
17040 VAR
17041 s: SET OF CHAR ;
17042 r: [20..40] ;
17043 @end smallexample
17044
17045 @noindent
17046 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
17047 @code{r} and @code{s}.
17048
17049 @smallexample
17050 (@value{GDBP}) print s
17051 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
17052 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17053 SET OF CHAR
17054 (@value{GDBP}) print r
17055 21
17056 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
17057 [20..40]
17058 @end smallexample
17059
17060 @noindent
17061 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
17062
17063 @smallexample
17064 VAR
17065 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
17066 @end smallexample
17067
17068 @noindent
17069 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
17070
17071 @smallexample
17072 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17073 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
17074 @end smallexample
17075
17076 @noindent
17077 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
17078 expressions using the debugger.
17079
17080 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
17081 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
17082
17083 @smallexample
17084 VAR
17085 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
17086 @end smallexample
17087
17088 @smallexample
17089 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17090 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
17091 @end smallexample
17092
17093 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
17094 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
17095 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
17096 above.
17097
17098 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
17099
17100 @smallexample
17101 TYPE
17102 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
17103 t = [blue..yellow] ;
17104 VAR
17105 s: t ;
17106 BEGIN
17107 s := blue ;
17108 @end smallexample
17109
17110 @noindent
17111 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
17112 and value of a variable.
17113
17114 @smallexample
17115 (@value{GDBP}) print s
17116 $1 = blue
17117 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
17118 type = [blue..yellow]
17119 @end smallexample
17120
17121 @noindent
17122 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
17123 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
17124 their @code{C} counterparts.
17125
17126 @smallexample
17127 VAR
17128 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
17129 BEGIN
17130 s[1] := 1 ;
17131 @end smallexample
17132
17133 @smallexample
17134 (@value{GDBP}) print s
17135 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
17136 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17137 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
17138 @end smallexample
17139
17140 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
17141 pointer types as shown in this example:
17142
17143 @smallexample
17144 VAR
17145 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
17146 BEGIN
17147 NEW(s) ;
17148 s^[1] := 1 ;
17149 @end smallexample
17150
17151 @noindent
17152 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
17153
17154 @smallexample
17155 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17156 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
17157 @end smallexample
17158
17159 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
17160 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
17161 types:
17162
17163 @smallexample
17164 TYPE
17165 foo = RECORD
17166 f1: CARDINAL ;
17167 f2: CHAR ;
17168 f3: myarray ;
17169 END ;
17170
17171 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
17172 myrange = [-2..2] ;
17173 VAR
17174 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
17175 @end smallexample
17176
17177 @noindent
17178 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
17179 below.
17180
17181 @smallexample
17182 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17183 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
17184 f1 : CARDINAL;
17185 f2 : CHAR;
17186 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
17187 END
17188 @end smallexample
17189
17190 @node M2 Defaults
17191 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
17192 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
17193
17194 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
17195 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
17196 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
17197 selected the working language.
17198
17199 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
17200 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
17201 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
17202 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
17203
17204 @node Deviations
17205 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
17206 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
17207
17208 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
17209 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
17210
17211 @itemize @bullet
17212 @item
17213 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
17214 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
17215 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
17216 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
17217 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
17218 returned a pointer.)
17219
17220 @item
17221 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
17222 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
17223 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
17224 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
17225
17226 @item
17227 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
17228 argument.
17229
17230 @item
17231 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
17232 @end itemize
17233
17234 @node M2 Checks
17235 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
17236 @cindex Modula-2 checks
17237
17238 @quotation
17239 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
17240 range checking.
17241 @end quotation
17242 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
17243
17244 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
17245
17246 @itemize @bullet
17247 @item
17248 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
17249 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
17250
17251 @item
17252 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
17253 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
17254 @end itemize
17255
17256 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
17257 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
17258
17259 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
17260 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
17261
17262 @node M2 Scope
17263 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
17264 @cindex scope
17265 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
17266 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
17267 @ifinfo
17268 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
17269 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
17270 @end ifinfo
17271 @ifnotinfo
17272 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
17273 @end ifnotinfo
17274
17275 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
17276 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
17277 similar syntax:
17278
17279 @smallexample
17280
17281 @var{module} . @var{id}
17282 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
17283 @end smallexample
17284
17285 @noindent
17286 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
17287 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
17288 identifier within your program, except another module.
17289
17290 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
17291 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
17292 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
17293 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
17294
17295 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
17296 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
17297 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
17298 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
17299 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
17300 @var{module}.
17301
17302 @node GDB/M2
17303 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
17304
17305 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
17306 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
17307 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
17308 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
17309 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
17310 analogue in Modula-2.
17311
17312 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
17313 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
17314 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
17315 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
17316 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
17317 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
17318
17319 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
17320 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
17321 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
17322
17323 @node Ada
17324 @subsection Ada
17325 @cindex Ada
17326
17327 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
17328 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
17329 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
17330 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
17331 to be difficult.
17332
17333
17334 @cindex expressions in Ada
17335 @menu
17336 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
17337 and semantics supported by Ada mode
17338 in @value{GDBN}.
17339 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
17340 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
17341 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
17342 subprograms.
17343 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
17344 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
17345 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
17346 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17347 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
17348 Profile
17349 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
17350 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
17351 @end menu
17352
17353 @node Ada Mode Intro
17354 @subsubsection Introduction
17355 @cindex Ada mode, general
17356
17357 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
17358 syntax, with some extensions.
17359 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
17360
17361 @itemize @bullet
17362 @item
17363 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
17364 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
17365 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
17366 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
17367
17368 @item
17369 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
17370 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
17371
17372 @item
17373 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
17374 @end itemize
17375
17376 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
17377 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
17378 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
17379 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
17380 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
17381
17382 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
17383 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
17384 was translated from an Ada source file.
17385
17386 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
17387 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
17388 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
17389 middle (to allow based literals).
17390
17391 @node Omissions from Ada
17392 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
17393 @cindex Ada, omissions from
17394
17395 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
17396
17397 @itemize @bullet
17398 @item
17399 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
17400
17401 @itemize @minus
17402 @item
17403 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
17404 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
17405
17406 @item
17407 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
17408
17409 @item
17410 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
17411
17412 @item
17413 @t{'Tag}.
17414
17415 @item
17416 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
17417 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
17418
17419 @item
17420 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
17421 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
17422
17423 @item
17424 @t{'Address}.
17425 @end itemize
17426
17427 @item
17428 The names in
17429 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
17430 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
17431 not currently available.
17432
17433 @item
17434 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
17435 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
17436 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
17437 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
17438 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
17439 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
17440 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
17441 indeterminate values.
17442
17443 @item
17444 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
17445 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
17446 are not implemented.
17447
17448 @item
17449 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
17450 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
17451 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
17452 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
17453 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
17454
17455 @smallexample
17456 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
17457 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
17458 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
17459 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
17460 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
17461 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
17462 @end smallexample
17463
17464 Changing a
17465 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
17466 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
17467 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
17468 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
17469 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
17470 declared to have a type such as:
17471
17472 @smallexample
17473 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
17474 Id : Integer;
17475 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
17476 end record;
17477 @end smallexample
17478
17479 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
17480 assignments:
17481
17482 @smallexample
17483 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
17484 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
17485 @end smallexample
17486
17487 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
17488 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
17489 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
17490 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
17491 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
17492 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
17493 redundant component associations, although which component values are
17494 assigned in such cases is not defined.
17495
17496 @item
17497 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
17498
17499 @item
17500 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
17501 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
17502 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
17503 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
17504 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
17505 the proper resolution.
17506
17507 @item
17508 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
17509
17510 @item
17511 Entry calls are not implemented.
17512
17513 @item
17514 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
17515 formats are not supported.
17516
17517 @item
17518 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
17519
17520 @item
17521 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
17522 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
17523 context.
17524 Should your program
17525 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
17526 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
17527 @end itemize
17528
17529 @node Additions to Ada
17530 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
17531 @cindex Ada, deviations from
17532
17533 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
17534 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
17535
17536 @itemize @bullet
17537 @item
17538 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
17539 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
17540 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
17541 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
17542 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
17543 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
17544 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
17545 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
17546
17547 @item
17548 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
17549 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
17550 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
17551
17552 @item
17553 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
17554 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
17555
17556 @item
17557 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
17558 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
17559 @end itemize
17560
17561 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
17562 additions specific to Ada:
17563
17564 @itemize @bullet
17565 @item
17566 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
17567 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
17568
17569 @smallexample
17570 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
17571 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
17572 @end smallexample
17573
17574 @item
17575 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
17576 the value of its right-hand operand.
17577 This allows, for example,
17578 complex conditional breaks:
17579
17580 @smallexample
17581 (@value{GDBP}) break f
17582 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
17583 @end smallexample
17584
17585 @item
17586 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
17587 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
17588 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
17589 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
17590 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
17591 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
17592 in strings. For example,
17593 @smallexample
17594 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
17595 @end smallexample
17596 @noindent
17597 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
17598 after each period.
17599
17600 @item
17601 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
17602 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
17603 to write
17604
17605 @smallexample
17606 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
17607 @end smallexample
17608
17609 @item
17610 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
17611 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
17612 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
17613 of 3 might print as
17614
17615 @smallexample
17616 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
17617 @end smallexample
17618
17619 @noindent
17620 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
17621 clause.
17622
17623 @item
17624 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
17625 multi-character subsequence of
17626 their names (an exact match gets preference).
17627 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
17628 in place of @t{a'length}.
17629
17630 @item
17631 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
17632 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
17633 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
17634 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
17635 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
17636 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
17637 For example,
17638 @smallexample
17639 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
17640 @end smallexample
17641
17642 @item
17643 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
17644 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
17645 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
17646 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
17647 object.
17648
17649 @end itemize
17650
17651 @node Overloading support for Ada
17652 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
17653 @cindex overloading, Ada
17654
17655 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
17656 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
17657 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
17658 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
17659 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
17660 functions to procedures elsewhere.
17661
17662 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
17663 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
17664 use, for instance:
17665
17666 @smallexample
17667 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
17668 Multiple matches for f
17669 [0] cancel
17670 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
17671 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
17672 >
17673 @end smallexample
17674
17675 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
17676 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
17677 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
17678
17679 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
17680 case:
17681
17682 @table @code
17683
17684 @kindex set ada print-signatures
17685 @item set ada print-signatures
17686 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
17687 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
17688 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
17689
17690 @kindex show ada print-signatures
17691 @item show ada print-signatures
17692 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
17693 overloads selection menu.
17694 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
17695
17696 @end table
17697
17698 @node Stopping Before Main Program
17699 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
17700
17701 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
17702 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
17703 before reaching the main procedure.
17704 As defined in the Ada Reference
17705 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
17706 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
17707 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
17708 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
17709
17710 @node Ada Exceptions
17711 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
17712
17713 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
17714
17715 @table @code
17716 @kindex info exceptions
17717 @item info exceptions
17718 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
17719 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
17720 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
17721 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
17722 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
17723 @end table
17724
17725 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
17726 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
17727 argument.
17728
17729 @smallexample
17730 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
17731 All defined Ada exceptions:
17732 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17733 program_error: 0x613d20
17734 storage_error: 0x613ce0
17735 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
17736 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17737 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
17738 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
17739 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17740 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17741 @end smallexample
17742
17743 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
17744 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
17745
17746 @node Ada Tasks
17747 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
17748 @cindex Ada, tasking
17749
17750 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
17751 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
17752
17753 @table @code
17754 @kindex info tasks
17755 @item info tasks
17756 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
17757
17758
17759 @smallexample
17760 @iftex
17761 @leftskip=0.5cm
17762 @end iftex
17763 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17764 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17765 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17766 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
17767 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
17768 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
17769
17770 @end smallexample
17771
17772 @noindent
17773 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
17774 task currently being inspected.
17775
17776 @table @asis
17777 @item ID
17778 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
17779
17780 @item TID
17781 The Ada task ID.
17782
17783 @item P-ID
17784 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
17785
17786 @item Pri
17787 The base priority of the task.
17788
17789 @item State
17790 Current state of the task.
17791
17792 @table @code
17793 @item Unactivated
17794 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
17795 executing.
17796
17797 @item Runnable
17798 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
17799 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
17800
17801 @item Terminated
17802 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
17803 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
17804 terminated themselves.
17805
17806 @item Child Activation Wait
17807 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
17808
17809 @item Accept Statement
17810 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
17811
17812 @item Waiting on entry call
17813 The task is waiting on an entry call.
17814
17815 @item Async Select Wait
17816 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
17817 select statement.
17818
17819 @item Delay Sleep
17820 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
17821 alternative open.
17822
17823 @item Child Termination Wait
17824 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17825 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17826 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17827
17828 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17829 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17830 finish terminating.
17831
17832 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17833 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17834 @end table
17835
17836 @item Name
17837 Name of the task in the program.
17838
17839 @end table
17840
17841 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17842 @item info task @var{taskno}
17843 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17844 the following example:
17845 @smallexample
17846 @iftex
17847 @leftskip=0.5cm
17848 @end iftex
17849 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17850 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17851 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17852 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17853 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17854 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17855 Name: "task_1"
17856 Thread: 0
17857 LWP: 0x1fac
17858 Parent: 1 ("main_task")
17859 Base Priority: 15
17860 State: Runnable
17861 @end smallexample
17862
17863 @item task
17864 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17865 @cindex current Ada task ID
17866 This command prints the ID and name of the current task.
17867
17868 @smallexample
17869 @iftex
17870 @leftskip=0.5cm
17871 @end iftex
17872 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17873 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17874 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17875 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable some_task
17876 (@value{GDBP}) task
17877 [Current task is 2 "some_task"]
17878 @end smallexample
17879
17880 @item task @var{taskno}
17881 @cindex Ada task switching
17882 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17883 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17884 from the current task to the given task.
17885
17886 @smallexample
17887 @iftex
17888 @leftskip=0.5cm
17889 @end iftex
17890 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17891 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17892 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17893 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable some_task
17894 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17895 [Switching to task 1 "main_task"]
17896 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17897 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17898 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17899 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17900 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17901 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17902 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17903 @end smallexample
17904
17905 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17906 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17907 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17908 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17909 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17910 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17911 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17912 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17913 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17914
17915 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17916 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17917 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17918 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17919 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17920
17921 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17922 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17923 program.
17924
17925 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17926 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17927 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17928
17929 For example,
17930
17931 @smallexample
17932 @iftex
17933 @leftskip=0.5cm
17934 @end iftex
17935 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17936 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17937 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17938 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17939 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17940 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17941 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17942 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17943 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17944 Continuing.
17945 task # 1 running
17946 task # 2 running
17947
17948 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17949 15 flush;
17950 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17951 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17952 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17953 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17954 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17955 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17956 @end smallexample
17957 @end table
17958
17959 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17960 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17961 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17962
17963 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17964 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17965 the platform being used.
17966 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17967 switching is not supported.
17968
17969 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17970 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17971 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17972 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17973 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17974 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17975
17976 @node Ravenscar Profile
17977 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17978 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17979
17980 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17981 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17982 requirements.
17983
17984 @table @code
17985 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17986 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17987 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17988 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17989 Profile. This is the default.
17990
17991 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17992 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17993 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17994 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17995 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17996 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17997 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17998
17999 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
18000 @item show ravenscar task-switching
18001 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
18002 using the Ravenscar Profile.
18003
18004 @end table
18005
18006 @node Ada Settings
18007 @subsubsection Ada Settings
18008 @cindex Ada settings
18009
18010 @table @code
18011 @kindex set varsize-limit
18012 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
18013 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
18014 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
18015 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
18016 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
18017 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
18018 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
18019
18020 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18021 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
18022 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
18023 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
18024 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
18025 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
18026 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
18027 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
18028 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
18029 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
18030 size is less than @var{size}.
18031
18032 @kindex show varsize-limit
18033 @item show varsize-limit
18034 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
18035 @end table
18036
18037 @node Ada Glitches
18038 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
18039 @cindex Ada, problems
18040
18041 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
18042 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
18043 @value{GDBN},
18044 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
18045 and the GNU Ada compiler.
18046
18047 @itemize @bullet
18048 @item
18049 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
18050 storage are invisible to the debugger.
18051
18052 @item
18053 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
18054 argument lists are treated as positional).
18055
18056 @item
18057 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
18058
18059 @item
18060 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
18061 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
18062 the host machine.
18063
18064 @item
18065 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
18066 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
18067 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
18068 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
18069 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
18070 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
18071 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
18072 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
18073 you can usually resolve the confusion
18074 by qualifying the problematic names with package
18075 @code{Standard} explicitly.
18076 @end itemize
18077
18078 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
18079 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
18080 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
18081 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
18082 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
18083 enabled.
18084
18085 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
18086 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
18087 @table @code
18088
18089 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
18090 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
18091 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
18092 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
18093 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
18094 This is the default.
18095
18096 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
18097 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
18098 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
18099 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
18100 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
18101 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
18102 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
18103
18104 @end table
18105
18106 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
18107 @cindex GNAT encoding
18108 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
18109 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
18110 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
18111 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
18112 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
18113 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
18114
18115 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
18116 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
18117 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
18118 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
18119 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
18120 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
18121 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
18122 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
18123
18124 @table @code
18125
18126 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
18127 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
18128 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
18129 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
18130
18131 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
18132 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
18133 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
18134
18135 @end table
18136
18137 @node Unsupported Languages
18138 @section Unsupported Languages
18139
18140 @cindex unsupported languages
18141 @cindex minimal language
18142 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
18143 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
18144 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
18145 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
18146 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
18147 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
18148
18149 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
18150 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
18151 language.
18152
18153 @node Symbols
18154 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
18155
18156 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
18157 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
18158 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
18159 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
18160 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
18161 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
18162 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
18163
18164 @cindex symbol names
18165 @cindex names of symbols
18166 @cindex quoting names
18167 @anchor{quoting names}
18168 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
18169 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
18170 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
18171 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
18172 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
18173 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
18174 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
18175 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
18176
18177 @smallexample
18178 p 'foo.c'::x
18179 @end smallexample
18180
18181 @noindent
18182 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
18183
18184 @table @code
18185 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
18186 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
18187 @kindex set case-sensitive
18188 @item set case-sensitive on
18189 @itemx set case-sensitive off
18190 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
18191 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
18192 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
18193 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
18194 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
18195 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
18196 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
18197 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
18198 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
18199 case-insensitive matches.
18200
18201 @kindex show case-sensitive
18202 @item show case-sensitive
18203 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
18204 lookups.
18205
18206 @kindex set print type methods
18207 @item set print type methods
18208 @itemx set print type methods on
18209 @itemx set print type methods off
18210 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
18211 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
18212 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
18213 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
18214 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
18215 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
18216
18217 @kindex show print type methods
18218 @item show print type methods
18219 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
18220 classes.
18221
18222 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
18223 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
18224 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
18225 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
18226 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
18227 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
18228 types defined in classes.
18229
18230 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
18231 @item show print type nested-type-limit
18232 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
18233 printing classes.
18234
18235 @kindex set print type typedefs
18236 @item set print type typedefs
18237 @itemx set print type typedefs on
18238 @itemx set print type typedefs off
18239
18240 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
18241 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
18242 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
18243 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
18244 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
18245 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
18246 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
18247 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
18248 types.
18249
18250 @kindex show print type typedefs
18251 @item show print type typedefs
18252 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
18253 printing classes.
18254
18255 @kindex info address
18256 @cindex address of a symbol
18257 @item info address @var{symbol}
18258 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
18259 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
18260 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
18261 is always stored.
18262
18263 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
18264 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
18265 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
18266
18267 @kindex info symbol
18268 @cindex symbol from address
18269 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
18270 @item info symbol @var{addr}
18271 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
18272 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
18273 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
18274
18275 @smallexample
18276 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
18277 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
18278 @end smallexample
18279
18280 @noindent
18281 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
18282 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
18283
18284 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
18285 library containing the symbol is also printed:
18286
18287 @smallexample
18288 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
18289 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
18290 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
18291 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
18292 @end smallexample
18293
18294 @kindex demangle
18295 @cindex demangle
18296 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
18297 Demangle @var{name}.
18298 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
18299 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
18300
18301 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
18302 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
18303
18304 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
18305 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
18306
18307 @kindex whatis
18308 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
18309 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
18310 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
18311 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
18312
18313 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
18314 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
18315 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
18316
18317 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
18318 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
18319 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
18320 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
18321 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
18322 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
18323 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
18324 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
18325 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
18326
18327 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
18328 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
18329 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
18330 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
18331 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
18332 unroll it.
18333
18334 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
18335 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
18336 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
18337
18338 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
18339 Available flags are:
18340
18341 @table @code
18342 @item r
18343 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
18344 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
18345 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
18346
18347 @item m
18348 Do not print methods defined in the class.
18349
18350 @item M
18351 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
18352 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
18353
18354 @item t
18355 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
18356 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
18357 names are substituted when printing other types.
18358
18359 @item T
18360 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
18361 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
18362
18363 @item o
18364 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
18365 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
18366
18367 For example, given the following declarations:
18368
18369 @smallexample
18370 struct tuv
18371 @{
18372 int a1;
18373 char *a2;
18374 int a3;
18375 @};
18376
18377 struct xyz
18378 @{
18379 int f1;
18380 char f2;
18381 void *f3;
18382 struct tuv f4;
18383 @};
18384
18385 union qwe
18386 @{
18387 struct tuv fff1;
18388 struct xyz fff2;
18389 @};
18390
18391 struct tyu
18392 @{
18393 int a1 : 1;
18394 int a2 : 3;
18395 int a3 : 23;
18396 char a4 : 2;
18397 int64_t a5;
18398 int a6 : 5;
18399 int64_t a7 : 3;
18400 @};
18401 @end smallexample
18402
18403 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
18404
18405 @smallexample
18406 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
18407 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
18408 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
18409 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
18410 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
18411 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
18412
18413 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
18414 @}
18415 @end smallexample
18416
18417 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
18418 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
18419 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
18420 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
18421 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
18422 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
18423 its fields.
18424
18425 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
18426
18427 @smallexample
18428 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
18429 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
18430 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
18431 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
18432 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
18433 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
18434 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
18435
18436 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
18437 @} fff1;
18438 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
18439 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
18440 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
18441 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
18442 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
18443 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
18444 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
18445 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
18446 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
18447 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
18448
18449 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
18450 @} f4;
18451
18452 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
18453 @} fff2;
18454
18455 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
18456 @}
18457 @end smallexample
18458
18459 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
18460 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
18461 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
18462 of these structures' fields.
18463
18464 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
18465 bitfields:
18466
18467 @smallexample
18468 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
18469 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
18470 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
18471 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
18472 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
18473 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
18474 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
18475 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
18476 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
18477 /* 16: 0 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
18478 /* 16: 5 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
18479 "/* XXX 7-byte padding */
18480
18481 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
18482 @}
18483 @end smallexample
18484
18485 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include the
18486 first bit of the bitfield.
18487 @end table
18488
18489 @kindex ptype
18490 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
18491 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
18492 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
18493 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
18494
18495 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
18496 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
18497 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
18498 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
18499 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
18500 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
18501 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
18502 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
18503
18504 For example, for this variable declaration:
18505
18506 @smallexample
18507 typedef double real_t;
18508 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
18509 typedef struct complex complex_t;
18510 complex_t var;
18511 real_t *real_pointer_var;
18512 @end smallexample
18513
18514 @noindent
18515 the two commands give this output:
18516
18517 @smallexample
18518 @group
18519 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
18520 type = complex_t
18521 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
18522 type = struct complex @{
18523 real_t real;
18524 double imag;
18525 @}
18526 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
18527 type = struct complex
18528 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
18529 type = struct complex
18530 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
18531 type = struct complex @{
18532 real_t real;
18533 double imag;
18534 @}
18535 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
18536 type = real_t *
18537 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
18538 type = double *
18539 @end group
18540 @end smallexample
18541
18542 @noindent
18543 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
18544 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
18545
18546 @cindex incomplete type
18547 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
18548 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
18549 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
18550 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
18551 given these declarations:
18552
18553 @smallexample
18554 struct foo;
18555 struct foo *fooptr;
18556 @end smallexample
18557
18558 @noindent
18559 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
18560
18561 @smallexample
18562 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
18563 $1 = <incomplete type>
18564 @end smallexample
18565
18566 @noindent
18567 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
18568 completely specified.
18569
18570 @cindex unknown type
18571 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
18572 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
18573 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
18574 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
18575 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
18576 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
18577 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
18578 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
18579
18580 @smallexample
18581 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
18582 type = <data variable, no debug info>
18583 @end smallexample
18584
18585 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
18586 of such variables.
18587
18588 @kindex info types
18589 @item info types [-q] [@var{regexp}]
18590 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
18591 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
18592 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
18593 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
18594 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
18595 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
18596 name is @code{value}.
18597
18598 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18599 to print the type description according to the
18600 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18601 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18602 language of the type, other values mean to use
18603 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18604
18605 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
18606 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
18607 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
18608
18609 The output from @samp{into types} is proceeded with a header line
18610 describing what types are being listed. The optional flag @samp{-q},
18611 which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables printing this header
18612 information.
18613
18614 @kindex info type-printers
18615 @item info type-printers
18616 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
18617 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
18618 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
18619 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
18620 type printers.
18621
18622 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
18623
18624 @kindex enable type-printer
18625 @kindex disable type-printer
18626 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
18627 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
18628 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
18629
18630 @kindex info scope
18631 @cindex local variables
18632 @item info scope @var{location}
18633 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
18634 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
18635 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
18636 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
18637 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
18638
18639 @smallexample
18640 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
18641 Scope for command_line_handler:
18642 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
18643 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
18644 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
18645 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
18646 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
18647 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
18648 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
18649 @end smallexample
18650
18651 @noindent
18652 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
18653 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
18654 collect}.
18655
18656 @kindex info source
18657 @item info source
18658 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
18659 the function containing the current point of execution:
18660 @itemize @bullet
18661 @item
18662 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
18663 @item
18664 the directory it was compiled in,
18665 @item
18666 its length, in lines,
18667 @item
18668 which programming language it is written in,
18669 @item
18670 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
18671 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
18672 @item
18673 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
18674 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
18675 @item
18676 whether the debugging information includes information about
18677 preprocessor macros.
18678 @end itemize
18679
18680
18681 @kindex info sources
18682 @item info sources
18683 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
18684 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
18685 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
18686
18687 @item info sources [-dirname | -basename] [--] [@var{regexp}]
18688 Like @samp{info sources}, but only print the names of the files
18689 matching the provided @var{regexp}.
18690 By default, the @var{regexp} is used to match anywhere in the filename.
18691 If @code{-dirname}, only files having a dirname matching @var{regexp} are shown.
18692 If @code{-basename}, only files having a basename matching @var{regexp}
18693 are shown.
18694 The matching is case-sensitive, except on operating systems that
18695 have case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows).
18696
18697 @kindex info functions
18698 @item info functions [-q] [-n]
18699 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
18700 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
18701 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
18702 number.
18703
18704 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18705 to print the function name and type according to the
18706 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18707 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18708 language of the function, other values mean to use
18709 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18710
18711 The @samp{-n} flag excludes @dfn{non-debugging symbols} from the
18712 results. A non-debugging symbol is a symbol that comes from the
18713 executable's symbol table, not from the debug information (for
18714 example, DWARF) associated with the executable.
18715
18716 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18717 printing header information and messages explaining why no functions
18718 have been printed.
18719
18720 @item info functions [-q] [-n] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18721 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types
18722 of the functions selected with the provided regexp(s).
18723
18724 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose names
18725 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18726 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
18727 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
18728 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
18729 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
18730 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
18731
18732 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose
18733 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18734 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18735 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18736 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18737 of special characters or quotes.
18738 Thus, @samp{info fun -t '^int ('} finds the functions that return
18739 an integer; @samp{info fun -t '(.*int.*'} finds the functions that
18740 have an argument type containing int; @samp{info fun -t '^int (' ^step}
18741 finds the functions whose names start with @code{step} and that return
18742 int.
18743
18744 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a function
18745 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18746 @var{type_regexp}.
18747
18748
18749 @kindex info variables
18750 @item info variables [-q] [-n]
18751 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
18752 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
18753 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
18754 their respective source line numbers.
18755
18756 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18757 to print the variable name and type according to the
18758 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18759 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18760 language of the variable, other values mean to use
18761 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18762
18763 The @samp{-n} flag excludes non-debugging symbols from the results.
18764
18765 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18766 printing header information and messages explaining why no variables
18767 have been printed.
18768
18769 @item info variables [-q] [-n] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18770 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the variables selected
18771 with the provided regexp(s).
18772
18773 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose names
18774 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18775
18776 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose
18777 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18778 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18779 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18780 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18781 of special characters or quotes.
18782
18783 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
18784 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18785 @var{type_regexp}.
18786
18787 @kindex info classes
18788 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
18789 @item info classes
18790 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
18791 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
18792 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18793 expression.
18794
18795 @kindex info selectors
18796 @item info selectors
18797 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
18798 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
18799 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18800 expression.
18801
18802 @ignore
18803 This was never implemented.
18804 @kindex info methods
18805 @item info methods
18806 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
18807 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
18808 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
18809 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
18810 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
18811 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
18812 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
18813 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
18814 @end ignore
18815
18816 @cindex opaque data types
18817 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
18818 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
18819 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
18820 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
18821 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
18822 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
18823 another source file. The default is on.
18824
18825 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
18826 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
18827
18828 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
18829 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
18830 is printed as follows:
18831 @smallexample
18832 @{<no data fields>@}
18833 @end smallexample
18834
18835 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
18836 @item show opaque-type-resolution
18837 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
18838
18839 @kindex set print symbol-loading
18840 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
18841 @item set print symbol-loading
18842 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
18843 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
18844 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
18845 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
18846 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
18847 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
18848 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
18849 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
18850 can be annoying.
18851 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
18852 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
18853 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
18854 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
18855
18856 @kindex show print symbol-loading
18857 @item show print symbol-loading
18858 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
18859 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
18860
18861 @kindex maint print symbols
18862 @cindex symbol dump
18863 @kindex maint print psymbols
18864 @cindex partial symbol dump
18865 @kindex maint print msymbols
18866 @cindex minimal symbol dump
18867 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18868 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18869 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18870 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18871 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18872 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
18873 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
18874 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
18875 that objfile.
18876 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
18877 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
18878 @code{main}.
18879 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
18880 source file.
18881
18882 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
18883 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
18884 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
18885 tables.
18886 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
18887 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
18888 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
18889 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
18890 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
18891 ``ELF symbols''.
18892
18893 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
18894 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
18895
18896 @kindex maint info symtabs
18897 @kindex maint info psymtabs
18898 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
18899 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18900 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18901 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18902 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18903 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18904
18905 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
18906 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18907 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18908 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18909 structure in more detail. For example:
18910
18911 @smallexample
18912 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18913 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18914 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18915 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18916 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18917 readin no
18918 fullname (null)
18919 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18920 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18921 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18922 dependencies (none)
18923 @}
18924 @}
18925 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18926 (@value{GDBP})
18927 @end smallexample
18928 @noindent
18929 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18930 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18931 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18932 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18933 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18934
18935 @smallexample
18936 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18937 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18938 line 1574.
18939 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18940 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18941 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18942 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18943 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18944 dirname (null)
18945 fullname (null)
18946 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18947 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18948 debugformat DWARF 2
18949 @}
18950 @}
18951 (@value{GDBP})
18952 @end smallexample
18953
18954 @kindex maint info line-table
18955 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18956 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18957 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18958
18959 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18960 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18961 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18962
18963 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18964 @cindex symbol cache size
18965 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18966 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18967 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18968 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18969 with different sizes.
18970
18971 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18972 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18973 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18974
18975 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18976 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18977 @item maint print symbol-cache
18978 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18979 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18980
18981 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18982 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18983 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18984 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18985 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18986
18987 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18988 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18989 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18990 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18991 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18992 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18993
18994 @end table
18995
18996 @node Altering
18997 @chapter Altering Execution
18998
18999 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
19000 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
19001 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
19002 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
19003 program.
19004
19005 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
19006 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
19007 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
19008
19009 @menu
19010 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
19011 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
19012 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
19013 * Returning:: Returning from a function
19014 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
19015 * Patching:: Patching your program
19016 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
19017 @end menu
19018
19019 @node Assignment
19020 @section Assignment to Variables
19021
19022 @cindex assignment
19023 @cindex setting variables
19024 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
19025 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
19026
19027 @smallexample
19028 print x=4
19029 @end smallexample
19030
19031 @noindent
19032 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
19033 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
19034 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
19035 information on operators in supported languages.
19036
19037 @kindex set variable
19038 @cindex variables, setting
19039 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
19040 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
19041 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
19042 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
19043 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
19044
19045 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
19046 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
19047 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
19048 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
19049 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
19050 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
19051 command @code{set width}:
19052
19053 @smallexample
19054 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
19055 type = double
19056 (@value{GDBP}) p width
19057 $4 = 13
19058 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
19059 Invalid syntax in expression.
19060 @end smallexample
19061
19062 @noindent
19063 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
19064 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
19065
19066 @smallexample
19067 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
19068 @end smallexample
19069
19070 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
19071 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
19072 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
19073 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
19074 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
19075 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
19076
19077 @smallexample
19078 @group
19079 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
19080 type = double
19081 (@value{GDBP}) p g
19082 $1 = 1
19083 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
19084 (@value{GDBP}) p g
19085 $2 = 1
19086 (@value{GDBP}) r
19087 The program being debugged has been started already.
19088 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
19089 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
19090 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
19091 Invalid bfd target.
19092 (@value{GDBP}) show g
19093 The current BFD target is "=4".
19094 @end group
19095 @end smallexample
19096
19097 @noindent
19098 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
19099 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
19100 @code{g}, use
19101
19102 @smallexample
19103 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
19104 @end smallexample
19105
19106 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
19107 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
19108 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
19109 same length or shorter.
19110 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
19111 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
19112
19113 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
19114 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
19115 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
19116 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
19117 and representation in memory), and
19118
19119 @smallexample
19120 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
19121 @end smallexample
19122
19123 @noindent
19124 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
19125
19126 @node Jumping
19127 @section Continuing at a Different Address
19128
19129 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
19130 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
19131 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
19132
19133 @table @code
19134 @kindex jump
19135 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
19136 @item jump @var{location}
19137 @itemx j @var{location}
19138 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
19139 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
19140 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
19141 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
19142 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
19143
19144 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
19145 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
19146 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
19147 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
19148 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
19149 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
19150 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
19151 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
19152 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
19153 @end table
19154
19155 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
19156 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
19157 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
19158 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
19159 example,
19160
19161 @smallexample
19162 set $pc = 0x485
19163 @end smallexample
19164
19165 @noindent
19166 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
19167 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
19168 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
19169
19170 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
19171 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
19172 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
19173 detail.
19174
19175 @c @group
19176 @node Signaling
19177 @section Giving your Program a Signal
19178 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
19179
19180 @table @code
19181 @kindex signal
19182 @item signal @var{signal}
19183 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
19184 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
19185 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
19186 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
19187
19188 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
19189 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
19190 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
19191 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
19192 signal.
19193
19194 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
19195 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
19196 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
19197 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
19198 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
19199 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
19200 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
19201 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
19202
19203 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
19204 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
19205 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
19206 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
19207 passes the signal directly to your program.
19208
19209 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
19210 after executing the command.
19211
19212 @kindex queue-signal
19213 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
19214 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
19215 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
19216 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
19217 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
19218 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
19219 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
19220 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
19221 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
19222
19223 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
19224 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
19225 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
19226 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
19227 @code{continue} command.
19228
19229 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
19230 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
19231 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
19232 (@pxref{Signals}).
19233 @end table
19234 @c @end group
19235
19236 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
19237 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
19238
19239 @node Returning
19240 @section Returning from a Function
19241
19242 @table @code
19243 @cindex returning from a function
19244 @kindex return
19245 @item return
19246 @itemx return @var{expression}
19247 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
19248 command. If you give an
19249 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
19250 value.
19251 @end table
19252
19253 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
19254 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
19255 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
19256 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
19257
19258 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
19259 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
19260 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
19261 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
19262 of functions.
19263
19264 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
19265 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
19266 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
19267 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
19268 selected stack frame returns naturally.
19269
19270 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
19271 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
19272 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
19273 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
19274 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
19275 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
19276 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
19277 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
19278 assignment into the right register(s).
19279
19280 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
19281 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
19282 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
19283 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
19284 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
19285 into a @code{long long int}:
19286
19287 @smallexample
19288 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
19289 29 return 31;
19290 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
19291 Make func return now? (y or n) y
19292 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
19293 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
19294 (@value{GDBP})
19295 @end smallexample
19296
19297 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
19298 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
19299 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
19300 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
19301 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
19302 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
19303 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
19304 an appropriate cast explicitly:
19305
19306 @smallexample
19307 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
19308 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
19309 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
19310 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
19311 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
19312 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
19313 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
19314 (@value{GDBP})
19315 @end smallexample
19316
19317 @node Calling
19318 @section Calling Program Functions
19319
19320 @table @code
19321 @cindex calling functions
19322 @cindex inferior functions, calling
19323 @item print @var{expr}
19324 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
19325 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
19326 debugged.
19327
19328 @kindex call
19329 @item call @var{expr}
19330 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
19331 returned values.
19332
19333 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
19334 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
19335 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
19336 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
19337 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
19338 value history.
19339 @end table
19340
19341 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
19342 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
19343 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
19344 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
19345
19346 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
19347 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
19348 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
19349 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
19350 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
19351 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
19352 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
19353 in that case is controlled by the
19354 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
19355
19356 @table @code
19357 @item set unwindonsignal
19358 @kindex set unwindonsignal
19359 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
19360 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
19361 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
19362 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
19363 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
19364 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
19365 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
19366 received.
19367
19368 @item show unwindonsignal
19369 @kindex show unwindonsignal
19370 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
19371 @value{GDBN}.
19372
19373 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
19374 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
19375 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
19376 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
19377 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
19378 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
19379 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
19380 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
19381 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
19382 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
19383
19384 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
19385 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
19386 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
19387 @value{GDBN}.
19388
19389 @item set may-call-functions
19390 @kindex set may-call-functions
19391 @cindex disabling calling functions in the program
19392 @cindex calling functions in the program, disabling
19393 Set permission to call functions in the program.
19394 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to call functions in
19395 the program, such as with expressions in the @code{print} command. It
19396 defaults to @code{on}.
19397
19398 To call a function in the program, @value{GDBN} has to temporarily
19399 modify the state of the inferior. This has potentially undesired side
19400 effects. Also, having @value{GDBN} call nested functions is likely to
19401 be erroneous and may even crash the program being debugged. You can
19402 avoid such hazards by forbidding @value{GDBN} from calling functions
19403 in the program being debugged. If calling functions in the program
19404 is forbidden, GDB will throw an error when a command (such as printing
19405 an expression) starts a function call in the program.
19406
19407 @item show may-call-functions
19408 @kindex show may-call-functions
19409 Show permission to call functions in the program.
19410
19411 @end table
19412
19413 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
19414
19415 @cindex no debug info functions
19416 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
19417 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
19418 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
19419 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
19420 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
19421 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
19422
19423 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
19424 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
19425 declared return type. For example:
19426
19427 @smallexample
19428 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
19429 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
19430 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
19431 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
19432 @end smallexample
19433
19434 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
19435 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
19436 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
19437 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
19438
19439 @smallexample
19440 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
19441 @end smallexample
19442
19443 @noindent
19444 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
19445
19446 @smallexample
19447 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
19448 @end smallexample
19449
19450 @noindent
19451 these calls are equivalent:
19452
19453 @smallexample
19454 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
19455 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
19456 @end smallexample
19457
19458 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
19459 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
19460 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
19461 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
19462 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
19463 float parameters, and no debug info:
19464
19465 @smallexample
19466 float
19467 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
19468 float v1, v2;
19469 @{
19470 return v1 * v2;
19471 @}
19472 @end smallexample
19473
19474 @noindent
19475 you call it like this:
19476
19477 @smallexample
19478 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
19479 @end smallexample
19480
19481 @node Patching
19482 @section Patching Programs
19483
19484 @cindex patching binaries
19485 @cindex writing into executables
19486 @cindex writing into corefiles
19487
19488 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
19489 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
19490 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
19491 patching your program's binary.
19492
19493 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
19494 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
19495 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
19496 repairs.
19497
19498 @table @code
19499 @kindex set write
19500 @item set write on
19501 @itemx set write off
19502 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
19503 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
19504 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
19505
19506 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
19507 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
19508 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
19509
19510 @item show write
19511 @kindex show write
19512 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
19513 as well as reading.
19514 @end table
19515
19516 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
19517 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
19518 @cindex injecting code
19519 @cindex writing into executables
19520 @cindex compiling code
19521
19522 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
19523 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
19524 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
19525 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
19526
19527 @table @code
19528 @kindex compile code
19529 @item compile code @var{source-code}
19530 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
19531 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
19532 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
19533 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
19534 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
19535 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
19536 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
19537 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
19538 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
19539 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
19540 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
19541
19542 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
19543 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
19544 E.g.:
19545
19546 @smallexample
19547 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
19548 @end smallexample
19549
19550 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
19551 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
19552 from actual source code. E.g.:
19553
19554 @smallexample
19555 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
19556 @end smallexample
19557
19558 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
19559 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
19560 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
19561 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
19562 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
19563 editor.
19564
19565 @smallexample
19566 compile code
19567 >printf ("hello\n");
19568 >printf ("world\n");
19569 >end
19570 @end smallexample
19571
19572 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
19573 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
19574 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
19575 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
19576 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
19577 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
19578 inferior symbols otherwise.
19579
19580 @kindex compile file
19581 @item compile file @var{filename}
19582 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
19583 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
19584
19585 @smallexample
19586 compile file /home/user/example.c
19587 @end smallexample
19588 @end table
19589
19590 @table @code
19591 @item compile print [[@var{options}] --] @var{expr}
19592 @itemx compile print [[@var{options}] --] /@var{f} @var{expr}
19593 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
19594 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
19595 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
19596 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
19597 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
19598 Formats}. The @code{compile print} command accepts the same options
19599 as the @code{print} command; see @ref{print options}.
19600
19601 @item compile print [[@var{options}] --]
19602 @itemx compile print [[@var{options}] --] /@var{f}
19603 @cindex reprint the last value
19604 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
19605 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
19606 command without any text following the command. This will start the
19607 multiple-line editor.
19608 @end table
19609
19610 @noindent
19611 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
19612
19613 @table @code
19614 @anchor{set debug compile}
19615 @item set debug compile
19616 @cindex compile command debugging info
19617 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
19618 injecting the code. The default is off.
19619
19620 @item show debug compile
19621 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
19622 compiling and injecting the code.
19623
19624 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
19625 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
19626 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
19627 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
19628 The default is off.
19629
19630 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
19631 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
19632 C@t{++} type conversion.
19633 @end table
19634
19635 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
19636
19637 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
19638 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
19639 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
19640 injecting process.
19641
19642 @noindent
19643 The options used, in increasing precedence:
19644
19645 @table @asis
19646 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
19647 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
19648 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
19649 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
19650
19651 @item compilation options recorded in the target
19652 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
19653 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
19654 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
19655 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
19656 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
19657 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
19658 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
19659
19660 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
19661 @end table
19662
19663 @noindent
19664 You can override compilation options using the following command:
19665
19666 @table @code
19667 @item set compile-args
19668 @cindex compile command options override
19669 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
19670 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
19671 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
19672 compilation.
19673
19674 @item show compile-args
19675 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
19676 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
19677 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
19678 @end table
19679
19680 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
19681
19682 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
19683 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
19684 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
19685
19686 @table @asis
19687 @item C code examples and caveats
19688 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
19689 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
19690 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
19691 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
19692 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
19693
19694 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
19695 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
19696 much like any other normal debugging session.
19697
19698 @smallexample
19699 void function1 (void)
19700 @{
19701 int i = 42;
19702 printf ("function 1\n");
19703 @}
19704
19705 void function2 (void)
19706 @{
19707 int j = 12;
19708 function1 ();
19709 @}
19710
19711 int main(void)
19712 @{
19713 int k = 6;
19714 int *p;
19715 function2 ();
19716 return 0;
19717 @}
19718 @end smallexample
19719
19720 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
19721 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
19722 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
19723
19724 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
19725 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
19726 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
19727 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
19728 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
19729
19730 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
19731 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
19732 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
19733 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
19734 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
19735 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
19736 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
19737 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
19738 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
19739 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
19740
19741 @smallexample
19742 compile code k = 3;
19743 @end smallexample
19744
19745 @noindent
19746 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
19747 something else in the example program changes it, or another
19748 @code{compile} command changes it.
19749
19750 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
19751 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
19752 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
19753 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
19754 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
19755
19756 @smallexample
19757 compile code j = 3;
19758 @end smallexample
19759
19760 @noindent
19761 will result in a compilation error message.
19762
19763 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
19764 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
19765 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
19766
19767 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
19768 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
19769 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
19770 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
19771
19772 @smallexample
19773 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
19774 @end smallexample
19775
19776 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
19777 command has completed:
19778
19779 @smallexample
19780 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
19781 @end smallexample
19782
19783 @noindent
19784 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
19785 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
19786 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
19787 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
19788 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
19789
19790 @smallexample
19791 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
19792 @end smallexample
19793
19794 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
19795 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
19796 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
19797 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
19798 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
19799 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
19800 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
19801 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
19802
19803 @smallexample
19804 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
19805 @end smallexample
19806
19807 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
19808 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
19809 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
19810 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
19811 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
19812 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
19813 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
19814
19815 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
19816 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
19817 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
19818 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
19819 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
19820 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
19821
19822 @smallexample
19823 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
19824 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19825 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
19826 Compilation failed.
19827 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19828 42
19829 @end smallexample
19830
19831 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
19832 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
19833 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
19834 will print to the console.
19835 @end table
19836
19837 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
19838
19839 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
19840 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
19841 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
19842 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
19843 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
19844 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
19845 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
19846 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
19847
19848
19849 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
19850 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
19851 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
19852 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
19853 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
19854 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
19855 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
19856
19857 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
19858 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
19859 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
19860 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
19861 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
19862 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
19863 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
19864
19865 @table @code
19866 @item set compile-gcc
19867 @cindex compile command driver filename override
19868 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
19869 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
19870 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
19871 default.
19872
19873 @item show compile-gcc
19874 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
19875 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
19876 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
19877 @end table
19878
19879 @node GDB Files
19880 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
19881
19882 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
19883 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
19884 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
19885 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
19886
19887 @menu
19888 * Files:: Commands to specify files
19889 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
19890 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
19891 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
19892 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
19893 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
19894 * Data Files:: GDB data files
19895 @end menu
19896
19897 @node Files
19898 @section Commands to Specify Files
19899
19900 @cindex symbol table
19901 @cindex core dump file
19902
19903 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
19904 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
19905 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
19906 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
19907
19908 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
19909 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
19910 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
19911 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
19912 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
19913 new files are useful.
19914
19915 @table @code
19916 @cindex executable file
19917 @kindex file
19918 @item file @var{filename}
19919 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
19920 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
19921 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
19922 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
19923 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
19924 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
19925 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
19926 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
19927
19928 @cindex unlinked object files
19929 @cindex patching object files
19930 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
19931 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
19932 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
19933 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
19934 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
19935 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
19936 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
19937 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
19938
19939 @item file
19940 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19941 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19942
19943 @kindex exec-file
19944 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19945 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19946 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19947 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19948 discard information on the executable file.
19949
19950 @kindex symbol-file
19951 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19952 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19953 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19954 table and program to run from the same file.
19955
19956 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19957 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19958 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19959 enabled.
19960
19961 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19962 program's symbol table.
19963
19964 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19965 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19966 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19967 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19968 @value{GDBN}.
19969
19970 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19971 executing it once.
19972
19973 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19974 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19975 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19976 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19977 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19978 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19979 optimized code.
19980
19981 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19982 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19983 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19984 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19985 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19986
19987 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19988 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19989 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19990 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19991 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19992 Warnings and Messages}.)
19993
19994 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19995 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19996 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19997 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19998 in stabs format.
19999
20000 @kindex readnow
20001 @cindex reading symbols immediately
20002 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
20003 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
20004 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
20005 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
20006 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
20007 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
20008 entire symbol table available.
20009
20010 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
20011 @cindex never read symbols
20012 @cindex symbols, never read
20013 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
20014 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
20015 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
20016 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
20017 @xref{--readnever}.
20018
20019 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
20020 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
20021 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
20022 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
20023 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
20024 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
20025 @c files.
20026
20027 @kindex core-file
20028 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
20029 @itemx core
20030 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
20031 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
20032 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
20033 executable file itself for other parts.
20034
20035 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
20036 to be used.
20037
20038 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
20039 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
20040 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
20041 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
20042 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
20043
20044 @kindex add-symbol-file
20045 @cindex dynamic linking
20046 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
20047 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
20048 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
20049 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
20050 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
20051 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
20052 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
20053 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
20054 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
20055 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
20056 can be given as an expression.
20057
20058 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
20059 address of each section, except those for which the address was
20060 specified explicitly.
20061
20062 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
20063 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
20064 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
20065 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
20066
20067 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
20068
20069 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
20070 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
20071 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
20072 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
20073 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
20074 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
20075 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
20076 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
20077 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
20078
20079 @itemize @bullet
20080 @item
20081 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
20082 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
20083 @item
20084 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
20085 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
20086 @item
20087 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
20088 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20089 @end itemize
20090
20091 @noindent
20092 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
20093 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
20094 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
20095 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
20096 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
20097 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
20098 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
20099 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
20100 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
20101 way.
20102
20103 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
20104
20105 @kindex remove-symbol-file
20106 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
20107 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
20108 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
20109 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
20110 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
20111
20112 @smallexample
20113 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
20114 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
20115 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
20116 (y or n) y
20117 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
20118 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
20119 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
20120 (gdb)
20121 @end smallexample
20122
20123
20124 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
20125
20126 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
20127 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
20128 @cindex load symbols from memory
20129 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
20130 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
20131 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
20132 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
20133 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
20134 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
20135 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
20136 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
20137 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
20138
20139 @kindex section
20140 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
20141 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
20142 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
20143 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
20144 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
20145 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
20146 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
20147 their addresses.
20148
20149 @kindex info files
20150 @kindex info target
20151 @item info files
20152 @itemx info target
20153 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
20154 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
20155 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
20156 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
20157 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
20158 current ones.
20159
20160 @kindex maint info sections
20161 @item maint info sections
20162 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
20163 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
20164 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
20165 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
20166 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
20167 may be arbitrarily combined):
20168
20169 @table @code
20170 @item ALLOBJ
20171 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
20172 @item @var{sections}
20173 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
20174 @item @var{section-flags}
20175 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
20176 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
20177 @table @code
20178 @item ALLOC
20179 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
20180 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
20181 @item LOAD
20182 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
20183 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
20184 @item RELOC
20185 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
20186 @item READONLY
20187 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
20188 @item CODE
20189 Section contains executable code only.
20190 @item DATA
20191 Section contains data only (no executable code).
20192 @item ROM
20193 Section will reside in ROM.
20194 @item CONSTRUCTOR
20195 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
20196 @item HAS_CONTENTS
20197 Section is not empty.
20198 @item NEVER_LOAD
20199 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
20200 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
20201 A notification to the linker that the section contains
20202 COFF shared library information.
20203 @item IS_COMMON
20204 Section contains common symbols.
20205 @end table
20206 @end table
20207 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
20208 @cindex read-only sections
20209 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
20210 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
20211 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
20212 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
20213 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
20214 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
20215 enhancement to debugging performance.
20216
20217 The default is off.
20218
20219 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
20220 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
20221 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
20222 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
20223
20224 @item show trust-readonly-sections
20225 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
20226 @end table
20227
20228 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
20229 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
20230 name and remembers it that way.
20231
20232 @cindex shared libraries
20233 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
20234 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
20235 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
20236 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
20237
20238 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
20239 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
20240
20241 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
20242 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
20243 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
20244 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
20245 debugging a core file).
20246
20247 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
20248 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
20249 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
20250
20251 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
20252 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
20253 particularly large or there are many of them.
20254
20255 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
20256 commands:
20257
20258 @table @code
20259 @kindex set auto-solib-add
20260 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
20261 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
20262 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
20263 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
20264 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
20265 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
20266 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
20267
20268 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
20269 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
20270 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
20271 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
20272 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
20273 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
20274 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
20275 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
20276 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
20277
20278 @kindex show auto-solib-add
20279 @item show auto-solib-add
20280 Display the current autoloading mode.
20281 @end table
20282
20283 @cindex load shared library
20284 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
20285 command:
20286
20287 @table @code
20288 @kindex info sharedlibrary
20289 @kindex info share
20290 @item info share @var{regex}
20291 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
20292 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
20293 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
20294 all shared libraries that are loaded.
20295
20296 @kindex info dll
20297 @item info dll @var{regex}
20298 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
20299
20300 @kindex sharedlibrary
20301 @kindex share
20302 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
20303 @itemx share @var{regex}
20304 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
20305 Unix regular expression.
20306 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
20307 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
20308 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
20309 loaded.
20310
20311 @item nosharedlibrary
20312 @kindex nosharedlibrary
20313 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
20314 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
20315 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
20316 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
20317 discarded.
20318 @end table
20319
20320 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
20321 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
20322 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
20323 Catchpoints}).
20324
20325 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
20326 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
20327 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
20328 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
20329
20330 @table @code
20331 @item set stop-on-solib-events
20332 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
20333 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
20334 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
20335 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
20336 shared library.
20337
20338 @item show stop-on-solib-events
20339 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
20340 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
20341 library events happen.
20342 @end table
20343
20344 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
20345 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
20346 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
20347 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
20348 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
20349 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
20350 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
20351 not.
20352
20353 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
20354 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
20355 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
20356 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
20357 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
20358
20359 @table @code
20360 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
20361 @cindex system root, alternate
20362 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
20363 @kindex set sysroot
20364 @item set sysroot @var{path}
20365 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
20366 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
20367 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
20368 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
20369 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
20370 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
20371 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
20372 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
20373 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
20374 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
20375 @var{path}.
20376
20377 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
20378 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
20379 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
20380 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
20381 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
20382 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
20383 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
20384 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
20385 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
20386 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
20387 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
20388 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
20389 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
20390 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
20391
20392 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
20393 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
20394 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
20395 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
20396 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
20397
20398 @smallexample
20399 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
20400 @end smallexample
20401
20402 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
20403 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
20404 system:
20405
20406 @smallexample
20407 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
20408 @end smallexample
20409
20410 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
20411 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
20412 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
20413 colons:
20414
20415 @smallexample
20416 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
20417 @end smallexample
20418
20419 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
20420 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
20421 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
20422 @samp{z}):
20423
20424 @smallexample
20425 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
20426 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
20427 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
20428 @end smallexample
20429
20430 @noindent
20431 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
20432 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
20433 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
20434
20435 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
20436 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
20437
20438 @smallexample
20439 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
20440 @end smallexample
20441
20442 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
20443 if you don't want or need to.
20444
20445 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
20446 sysroot}.
20447
20448 @cindex default system root
20449 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
20450 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
20451 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
20452 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20453 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
20454 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20455 location.
20456
20457 @kindex show sysroot
20458 @item show sysroot
20459 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
20460
20461 @kindex set solib-search-path
20462 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
20463 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20464 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
20465 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
20466 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
20467 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
20468 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
20469 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
20470 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
20471 of shared library symbols.
20472
20473 @kindex show solib-search-path
20474 @item show solib-search-path
20475 Display the current shared library search path.
20476
20477 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
20478 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
20479 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
20480 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
20481 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
20482
20483 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
20484 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
20485 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
20486 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
20487 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
20488 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
20489 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
20490 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
20491 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
20492 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
20493 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
20494 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
20495 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
20496 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
20497 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
20498 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
20499 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
20500 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
20501 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
20502 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
20503 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
20504 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
20505
20506 @table @code
20507 @item unix
20508 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
20509 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
20510 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
20511 the forward slash.
20512
20513 @item dos-based
20514 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
20515 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
20516 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
20517 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
20518 considered directory separators.
20519
20520 @item auto
20521 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
20522 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
20523 This is the default.
20524 @end table
20525 @end table
20526
20527 @cindex file name canonicalization
20528 @cindex base name differences
20529 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
20530 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
20531 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
20532 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
20533 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
20534 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
20535 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
20536 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
20537 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
20538 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
20539 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
20540 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
20541 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
20542 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
20543 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
20544
20545 @table @code
20546 @item set basenames-may-differ
20547 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
20548 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
20549
20550 @item show basenames-may-differ
20551 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
20552 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
20553 @end table
20554
20555 @node File Caching
20556 @section File Caching
20557 @cindex caching of opened files
20558 @cindex caching of bfd objects
20559
20560 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
20561 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
20562 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
20563 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
20564
20565 @table @code
20566 @kindex maint info bfds
20567 @item maint info bfds
20568 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
20569 @value{GDBN}.
20570
20571 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
20572 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
20573 @kindex bfd caching
20574 @item maint set bfd-sharing
20575 @item maint show bfd-sharing
20576 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
20577 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
20578 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
20579 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
20580 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
20581 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
20582 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
20583
20584 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
20585 @kindex bfd caching
20586 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
20587 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
20588
20589 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
20590 @kindex bfd caching
20591 @item show debug bfd-cache
20592 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
20593 @end table
20594
20595 @node Separate Debug Files
20596 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
20597 @cindex separate debugging information files
20598 @cindex debugging information in separate files
20599 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
20600 @cindex debugging information directory, global
20601 @cindex global debugging information directories
20602 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
20603 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
20604
20605 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
20606 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
20607 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
20608 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
20609 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
20610 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
20611 install only when they need to debug a problem.
20612
20613 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
20614 file:
20615
20616 @itemize @bullet
20617 @item
20618 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
20619 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
20620 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
20621 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
20622 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
20623 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
20624 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
20625 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
20626
20627 @item
20628 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
20629 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
20630 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
20631 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
20632 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
20633 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
20634 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
20635 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
20636 below.
20637 @end itemize
20638
20639 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
20640 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
20641
20642 @itemize @bullet
20643 @item
20644 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
20645 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
20646 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the
20647 global debug directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to
20648 the leading directories of the executable's absolute file name. (On
20649 MS-Windows/MS-DOS, the drive letter of the executable's leading
20650 directories is converted to a one-letter subdirectory, i.e.@:
20651 @file{d:/usr/bin/} is converted to @file{/d/usr/bin/}, because Windows
20652 filesystems disallow colons in file names.)
20653
20654 @item
20655 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
20656 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
20657 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
20658 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
20659 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
20660 hex characters, not 10.)
20661 @end itemize
20662
20663 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
20664 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
20665 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
20666 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
20667 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
20668 debug information files, in the indicated order:
20669
20670 @itemize @minus
20671 @item
20672 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
20673 @item
20674 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
20675 @item
20676 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
20677 @item
20678 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
20679 @end itemize
20680
20681 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
20682 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
20683 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
20684 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
20685 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
20686
20687 @table @code
20688
20689 @kindex set debug-file-directory
20690 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
20691 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
20692 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
20693 concatenating them by a path separator.
20694
20695 @kindex show debug-file-directory
20696 @item show debug-file-directory
20697 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
20698 information files.
20699
20700 @end table
20701
20702 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
20703 @cindex debug link sections
20704 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
20705 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
20706
20707 @itemize
20708 @item
20709 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
20710 a zero byte,
20711 @item
20712 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
20713 boundary within the section, and
20714 @item
20715 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
20716 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
20717 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
20718 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
20719 @end itemize
20720
20721 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
20722 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
20723 described above.
20724
20725 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
20726 @cindex build ID sections
20727 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
20728 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
20729 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
20730 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
20731 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
20732 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
20733 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
20734 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
20735 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
20736
20737 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
20738 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
20739 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
20740 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
20741 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
20742 in an ordinary executable.
20743
20744 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
20745 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
20746 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
20747 following commands:
20748
20749 @smallexample
20750 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
20751 @kbd{strip -g foo}
20752 @end smallexample
20753
20754 @noindent
20755 These commands remove the debugging
20756 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
20757 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
20758 two files:
20759
20760 @itemize @bullet
20761 @item
20762 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
20763 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
20764
20765 @smallexample
20766 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
20767 @end smallexample
20768
20769 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
20770 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
20771 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
20772 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
20773
20774 @item
20775 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
20776 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
20777 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
20778 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
20779 @end itemize
20780
20781 @noindent
20782
20783 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
20784 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
20785 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
20786
20787 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
20788 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
20789 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
20790 @c different ways!
20791 @ifhtml
20792 @display
20793 @html
20794 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
20795 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
20796 @end html
20797 @end display
20798 @end ifhtml
20799 @ifnothtml
20800 @display
20801 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
20802 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
20803 @end display
20804 @end ifnothtml
20805
20806 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
20807 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
20808 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
20809 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
20810 CRC.
20811
20812 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
20813 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
20814 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
20815 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
20816 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
20817
20818 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
20819 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
20820 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
20821 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
20822 @code{0xffffffff}.
20823
20824 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
20825 @smallexample
20826 unsigned long
20827 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
20828 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
20829 @{
20830 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
20831 @{
20832 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
20833 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
20834 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
20835 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
20836 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
20837 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
20838 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
20839 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
20840 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
20841 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
20842 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
20843 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
20844 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
20845 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
20846 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
20847 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
20848 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
20849 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
20850 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
20851 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
20852 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
20853 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
20854 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
20855 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
20856 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
20857 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
20858 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
20859 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
20860 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
20861 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
20862 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
20863 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
20864 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
20865 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
20866 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
20867 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
20868 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
20869 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
20870 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
20871 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
20872 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
20873 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
20874 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
20875 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
20876 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
20877 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
20878 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
20879 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
20880 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
20881 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
20882 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
20883 0x2d02ef8d
20884 @};
20885 unsigned char *end;
20886
20887 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20888 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
20889 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
20890 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20891 @}
20892 @end smallexample
20893
20894 @noindent
20895 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
20896
20897 @node MiniDebugInfo
20898 @section Debugging information in a special section
20899 @cindex separate debug sections
20900 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
20901
20902 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
20903 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
20904 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
20905 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
20906
20907 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
20908 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
20909 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
20910 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
20911 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
20912 debugging information might be included in the section.
20913
20914 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
20915 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
20916 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
20917
20918 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
20919 standard utilities:
20920
20921 @smallexample
20922 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
20923 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
20924 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20925 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
20926
20927 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
20928 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
20929 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
20930 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20931 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
20932 | sort > funcsyms
20933
20934 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
20935 # table.
20936 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
20937
20938 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
20939 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
20940
20941 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
20942 # removing some unnecessary sections.
20943 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
20944 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20945
20946 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20947 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20948
20949 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20950 # original binary.
20951 xz mini_debuginfo
20952 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20953 @end smallexample
20954
20955 @node Index Files
20956 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20957 @cindex index files
20958 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20959
20960 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20961 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20962 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20963 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20964 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20965 startup.
20966
20967 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20968 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20969 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20970
20971 @smallexample
20972 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20973 @end smallexample
20974
20975 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20976
20977 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20978 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20979
20980 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20981 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20982 using @command{objcopy}.
20983
20984 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20985
20986 @table @code
20987 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20988 @kindex save gdb-index
20989 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20990 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20991 default creates it produces a single file
20992 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20993 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20994 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20995 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20996 given @var{directory}.
20997 @end table
20998
20999 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
21000 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
21001
21002 @smallexample
21003 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
21004 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
21005 @end smallexample
21006
21007 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
21008
21009 @smallexample
21010 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
21011 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
21012 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
21013 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
21014 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
21015 @end smallexample
21016
21017 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
21018 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
21019 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
21020 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
21021 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
21022 The default is @code{off}.
21023 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
21024 @xref{Index Section Format}.
21025
21026 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
21027 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
21028
21029 @smallexample
21030 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
21031 @end smallexample
21032
21033 Instead you must do, for example,
21034
21035 @smallexample
21036 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
21037 @end smallexample
21038
21039 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
21040 using DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, only the
21041 @code{-dwarf-5} index works for programs using Ada.
21042
21043 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
21044
21045 @cindex automatic symbol index cache
21046 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
21047 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
21048 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
21049 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
21050
21051 @table @code
21052
21053 @kindex set index-cache
21054 @item set index-cache on
21055 @itemx set index-cache off
21056 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
21057
21058 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
21059 @kindex show index-cache
21060 @itemx show index-cache directory
21061 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
21062
21063 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
21064 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
21065 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
21066 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
21067 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
21068 differ according to local convention.
21069
21070 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
21071 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
21072
21073 @item show index-cache stats
21074 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
21075
21076 @end table
21077
21078 @node Symbol Errors
21079 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
21080
21081 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
21082 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
21083 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
21084 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
21085 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
21086 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
21087 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
21088 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
21089 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
21090 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
21091 Messages}).
21092
21093 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
21094
21095 @table @code
21096 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
21097
21098 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
21099 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
21100 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
21101 in its outer scope blocks.
21102
21103 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
21104 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
21105 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
21106 function.
21107
21108 @item block at @var{address} out of order
21109
21110 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
21111 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
21112 do so.
21113
21114 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
21115 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
21116 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
21117 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
21118 Messages}.)
21119
21120 @item bad block start address patched
21121
21122 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
21123 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
21124 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
21125
21126 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
21127 starting on the previous source line.
21128
21129 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
21130
21131 @cindex foo
21132 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
21133 larger than the size of the string table.
21134
21135 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
21136 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
21137 with this name.
21138
21139 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
21140
21141 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
21142 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
21143 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
21144
21145 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
21146 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
21147 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
21148 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
21149 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
21150 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
21151
21152 @item stub type has NULL name
21153
21154 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
21155
21156 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
21157 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
21158 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
21159 it.
21160
21161 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
21162
21163 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
21164
21165 @end table
21166
21167 @node Data Files
21168 @section GDB Data Files
21169
21170 @cindex prefix for data files
21171 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
21172 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
21173
21174 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
21175 is currently using.
21176
21177 @table @code
21178 @kindex set data-directory
21179 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
21180 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
21181 to @var{directory}.
21182
21183 @kindex show data-directory
21184 @item show data-directory
21185 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
21186 @end table
21187
21188 @cindex default data directory
21189 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
21190 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
21191 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
21192 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
21193 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
21194 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
21195 location.
21196
21197 The data directory may also be specified with the
21198 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
21199 @xref{Mode Options}.
21200
21201 @node Targets
21202 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
21203
21204 @cindex debugging target
21205 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
21206
21207 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
21208 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
21209 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
21210 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
21211 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
21212 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
21213 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
21214 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
21215
21216 @cindex target architecture
21217 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
21218 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
21219 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
21220 command.
21221
21222 @table @code
21223 @kindex set architecture
21224 @kindex show architecture
21225 @item set architecture @var{arch}
21226 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
21227 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
21228 supported architectures.
21229
21230 @item show architecture
21231 Show the current target architecture.
21232
21233 @item set processor
21234 @itemx processor
21235 @kindex set processor
21236 @kindex show processor
21237 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
21238 and @code{show architecture}.
21239 @end table
21240
21241 @menu
21242 * Active Targets:: Active targets
21243 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
21244 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
21245 @end menu
21246
21247 @node Active Targets
21248 @section Active Targets
21249
21250 @cindex stacking targets
21251 @cindex active targets
21252 @cindex multiple targets
21253
21254 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
21255 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
21256 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
21257 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
21258 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
21259 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
21260 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
21261 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
21262 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
21263
21264 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
21265 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
21266 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
21267 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
21268
21269 @node Target Commands
21270 @section Commands for Managing Targets
21271
21272 @table @code
21273 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
21274 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
21275 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
21276 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
21277 protocol of the target machine.
21278
21279 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
21280 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
21281 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
21282
21283 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
21284 after executing the command.
21285
21286 @kindex help target
21287 @item help target
21288 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
21289 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
21290 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
21291
21292 @item help target @var{name}
21293 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
21294 select it.
21295
21296 @kindex set gnutarget
21297 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
21298 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
21299 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
21300 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
21301 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
21302 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
21303
21304 @quotation
21305 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
21306 you must know the actual BFD name.
21307 @end quotation
21308
21309 @noindent
21310 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
21311
21312 @kindex show gnutarget
21313 @item show gnutarget
21314 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
21315 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
21316 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
21317 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
21318 @end table
21319
21320 @cindex common targets
21321 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
21322 configuration):
21323
21324 @table @code
21325 @kindex target
21326 @item target exec @var{program}
21327 @cindex executable file target
21328 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
21329 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
21330
21331 @item target core @var{filename}
21332 @cindex core dump file target
21333 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
21334 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
21335
21336 @item target remote @var{medium}
21337 @cindex remote target
21338 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
21339 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
21340 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
21341
21342 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
21343 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
21344
21345 @smallexample
21346 target remote /dev/ttya
21347 @end smallexample
21348
21349 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
21350 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
21351 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
21352 clobbered by the download.
21353
21354 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21355 @cindex built-in simulator target
21356 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
21357 In general,
21358 @smallexample
21359 target sim
21360 load
21361 run
21362 @end smallexample
21363 @noindent
21364 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
21365 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
21366 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
21367 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
21368 Processors}.
21369
21370 @item target native
21371 @cindex native target
21372 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
21373 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
21374 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
21375 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
21376
21377 @end table
21378
21379 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
21380 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
21381
21382 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
21383 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
21384 various aspects of this process.
21385
21386 @table @code
21387
21388 @item set hash
21389 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
21390 @cindex hash mark while downloading
21391 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
21392 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
21393 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
21394 monitor.
21395
21396 @item show hash
21397 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
21398 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
21399
21400 @item set debug monitor
21401 @kindex set debug monitor
21402 @cindex display remote monitor communications
21403 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
21404 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
21405
21406 @item show debug monitor
21407 @kindex show debug monitor
21408 Show the current status of displaying communications between
21409 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
21410 @end table
21411
21412 @table @code
21413
21414 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
21415 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
21416 @anchor{load}
21417 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
21418 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
21419 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
21420 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
21421 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
21422 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
21423
21424 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
21425 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
21426 target is @dots{}}''
21427
21428 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
21429 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
21430 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
21431 specifies a fixed address.
21432 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
21433
21434 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
21435 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
21436 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
21437
21438 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
21439 load programs into flash memory.
21440
21441 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
21442 @end table
21443
21444 @table @code
21445
21446 @kindex flash-erase
21447 @item flash-erase
21448 @anchor{flash-erase}
21449
21450 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
21451
21452 @end table
21453
21454 @node Byte Order
21455 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
21456
21457 @cindex choosing target byte order
21458 @cindex target byte order
21459
21460 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
21461 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
21462 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
21463 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
21464 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
21465 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
21466
21467 @table @code
21468 @kindex set endian
21469 @item set endian big
21470 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
21471
21472 @item set endian little
21473 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
21474
21475 @item set endian auto
21476 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
21477 executable.
21478
21479 @item show endian
21480 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
21481
21482 @end table
21483
21484 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
21485 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
21486 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
21487 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
21488 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
21489 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
21490 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
21491 and @code{big} otherwise.
21492
21493 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
21494 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
21495 target system.
21496
21497
21498 @node Remote Debugging
21499 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
21500 @cindex remote debugging
21501
21502 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
21503 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
21504 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
21505 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
21506 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
21507
21508 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
21509 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
21510 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
21511 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
21512 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
21513 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
21514
21515 Other remote targets may be available in your
21516 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
21517
21518 @menu
21519 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
21520 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
21521 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
21522 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
21523 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
21524 @end menu
21525
21526 @node Connecting
21527 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
21528 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
21529 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
21530 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
21531 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
21532 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
21533 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
21534
21535 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
21536 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
21537 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
21538 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
21539
21540 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
21541
21542 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
21543 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
21544 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
21545 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
21546
21547 @table @asis
21548
21549 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
21550 @item Result of detach or program exit
21551 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
21552 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
21553 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
21554
21555 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
21556 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
21557 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
21558 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
21559
21560 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
21561 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
21562 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
21563 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
21564
21565 @item Specifying the program to debug
21566 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
21567 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
21568 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
21569 target.
21570
21571 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
21572 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
21573 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
21574
21575 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
21576 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
21577 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
21578 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
21579
21580 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
21581 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
21582 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
21583 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
21584 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
21585 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
21586 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
21587 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
21588 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
21589
21590 @item The @code{run} command
21591 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
21592 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
21593 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
21594 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
21595 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
21596
21597 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
21598 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
21599 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
21600 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
21601 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
21602
21603 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
21604 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
21605 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
21606 @code{target remote} mode.
21607
21608 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
21609 @item Attaching
21610 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
21611 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
21612 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
21613
21614 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
21615 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
21616 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
21617 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
21618 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
21619
21620 @end table
21621
21622 @anchor{Host and target files}
21623 @subsection Host and Target Files
21624 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
21625 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
21626
21627 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
21628 information for your program running on the target. This requires
21629 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
21630 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
21631 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
21632
21633 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
21634 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
21635 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
21636 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
21637 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
21638
21639 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
21640 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
21641 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
21642 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
21643 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
21644 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
21645 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
21646 target libraries.
21647
21648 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
21649 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
21650 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
21651 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
21652 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
21653 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
21654 programs.
21655
21656 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
21657 @cindex remote connection commands
21658 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, a
21659 local Unix domain socket, or
21660 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
21661 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
21662 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
21663 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
21664 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
21665 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
21666
21667 @table @code
21668
21669 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
21670 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
21671 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
21672 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
21673 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
21674
21675 @smallexample
21676 target remote /dev/ttyb
21677 @end smallexample
21678
21679 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
21680 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
21681 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
21682 @code{target} command.
21683
21684 @item target remote @var{local-socket}
21685 @itemx target extended-remote @var{local-socket}
21686 @cindex local socket, @code{target remote}
21687 @cindex Unix domain socket
21688 Use @var{local-socket} to communicate with the target. For example,
21689 to use a local Unix domain socket bound to the file system entry @file{/tmp/gdb-socket0}:
21690
21691 @smallexample
21692 target remote /tmp/gdb-socket0
21693 @end smallexample
21694
21695 Note that this command has the same form as the command to connect
21696 to a serial line. @value{GDBN} will automatically determine which
21697 kind of file you have specified and will make the appropriate kind
21698 of connection.
21699 This feature is not available if the host system does not support
21700 Unix domain sockets.
21701
21702 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
21703 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21704 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21705 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21706 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21707 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21708 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21709 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
21710 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21711 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21712 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21713 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21714 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21715 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21716 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
21717 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
21718 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
21719 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
21720 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
21721 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
21722 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
21723 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
21724
21725 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
21726 @code{manyfarms}:
21727
21728 @smallexample
21729 target remote manyfarms:2828
21730 @end smallexample
21731
21732 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
21733 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
21734 square bracket syntax:
21735
21736 @smallexample
21737 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
21738 @end smallexample
21739
21740 @noindent
21741 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
21742
21743 @smallexample
21744 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
21745 @end smallexample
21746
21747 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
21748 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
21749 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
21750 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
21751 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
21752 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
21753
21754 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
21755 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
21756 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
21757 port 1234 on your local machine:
21758
21759 @smallexample
21760 target remote :1234
21761 @end smallexample
21762 @noindent
21763
21764 Note that the colon is still required here.
21765
21766 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21767 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21768 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21769 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21770 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21771 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21772 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21773 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21774 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21775 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21776 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
21777 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
21778 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
21779
21780 @smallexample
21781 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
21782 @end smallexample
21783
21784 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
21785 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
21786 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
21787 cause havoc with your debugging session.
21788
21789 @item target remote | @var{command}
21790 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
21791 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
21792 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
21793 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
21794 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
21795 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
21796 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
21797 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
21798 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
21799
21800 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
21801 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
21802 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
21803
21804 @end table
21805
21806 @cindex interrupting remote programs
21807 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
21808 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
21809 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
21810 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
21811 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
21812 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
21813
21814 @smallexample
21815 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
21816 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
21817 @end smallexample
21818
21819 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
21820 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
21821 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
21822 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
21823
21824 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
21825 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
21826
21827 @table @code
21828 @kindex detach (remote)
21829 @item detach
21830 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
21831 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
21832 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
21833 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
21834 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
21835 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
21836 still connected to the target.
21837
21838 @kindex disconnect
21839 @item disconnect
21840 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
21841 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
21842 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
21843 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
21844 another target.
21845
21846 @cindex send command to remote monitor
21847 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
21848 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
21849 @kindex monitor
21850 @item monitor @var{cmd}
21851 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
21852 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
21853 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
21854 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
21855 and implement.
21856 @end table
21857
21858 @node File Transfer
21859 @section Sending files to a remote system
21860 @cindex remote target, file transfer
21861 @cindex file transfer
21862 @cindex sending files to remote systems
21863
21864 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
21865 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
21866 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
21867 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
21868 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
21869 the only way to upload or download files.
21870
21871 Not all remote targets support these commands.
21872
21873 @table @code
21874 @kindex remote put
21875 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21876 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21877 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21878
21879 @kindex remote get
21880 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21881 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21882 on the host system.
21883
21884 @kindex remote delete
21885 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
21886 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21887
21888 @end table
21889
21890 @node Server
21891 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
21892
21893 @kindex gdbserver
21894 @cindex remote connection without stubs
21895 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
21896 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
21897 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
21898 linking in the usual debugging stub.
21899
21900 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
21901 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
21902 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
21903 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
21904 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
21905 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
21906 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
21907 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
21908 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
21909 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
21910 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
21911 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
21912 choice for debugging.
21913
21914 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
21915 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
21916 protocol.
21917
21918 @quotation
21919 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
21920 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
21921 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
21922 target system with the same privileges as the user running
21923 @code{gdbserver}.
21924 @end quotation
21925
21926 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
21927 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
21928 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
21929 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
21930
21931 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
21932 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
21933 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
21934 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
21935 system does all the symbol handling.
21936
21937 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
21938 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
21939 syntax is:
21940
21941 @smallexample
21942 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
21943 @end smallexample
21944
21945 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
21946 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
21947 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
21948 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
21949 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
21950 @file{/dev/com1}:
21951
21952 @smallexample
21953 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
21954 @end smallexample
21955
21956 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
21957 with it.
21958
21959 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
21960
21961 @smallexample
21962 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
21963 @end smallexample
21964
21965 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
21966 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
21967 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
21968 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
21969 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
21970 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
21971 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
21972 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
21973 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
21974 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
21975 @code{target remote} command.
21976
21977 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
21978 with ssh:
21979
21980 @smallexample
21981 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
21982 @end smallexample
21983
21984 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
21985 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
21986 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
21987 You could elide it if you want to.
21988
21989 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
21990 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
21991 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
21992 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
21993
21994 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
21995 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
21996 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
21997 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
21998
21999 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
22000 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
22001
22002 @smallexample
22003 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
22004 @end smallexample
22005
22006 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
22007 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
22008
22009 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
22010 @value{GDBN} attach command
22011 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
22012
22013 @pindex pidof
22014 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
22015 @code{pidof} utility:
22016
22017 @smallexample
22018 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
22019 @end smallexample
22020
22021 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
22022 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
22023 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
22024
22025 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
22026
22027 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
22028 port.
22029
22030 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
22031 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
22032 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
22033 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
22034 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
22035 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
22036 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
22037 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
22038
22039 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
22040 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
22041 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
22042
22043 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
22044 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
22045 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
22046 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
22047 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
22048 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
22049 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
22050 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
22051 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
22052 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
22053 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
22054 instance closes its port after the first connection.
22055
22056 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
22057 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
22058
22059 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
22060 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
22061 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
22062 program. For more information,
22063 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
22064
22065 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
22066 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
22067 status information about the debugging process.
22068 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
22069 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
22070 remote protocol debug output.
22071 @cindex @option{--debug-file}, @code{gdbserver} option
22072 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, send all debug output to a single file
22073 The @option{--debug-file=@var{filename}} option tells @code{gdbserver} to
22074 write any debug output to the given @var{filename}. These options are intended
22075 for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
22076
22077 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
22078 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
22079 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
22080 Possible options are:
22081
22082 @table @code
22083 @item none
22084 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
22085 @item all
22086 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
22087 @item timestamps
22088 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
22089 @end table
22090
22091 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
22092 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
22093
22094 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
22095 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
22096 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
22097 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
22098 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
22099
22100 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
22101 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
22102 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
22103 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
22104
22105 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
22106 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
22107 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
22108 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
22109
22110 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
22111 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
22112 environment:
22113
22114 @smallexample
22115 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
22116 @end smallexample
22117
22118 @cindex @option{--selftest}
22119 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
22120
22121 @smallexample
22122 $ gdbserver --selftest
22123 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
22124 @end smallexample
22125
22126 These tests are disabled in release.
22127 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
22128
22129 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
22130 @itemize
22131
22132 @item
22133 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
22134
22135 @item
22136 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
22137 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
22138 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
22139 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
22140 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
22141 @code{--with-sysroot}).
22142
22143 @item
22144 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22145 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
22146 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
22147 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
22148 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
22149 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
22150 program is already on the target.
22151
22152 @end itemize
22153
22154 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
22155 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
22156 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
22157
22158 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
22159 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
22160 Here are the available commands.
22161
22162 @table @code
22163 @item monitor help
22164 List the available monitor commands.
22165
22166 @item monitor set debug 0
22167 @itemx monitor set debug 1
22168 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
22169
22170 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
22171 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
22172 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
22173 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
22174
22175 @item monitor set debug-file filename
22176 @itemx monitor set debug-file
22177 Send any debug output to the given file, or to stderr.
22178
22179 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
22180 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
22181 Possible options are:
22182
22183 @table @code
22184 @item none
22185 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
22186 @item all
22187 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
22188 @item timestamps
22189 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
22190 @end table
22191
22192 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
22193 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
22194
22195 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
22196 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
22197 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
22198 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
22199 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
22200 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
22201
22202 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
22203 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
22204
22205 @item monitor exit
22206 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
22207 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
22208 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
22209 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
22210 of a multi-process mode debug session.
22211
22212 @end table
22213
22214 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
22215 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
22216
22217 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
22218 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
22219
22220 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
22221 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
22222 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
22223 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
22224 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
22225 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
22226 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
22227 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
22228 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
22229 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
22230 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
22231 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
22232
22233 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
22234
22235 @table @code
22236 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
22237
22238 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
22239 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
22240 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
22241
22242 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
22243
22244 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
22245 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
22246 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
22247 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
22248 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
22249 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
22250
22251 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
22252
22253 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
22254 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
22255 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
22256 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
22257 command for that. For example:
22258
22259 @smallexample
22260 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
22261 @end smallexample
22262
22263 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
22264 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
22265 @end table
22266
22267 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
22268 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
22269 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
22270 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
22271 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
22272 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
22273 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
22274 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
22275 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
22276 @code{gdbserver} like so:
22277
22278 @smallexample
22279 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
22280 @end smallexample
22281
22282 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
22283
22284 @smallexample
22285 $ gdb myprogram
22286 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
22287 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
22288 (@value{GDBP}) b main
22289 (@value{GDBP}) continue
22290 @end smallexample
22291
22292 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
22293 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
22294 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
22295 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
22296 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
22297 tracing.
22298
22299 @node Remote Configuration
22300 @section Remote Configuration
22301
22302 @kindex set remote
22303 @kindex show remote
22304 This section documents the configuration options available when
22305 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
22306 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
22307 system-call-allowed}.
22308
22309 @table @code
22310 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
22311 @cindex address size for remote targets
22312 @cindex bits in remote address
22313 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
22314 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
22315 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
22316 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
22317
22318 @item show remoteaddresssize
22319 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
22320
22321 @item set serial baud @var{n}
22322 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
22323 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
22324 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
22325 remote targets.
22326
22327 @item show serial baud
22328 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
22329
22330 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
22331 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
22332 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
22333
22334 @item show serial parity
22335 Show the current parity of the serial port.
22336
22337 @item set remotebreak
22338 @cindex interrupt remote programs
22339 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
22340 @anchor{set remotebreak}
22341 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
22342 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
22343 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
22344 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
22345 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
22346
22347 @item show remotebreak
22348 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
22349 interrupt the remote program.
22350
22351 @item set remoteflow on
22352 @itemx set remoteflow off
22353 @kindex set remoteflow
22354 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
22355 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
22356
22357 @item show remoteflow
22358 @kindex show remoteflow
22359 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
22360
22361 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
22362 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
22363 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
22364 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
22365 @code{ascii}.
22366
22367 @item show remotelogbase
22368 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
22369 protocol.
22370
22371 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
22372 @cindex record serial communications on file
22373 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
22374 default is not to record at all.
22375
22376 @item show remotelogfile
22377 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
22378 serial communications.
22379
22380 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
22381 @cindex timeout for serial communications
22382 @cindex remote timeout
22383 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
22384 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
22385
22386 @item show remotetimeout
22387 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
22388 responses.
22389
22390 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
22391 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
22392 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
22393 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
22394 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
22395 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
22396 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
22397 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
22398 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
22399 watchpoints or breakpoints.
22400
22401 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
22402 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
22403 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
22404 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
22405
22406 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
22407 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
22408 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
22409 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
22410 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
22411 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
22412 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
22413 length.
22414
22415 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
22416 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
22417 a remote hardware watchpoint.
22418
22419 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
22420 @itemx show remote exec-file
22421 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
22422 @cindex executable file, for remote target
22423 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
22424 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
22425 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
22426 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
22427
22428 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
22429 @cindex interrupt remote programs
22430 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
22431 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
22432 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
22433 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
22434 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
22435 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
22436 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
22437 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
22438
22439 @item show interrupt-sequence
22440 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
22441 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
22442 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
22443 also known as Magic SysRq g.
22444
22445 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
22446 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
22447 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
22448 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
22449 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
22450 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
22451
22452 @item show interrupt-on-connect
22453 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
22454 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
22455
22456 @kindex set tcp
22457 @kindex show tcp
22458 @item set tcp auto-retry on
22459 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
22460 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
22461 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
22462 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
22463 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
22464 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
22465 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
22466 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
22467
22468 @item set tcp auto-retry off
22469 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
22470
22471 @item show tcp auto-retry
22472 Show the current auto-retry setting.
22473
22474 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
22475 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
22476 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
22477 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
22478 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
22479 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
22480 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
22481 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
22482 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
22483 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
22484 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
22485
22486 @item show tcp connect-timeout
22487 Show the current connection timeout setting.
22488 @end table
22489
22490 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
22491 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
22492 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
22493 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
22494 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
22495 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
22496 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
22497 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
22498 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
22499
22500 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
22501 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
22502 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
22503 @value{GDBN} developers.
22504
22505 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
22506 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
22507 are:
22508
22509 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
22510 @item Command Name
22511 @tab Remote Packet
22512 @tab Related Features
22513
22514 @item @code{fetch-register}
22515 @tab @code{p}
22516 @tab @code{info registers}
22517
22518 @item @code{set-register}
22519 @tab @code{P}
22520 @tab @code{set}
22521
22522 @item @code{binary-download}
22523 @tab @code{X}
22524 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
22525
22526 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
22527 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
22528 @tab @code{info auxv}
22529
22530 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
22531 @tab @code{qSymbol}
22532 @tab Detecting multiple threads
22533
22534 @item @code{attach}
22535 @tab @code{vAttach}
22536 @tab @code{attach}
22537
22538 @item @code{verbose-resume}
22539 @tab @code{vCont}
22540 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
22541
22542 @item @code{run}
22543 @tab @code{vRun}
22544 @tab @code{run}
22545
22546 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
22547 @tab @code{Z0}
22548 @tab @code{break}
22549
22550 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
22551 @tab @code{Z1}
22552 @tab @code{hbreak}
22553
22554 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
22555 @tab @code{Z2}
22556 @tab @code{watch}
22557
22558 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
22559 @tab @code{Z3}
22560 @tab @code{rwatch}
22561
22562 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
22563 @tab @code{Z4}
22564 @tab @code{awatch}
22565
22566 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
22567 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
22568 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
22569
22570 @item @code{target-features}
22571 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
22572 @tab @code{set architecture}
22573
22574 @item @code{library-info}
22575 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
22576 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
22577
22578 @item @code{memory-map}
22579 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
22580 @tab @code{info mem}
22581
22582 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
22583 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
22584 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
22585
22586 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
22587 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
22588 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
22589
22590 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
22591 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
22592 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
22593
22594 @item @code{threads}
22595 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
22596 @tab @code{info threads}
22597
22598 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
22599 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
22600 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
22601
22602 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
22603 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
22604 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
22605
22606 @item @code{search-memory}
22607 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
22608 @tab @code{find}
22609
22610 @item @code{supported-packets}
22611 @tab @code{qSupported}
22612 @tab Remote communications parameters
22613
22614 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
22615 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
22616 @tab @code{catch syscall}
22617
22618 @item @code{pass-signals}
22619 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
22620 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
22621
22622 @item @code{program-signals}
22623 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
22624 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
22625
22626 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
22627 @tab @code{vFile:close}
22628 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
22629
22630 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
22631 @tab @code{vFile:open}
22632 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
22633
22634 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
22635 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
22636 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
22637
22638 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
22639 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
22640 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
22641
22642 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
22643 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
22644 @tab @code{remote delete}
22645
22646 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
22647 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
22648 @tab Host I/O
22649
22650 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
22651 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
22652 @tab Host I/O
22653
22654 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
22655 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
22656 @tab Host I/O
22657
22658 @item @code{noack-packet}
22659 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
22660 @tab Packet acknowledgment
22661
22662 @item @code{osdata}
22663 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
22664 @tab @code{info os}
22665
22666 @item @code{query-attached}
22667 @tab @code{qAttached}
22668 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
22669
22670 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
22671 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
22672 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
22673
22674 @item @code{trace-status}
22675 @tab @code{qTStatus}
22676 @tab @code{tstatus}
22677
22678 @item @code{traceframe-info}
22679 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
22680 @tab Traceframe info
22681
22682 @item @code{install-in-trace}
22683 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
22684 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
22685
22686 @item @code{disable-randomization}
22687 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
22688 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
22689
22690 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
22691 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
22692 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
22693
22694 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
22695 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
22696 @tab @code{set environment}
22697
22698 @item @code{environment-unset}
22699 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
22700 @tab @code{unset environment}
22701
22702 @item @code{environment-reset}
22703 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
22704 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
22705
22706 @item @code{set-working-dir}
22707 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
22708 @tab @code{set cwd}
22709
22710 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
22711 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
22712 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
22713
22714 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
22715 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
22716 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
22717
22718 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
22719 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
22720 @tab @code{break}
22721
22722 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
22723 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
22724 @tab @code{hbreak}
22725
22726 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
22727 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
22728 @tab @code{fork}
22729
22730 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
22731 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
22732 @tab @code{vfork}
22733
22734 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
22735 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
22736 @tab @code{exec}
22737
22738 @item @code{thread-events}
22739 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
22740 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
22741
22742 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
22743 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
22744 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
22745
22746 @end multitable
22747
22748 @node Remote Stub
22749 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
22750
22751 @cindex debugging stub, example
22752 @cindex remote stub, example
22753 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
22754 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
22755 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
22756 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
22757 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
22758 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
22759 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
22760 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
22761
22762 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
22763 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
22764 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
22765 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
22766 program, you need:
22767
22768 @enumerate
22769 @item
22770 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
22771 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
22772 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
22773
22774 @item
22775 A C subroutine library to support your program's
22776 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
22777
22778 @item
22779 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
22780 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
22781 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
22782 documentation.
22783 @end enumerate
22784
22785 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
22786 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
22787 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
22788
22789 @table @emph
22790 @item On the host,
22791 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
22792 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
22793 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
22794
22795 @item On the target,
22796 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
22797 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
22798 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
22799
22800 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
22801 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
22802 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
22803 @end table
22804
22805 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
22806 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
22807 @sc{sparc} boards.
22808
22809 @cindex remote serial stub list
22810 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
22811
22812 @table @code
22813
22814 @item i386-stub.c
22815 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
22816 @cindex Intel
22817 @cindex i386
22818 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
22819
22820 @item m68k-stub.c
22821 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
22822 @cindex Motorola 680x0
22823 @cindex m680x0
22824 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
22825
22826 @item sh-stub.c
22827 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
22828 @cindex Renesas
22829 @cindex SH
22830 For Renesas SH architectures.
22831
22832 @item sparc-stub.c
22833 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
22834 @cindex Sparc
22835 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
22836
22837 @item sparcl-stub.c
22838 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
22839 @cindex Fujitsu
22840 @cindex SparcLite
22841 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
22842
22843 @end table
22844
22845 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
22846 recently added stubs.
22847
22848 @menu
22849 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
22850 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
22851 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
22852 @end menu
22853
22854 @node Stub Contents
22855 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
22856
22857 @cindex remote serial stub
22858 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
22859 subroutines:
22860
22861 @table @code
22862 @item set_debug_traps
22863 @findex set_debug_traps
22864 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
22865 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
22866 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
22867 program's startup code.
22868
22869 @item handle_exception
22870 @findex handle_exception
22871 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
22872 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
22873 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
22874 run when a trap is triggered.
22875
22876 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
22877 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
22878 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
22879 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
22880 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
22881 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
22882 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
22883 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
22884 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
22885 machine.
22886
22887 @item breakpoint
22888 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
22889 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
22890 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
22891 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
22892 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
22893 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
22894 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
22895 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
22896 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
22897 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
22898 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
22899
22900 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
22901 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
22902 start of your debugging session.
22903 @end table
22904
22905 @node Bootstrapping
22906 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
22907
22908 @cindex remote stub, support routines
22909 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
22910 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
22911 debugging target machine.
22912
22913 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
22914 serial port.
22915
22916 @table @code
22917 @item int getDebugChar()
22918 @findex getDebugChar
22919 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
22920 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
22921 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22922
22923 @item void putDebugChar(int)
22924 @findex putDebugChar
22925 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
22926 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
22927 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22928 @end table
22929
22930 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
22931 @cindex interrupting remote targets
22932 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
22933 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
22934 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
22935 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
22936 remote system to stop.
22937
22938 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
22939 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
22940 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
22941 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
22942
22943 Other routines you need to supply are:
22944
22945 @table @code
22946 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
22947 @findex exceptionHandler
22948 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
22949 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
22950 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
22951 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
22952 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
22953 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
22954 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
22955 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
22956 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
22957 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
22958 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
22959 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
22960 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
22961
22962 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
22963 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
22964 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
22965 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
22966 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
22967
22968 @item void flush_i_cache()
22969 @findex flush_i_cache
22970 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
22971 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
22972 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
22973
22974 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
22975 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
22976 @end table
22977
22978 @noindent
22979 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
22980
22981 @table @code
22982 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
22983 @findex memset
22984 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
22985 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
22986 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
22987 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
22988 @end table
22989
22990 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
22991 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
22992 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
22993 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
22994
22995
22996 @node Debug Session
22997 @subsection Putting it All Together
22998
22999 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
23000 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
23001 steps.
23002
23003 @enumerate
23004 @item
23005 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
23006 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
23007 @display
23008 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
23009 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
23010 @end display
23011
23012 @item
23013 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
23014 procedure is called:
23015
23016 @smallexample
23017 set_debug_traps();
23018 breakpoint();
23019 @end smallexample
23020
23021 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
23022 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
23023 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
23024 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
23025 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
23026 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
23027 progress.
23028
23029 @item
23030 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
23031 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
23032
23033 @smallexample
23034 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
23035 @end smallexample
23036
23037 @noindent
23038 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
23039 function in your program, that function is called when
23040 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
23041 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
23042 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
23043
23044 @item
23045 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
23046 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
23047
23048 @item
23049 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
23050 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
23051
23052 @item
23053 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
23054 @c document that. FIXME.
23055 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
23056 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
23057
23058 @item
23059 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
23060 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
23061
23062 @end enumerate
23063
23064 @node Configurations
23065 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
23066
23067 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
23068 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
23069 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
23070
23071 There are three major categories of configurations: native
23072 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
23073 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
23074 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
23075 are quite different from each other.
23076
23077 @menu
23078 * Native::
23079 * Embedded OS::
23080 * Embedded Processors::
23081 * Architectures::
23082 @end menu
23083
23084 @node Native
23085 @section Native
23086
23087 This section describes details specific to particular native
23088 configurations.
23089
23090 @menu
23091 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
23092 * Process Information:: Process information
23093 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
23094 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
23095 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
23096 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
23097 * FreeBSD:: Features specific to FreeBSD
23098 @end menu
23099
23100 @node BSD libkvm Interface
23101 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
23102
23103 @cindex libkvm
23104 @cindex kernel memory image
23105 @cindex kernel crash dump
23106
23107 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
23108 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
23109 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
23110 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
23111 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
23112 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
23113 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
23114 @code{kvm} target:
23115
23116 @smallexample
23117 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
23118 @end smallexample
23119
23120 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
23121 argument:
23122
23123 @smallexample
23124 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
23125 @end smallexample
23126
23127 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
23128 available:
23129
23130 @table @code
23131 @kindex kvm
23132 @item kvm pcb
23133 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
23134
23135 @item kvm proc
23136 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
23137 modern FreeBSD systems.
23138 @end table
23139
23140 @node Process Information
23141 @subsection Process Information
23142 @cindex /proc
23143 @cindex examine process image
23144 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
23145
23146 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
23147 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
23148 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
23149 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
23150 to report information about the process running your program, or about
23151 any process running on your system.
23152
23153 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
23154 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
23155 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
23156 systems.
23157
23158 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
23159 information.
23160
23161 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
23162 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
23163 information available from a live process. Process information is
23164 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
23165 systems.
23166
23167 @table @code
23168 @kindex info proc
23169 @cindex process ID
23170 @item info proc
23171 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
23172 Summarize available information about a process. If a
23173 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
23174 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
23175 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
23176 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
23177 executable file's absolute file name.
23178
23179 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
23180 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
23181 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
23182 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
23183 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
23184 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
23185
23186 @item info proc cmdline
23187 @cindex info proc cmdline
23188 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
23189 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
23190
23191 @item info proc cwd
23192 @cindex info proc cwd
23193 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
23194 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
23195
23196 @item info proc exe
23197 @cindex info proc exe
23198 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
23199 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
23200
23201 @item info proc files
23202 @cindex info proc files
23203 Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file
23204 descriptor, @value{GDBN} shows its number, type (file, directory,
23205 character device, socket), file pointer offset, and the name of the
23206 resource open on the descriptor. The resource name can be a file name
23207 (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed by socket
23208 address (for network connections). This command is supported on
23209 FreeBSD.
23210
23211 This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a
23212 tty for standard input and output as well as two network sockets:
23213
23214 @smallexample
23215 (gdb) info proc files 22136
23216 process 22136
23217 Open files:
23218
23219 FD Type Offset Flags Name
23220 text file - r-------- /usr/bin/ssh
23221 ctty chr - rw------- /dev/pts/20
23222 cwd dir - r-------- /usr/home/john
23223 root dir - r-------- /
23224 0 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
23225 1 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
23226 2 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
23227 3 socket 0x0 rw----n-- tcp4 10.0.1.2:53014 -> 10.0.1.10:22
23228 4 socket 0x0 rw------- unix stream:/tmp/ssh-FIt89oAzOn5f/agent.2456
23229 @end smallexample
23230
23231 @item info proc mappings
23232 @cindex memory address space mappings
23233 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in a process. On
23234 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
23235 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
23236 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
23237 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
23238
23239 @item info proc stat
23240 @itemx info proc status
23241 @cindex process detailed status information
23242 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
23243 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
23244 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
23245 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
23246 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
23247
23248 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
23249 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
23250
23251 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
23252 proc status}.
23253
23254 @item info proc all
23255 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
23256 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
23257
23258 @ignore
23259 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
23260 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
23261 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
23262 @kindex info proc times
23263 @item info proc times
23264 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
23265 its children.
23266
23267 @kindex info proc id
23268 @item info proc id
23269 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
23270 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
23271 @end ignore
23272
23273 @item set procfs-trace
23274 @kindex set procfs-trace
23275 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
23276 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
23277
23278 @item show procfs-trace
23279 @kindex show procfs-trace
23280 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
23281
23282 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
23283 @kindex set procfs-file
23284 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
23285 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
23286 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
23287 standard output.
23288
23289 @item show procfs-file
23290 @kindex show procfs-file
23291 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
23292
23293 @item proc-trace-entry
23294 @itemx proc-trace-exit
23295 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
23296 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
23297 @kindex proc-trace-entry
23298 @kindex proc-trace-exit
23299 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
23300 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
23301 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
23302 from the @code{syscall} interface.
23303
23304 @item info pidlist
23305 @kindex info pidlist
23306 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
23307 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
23308 processes and all the threads within each process.
23309
23310 @item info meminfo
23311 @kindex info meminfo
23312 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
23313 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
23314 @end table
23315
23316 @node DJGPP Native
23317 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
23318 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
23319 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
23320 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
23321
23322 @cindex DPMI
23323 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
23324 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
23325 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
23326 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
23327
23328 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
23329 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
23330 subsection describes those commands.
23331
23332 @table @code
23333 @kindex info dos
23334 @item info dos
23335 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
23336 information about the target system and important OS structures.
23337
23338 @kindex sysinfo
23339 @cindex MS-DOS system info
23340 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
23341 @item info dos sysinfo
23342 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
23343 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
23344 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
23345
23346 @cindex GDT
23347 @cindex LDT
23348 @cindex IDT
23349 @cindex segment descriptor tables
23350 @cindex descriptor tables display
23351 @item info dos gdt
23352 @itemx info dos ldt
23353 @itemx info dos idt
23354 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
23355 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
23356 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
23357 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
23358 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
23359 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
23360 rights.
23361
23362 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
23363 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
23364 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
23365 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
23366 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
23367
23368 @cindex garbled pointers
23369 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
23370 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
23371 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
23372 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
23373 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
23374 debugged program's data segment:
23375
23376 @smallexample
23377 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
23378 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
23379 @end smallexample
23380
23381 @noindent
23382 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
23383 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
23384
23385 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
23386 @item info dos pde
23387 @itemx info dos pte
23388 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
23389 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
23390 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
23391 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
23392 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
23393 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
23394 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
23395 that is currently in use.
23396
23397 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
23398 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
23399 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
23400 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
23401 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
23402 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
23403 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
23404
23405 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
23406 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
23407 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
23408 controller.
23409
23410 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
23411
23412 @cindex physical address from linear address
23413 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
23414 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
23415 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
23416 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
23417 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
23418 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
23419 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
23420
23421 @smallexample
23422 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
23423 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
23424 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
23425 @end smallexample
23426
23427 @noindent
23428 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
23429 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
23430 attributes of that page.
23431
23432 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
23433 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
23434 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
23435 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
23436 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
23437 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
23438
23439 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
23440 transfer buffer:
23441
23442 @smallexample
23443 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
23444 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
23445 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
23446 @end smallexample
23447
23448 @noindent
23449 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
23450 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
23451 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
23452 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
23453 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
23454
23455 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
23456 @end table
23457
23458 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
23459 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
23460 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
23461 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
23462
23463 @table @code
23464 @kindex set com1base
23465 @kindex set com1irq
23466 @kindex set com2base
23467 @kindex set com2irq
23468 @kindex set com3base
23469 @kindex set com3irq
23470 @kindex set com4base
23471 @kindex set com4irq
23472 @item set com1base @var{addr}
23473 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
23474 port.
23475
23476 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
23477 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
23478 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
23479
23480 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
23481 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
23482 other 3 COM ports.
23483
23484 @kindex show com1base
23485 @kindex show com1irq
23486 @kindex show com2base
23487 @kindex show com2irq
23488 @kindex show com3base
23489 @kindex show com3irq
23490 @kindex show com4base
23491 @kindex show com4irq
23492 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
23493 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
23494 lines used by the COM ports.
23495
23496 @item info serial
23497 @kindex info serial
23498 @cindex DOS serial port status
23499 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
23500 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
23501 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
23502 counts of various errors encountered so far.
23503 @end table
23504
23505
23506 @node Cygwin Native
23507 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
23508 @cindex MS Windows debugging
23509 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
23510 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
23511
23512 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
23513 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
23514
23515 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
23516 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
23517 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
23518 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
23519 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
23520 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
23521 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
23522 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
23523
23524 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
23525 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
23526 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
23527
23528 @table @code
23529 @kindex info w32
23530 @item info w32
23531 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
23532 information about the target system and important OS structures.
23533
23534 @item info w32 selector
23535 This command displays information returned by
23536 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
23537 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
23538 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
23539 Without argument, this command displays information
23540 about the six segment registers.
23541
23542 @item info w32 thread-information-block
23543 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
23544 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
23545 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
23546
23547 @kindex signal-event
23548 @item signal-event @var{id}
23549 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
23550 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
23551
23552 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
23553 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
23554 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
23555 (for x86_64 versions):
23556
23557 @itemize @minus
23558 @item
23559 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
23560 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
23561 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
23562
23563 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
23564 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
23565 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
23566 to attach.
23567
23568 @item
23569 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
23570 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
23571 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
23572 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
23573 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
23574 @end itemize
23575
23576 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
23577 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
23578 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
23579 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
23580 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
23581 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
23582 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
23583 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
23584 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
23585 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
23586 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
23587
23588 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
23589 @item show cygwin-exceptions
23590 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
23591 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
23592
23593 @kindex set new-console
23594 @item set new-console @var{mode}
23595 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
23596 be started in a new console on next start.
23597 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
23598 be started in the same console as the debugger.
23599
23600 @kindex show new-console
23601 @item show new-console
23602 Displays whether a new console is used
23603 when the debuggee is started.
23604
23605 @kindex set new-group
23606 @item set new-group @var{mode}
23607 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
23608 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
23609 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
23610 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
23611
23612 @kindex show new-group
23613 @item show new-group
23614 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
23615
23616 @kindex set debugevents
23617 @item set debugevents
23618 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
23619 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
23620 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
23621 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
23622 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
23623
23624 @kindex set debugexec
23625 @item set debugexec
23626 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
23627 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
23628
23629 @kindex set debugexceptions
23630 @item set debugexceptions
23631 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
23632 debuggee seen by the debugger.
23633
23634 @kindex set debugmemory
23635 @item set debugmemory
23636 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
23637 and writes by the debugger.
23638
23639 @kindex set shell
23640 @item set shell
23641 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
23642 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
23643
23644 @kindex show shell
23645 @item show shell
23646 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
23647
23648 @end table
23649
23650 @menu
23651 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
23652 @end menu
23653
23654 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
23655 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
23656 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
23657 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
23658
23659 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
23660 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
23661 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
23662 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
23663 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
23664 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
23665 ``minimal symbols''.
23666
23667 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
23668 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
23669 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
23670 program run once to completion.
23671
23672 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
23673
23674 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
23675 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
23676 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
23677 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
23678 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
23679 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
23680 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
23681 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
23682 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
23683
23684 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
23685 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
23686 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
23687 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
23688 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
23689 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
23690
23691 @smallexample
23692 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
23693 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
23694
23695 Non-debugging symbols:
23696 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
23697 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
23698 @end smallexample
23699
23700 @smallexample
23701 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
23702 All functions matching regular expression "!":
23703
23704 Non-debugging symbols:
23705 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
23706 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
23707 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
23708 [etc...]
23709 @end smallexample
23710
23711 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
23712
23713 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
23714 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
23715 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
23716 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
23717 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
23718 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
23719 a function within a DLL without a running program.
23720
23721 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
23722 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
23723 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
23724 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
23725 problem:
23726
23727 @smallexample
23728 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
23729 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
23730 @end smallexample
23731
23732 @smallexample
23733 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
23734 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
23735 @end smallexample
23736
23737 And two possible solutions:
23738
23739 @smallexample
23740 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
23741 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
23742 @end smallexample
23743
23744 @smallexample
23745 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
23746 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
23747 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
23748 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
23749 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
23750 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
23751 @end smallexample
23752
23753 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
23754 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
23755 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
23756 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
23757 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
23758
23759 @smallexample
23760 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
23761 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
23762 @end smallexample
23763
23764 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
23765 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
23766 safe.
23767
23768 @node Hurd Native
23769 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
23770 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
23771
23772 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
23773 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
23774
23775 @table @code
23776 @item set signals
23777 @itemx set sigs
23778 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
23779 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23780 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
23781 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
23782 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
23783 @code{signals}.
23784
23785 @item show signals
23786 @itemx show sigs
23787 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
23788 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23789 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
23790
23791 @item set signal-thread
23792 @itemx set sigthread
23793 @kindex set signal-thread
23794 @kindex set sigthread
23795 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
23796 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
23797 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
23798 signal-thread}.
23799
23800 @item show signal-thread
23801 @itemx show sigthread
23802 @kindex show signal-thread
23803 @kindex show sigthread
23804 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
23805 delivered a signal.
23806
23807 @item set stopped
23808 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23809 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
23810 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
23811 continued by delivering a signal to it.
23812
23813 @item show stopped
23814 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23815 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
23816 stopped.
23817
23818 @item set exceptions
23819 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23820 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
23821 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
23822 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
23823 trapping on.
23824
23825 @item show exceptions
23826 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23827 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
23828
23829 @item set task pause
23830 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
23831 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23832 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23833 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
23834 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
23835 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
23836 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
23837 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
23838 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
23839
23840 @item show task pause
23841 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
23842 Show the current state of task suspension.
23843
23844 @item set task detach-suspend-count
23845 @cindex task suspend count
23846 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23847 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
23848 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
23849
23850 @item show task detach-suspend-count
23851 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
23852
23853 @item set task exception-port
23854 @itemx set task excp
23855 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23856 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
23857 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
23858 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
23859
23860 @item set noninvasive
23861 @cindex noninvasive task options
23862 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
23863 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
23864 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
23865 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
23866
23867 @item info send-rights
23868 @itemx info receive-rights
23869 @itemx info port-rights
23870 @itemx info port-sets
23871 @itemx info dead-names
23872 @itemx info ports
23873 @itemx info psets
23874 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23875 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23876 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23877 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23878 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23879 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
23880 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
23881 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
23882 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
23883
23884 @item set thread pause
23885 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
23886 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23887 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23888 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
23889 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
23890 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
23891 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
23892 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
23893 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
23894 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
23895 only the current thread.
23896
23897 @item show thread pause
23898 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
23899 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
23900
23901 @item set thread run
23902 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23903
23904 @item show thread run
23905 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23906
23907 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
23908 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23909 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23910 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
23911 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
23912 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
23913 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
23914
23915 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
23916 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
23917 detaching.
23918
23919 @item set thread exception-port
23920 @itemx set thread excp
23921 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
23922 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
23923 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
23924
23925 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
23926 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
23927 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
23928 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
23929
23930 @item set thread default
23931 @itemx show thread default
23932 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23933 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
23934 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
23935 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
23936 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
23937 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
23938 the non-default commands.
23939 @end table
23940
23941 @node Darwin
23942 @subsection Darwin
23943 @cindex Darwin
23944
23945 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
23946
23947 @table @code
23948 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
23949 @kindex set debug darwin
23950 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
23951 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
23952
23953 @item show debug darwin
23954 @kindex show debug darwin
23955 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
23956
23957 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
23958 @kindex set debug mach-o
23959 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
23960 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
23961 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
23962 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
23963 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
23964 usage.
23965
23966 @item show debug mach-o
23967 @kindex show debug mach-o
23968 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
23969
23970 @item set mach-exceptions on
23971 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
23972 @kindex set mach-exceptions
23973 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
23974 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
23975 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
23976 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
23977
23978 @item show mach-exceptions
23979 @kindex show mach-exceptions
23980 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
23981 @end table
23982
23983 @node FreeBSD
23984 @subsection FreeBSD
23985 @cindex FreeBSD
23986
23987 When the ABI of a system call is changed in the FreeBSD kernel, this
23988 is implemented by leaving a compatibility system call using the old
23989 ABI at the existing number and allocating a new system call number for
23990 the version using the new ABI. As a convenience, when a system call
23991 is caught by name (@pxref{catch syscall}), compatibility system calls
23992 are also caught.
23993
23994 For example, FreeBSD 12 introduced a new variant of the @code{kevent}
23995 system call and catching the @code{kevent} system call by name catches
23996 both variants:
23997
23998 @smallexample
23999 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall kevent
24000 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'freebsd11_kevent' [363] 'kevent' [560])
24001 (@value{GDBP})
24002 @end smallexample
24003
24004
24005 @node Embedded OS
24006 @section Embedded Operating Systems
24007
24008 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
24009 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
24010 architectures.
24011
24012 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
24013 various real-time operating systems.
24014
24015 @node Embedded Processors
24016 @section Embedded Processors
24017
24018 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
24019 configurations.
24020
24021 @cindex send command to simulator
24022 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
24023 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
24024
24025 @table @code
24026 @item sim @var{command}
24027 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
24028 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
24029 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
24030 acceptable commands.
24031 @end table
24032
24033
24034 @menu
24035 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
24036 * ARM:: ARM
24037 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
24038 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
24039 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
24040 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
24041 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
24042 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
24043 * CRIS:: CRIS
24044 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
24045 @end menu
24046
24047 @node ARC
24048 @subsection Synopsys ARC
24049 @cindex Synopsys ARC
24050 @cindex ARC specific commands
24051 @cindex ARC600
24052 @cindex ARC700
24053 @cindex ARC EM
24054 @cindex ARC HS
24055
24056 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
24057
24058 @table @code
24059 @item set debug arc
24060 @kindex set debug arc
24061 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
24062 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
24063
24064 @item show debug arc
24065 @kindex show debug arc
24066 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
24067
24068 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
24069 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
24070 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
24071
24072 @end table
24073
24074 @node ARM
24075 @subsection ARM
24076
24077 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
24078
24079 @table @code
24080 @item set arm disassembler
24081 @kindex set arm
24082 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
24083 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
24084
24085 @item show arm disassembler
24086 @kindex show arm
24087 Show the current disassembly style.
24088
24089 @item set arm apcs32
24090 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
24091 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
24092
24093 @item show arm apcs32
24094 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
24095
24096 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
24097 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
24098 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
24099
24100 @table @code
24101 @item auto
24102 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
24103 @item softfpa
24104 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
24105 processors.
24106 @item fpa
24107 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
24108 @item softvfp
24109 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
24110 @item vfp
24111 VFP co-processor.
24112 @end table
24113
24114 @item show arm fpu
24115 Show the current type of the FPU.
24116
24117 @item set arm abi
24118 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
24119
24120 @item show arm abi
24121 Show the currently used ABI.
24122
24123 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
24124 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
24125 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
24126 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
24127 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
24128 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
24129 register).
24130
24131 @item show arm fallback-mode
24132 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
24133
24134 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
24135 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
24136 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
24137 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
24138 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
24139
24140 @item show arm force-mode
24141 Show the current forced instruction mode.
24142
24143 @item set debug arm
24144 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
24145 target support subsystem.
24146
24147 @item show debug arm
24148 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
24149 @end table
24150
24151 @table @code
24152 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
24153 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
24154
24155 @table @code
24156 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
24157 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
24158 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
24159 The default value is @code{all}.
24160
24161 @table @code
24162 @item none
24163 @item demon
24164 @item angel
24165 @item redboot
24166 @item all
24167 @end table
24168 @end table
24169 @end table
24170
24171 @node M68K
24172 @subsection M68k
24173
24174 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
24175
24176 @node MicroBlaze
24177 @subsection MicroBlaze
24178 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
24179 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
24180
24181 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
24182 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
24183 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
24184 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
24185 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
24186 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
24187 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
24188 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
24189 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
24190 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
24191 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
24192
24193 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
24194
24195 @table @code
24196 @item target remote :1234
24197 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
24198 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
24199
24200 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
24201 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
24202 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
24203
24204 @item load
24205 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
24206
24207 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
24208 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
24209
24210 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
24211 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
24212 @end table
24213
24214 @node MIPS Embedded
24215 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
24216
24217 @noindent
24218 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
24219
24220 @table @code
24221 @item set mipsfpu double
24222 @itemx set mipsfpu single
24223 @itemx set mipsfpu none
24224 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
24225 @itemx show mipsfpu
24226 @kindex set mipsfpu
24227 @kindex show mipsfpu
24228 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
24229 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
24230 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
24231 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
24232 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
24233 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
24234 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
24235 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
24236 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
24237 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
24238 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
24239 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
24240 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
24241
24242 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
24243 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
24244 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
24245
24246 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
24247 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
24248 @end table
24249
24250 @node OpenRISC 1000
24251 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
24252 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
24253
24254 @noindent
24255 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
24256 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
24257 FPGA's.
24258
24259 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
24260 a target:
24261
24262 @table @code
24263
24264 @kindex target sim
24265 @item target sim
24266
24267 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
24268 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
24269 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
24270 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
24271
24272 Example: @code{target sim}
24273
24274 @item set debug or1k
24275 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
24276 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
24277
24278 @item show debug or1k
24279 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
24280 @end table
24281
24282 @node PowerPC Embedded
24283 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
24284
24285 @cindex DVC register
24286 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
24287 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
24288
24289 @smallexample
24290 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
24291 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
24292 @end smallexample
24293
24294 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
24295 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
24296 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
24297 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
24298 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
24299 or newer.
24300
24301 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
24302 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
24303 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
24304 watching variables of scalar types.
24305
24306 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
24307 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
24308
24309 @smallexample
24310 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
24311 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
24312 @end smallexample
24313
24314 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
24315 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
24316
24317 @cindex ranged breakpoint
24318 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
24319 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
24320 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
24321 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
24322 use the @code{break-range} command.
24323
24324 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
24325
24326 @table @code
24327 @kindex break-range
24328 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
24329 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
24330 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
24331 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
24332 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
24333 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
24334 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
24335 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
24336 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
24337
24338 @kindex set powerpc
24339 @item set powerpc soft-float
24340 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
24341 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
24342 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
24343 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
24344
24345 @item set powerpc vector-abi
24346 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
24347 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
24348 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
24349 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
24350 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
24351 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
24352 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
24353
24354 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
24355 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
24356 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
24357 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
24358 address of its first byte.
24359
24360 @end table
24361
24362 @node AVR
24363 @subsection Atmel AVR
24364 @cindex AVR
24365
24366 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
24367 following AVR-specific commands:
24368
24369 @table @code
24370 @item info io_registers
24371 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
24372 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
24373 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
24374 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
24375 @end table
24376
24377 @node CRIS
24378 @subsection CRIS
24379 @cindex CRIS
24380
24381 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
24382 following CRIS-specific commands:
24383
24384 @table @code
24385 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
24386 @cindex CRIS version
24387 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
24388 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
24389 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
24390
24391 @item show cris-version
24392 Show the current CRIS version.
24393
24394 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
24395 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
24396 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
24397 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
24398 @code{R59}.
24399
24400 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
24401 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
24402
24403 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
24404 @cindex CRIS mode
24405 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
24406 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
24407 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
24408
24409 @item show cris-mode
24410 Show the current CRIS mode.
24411 @end table
24412
24413 @node Super-H
24414 @subsection Renesas Super-H
24415 @cindex Super-H
24416
24417 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
24418 commands:
24419
24420 @table @code
24421 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
24422 @kindex set sh calling-convention
24423 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
24424 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
24425 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
24426 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
24427 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
24428 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
24429 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
24430 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
24431 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
24432 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
24433
24434 @item show sh calling-convention
24435 @kindex show sh calling-convention
24436 Show the current calling convention setting.
24437
24438 @end table
24439
24440
24441 @node Architectures
24442 @section Architectures
24443
24444 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
24445 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
24446
24447 @menu
24448 * AArch64::
24449 * i386::
24450 * Alpha::
24451 * MIPS::
24452 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
24453 * PowerPC::
24454 * Nios II::
24455 * Sparc64::
24456 * S12Z::
24457 @end menu
24458
24459 @node AArch64
24460 @subsection AArch64
24461 @cindex AArch64 support
24462
24463 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
24464 following special commands:
24465
24466 @table @code
24467 @item set debug aarch64
24468 @kindex set debug aarch64
24469 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
24470 messages are to be displayed.
24471
24472 @item show debug aarch64
24473 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
24474
24475 @end table
24476
24477 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
24478 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
24479
24480 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
24481 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
24482 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
24483 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
24484 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
24485 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
24486
24487 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
24488 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
24489 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
24490 target process.
24491
24492 @subsubsection AArch64 Pointer Authentication.
24493 @cindex AArch64 Pointer Authentication.
24494
24495 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, and the program is
24496 using the v8.3-A feature Pointer Authentication (PAC), then whenever the link
24497 register @code{$lr} is pointing to an PAC function its value will be masked.
24498 When GDB prints a backtrace, any addresses that required unmasking will be
24499 postfixed with the marker [PAC]. When using the MI, this is printed as part
24500 of the @code{addr_flags} field.
24501
24502 @node i386
24503 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
24504
24505 @table @code
24506 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
24507 @kindex set struct-convention
24508 @cindex struct return convention
24509 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
24510 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
24511 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
24512 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
24513 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
24514 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
24515 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
24516 be returned in a register.
24517
24518 @item show struct-convention
24519 @kindex show struct-convention
24520 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
24521 from functions.
24522 @end table
24523
24524
24525 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
24526 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
24527
24528 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
24529 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
24530 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
24531 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
24532 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
24533 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
24534 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
24535
24536 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
24537 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
24538 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
24539 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
24540 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
24541 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
24542
24543 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
24544 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
24545 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
24546
24547 @smallexample
24548 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
24549 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
24550 @end smallexample
24551
24552 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
24553 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
24554 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
24555 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
24556 the pointer.
24557
24558 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
24559 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
24560 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
24561 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
24562 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
24563
24564 @table @code
24565 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
24566 @kindex show mpx bound
24567 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
24568
24569 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
24570 @kindex set mpx bound
24571 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
24572 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
24573 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
24574 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
24575 @end table
24576
24577 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
24578 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
24579 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
24580 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
24581
24582 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
24583 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
24584 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
24585 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
24586 function.
24587
24588 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
24589 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
24590 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
24591 continuing the execution. For example:
24592
24593 @smallexample
24594 $ break *upper
24595 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
24596 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
24597 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
24598 $ print $bnd0
24599 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
24600 @end smallexample
24601
24602 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
24603 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
24604 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
24605
24606 @node Alpha
24607 @subsection Alpha
24608
24609 See the following section.
24610
24611 @node MIPS
24612 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
24613
24614 @cindex stack on Alpha
24615 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
24616 @cindex Alpha stack
24617 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
24618 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
24619 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
24620 find the beginning of a function.
24621
24622 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
24623 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
24624 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
24625 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
24626 commands:
24627
24628 @table @code
24629 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
24630 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
24631 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
24632 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
24633 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
24634 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
24635 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
24636 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
24637
24638 @item show heuristic-fence-post
24639 Display the current limit.
24640 @end table
24641
24642 @noindent
24643 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
24644 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
24645
24646 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
24647 programs:
24648
24649 @table @code
24650 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
24651 @kindex set mips abi
24652 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
24653 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
24654 values of @var{arg} are:
24655
24656 @table @samp
24657 @item auto
24658 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
24659 default).
24660 @item o32
24661 @item o64
24662 @item n32
24663 @item n64
24664 @item eabi32
24665 @item eabi64
24666 @end table
24667
24668 @item show mips abi
24669 @kindex show mips abi
24670 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
24671
24672 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
24673 @kindex set mips compression
24674 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
24675 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
24676 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
24677 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
24678 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
24679 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
24680 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
24681 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
24682 provided by the executable.
24683
24684 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
24685 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
24686 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
24687 identified as such.
24688
24689 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
24690 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
24691 implicitly from an executable.
24692
24693 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
24694 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
24695 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
24696 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
24697 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
24698
24699 @item show mips compression
24700 @kindex show mips compression
24701 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
24702 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
24703
24704 @item set mipsfpu
24705 @itemx show mipsfpu
24706 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
24707
24708 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
24709 @kindex set mips mask-address
24710 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
24711 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
24712 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
24713 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
24714 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
24715
24716 @item show mips mask-address
24717 @kindex show mips mask-address
24718 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
24719 not.
24720
24721 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
24722 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
24723 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
24724 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
24725 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
24726 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
24727
24728 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
24729 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
24730 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
24731
24732 @item set debug mips
24733 @kindex set debug mips
24734 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
24735 target code in @value{GDBN}.
24736
24737 @item show debug mips
24738 @kindex show debug mips
24739 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
24740 @end table
24741
24742
24743 @node HPPA
24744 @subsection HPPA
24745 @cindex HPPA support
24746
24747 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
24748 following special commands:
24749
24750 @table @code
24751 @item set debug hppa
24752 @kindex set debug hppa
24753 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
24754 messages are to be displayed.
24755
24756 @item show debug hppa
24757 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
24758
24759 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
24760 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
24761 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
24762 given @var{address}.
24763
24764 @end table
24765
24766
24767 @node PowerPC
24768 @subsection PowerPC
24769 @cindex PowerPC architecture
24770
24771 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
24772 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
24773 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
24774 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
24775 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
24776
24777 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
24778 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
24779 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
24780
24781 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
24782 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
24783
24784 @node Nios II
24785 @subsection Nios II
24786 @cindex Nios II architecture
24787
24788 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
24789 it provides the following special commands:
24790
24791 @table @code
24792
24793 @item set debug nios2
24794 @kindex set debug nios2
24795 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
24796 target code in @value{GDBN}.
24797
24798 @item show debug nios2
24799 @kindex show debug nios2
24800 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
24801 @end table
24802
24803 @node Sparc64
24804 @subsection Sparc64
24805 @cindex Sparc64 support
24806 @cindex Application Data Integrity
24807 @subsubsection ADI Support
24808
24809 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
24810 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
24811 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
24812 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
24813 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
24814 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
24815 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
24816 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
24817 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
24818 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
24819 signal.
24820
24821 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
24822 ADI-enabled.
24823
24824 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
24825 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
24826
24827
24828 @table @code
24829 @kindex adi examine
24830 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
24831
24832 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
24833 cacheline.
24834
24835 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
24836 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
24837 block size, to display.
24838
24839 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24840 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
24841
24842 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
24843
24844 @smallexample
24845 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24846 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
24847 @end smallexample
24848
24849 @kindex adi assign
24850 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
24851
24852 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
24853 to an address.
24854
24855 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
24856 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
24857 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
24858
24859 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24860 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
24861
24862 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
24863
24864 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
24865 variable "shmaddr":
24866
24867 @smallexample
24868 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
24869 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24870 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
24871 @end smallexample
24872
24873 @end table
24874
24875 @node S12Z
24876 @subsection S12Z
24877 @cindex S12Z support
24878
24879 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the S12Z architecture,
24880 it provides the following special command:
24881
24882 @table @code
24883 @item maint info bdccsr
24884 @kindex maint info bdccsr@r{, S12Z}
24885 This command displays the current value of the microprocessor's
24886 BDCCSR register.
24887 @end table
24888
24889
24890 @node Controlling GDB
24891 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
24892
24893 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
24894 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
24895 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
24896 described here.
24897
24898 @menu
24899 * Prompt:: Prompt
24900 * Editing:: Command editing
24901 * Command History:: Command history
24902 * Screen Size:: Screen size
24903 * Output Styling:: Output styling
24904 * Numbers:: Numbers
24905 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
24906 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
24907 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
24908 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
24909 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
24910 @end menu
24911
24912 @node Prompt
24913 @section Prompt
24914
24915 @cindex prompt
24916
24917 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
24918 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
24919 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
24920 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
24921 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
24922 which one you are talking to.
24923
24924 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
24925 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
24926 or a prompt that does not.
24927
24928 @table @code
24929 @kindex set prompt
24930 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
24931 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
24932
24933 @kindex show prompt
24934 @item show prompt
24935 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
24936 @end table
24937
24938 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
24939 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
24940 are:
24941
24942 @table @code
24943 @kindex set extended-prompt
24944 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
24945 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
24946 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
24947 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
24948 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
24949 is displayed.
24950
24951 For example:
24952
24953 @smallexample
24954 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
24955 @end smallexample
24956
24957 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
24958 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
24959
24960 @kindex show extended-prompt
24961 @item show extended-prompt
24962 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
24963 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
24964 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
24965 @end table
24966
24967 @node Editing
24968 @section Command Editing
24969 @cindex readline
24970 @cindex command line editing
24971
24972 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
24973 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
24974 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
24975 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
24976 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
24977 debugging sessions.
24978
24979 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
24980 command @code{set}.
24981
24982 @table @code
24983 @kindex set editing
24984 @cindex editing
24985 @item set editing
24986 @itemx set editing on
24987 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
24988
24989 @item set editing off
24990 Disable command line editing.
24991
24992 @kindex show editing
24993 @item show editing
24994 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
24995 @end table
24996
24997 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24998 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
24999 @end ifset
25000 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25001 @xref{Command Line Editing},
25002 @end ifclear
25003 for more details about the Readline
25004 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
25005 encouraged to read that chapter.
25006
25007 @cindex Readline application name
25008 @value{GDBN} sets the Readline application name to @samp{gdb}. This
25009 is useful for conditions in @file{.inputrc}.
25010
25011 @node Command History
25012 @section Command History
25013 @cindex command history
25014
25015 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
25016 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
25017 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
25018 history facility.
25019
25020 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
25021 package, to provide the history facility.
25022 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25023 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
25024 @end ifset
25025 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25026 @xref{Using History Interactively},
25027 @end ifclear
25028 for the detailed description of the History library.
25029
25030 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
25031 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
25032 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
25033 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
25034 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
25035 pressed on a line by itself.
25036
25037 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
25038 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
25039 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
25040 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
25041
25042 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
25043 history.
25044
25045 @table @code
25046 @cindex history substitution
25047 @cindex history file
25048 @kindex set history filename
25049 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
25050 @item set history filename @var{fname}
25051 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
25052 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
25053 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
25054 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
25055 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
25056 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
25057 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
25058 is not set.
25059
25060 @cindex save command history
25061 @kindex set history save
25062 @item set history save
25063 @itemx set history save on
25064 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
25065 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
25066
25067 @item set history save off
25068 Stop recording command history in a file.
25069
25070 @cindex history size
25071 @kindex set history size
25072 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
25073 @item set history size @var{size}
25074 @itemx set history size unlimited
25075 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
25076 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
25077 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
25078 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
25079 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
25080 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
25081
25082 @cindex remove duplicate history
25083 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
25084 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
25085 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
25086 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
25087 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
25088 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
25089 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
25090 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
25091 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
25092
25093 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
25094 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
25095
25096 @end table
25097
25098 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
25099 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25100 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
25101 @end ifset
25102 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25103 @xref{Event Designators},
25104 @end ifclear
25105 for more details.
25106
25107 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
25108 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
25109 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
25110 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
25111 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
25112 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
25113 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
25114 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
25115
25116 The commands to control history expansion are:
25117
25118 @table @code
25119 @item set history expansion on
25120 @itemx set history expansion
25121 @kindex set history expansion
25122 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
25123
25124 @item set history expansion off
25125 Disable history expansion.
25126
25127 @c @group
25128 @kindex show history
25129 @item show history
25130 @itemx show history filename
25131 @itemx show history save
25132 @itemx show history size
25133 @itemx show history expansion
25134 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
25135 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
25136 @c @end group
25137 @end table
25138
25139 @table @code
25140 @kindex show commands
25141 @cindex show last commands
25142 @cindex display command history
25143 @item show commands
25144 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
25145
25146 @item show commands @var{n}
25147 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
25148
25149 @item show commands +
25150 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
25151 @end table
25152
25153 @node Screen Size
25154 @section Screen Size
25155 @cindex size of screen
25156 @cindex screen size
25157 @cindex pagination
25158 @cindex page size
25159 @cindex pauses in output
25160
25161 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
25162 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
25163 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
25164 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
25165 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
25166 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
25167 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
25168 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
25169 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
25170 following line.
25171
25172 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
25173 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
25174 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
25175 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
25176 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
25177 width} commands:
25178
25179 @table @code
25180 @kindex set height
25181 @kindex set width
25182 @kindex show width
25183 @kindex show height
25184 @item set height @var{lpp}
25185 @itemx set height unlimited
25186 @itemx show height
25187 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
25188 @itemx set width unlimited
25189 @itemx show width
25190 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
25191 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
25192 commands display the current settings.
25193
25194 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
25195 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
25196 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
25197 buffer.
25198
25199 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
25200 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
25201
25202 @item set pagination on
25203 @itemx set pagination off
25204 @kindex set pagination
25205 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
25206 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
25207 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
25208 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
25209
25210 @item show pagination
25211 @kindex show pagination
25212 Show the current pagination mode.
25213 @end table
25214
25215 @node Output Styling
25216 @section Output Styling
25217 @cindex styling
25218 @cindex colors
25219
25220 @kindex set style
25221 @kindex show style
25222 @value{GDBN} can style its output on a capable terminal. This is
25223 enabled by default on most systems, but disabled by default when in
25224 batch mode (@pxref{Mode Options}). Various style settings are available;
25225 and styles can also be disabled entirely.
25226
25227 @table @code
25228 @item set style enabled @samp{on|off}
25229 Enable or disable all styling. The default is host-dependent, with
25230 most hosts defaulting to @samp{on}.
25231
25232 @item show style enabled
25233 Show the current state of styling.
25234
25235 @item set style sources @samp{on|off}
25236 Enable or disable source code styling. This affects whether source
25237 code, such as the output of the @code{list} command, is styled. Note
25238 that source styling only works if styling in general is enabled, and
25239 if @value{GDBN} was linked with the GNU Source Highlight library. The
25240 default is @samp{on}.
25241
25242 @item show style sources
25243 Show the current state of source code styling.
25244 @end table
25245
25246 Subcommands of @code{set style} control specific forms of styling.
25247 These subcommands all follow the same pattern: each style-able object
25248 can be styled with a foreground color, a background color, and an
25249 intensity.
25250
25251 For example, the style of file names can be controlled using the
25252 @code{set style filename} group of commands:
25253
25254 @table @code
25255 @item set style filename background @var{color}
25256 Set the background to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
25257 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
25258 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
25259 and@samp{white}.
25260
25261 @item set style filename foreground @var{color}
25262 Set the foreground to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
25263 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
25264 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
25265 and@samp{white}.
25266
25267 @item set style filename intensity @var{value}
25268 Set the intensity to @var{value}. Valid intensities are @samp{normal}
25269 (the default), @samp{bold}, and @samp{dim}.
25270 @end table
25271
25272 The @code{show style} command and its subcommands are styling
25273 a style name in their output using its own style.
25274 So, use @command{show style} to see the complete list of styles,
25275 their characteristics and the visual aspect of each style.
25276
25277 The style-able objects are:
25278 @table @code
25279 @item filename
25280 Control the styling of file names. By default, this style's
25281 foreground color is green.
25282
25283 @item function
25284 Control the styling of function names. These are managed with the
25285 @code{set style function} family of commands. By default, this
25286 style's foreground color is yellow.
25287
25288 @item variable
25289 Control the styling of variable names. These are managed with the
25290 @code{set style variable} family of commands. By default, this style's
25291 foreground color is cyan.
25292
25293 @item address
25294 Control the styling of addresses. These are managed with the
25295 @code{set style address} family of commands. By default, this style's
25296 foreground color is blue.
25297
25298 @item title
25299 Control the styling of titles. These are managed with the
25300 @code{set style title} family of commands. By default, this style's
25301 intensity is bold. Commands are using the title style to improve
25302 the readibility of large output. For example, the commands
25303 @command{apropos} and @command{help} are using the title style
25304 for the command names.
25305
25306 @item highlight
25307 Control the styling of highlightings. These are managed with the
25308 @code{set style highlight} family of commands. By default, this style's
25309 foreground color is red. Commands are using the highlight style to draw
25310 the user attention to some specific parts of their output. For example,
25311 the command @command{apropos -v REGEXP} uses the highlight style to
25312 mark the documentation parts matching @var{regexp}.
25313
25314 @end table
25315
25316 @node Numbers
25317 @section Numbers
25318 @cindex number representation
25319 @cindex entering numbers
25320
25321 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
25322 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
25323 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
25324 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
25325 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
25326 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
25327 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
25328 both input and output with the commands described below.
25329
25330 @table @code
25331 @kindex set input-radix
25332 @item set input-radix @var{base}
25333 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
25334 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
25335 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
25336 example, any of
25337
25338 @smallexample
25339 set input-radix 012
25340 set input-radix 10.
25341 set input-radix 0xa
25342 @end smallexample
25343
25344 @noindent
25345 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
25346 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
25347 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
25348 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
25349 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
25350 change the radix.
25351
25352 @kindex set output-radix
25353 @item set output-radix @var{base}
25354 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
25355 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
25356 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
25357
25358 @kindex show input-radix
25359 @item show input-radix
25360 Display the current default base for numeric input.
25361
25362 @kindex show output-radix
25363 @item show output-radix
25364 Display the current default base for numeric display.
25365
25366 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
25367 @itemx show radix
25368 @kindex set radix
25369 @kindex show radix
25370 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
25371 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
25372 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
25373 default value of 10.
25374
25375 @end table
25376
25377 @node ABI
25378 @section Configuring the Current ABI
25379
25380 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
25381 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
25382 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
25383 current ABI.
25384
25385 @cindex OS ABI
25386 @kindex set osabi
25387 @kindex show osabi
25388 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
25389
25390 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
25391 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
25392 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
25393 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
25394 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
25395 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
25396 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
25397 platform provides.
25398
25399 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
25400 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
25401 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
25402 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
25403
25404 @table @code
25405 @item show osabi
25406 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
25407
25408 @item set osabi
25409 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
25410
25411 @item set osabi @var{abi}
25412 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
25413 @end table
25414
25415 @cindex float promotion
25416
25417 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
25418 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
25419 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
25420 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
25421 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
25422 @code{double} and then passed.
25423
25424 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
25425 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
25426 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
25427
25428 @table @code
25429 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
25430 @item set coerce-float-to-double
25431 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
25432 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
25433 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
25434
25435 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
25436 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
25437 functions.
25438
25439 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
25440 @item show coerce-float-to-double
25441 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
25442 @end table
25443
25444 @kindex set cp-abi
25445 @kindex show cp-abi
25446 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
25447 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
25448 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
25449 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
25450 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
25451 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
25452 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
25453 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
25454 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
25455 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
25456 ``auto''.
25457
25458 @table @code
25459 @item show cp-abi
25460 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
25461
25462 @item set cp-abi
25463 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
25464
25465 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
25466 @itemx set cp-abi auto
25467 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
25468 @end table
25469
25470 @node Auto-loading
25471 @section Automatically loading associated files
25472 @cindex auto-loading
25473
25474 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
25475 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
25476 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
25477 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
25478 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
25479 sources).
25480
25481 @menu
25482 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
25483 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
25484
25485 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
25486 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
25487 @end menu
25488
25489 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
25490 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
25491 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
25492
25493 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
25494 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
25495 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25496
25497 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
25498 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
25499
25500 @table @code
25501 @anchor{set auto-load off}
25502 @kindex set auto-load off
25503 @item set auto-load off
25504 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
25505 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
25506 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
25507 @smallexample
25508 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
25509 @end smallexample
25510
25511 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
25512 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
25513 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
25514 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
25515 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
25516 @code{set auto-load no}.
25517
25518 @anchor{show auto-load}
25519 @kindex show auto-load
25520 @item show auto-load
25521 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
25522 or disabled.
25523
25524 @smallexample
25525 (gdb) show auto-load
25526 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
25527 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
25528 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
25529 is on.
25530 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
25531 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
25532 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
25533 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
25534 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
25535 @end smallexample
25536
25537 @anchor{info auto-load}
25538 @kindex info auto-load
25539 @item info auto-load
25540 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
25541 not.
25542
25543 @smallexample
25544 (gdb) info auto-load
25545 gdb-scripts:
25546 Loaded Script
25547 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
25548 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
25549 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
25550 loaded.
25551 python-scripts:
25552 Loaded Script
25553 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
25554 @end smallexample
25555 @end table
25556
25557 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
25558
25559 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
25560 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
25561 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
25562 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
25563 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
25564 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
25565 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
25566 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
25567 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
25568 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
25569 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
25570 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
25571 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
25572 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
25573 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
25574 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
25575 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
25576 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
25577 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
25578 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
25579 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
25580 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
25581 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
25582 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
25583 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
25584 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
25585 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25586 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
25587 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25588 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
25589 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
25590 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
25591 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
25592 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
25593 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
25594 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
25595 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
25596 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
25597 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
25598 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
25599 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
25600 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
25601 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
25602 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
25603 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
25604 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
25605 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
25606 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
25607 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
25608 @end multitable
25609
25610 @node Init File in the Current Directory
25611 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
25612 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
25613
25614 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
25615 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
25616 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
25617
25618 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
25619 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25620
25621 @table @code
25622 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
25623 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
25624 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
25625 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
25626 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
25627
25628 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
25629 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
25630 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
25631 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
25632 current directory is enabled or disabled.
25633
25634 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
25635 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
25636 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
25637 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
25638 current directory have been auto-loaded.
25639 @end table
25640
25641 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
25642 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
25643 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
25644
25645 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
25646
25647 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
25648 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
25649
25650 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
25651 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
25652 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
25653 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
25654 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
25655 library.
25656
25657 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
25658 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25659
25660 @table @code
25661 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
25662 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
25663 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
25664 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
25665
25666 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
25667 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
25668 @item show auto-load libthread-db
25669 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
25670 enabled or disabled.
25671
25672 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
25673 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
25674 @item info auto-load libthread-db
25675 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
25676 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
25677 @end table
25678
25679 @node Auto-loading safe path
25680 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
25681 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
25682
25683 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
25684 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
25685 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
25686 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
25687 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
25688
25689 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
25690 get loaded:
25691
25692 @smallexample
25693 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
25694 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
25695 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
25696 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
25697 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
25698 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
25699 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
25700 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
25701 @end smallexample
25702
25703 @noindent
25704 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
25705 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
25706
25707 @smallexample
25708 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
25709 @end smallexample
25710
25711 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
25712
25713 @table @code
25714 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
25715 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
25716 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25717 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
25718 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
25719 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
25720 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
25721 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
25722 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
25723 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
25724
25725 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25726 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25727 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25728
25729 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
25730 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
25731 @item show auto-load safe-path
25732 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
25733 scripts.
25734
25735 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
25736 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
25737 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
25738 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
25739 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
25740 by the host platform path separator in use.
25741 @end table
25742
25743 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
25744 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
25745 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
25746 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
25747 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
25748
25749 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
25750 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
25751 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
25752 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
25753 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
25754 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
25755 init file in the current directory
25756 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
25757
25758 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
25759 example, you could use one of the following ways:
25760
25761 @table @asis
25762 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
25763 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
25764 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
25765 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
25766
25767 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
25768 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
25769 @value{GDBN} session.
25770
25771 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
25772 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
25773 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
25774 from trusted sources.
25775
25776 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
25777 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
25778 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
25779 trusted sources.
25780 @end table
25781
25782 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
25783 also suppresses any such warning messages:
25784
25785 @table @asis
25786 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
25787 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
25788
25789 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
25790 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
25791 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
25792 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
25793 @end table
25794
25795 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
25796 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
25797 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
25798 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
25799 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
25800 recommended to be entered.
25801
25802 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
25803 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
25804 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
25805
25806 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
25807 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
25808 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
25809 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
25810 be printed.
25811
25812 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
25813 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
25814 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
25815
25816 @smallexample
25817 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
25818 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
25819 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
25820 for objfile "/tmp/true".
25821 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
25822 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
25823 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
25824 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
25825 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
25826 @end smallexample
25827
25828 @table @code
25829 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
25830 @kindex set debug auto-load
25831 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
25832 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
25833
25834 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
25835 @kindex show debug auto-load
25836 @item show debug auto-load
25837 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
25838 on or off.
25839 @end table
25840
25841 @node Messages/Warnings
25842 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
25843
25844 @cindex verbose operation
25845 @cindex optional warnings
25846 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
25847 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
25848 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
25849 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
25850
25851 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
25852 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
25853 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25854
25855 @table @code
25856 @kindex set verbose
25857 @item set verbose on
25858 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25859
25860 @item set verbose off
25861 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25862
25863 @kindex show verbose
25864 @item show verbose
25865 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
25866 @end table
25867
25868 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
25869 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
25870 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
25871 Symbol Files}).
25872
25873 @table @code
25874
25875 @kindex set complaints
25876 @item set complaints @var{limit}
25877 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
25878 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
25879 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
25880 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
25881
25882 @kindex show complaints
25883 @item show complaints
25884 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
25885
25886 @end table
25887
25888 @anchor{confirmation requests}
25889 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
25890 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
25891 you try to run a program which is already running:
25892
25893 @smallexample
25894 (@value{GDBP}) run
25895 The program being debugged has been started already.
25896 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
25897 @end smallexample
25898
25899 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
25900 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
25901
25902 @table @code
25903
25904 @kindex set confirm
25905 @cindex flinching
25906 @cindex confirmation
25907 @cindex stupid questions
25908 @item set confirm off
25909 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
25910 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
25911 automatically disables confirmation requests.
25912
25913 @item set confirm on
25914 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
25915
25916 @kindex show confirm
25917 @item show confirm
25918 Displays state of confirmation requests.
25919
25920 @end table
25921
25922 @cindex command tracing
25923 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
25924 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
25925 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
25926 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
25927
25928 @table @code
25929 @kindex set trace-commands
25930 @cindex command scripts, debugging
25931 @item set trace-commands on
25932 Enable command tracing.
25933 @item set trace-commands off
25934 Disable command tracing.
25935 @item show trace-commands
25936 Display the current state of command tracing.
25937 @end table
25938
25939 @node Debugging Output
25940 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
25941 @cindex optional debugging messages
25942
25943 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
25944 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
25945 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
25946 section documents those commands.
25947
25948 @table @code
25949 @kindex set exec-done-display
25950 @item set exec-done-display
25951 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
25952 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
25953 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
25954 @kindex show exec-done-display
25955 @item show exec-done-display
25956 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
25957 notification.
25958 @kindex set debug
25959 @cindex ARM AArch64
25960 @item set debug aarch64
25961 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
25962 The default is off.
25963 @kindex show debug
25964 @item show debug aarch64
25965 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25966 ARM AArch64.
25967 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
25968 @cindex architecture debugging info
25969 @item set debug arch
25970 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
25971 @item show debug arch
25972 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
25973 @item set debug aix-solib
25974 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
25975 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
25976 support module. The default is off.
25977 @item show debug aix-thread
25978 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
25979 @item set debug aix-thread
25980 @cindex AIX threads
25981 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
25982 module.
25983 @item show debug aix-thread
25984 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
25985 @item set debug check-physname
25986 @cindex physname
25987 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
25988 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
25989 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
25990 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
25991 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
25992 both ways and display any discrepancies.
25993 @item show debug check-physname
25994 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
25995 @item set debug coff-pe-read
25996 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
25997 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
25998 exported symbols. The default is off.
25999 @item show debug coff-pe-read
26000 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
26001 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
26002 @item set debug dwarf-die
26003 @cindex DWARF DIEs
26004 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
26005 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
26006 A value of zero turns off the display.
26007 @item show debug dwarf-die
26008 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
26009 @item set debug dwarf-line
26010 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
26011 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
26012 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
26013 A value of 1 provides basic information.
26014 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
26015 @item show debug dwarf-line
26016 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
26017 @item set debug dwarf-read
26018 @cindex DWARF Reading
26019 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
26020 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
26021 A value of 1 provides basic information.
26022 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
26023 @item show debug dwarf-read
26024 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
26025 @item set debug displaced
26026 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
26027 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
26028 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
26029 @item show debug displaced
26030 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
26031 related to displaced stepping.
26032 @item set debug event
26033 @cindex event debugging info
26034 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
26035 default is off.
26036 @item show debug event
26037 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
26038 info.
26039 @item set debug expression
26040 @cindex expression debugging info
26041 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
26042 expression parsing. The default is off.
26043 @item show debug expression
26044 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
26045 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
26046 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
26047 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
26048 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
26049 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
26050 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
26051 @item set debug fbsd-nat
26052 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
26053 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
26054 @item show debug fbsd-nat
26055 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
26056 @item set debug frame
26057 @cindex frame debugging info
26058 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
26059 default is off.
26060 @item show debug frame
26061 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
26062 info.
26063 @item set debug gnu-nat
26064 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
26065 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
26066 @item show debug gnu-nat
26067 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
26068 @item set debug infrun
26069 @cindex inferior debugging info
26070 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
26071 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
26072 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
26073 @item show debug infrun
26074 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
26075 @item set debug jit
26076 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
26077 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
26078 @item show debug jit
26079 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
26080 @item set debug lin-lwp
26081 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
26082 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
26083 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
26084 @item show debug lin-lwp
26085 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
26086 @item set debug linux-namespaces
26087 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
26088 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
26089 @item show debug linux-namespaces
26090 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
26091 @item set debug mach-o
26092 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
26093 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
26094 processing. The default is off.
26095 @item show debug mach-o
26096 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
26097 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
26098 @item set debug notification
26099 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
26100 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
26101 The default is off.
26102 @item show debug notification
26103 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
26104 @item set debug observer
26105 @cindex observer debugging info
26106 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
26107 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
26108 @item show debug observer
26109 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
26110 @item set debug overload
26111 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
26112 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
26113 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
26114 is off.
26115 @item show debug overload
26116 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
26117 debugging info.
26118 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
26119 @cindex debug expression parser
26120 @item set debug parser
26121 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
26122 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
26123 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
26124 details. The default is off.
26125 @item show debug parser
26126 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
26127 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
26128 @cindex serial connections, debugging
26129 @cindex debug remote protocol
26130 @cindex remote protocol debugging
26131 @cindex display remote packets
26132 @item set debug remote
26133 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
26134 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
26135 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
26136 @item show debug remote
26137 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
26138
26139 @item set debug separate-debug-file
26140 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
26141 @item show debug separate-debug-file
26142 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
26143
26144 @item set debug serial
26145 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
26146 default is off.
26147 @item show debug serial
26148 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
26149 info.
26150 @item set debug solib-frv
26151 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
26152 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
26153 @item show debug solib-frv
26154 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
26155 messages.
26156 @item set debug symbol-lookup
26157 @cindex symbol lookup
26158 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
26159 The default is 0 (off).
26160 A value of 1 provides basic information.
26161 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
26162 @item show debug symbol-lookup
26163 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
26164 @item set debug symfile
26165 @cindex symbol file functions
26166 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
26167 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
26168 @item show debug symfile
26169 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
26170 @item set debug symtab-create
26171 @cindex symbol table creation
26172 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
26173 The default is 0 (off).
26174 A value of 1 provides basic information.
26175 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
26176 @item show debug symtab-create
26177 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
26178 @item set debug target
26179 @cindex target debugging info
26180 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
26181 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
26182 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
26183 value of large memory transfers.
26184 @item show debug target
26185 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
26186 info.
26187 @item set debug timestamp
26188 @cindex timestampping debugging info
26189 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
26190 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
26191 message.
26192 @item show debug timestamp
26193 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
26194 debugging info.
26195 @item set debug varobj
26196 @cindex variable object debugging info
26197 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
26198 info. The default is off.
26199 @item show debug varobj
26200 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
26201 debugging info.
26202 @item set debug xml
26203 @cindex XML parser debugging
26204 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
26205 @item show debug xml
26206 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
26207 @end table
26208
26209 @node Other Misc Settings
26210 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
26211 @cindex miscellaneous settings
26212
26213 @table @code
26214 @kindex set interactive-mode
26215 @item set interactive-mode
26216 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
26217 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
26218 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
26219 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
26220 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
26221 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
26222 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
26223 is, non-interactively otherwise.
26224
26225 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
26226 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
26227 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
26228 inside a cygwin window.
26229
26230 @kindex show interactive-mode
26231 @item show interactive-mode
26232 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
26233 @end table
26234
26235 @node Extending GDB
26236 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
26237 @cindex extending GDB
26238
26239 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
26240 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
26241 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
26242 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
26243 being debugged.
26244
26245 @menu
26246 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
26247 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
26248 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
26249 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
26250 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
26251 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
26252 @end menu
26253
26254 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
26255 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
26256 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
26257 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
26258 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
26259 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
26260
26261 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
26262 setting:
26263
26264 @table @code
26265 @kindex set script-extension
26266 @kindex show script-extension
26267 @item set script-extension off
26268 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
26269
26270 @item set script-extension soft
26271 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
26272 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
26273 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
26274 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
26275
26276 @item set script-extension strict
26277 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
26278 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
26279 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
26280
26281 @item show script-extension
26282 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
26283
26284 @end table
26285
26286 @node Sequences
26287 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
26288
26289 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
26290 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
26291 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
26292 files.
26293
26294 @menu
26295 * Define:: How to define your own commands
26296 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
26297 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
26298 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
26299 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
26300 @end menu
26301
26302 @node Define
26303 @subsection User-defined Commands
26304
26305 @cindex user-defined command
26306 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
26307 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
26308 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
26309 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
26310 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
26311 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
26312
26313 @smallexample
26314 define adder
26315 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
26316 end
26317 @end smallexample
26318
26319 @noindent
26320 To execute the command use:
26321
26322 @smallexample
26323 adder 1 2 3
26324 @end smallexample
26325
26326 @noindent
26327 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
26328 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
26329 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
26330 functions calls.
26331
26332 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
26333 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
26334 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
26335 been passed.
26336
26337 @smallexample
26338 define adder
26339 if $argc == 2
26340 print $arg0 + $arg1
26341 end
26342 if $argc == 3
26343 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
26344 end
26345 end
26346 @end smallexample
26347
26348 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
26349 to process a variable number of arguments:
26350
26351 @smallexample
26352 define adder
26353 set $i = 0
26354 set $sum = 0
26355 while $i < $argc
26356 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
26357 set $i = $i + 1
26358 end
26359 print $sum
26360 end
26361 @end smallexample
26362
26363 @table @code
26364
26365 @kindex define
26366 @item define @var{commandname}
26367 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
26368 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
26369 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
26370 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
26371 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
26372 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
26373
26374 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
26375 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
26376 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
26377
26378 @kindex document
26379 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
26380 @item document @var{commandname}
26381 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
26382 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
26383 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
26384 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
26385 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
26386 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
26387
26388 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
26389 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
26390 does not change the documentation.
26391
26392 @kindex dont-repeat
26393 @cindex don't repeat command
26394 @item dont-repeat
26395 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
26396 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
26397 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
26398
26399 @kindex help user-defined
26400 @item help user-defined
26401 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
26402 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
26403 included (if any).
26404
26405 @kindex show user
26406 @item show user
26407 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
26408 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
26409 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
26410 definitions for all user-defined commands.
26411 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
26412
26413 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
26414 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
26415 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
26416 @item show max-user-call-depth
26417 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
26418 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
26419 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
26420 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
26421 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
26422 @end table
26423
26424 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
26425 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
26426
26427 When user-defined commands are executed, the
26428 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
26429 stops execution of the user-defined command.
26430
26431 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
26432 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
26433 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
26434 messages when used in a user-defined command.
26435
26436 @node Hooks
26437 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
26438 @cindex command hooks
26439 @cindex hooks, for commands
26440 @cindex hooks, pre-command
26441
26442 @kindex hook
26443 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
26444 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
26445 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
26446 before that command.
26447
26448 @cindex hooks, post-command
26449 @kindex hookpost
26450 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
26451 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
26452 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
26453 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
26454 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
26455
26456 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
26457 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
26458
26459 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
26460 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
26461
26462 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
26463 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
26464 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
26465 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
26466 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
26467
26468 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
26469 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
26470 you could define:
26471
26472 @smallexample
26473 define hook-stop
26474 handle SIGALRM nopass
26475 end
26476
26477 define hook-run
26478 handle SIGALRM pass
26479 end
26480
26481 define hook-continue
26482 handle SIGALRM pass
26483 end
26484 @end smallexample
26485
26486 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
26487 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
26488 you could define:
26489
26490 @smallexample
26491 define hook-echo
26492 echo <<<---
26493 end
26494
26495 define hookpost-echo
26496 echo --->>>\n
26497 end
26498
26499 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
26500 <<<---Hello World--->>>
26501 (@value{GDBP})
26502
26503 @end smallexample
26504
26505 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
26506 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
26507 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
26508 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
26509 @c or not?
26510 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
26511 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
26512 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
26513
26514 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
26515 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
26516 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
26517
26518 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
26519 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
26520
26521 @node Command Files
26522 @subsection Command Files
26523
26524 @cindex command files
26525 @cindex scripting commands
26526 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
26527 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
26528 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
26529 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
26530 terminal.
26531
26532 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
26533 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
26534 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
26535 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
26536 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
26537
26538 @table @code
26539 @kindex source
26540 @cindex execute commands from a file
26541 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
26542 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
26543 @end table
26544
26545 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
26546 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
26547 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
26548 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
26549 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
26550
26551 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
26552 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
26553 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
26554 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
26555 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
26556 is not relevant to scripts.
26557
26558 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
26559 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
26560 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
26561 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
26562 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
26563 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
26564 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
26565 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
26566 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
26567 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
26568 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
26569 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
26570 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
26571 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
26572
26573 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
26574 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
26575 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
26576
26577 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
26578 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
26579 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
26580 when called from command files.
26581
26582 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
26583 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
26584 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
26585 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
26586 the next command.
26587
26588 @smallexample
26589 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
26590 @end smallexample
26591
26592 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
26593 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
26594 would be directed to @file{log}.
26595
26596 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
26597 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
26598 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
26599 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
26600 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
26601 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
26602 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
26603 conditionally, etc.
26604
26605 @table @code
26606 @kindex if
26607 @kindex else
26608 @item if
26609 @itemx else
26610 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
26611 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
26612 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
26613 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
26614 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
26615 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
26616 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
26617
26618 @kindex while
26619 @item while
26620 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
26621 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
26622 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
26623 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
26624 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
26625 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
26626
26627 @kindex loop_break
26628 @item loop_break
26629 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
26630 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
26631 line.
26632
26633 @kindex loop_continue
26634 @item loop_continue
26635 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
26636 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
26637 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
26638 the controlling expression.
26639
26640 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
26641 @item end
26642 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
26643 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
26644 @end table
26645
26646
26647 @node Output
26648 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
26649
26650 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
26651 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
26652 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
26653 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
26654 want.
26655
26656 @table @code
26657 @kindex echo
26658 @item echo @var{text}
26659 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
26660 @c because it is not in ANSI.
26661 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
26662 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
26663 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
26664 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
26665 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
26666 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
26667 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
26668 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
26669 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
26670
26671 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
26672 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
26673
26674 @smallexample
26675 echo This is some text\n\
26676 which is continued\n\
26677 onto several lines.\n
26678 @end smallexample
26679
26680 produces the same output as
26681
26682 @smallexample
26683 echo This is some text\n
26684 echo which is continued\n
26685 echo onto several lines.\n
26686 @end smallexample
26687
26688 @kindex output
26689 @item output @var{expression}
26690 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
26691 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
26692 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
26693 on expressions.
26694
26695 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
26696 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
26697 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
26698 Formats}, for more information.
26699
26700 @kindex printf
26701 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
26702 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
26703 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
26704 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
26705 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
26706 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
26707 executing the code below:
26708
26709 @smallexample
26710 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
26711 @end smallexample
26712
26713 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
26714 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
26715 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
26716 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
26717 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
26718 printed.
26719
26720 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
26721
26722 @smallexample
26723 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
26724 @end smallexample
26725
26726 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
26727 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
26728 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
26729
26730 @itemize @bullet
26731 @item
26732 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
26733
26734 @item
26735 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
26736 width.
26737
26738 @item
26739 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
26740 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
26741
26742 @item
26743 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
26744 supported.
26745
26746 @item
26747 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
26748
26749 @item
26750 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
26751 @end itemize
26752
26753 @noindent
26754 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
26755 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
26756 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
26757 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
26758
26759 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
26760 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
26761 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
26762 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
26763 supported.
26764
26765 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
26766 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
26767 together with a floating point specifier.
26768 letters:
26769
26770 @itemize @bullet
26771 @item
26772 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
26773
26774 @item
26775 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
26776
26777 @item
26778 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
26779 @end itemize
26780
26781 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
26782 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
26783 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
26784
26785 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
26786 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
26787
26788 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
26789 @smallexample
26790 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
26791 @end smallexample
26792
26793 @anchor{eval}
26794 @kindex eval
26795 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
26796 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
26797 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
26798
26799 @end table
26800
26801 @node Auto-loading sequences
26802 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
26803 @cindex native script auto-loading
26804
26805 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26806 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
26807 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
26808 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
26809
26810 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26811 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26812
26813 @table @code
26814 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
26815 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
26816 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
26817 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
26818
26819 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
26820 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
26821 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
26822 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
26823 disabled.
26824
26825 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
26826 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
26827 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
26828 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
26829 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
26830 auto-loaded.
26831 @end table
26832
26833 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
26834 matching names are printed.
26835
26836 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
26837 @include python.texi
26838
26839 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
26840 @include guile.texi
26841
26842 @node Auto-loading extensions
26843 @section Auto-loading extensions
26844 @cindex auto-loading extensions
26845
26846 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
26847 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26848 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
26849 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
26850 section of modern file formats like ELF.
26851
26852 @menu
26853 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26854 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26855 * Which flavor to choose?::
26856 @end menu
26857
26858 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
26859 debugging commands and features.
26860
26861 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26862 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26863 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
26864 for more information.
26865 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
26866 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
26867
26868 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26869 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26870
26871 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
26872 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26873 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26874 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26875 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26876
26877 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
26878 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
26879 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
26880 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
26881
26882 @table @code
26883 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26884 GDB's own command language
26885 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26886 Python
26887 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26888 Guile
26889 @end table
26890
26891 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
26892 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
26893 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
26894 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
26895 script in the specified extension language.
26896
26897 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
26898 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
26899
26900 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
26901 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26902
26903 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
26904 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
26905 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
26906 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
26907 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
26908 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
26909
26910 @table @code
26911 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
26912 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
26913 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
26914 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
26915 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
26916 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
26917
26918 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
26919 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
26920
26921 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
26922 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
26923 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
26924 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
26925
26926 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
26927 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
26928 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
26929 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
26930 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
26931 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
26932 platform.
26933
26934 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
26935 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
26936 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
26937
26938 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
26939 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
26940 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
26941 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
26942
26943 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
26944 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
26945 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
26946 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
26947 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
26948 @end table
26949
26950 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
26951 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
26952 @var{objfile} is opened.
26953 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
26954 is evaluated more than once.
26955
26956 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
26957 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26958 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26959
26960 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
26961 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
26962 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26963 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
26964 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
26965 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
26966 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
26967
26968 The following entries are supported:
26969
26970 @table @code
26971 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
26972 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
26973 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
26974 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
26975 @end table
26976
26977 @subsubsection Script File Entries
26978
26979 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
26980 in the current directory and then along the source search path
26981 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
26982 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
26983 directory is not relevant to scripts.
26984
26985 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
26986 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
26987
26988 @example
26989 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
26990 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
26991 asm("\
26992 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
26993 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
26994 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
26995 .popsection \n\
26996 ");
26997 @end example
26998
26999 @noindent
27000 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
27001 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
27002
27003 @example
27004 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
27005 @end example
27006
27007 The script name may include directories if desired.
27008
27009 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
27010 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
27011
27012 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
27013 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
27014 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
27015 will remove duplicates.
27016
27017 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
27018
27019 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
27020 itself instead of loading it from a file.
27021 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
27022 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
27023 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
27024 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
27025 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
27026 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
27027 on its name.
27028
27029 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
27030 testsuite.
27031
27032 @example
27033 #include "symcat.h"
27034 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
27035 asm(
27036 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
27037 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
27038 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
27039 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
27040 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
27041 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
27042 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
27043 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
27044 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
27045 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
27046 ".byte 0\n"
27047 ".popsection\n"
27048 );
27049 @end example
27050
27051 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
27052 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
27053 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
27054 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
27055
27056 @node Which flavor to choose?
27057 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
27058
27059 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
27060 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
27061
27062 @noindent
27063 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
27064
27065 @itemize @bullet
27066 @item
27067 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
27068
27069 @item
27070 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
27071
27072 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
27073 in the source search path.
27074 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
27075 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
27076
27077 @item
27078 Doesn't require source code additions.
27079 @end itemize
27080
27081 @noindent
27082 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
27083
27084 @itemize @bullet
27085 @item
27086 Works with static linking.
27087
27088 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
27089 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
27090 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
27091 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
27092 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
27093
27094 @item
27095 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
27096
27097 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
27098 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
27099
27100 @item
27101 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
27102
27103 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
27104 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
27105 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
27106 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
27107 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
27108 top of the source tree to the source search path.
27109 @end itemize
27110
27111 @node Multiple Extension Languages
27112 @section Multiple Extension Languages
27113
27114 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
27115 and generally do not interfere with each other.
27116 There are some things to be aware of, however.
27117
27118 @subsection Python comes first
27119
27120 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
27121 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
27122 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
27123 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
27124 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
27125 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
27126 pretty-printed form of a value).
27127 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
27128 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
27129 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
27130
27131 @node Aliases
27132 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
27133 @cindex aliases for commands
27134
27135 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
27136 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
27137 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
27138 that involves less typing.
27139
27140 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
27141 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
27142 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
27143
27144 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
27145 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
27146 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
27147
27148 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
27149
27150 @table @code
27151
27152 @kindex alias
27153 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
27154
27155 @end table
27156
27157 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
27158 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
27159 underscores.
27160
27161 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
27162 that is being aliased.
27163
27164 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
27165 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
27166 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
27167
27168 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
27169 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
27170
27171 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
27172 of a command so that there is less to type.
27173 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
27174 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
27175 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
27176 The following will accomplish this.
27177
27178 @smallexample
27179 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
27180 @end smallexample
27181
27182 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
27183 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
27184 for it with the @samp{document} command.
27185 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
27186
27187 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
27188 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
27189 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
27190 of a command.
27191
27192 @smallexample
27193 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
27194 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
27195 (gdb) set p elms 20
27196 (gdb) show p elms
27197 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
27198 @end smallexample
27199
27200 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
27201 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
27202 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
27203
27204 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
27205 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
27206
27207 @smallexample
27208 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
27209 @end smallexample
27210
27211 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
27212 alias for a more complex command.
27213 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
27214
27215 @smallexample
27216 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
27217 (gdb) spe 20
27218 @end smallexample
27219
27220 @node Interpreters
27221 @chapter Command Interpreters
27222 @cindex command interpreters
27223
27224 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
27225 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
27226 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
27227
27228 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
27229 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
27230 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
27231 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
27232
27233 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
27234 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
27235 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
27236 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
27237
27238 @table @code
27239 @item console
27240 @cindex console interpreter
27241 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
27242 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
27243 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
27244
27245 @item mi
27246 @cindex mi interpreter
27247 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi3}). Used primarily
27248 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
27249 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
27250 Interface}.
27251
27252 @item mi3
27253 @cindex mi3 interpreter
27254 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 9.1.
27255
27256 @item mi2
27257 @cindex mi2 interpreter
27258 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 6.0.
27259
27260 @item mi1
27261 @cindex mi1 interpreter
27262 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 5.1.
27263
27264 @end table
27265
27266 @cindex invoke another interpreter
27267
27268 @kindex interpreter-exec
27269 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
27270 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
27271 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
27272
27273 @smallexample
27274 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
27275 @end smallexample
27276
27277 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
27278 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
27279
27280 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
27281 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
27282 permanently.
27283
27284 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
27285
27286 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
27287 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
27288 device (usually a tty).
27289
27290 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
27291 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
27292 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
27293 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
27294 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
27295 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
27296 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
27297 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
27298 the separate MI interpreter.
27299
27300 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
27301 @code{new-ui} command:
27302
27303 @kindex new-ui
27304 @cindex new user interface
27305 @smallexample
27306 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
27307 @end smallexample
27308
27309 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
27310 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
27311 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
27312 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
27313 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
27314 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
27315
27316 @smallexample
27317 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
27318 @end smallexample
27319
27320 @noindent
27321 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
27322
27323 @node TUI
27324 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
27325 @cindex TUI
27326 @cindex Text User Interface
27327
27328 @menu
27329 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
27330 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
27331 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
27332 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
27333 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
27334 @end menu
27335
27336 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
27337 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
27338 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
27339 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
27340 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
27341 is available.
27342
27343 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
27344 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
27345 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
27346 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
27347 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
27348 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
27349
27350 @node TUI Overview
27351 @section TUI Overview
27352
27353 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
27354
27355 @table @emph
27356 @item command
27357 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
27358 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
27359 managed using readline.
27360
27361 @item source
27362 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
27363 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
27364
27365 @item assembly
27366 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
27367
27368 @item register
27369 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
27370 when their values change.
27371 @end table
27372
27373 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
27374 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
27375 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
27376 indicates the breakpoint type:
27377
27378 @table @code
27379 @item B
27380 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
27381
27382 @item b
27383 Breakpoint which was never hit.
27384
27385 @item H
27386 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
27387
27388 @item h
27389 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
27390 @end table
27391
27392 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
27393
27394 @table @code
27395 @item +
27396 Breakpoint is enabled.
27397
27398 @item -
27399 Breakpoint is disabled.
27400 @end table
27401
27402 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
27403 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
27404 changes.
27405
27406 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
27407 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
27408 layouts:
27409
27410 @itemize @bullet
27411 @item
27412 source only,
27413
27414 @item
27415 assembly only,
27416
27417 @item
27418 source and assembly,
27419
27420 @item
27421 source and registers, or
27422
27423 @item
27424 assembly and registers.
27425 @end itemize
27426
27427 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
27428
27429 @table @emph
27430 @item target
27431 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
27432 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
27433
27434 @item process
27435 Gives the current process or thread number.
27436 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
27437
27438 @item function
27439 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
27440 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
27441 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
27442 the string @code{??} is displayed.
27443
27444 @item line
27445 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
27446 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
27447
27448 @item pc
27449 Indicates the current program counter address.
27450 @end table
27451
27452 @node TUI Keys
27453 @section TUI Key Bindings
27454 @cindex TUI key bindings
27455
27456 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
27457 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
27458 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
27459 @end ifset
27460 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
27461 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
27462 @end ifclear
27463 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
27464 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
27465
27466 @table @kbd
27467 @kindex C-x C-a
27468 @item C-x C-a
27469 @kindex C-x a
27470 @itemx C-x a
27471 @kindex C-x A
27472 @itemx C-x A
27473 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
27474 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
27475 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
27476 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
27477 The screen is then refreshed.
27478
27479 @kindex C-x 1
27480 @item C-x 1
27481 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
27482 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
27483 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
27484
27485 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
27486
27487 @kindex C-x 2
27488 @item C-x 2
27489 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
27490 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
27491 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
27492 previous layout and the new one.
27493
27494 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
27495
27496 @kindex C-x o
27497 @item C-x o
27498 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
27499 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
27500 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
27501
27502 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
27503
27504 @kindex C-x s
27505 @item C-x s
27506 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
27507 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
27508 @end table
27509
27510 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
27511
27512 @table @asis
27513 @kindex PgUp
27514 @item @key{PgUp}
27515 Scroll the active window one page up.
27516
27517 @kindex PgDn
27518 @item @key{PgDn}
27519 Scroll the active window one page down.
27520
27521 @kindex Up
27522 @item @key{Up}
27523 Scroll the active window one line up.
27524
27525 @kindex Down
27526 @item @key{Down}
27527 Scroll the active window one line down.
27528
27529 @kindex Left
27530 @item @key{Left}
27531 Scroll the active window one column left.
27532
27533 @kindex Right
27534 @item @key{Right}
27535 Scroll the active window one column right.
27536
27537 @kindex C-L
27538 @item @kbd{C-L}
27539 Refresh the screen.
27540 @end table
27541
27542 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
27543 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
27544 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
27545 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
27546 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
27547
27548 @node TUI Single Key Mode
27549 @section TUI Single Key Mode
27550 @cindex TUI single key mode
27551
27552 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
27553 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
27554 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
27555
27556 @table @kbd
27557 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27558 @item c
27559 continue
27560
27561 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27562 @item d
27563 down
27564
27565 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27566 @item f
27567 finish
27568
27569 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27570 @item n
27571 next
27572
27573 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27574 @item o
27575 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
27576
27577 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27578 @item q
27579 exit the SingleKey mode.
27580
27581 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27582 @item r
27583 run
27584
27585 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27586 @item s
27587 step
27588
27589 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27590 @item i
27591 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
27592
27593 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27594 @item u
27595 up
27596
27597 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27598 @item v
27599 info locals
27600
27601 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27602 @item w
27603 where
27604 @end table
27605
27606 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
27607 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
27608 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
27609 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
27610 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
27611 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
27612
27613 @cindex SingleKey keymap name
27614 If @value{GDBN} was built with Readline 8.0 or later, the TUI
27615 SingleKey keymap will be named @samp{SingleKey}. This can be used in
27616 @file{.inputrc} to add additional bindings to this keymap.
27617
27618 @node TUI Commands
27619 @section TUI-specific Commands
27620 @cindex TUI commands
27621
27622 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
27623 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
27624 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
27625 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
27626
27627 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
27628 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
27629 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
27630 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
27631 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
27632
27633 @table @code
27634 @item tui enable
27635 @kindex tui enable
27636 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
27637 TUI mode has previously been used in the current debugging session,
27638 otherwise a default layout is used.
27639
27640 @item tui disable
27641 @kindex tui disable
27642 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
27643
27644 @item info win
27645 @kindex info win
27646 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
27647
27648 @item layout @var{name}
27649 @kindex layout
27650 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
27651 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
27652 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
27653
27654 @table @code
27655 @item next
27656 Display the next layout.
27657
27658 @item prev
27659 Display the previous layout.
27660
27661 @item src
27662 Display the source and command windows.
27663
27664 @item asm
27665 Display the assembly and command windows.
27666
27667 @item split
27668 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
27669
27670 @item regs
27671 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
27672 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
27673 register, assembler, and command windows.
27674 @end table
27675
27676 @item focus @var{name}
27677 @kindex focus
27678 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
27679 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
27680
27681 @table @code
27682 @item next
27683 Make the next window active for scrolling.
27684
27685 @item prev
27686 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
27687
27688 @item src
27689 Make the source window active for scrolling.
27690
27691 @item asm
27692 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
27693
27694 @item regs
27695 Make the register window active for scrolling.
27696
27697 @item cmd
27698 Make the command window active for scrolling.
27699 @end table
27700
27701 @item refresh
27702 @kindex refresh
27703 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
27704
27705 @item tui reg @var{group}
27706 @kindex tui reg
27707 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
27708 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
27709 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
27710 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
27711 following groups are available on most targets:
27712 @table @code
27713 @item next
27714 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
27715 through all of the available register groups.
27716
27717 @item prev
27718 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
27719 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
27720 @var{next}.
27721
27722 @item general
27723 Display the general registers.
27724 @item float
27725 Display the floating point registers.
27726 @item system
27727 Display the system registers.
27728 @item vector
27729 Display the vector registers.
27730 @item all
27731 Display all registers.
27732 @end table
27733
27734 @item update
27735 @kindex update
27736 Update the source window and the current execution point.
27737
27738 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
27739 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
27740 @kindex winheight
27741 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
27742 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
27743 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
27744 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
27745 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
27746 @end table
27747
27748 @node TUI Configuration
27749 @section TUI Configuration Variables
27750 @cindex TUI configuration variables
27751
27752 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
27753
27754 @table @code
27755 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
27756 @kindex set tui border-kind
27757 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
27758 The possible values are the following:
27759 @table @code
27760 @item space
27761 Use a space character to draw the border.
27762
27763 @item ascii
27764 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
27765
27766 @item acs
27767 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
27768 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
27769 @end table
27770
27771 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
27772 @kindex set tui border-mode
27773 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
27774 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
27775 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
27776 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
27777 @table @code
27778 @item normal
27779 Use normal attributes to display the border.
27780
27781 @item standout
27782 Use standout mode.
27783
27784 @item reverse
27785 Use reverse video mode.
27786
27787 @item half
27788 Use half bright mode.
27789
27790 @item half-standout
27791 Use half bright and standout mode.
27792
27793 @item bold
27794 Use extra bright or bold mode.
27795
27796 @item bold-standout
27797 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
27798 @end table
27799
27800 @item set tui tab-width @var{nchars}
27801 @kindex set tui tab-width
27802 @kindex tabset
27803 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
27804 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
27805 assembly windows.
27806 @end table
27807
27808 @node Emacs
27809 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
27810
27811 @cindex Emacs
27812 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
27813 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
27814 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
27815 @value{GDBN}.
27816
27817 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
27818 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
27819 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
27820 created Emacs buffer.
27821 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
27822
27823 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
27824 things:
27825
27826 @itemize @bullet
27827 @item
27828 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
27829 the GUD buffer.
27830
27831 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
27832 and output done by the program you are debugging.
27833
27834 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
27835 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
27836 in this way.
27837
27838 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
27839 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
27840 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
27841 stop.
27842
27843 @item
27844 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
27845
27846 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
27847 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
27848 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
27849 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
27850 and the source.
27851
27852 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
27853 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
27854 @end itemize
27855
27856 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
27857 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
27858 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
27859 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
27860
27861 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
27862 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
27863 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
27864 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
27865 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
27866 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
27867 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
27868 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
27869 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
27870
27871 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
27872 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
27873 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
27874 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
27875
27876 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
27877 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
27878 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
27879 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
27880 one you want.
27881
27882 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
27883 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
27884
27885 @table @kbd
27886 @item C-h m
27887 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
27888
27889 @item C-c C-s
27890 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
27891 update the display window to show the current file and location.
27892
27893 @item C-c C-n
27894 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
27895 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
27896 to show the current file and location.
27897
27898 @item C-c C-i
27899 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
27900 display window accordingly.
27901
27902 @item C-c C-f
27903 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
27904 @code{finish} command.
27905
27906 @item C-c C-r
27907 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
27908 command.
27909
27910 @item C-c <
27911 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
27912 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
27913 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
27914
27915 @item C-c >
27916 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
27917 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
27918 @end table
27919
27920 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
27921 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
27922
27923 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
27924 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
27925 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
27926 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
27927 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
27928 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
27929 speedbar displays watch expressions.
27930
27931 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
27932 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
27933 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
27934 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
27935 frame.
27936
27937 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
27938 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
27939 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
27940 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
27941 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
27942 to correspond properly with the code.
27943
27944 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
27945 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
27946 Emacs Manual}).
27947
27948 @node GDB/MI
27949 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
27950
27951 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
27952
27953 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
27954 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
27955 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
27956 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
27957 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
27958 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
27959
27960 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
27961 in the form of a reference manual.
27962
27963 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
27964 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
27965 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
27966
27967 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
27968
27969 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
27970 This chapter uses the following notation:
27971
27972 @itemize @bullet
27973 @item
27974 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
27975
27976 @item
27977 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
27978 it may or may not be given.
27979
27980 @item
27981 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27982 may repeat zero or more times.
27983
27984 @item
27985 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
27986 may repeat one or more times.
27987
27988 @item
27989 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
27990 @end itemize
27991
27992 @ignore
27993 @heading Dependencies
27994 @end ignore
27995
27996 @menu
27997 * GDB/MI General Design::
27998 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
27999 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
28000 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
28001 * GDB/MI Output Records::
28002 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
28003 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
28004 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
28005 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28006 * GDB/MI Program Context::
28007 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
28008 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
28009 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
28010 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
28011 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
28012 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
28013 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
28014 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
28015 * GDB/MI File Commands::
28016 @ignore
28017 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
28018 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
28019 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
28020 @end ignore
28021 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
28022 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
28023 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
28024 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
28025 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
28026 @end menu
28027
28028 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28029 @node GDB/MI General Design
28030 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
28031 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
28032
28033 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
28034 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
28035 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
28036 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
28037 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
28038 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
28039 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
28040 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
28041 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
28042 a command and reported as part of that command response.
28043
28044 The important examples of notifications are:
28045 @itemize @bullet
28046
28047 @item
28048 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
28049 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
28050 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
28051 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
28052 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
28053 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
28054 command itself was successfully executed.
28055
28056 @item
28057 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
28058 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
28059 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
28060 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
28061 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
28062 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
28063
28064 @item
28065 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
28066 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
28067 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
28068 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
28069 orthogonal frontend design.
28070
28071 @end itemize
28072
28073 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
28074 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
28075 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
28076 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
28077 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
28078 the user interface.
28079
28080
28081 @menu
28082 * Context management::
28083 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
28084 * Thread groups::
28085 @end menu
28086
28087 @node Context management
28088 @subsection Context management
28089
28090 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
28091
28092 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
28093 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
28094 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
28095 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
28096 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
28097 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
28098 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
28099 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
28100 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
28101
28102 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
28103 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
28104 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
28105 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
28106 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
28107 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
28108 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
28109 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
28110 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
28111 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
28112 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
28113
28114 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
28115 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
28116 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
28117 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
28118 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
28119 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
28120 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
28121 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
28122 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
28123 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
28124
28125 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
28126 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
28127 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
28128 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
28129 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
28130 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
28131 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
28132 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
28133 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
28134 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
28135 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
28136 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
28137 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
28138 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
28139 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
28140 @samp{--frame} options.
28141
28142 @subsubsection Language
28143
28144 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
28145 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
28146 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
28147 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
28148 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
28149 For instance:
28150
28151 @smallexample
28152 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
28153 ^done,value="4"
28154 (gdb)
28155 @end smallexample
28156
28157 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
28158 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
28159 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
28160
28161 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
28162 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
28163
28164 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
28165 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
28166 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
28167 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
28168 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
28169 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
28170 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
28171 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
28172 @code{-list-target-features} command.
28173
28174 @table @code
28175 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
28176 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
28177 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
28178
28179 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
28180 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
28181 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
28182
28183 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
28184 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
28185 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
28186 MI commands even while the target is running.
28187
28188 @item -gdb-show mi-async
28189 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
28190 @end table
28191
28192 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
28193 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
28194 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
28195 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
28196 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
28197 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
28198
28199 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
28200 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
28201 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
28202 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
28203 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
28204 are running.
28205
28206 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
28207 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
28208 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
28209 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
28210 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
28211 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
28212 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
28213 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
28214 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
28215 @samp{--thread} option).
28216
28217 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
28218 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
28219 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
28220 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
28221
28222 @node Thread groups
28223 @subsection Thread groups
28224 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
28225 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
28226 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
28227 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
28228 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
28229
28230 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
28231 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
28232 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
28233 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
28234 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
28235 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
28236 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
28237 into processes.
28238
28239 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
28240 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
28241 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
28242 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
28243 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
28244 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
28245 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
28246 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
28247 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
28248 the members of specific thread group.
28249
28250 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
28251 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
28252 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
28253 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
28254 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
28255 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
28256 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
28257 after attaching to that thread group.
28258
28259 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
28260 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
28261 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
28262 such thread groups.
28263
28264 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28265 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
28266 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
28267
28268 @menu
28269 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
28270 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
28271 @end menu
28272
28273 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
28274 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
28275
28276 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
28277 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
28278 @table @code
28279 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
28280 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
28281
28282 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
28283 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
28284 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
28285
28286 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
28287 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
28288 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
28289
28290 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
28291 "any sequence of digits"
28292
28293 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
28294 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
28295
28296 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
28297 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
28298
28299 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
28300 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
28301
28302 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
28303 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
28304 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
28305
28306 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
28307 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
28308
28309 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
28310 @code{CR | CR-LF}
28311 @end table
28312
28313 @noindent
28314 Notes:
28315
28316 @itemize @bullet
28317 @item
28318 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
28319 output is described below.
28320
28321 @item
28322 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
28323 finishes.
28324
28325 @item
28326 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
28327 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
28328 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
28329 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
28330 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
28331 @end itemize
28332
28333 Pragmatics:
28334
28335 @itemize @bullet
28336 @item
28337 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
28338
28339 @item
28340 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
28341 @end itemize
28342
28343 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
28344 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
28345
28346 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
28347 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
28348 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
28349 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
28350 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
28351 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
28352
28353 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
28354 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
28355 @var{token}.
28356
28357 @table @code
28358 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
28359 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
28360
28361 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
28362 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
28363
28364 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
28365 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
28366
28367 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
28368 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
28369
28370 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
28371 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
28372
28373 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
28374 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
28375
28376 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
28377 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
28378
28379 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
28380 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
28381
28382 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
28383 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
28384
28385 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
28386 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
28387 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
28388
28389 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
28390 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
28391
28392 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
28393 @code{ @var{string} }
28394
28395 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
28396 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
28397
28398 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
28399 @code{@var{c-string}}
28400
28401 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
28402 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
28403
28404 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
28405 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
28406 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
28407
28408 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
28409 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
28410
28411 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
28412 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
28413
28414 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
28415 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
28416
28417 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
28418 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
28419
28420 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
28421 @code{CR | CR-LF}
28422
28423 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
28424 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
28425 @end table
28426
28427 @noindent
28428 Notes:
28429
28430 @itemize @bullet
28431 @item
28432 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
28433
28434 @item
28435 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
28436 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
28437 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
28438 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
28439 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
28440 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
28441 prior command.
28442
28443 @item
28444 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28445 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
28446 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
28447 prefixed by @samp{+}.
28448
28449 @item
28450 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28451 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
28452 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
28453 @samp{*}.
28454
28455 @item
28456 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28457 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
28458 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
28459 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
28460
28461 @item
28462 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28463 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
28464 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
28465 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
28466
28467 @item
28468 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28469 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
28470 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
28471
28472 @item
28473 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28474 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
28475 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
28476 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
28477
28478 @item
28479 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28480 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
28481 @var{values}.
28482
28483
28484 @end itemize
28485
28486 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
28487 details about the various output records.
28488
28489 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28490 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
28491 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
28492
28493 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
28494 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
28495
28496 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
28497 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
28498 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
28499 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
28500 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
28501 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
28502
28503 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
28504 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
28505 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
28506
28507 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28508 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
28509 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
28510 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
28511
28512 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
28513 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
28514
28515 Since @sc{gdb/mi} is used by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}, changes
28516 to the MI interface may break existing usage. This section describes how the
28517 protocol changes and how to request previous version of the protocol when it
28518 does.
28519
28520 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
28521 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
28522 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
28523 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
28524
28525 @itemize @bullet
28526 @item
28527 New MI commands may be added.
28528
28529 @item
28530 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
28531
28532 @item
28533 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
28534 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
28535
28536 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
28537 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
28538
28539 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
28540 @c resolve inconsistencies.
28541 @end itemize
28542
28543 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
28544 will be increased by one. The new versions of the MI protocol are not compatible
28545 with the old versions. Old versions of MI remain available, allowing front ends
28546 to keep using them until they are modified to use the latest MI version.
28547
28548 Since @code{--interpreter=mi} always points to the latest MI version, it is
28549 recommended that front ends request a specific version of MI when launching
28550 @value{GDBN} (e.g. @code{--interpreter=mi2}) to make sure they get an
28551 interpreter with the MI version they expect.
28552
28553 The following table gives a summary of the the released versions of the MI
28554 interface: the version number, the version of GDB in which it first appeared
28555 and the breaking changes compared to the previous version.
28556
28557 @multitable @columnfractions .05 .05 .9
28558 @headitem MI version @tab GDB version @tab Breaking changes
28559
28560 @item
28561 @center 1
28562 @tab
28563 @center 5.1
28564 @tab
28565 None
28566
28567 @item
28568 @center 2
28569 @tab
28570 @center 6.0
28571 @tab
28572
28573 @itemize
28574 @item
28575 The @code{-environment-pwd}, @code{-environment-directory} and
28576 @code{-environment-path} commands now returns values using the MI output
28577 syntax, rather than CLI output syntax.
28578
28579 @item
28580 @code{-var-list-children}'s @code{children} result field is now a list, rather
28581 than a tuple.
28582
28583 @item
28584 @code{-var-update}'s @code{changelist} result field is now a list, rather than
28585 a tuple.
28586 @end itemize
28587
28588 @item
28589 @center 3
28590 @tab
28591 @center 9.1
28592 @tab
28593
28594 @itemize
28595 @item
28596 The output of information about multi-location breakpoints has changed in the
28597 responses to the @code{-break-insert} and @code{-break-info} commands, as well
28598 as in the @code{=breakpoint-created} and @code{=breakpoint-modified} events.
28599 The multiple locations are now placed in a @code{locations} field, whose value
28600 is a list.
28601 @end itemize
28602
28603 @end multitable
28604
28605 If your front end cannot yet migrate to a more recent version of the
28606 MI protocol, you can nevertheless selectively enable specific features
28607 available in those recent MI versions, using the following commands:
28608
28609 @table @code
28610
28611 @item -fix-multi-location-breakpoint-output
28612 Use the output for multi-location breakpoints which was introduced by
28613 MI 3, even when using MI versions 2 or 1. This command has no
28614 effect when using MI version 3 or later.
28615
28616 @end table
28617
28618 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
28619 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
28620 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
28621 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
28622 @cindex mailing lists
28623
28624 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28625 @node GDB/MI Output Records
28626 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
28627
28628 @menu
28629 * GDB/MI Result Records::
28630 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
28631 * GDB/MI Async Records::
28632 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
28633 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
28634 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
28635 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
28636 @end menu
28637
28638 @node GDB/MI Result Records
28639 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
28640
28641 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
28642 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
28643 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
28644 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
28645
28646 @table @code
28647 @findex ^done
28648 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
28649 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
28650 values.
28651
28652 @item "^running"
28653 @findex ^running
28654 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
28655 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
28656 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
28657 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
28658 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
28659 which threads are resumed.
28660
28661 @item "^connected"
28662 @findex ^connected
28663 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
28664
28665 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
28666 @findex ^error
28667 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
28668 the corresponding error message.
28669
28670 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
28671 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
28672 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
28673
28674 @table @samp
28675 @item "undefined-command"
28676 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
28677 @end table
28678
28679 @item "^exit"
28680 @findex ^exit
28681 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
28682
28683 @end table
28684
28685 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
28686 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
28687
28688 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
28689 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
28690 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
28691 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
28692 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
28693
28694 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
28695 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
28696 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
28697 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
28698 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
28699
28700 @table @code
28701 @item "~" @var{string-output}
28702 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
28703 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
28704
28705 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
28706 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
28707 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
28708 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
28709
28710 @item "&" @var{string-output}
28711 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
28712 internals.
28713 @end table
28714
28715 @node GDB/MI Async Records
28716 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
28717
28718 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
28719 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
28720 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
28721 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
28722 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
28723 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
28724
28725 The following is the list of possible async records:
28726
28727 @table @code
28728
28729 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
28730 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
28731 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
28732 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
28733 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
28734 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
28735 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
28736 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
28737 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
28738 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
28739 it run freely.
28740
28741 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
28742 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
28743 following values:
28744
28745 @table @code
28746 @item breakpoint-hit
28747 A breakpoint was reached.
28748 @item watchpoint-trigger
28749 A watchpoint was triggered.
28750 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
28751 A read watchpoint was triggered.
28752 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
28753 An access watchpoint was triggered.
28754 @item function-finished
28755 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
28756 @item location-reached
28757 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
28758 @item watchpoint-scope
28759 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
28760 @item end-stepping-range
28761 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
28762 similar CLI command was accomplished.
28763 @item exited-signalled
28764 The inferior exited because of a signal.
28765 @item exited
28766 The inferior exited.
28767 @item exited-normally
28768 The inferior exited normally.
28769 @item signal-received
28770 A signal was received by the inferior.
28771 @item solib-event
28772 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
28773 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
28774 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
28775 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
28776 @item fork
28777 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
28778 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28779 @item vfork
28780 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
28781 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28782 @item syscall-entry
28783 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
28784 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28785 @item syscall-return
28786 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
28787 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28788 @item exec
28789 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
28790 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28791 @end table
28792
28793 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
28794 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
28795 Depending on whether all-stop
28796 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
28797 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
28798 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
28799 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
28800 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
28801 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
28802 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
28803 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
28804 if such information is not available.
28805
28806 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
28807 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
28808 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
28809 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
28810 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
28811 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
28812 cannot be used in any way.
28813
28814 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
28815 A thread group became associated with a running program,
28816 either because the program was just started or the thread group
28817 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
28818 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
28819 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
28820
28821 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
28822 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
28823 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
28824 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
28825 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
28826 only when the inferior exited with some code.
28827
28828 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
28829 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
28830 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
28831 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
28832 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
28833
28834 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
28835 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
28836 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
28837 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
28838 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
28839 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
28840 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
28841 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
28842 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
28843
28844 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
28845 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
28846
28847 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
28848 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
28849 that thread.
28850
28851 @item =library-loaded,...
28852 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
28853 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
28854 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
28855 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
28856 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
28857 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
28858 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
28859 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
28860 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
28861 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
28862 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
28863 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
28864 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
28865 to this library.
28866
28867 @item =library-unloaded,...
28868 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
28869 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
28870 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
28871 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
28872 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
28873 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
28874 thread groups.
28875
28876 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
28877 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
28878 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
28879 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
28880 frame is @var{tpnum}.
28881
28882 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
28883 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
28884 initial value @var{initial}.
28885
28886 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
28887 @itemx =tsv-deleted
28888 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
28889 trace state variables are deleted.
28890
28891 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
28892 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
28893 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
28894 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
28895 value of trace state variable is known.
28896
28897 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
28898 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
28899 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
28900 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
28901 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
28902 user.
28903
28904 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
28905 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
28906 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
28907
28908 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
28909 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
28910
28911 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
28912 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
28913 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
28914 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
28915 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
28916
28917 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
28918 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
28919 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
28920 for existing method and format values.
28921
28922 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
28923 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
28924 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
28925 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
28926 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
28927 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
28928
28929 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
28930 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
28931 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
28932 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
28933 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
28934 executable code.
28935 @end table
28936
28937 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
28938 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
28939
28940 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
28941 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
28942 following fields:
28943
28944 @table @code
28945 @item number
28946 The breakpoint number.
28947
28948 @item type
28949 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
28950 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
28951
28952 @item catch-type
28953 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
28954 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
28955
28956 @item disp
28957 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
28958 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
28959 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
28960
28961 @item enabled
28962 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
28963 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
28964 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
28965
28966 @item addr
28967 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
28968 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
28969 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
28970 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
28971 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
28972
28973 @item addr_flags
28974 Optional field containing any flags related to the address. These flags are
28975 architecture-dependent; see @ref{Architectures} for their meaning for a
28976 particular CPU.
28977
28978 @item func
28979 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
28980 If not known, this field is not present.
28981
28982 @item filename
28983 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
28984 If not known, this field is not present.
28985
28986 @item fullname
28987 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
28988 known. If not known, this field is not present.
28989
28990 @item line
28991 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
28992 If not known, this field is not present.
28993
28994 @item at
28995 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
28996 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
28997 by a symbol name.
28998
28999 @item pending
29000 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
29001 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
29002
29003 @item evaluated-by
29004 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
29005 @samp{target}.
29006
29007 @item thread
29008 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
29009 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
29010
29011 @item task
29012 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
29013 field will hold the task identifier.
29014
29015 @item cond
29016 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
29017
29018 @item ignore
29019 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
29020
29021 @item enable
29022 The enable count of the breakpoint.
29023
29024 @item traceframe-usage
29025 FIXME.
29026
29027 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
29028 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
29029
29030 @item mask
29031 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
29032
29033 @item pass
29034 A tracepoint's pass count.
29035
29036 @item original-location
29037 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
29038 This field is optional.
29039
29040 @item times
29041 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
29042
29043 @item installed
29044 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
29045 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
29046 is not.
29047
29048 @item what
29049 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
29050
29051 @item locations
29052 This field is present if the breakpoint has multiple locations. It is also
29053 exceptionally present if the breakpoint is enabled and has a single, disabled
29054 location.
29055
29056 The value is a list of locations. The format of a location is decribed below.
29057
29058 @end table
29059
29060 A location in a multi-location breakpoint is represented as a tuple with the
29061 following fields:
29062
29063 @table @code
29064
29065 @item number
29066 The location number as a dotted pair, like @samp{1.2}. The first digit is the
29067 number of the parent breakpoint. The second digit is the number of the
29068 location within that breakpoint.
29069
29070 @item enabled
29071 This indicates whether the location is enabled, in which case the
29072 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
29073 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
29074
29075 @item addr
29076 The address of this location as an hexidecimal number.
29077
29078 @item addr_flags
29079 Optional field containing any flags related to the address. These flags are
29080 architecture-dependent; see @ref{Architectures} for their meaning for a
29081 particular CPU.
29082
29083 @item func
29084 If known, the function in which the location appears.
29085 If not known, this field is not present.
29086
29087 @item file
29088 The name of the source file which contains this location, if known.
29089 If not known, this field is not present.
29090
29091 @item fullname
29092 The full file name of the source file which contains this location, if
29093 known. If not known, this field is not present.
29094
29095 @item line
29096 The line number at which this location appears, if known.
29097 If not known, this field is not present.
29098
29099 @item thread-groups
29100 The thread groups this location is in.
29101
29102 @end table
29103
29104 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
29105 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
29106
29107 @smallexample
29108 -> -break-insert main
29109 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29110 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
29111 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
29112 times="0"@}
29113 <- (gdb)
29114 @end smallexample
29115
29116 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
29117 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
29118
29119 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
29120 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
29121 fields:
29122
29123 @table @code
29124 @item level
29125 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
29126 zero. This field is always present.
29127
29128 @item func
29129 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
29130 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
29131
29132 @item addr
29133 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
29134
29135 @item addr_flags
29136 Optional field containing any flags related to the address. These flags are
29137 architecture-dependent; see @ref{Architectures} for their meaning for a
29138 particular CPU.
29139
29140 @item file
29141 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
29142 address. This field may be absent.
29143
29144 @item line
29145 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
29146 may be absent.
29147
29148 @item from
29149 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
29150 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
29151
29152 @end table
29153
29154 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
29155 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
29156
29157 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
29158 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
29159 stated otherwise.
29160
29161 @table @code
29162 @item id
29163 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
29164
29165 @item target-id
29166 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
29167
29168 @item details
29169 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
29170 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
29171 frontend. This field is optional.
29172
29173 @item name
29174 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
29175 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
29176 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
29177 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
29178 field is omitted.
29179
29180 @item state
29181 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
29182 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
29183
29184 @item frame
29185 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
29186 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
29187 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
29188
29189 @item core
29190 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
29191 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
29192 @end table
29193
29194 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
29195 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
29196
29197 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
29198 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
29199 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
29200 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
29201 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
29202 the @code{exception-message} field.
29203
29204 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29205 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
29206 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
29207 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
29208
29209 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
29210 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
29211 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
29212 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
29213
29214 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
29215 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
29216
29217 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
29218
29219 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
29220 information of the breakpoint.
29221
29222 @smallexample
29223 -> -break-insert main
29224 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29225 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
29226 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
29227 times="0"@}
29228 <- (gdb)
29229 @end smallexample
29230
29231 @subheading Program Execution
29232
29233 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
29234 reason that execution stopped.
29235
29236 @smallexample
29237 -> -exec-run
29238 <- ^running
29239 <- (gdb)
29240 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
29241 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
29242 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
29243 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
29244 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29245 <- (gdb)
29246 -> -exec-continue
29247 <- ^running
29248 <- (gdb)
29249 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
29250 <- (gdb)
29251 @end smallexample
29252
29253 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
29254
29255 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
29256
29257 @smallexample
29258 -> (gdb)
29259 <- -gdb-exit
29260 <- ^exit
29261 @end smallexample
29262
29263 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
29264 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
29265 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
29266 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
29267 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
29268 fails to exit in reasonable time.
29269
29270 @subheading A Bad Command
29271
29272 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
29273
29274 @smallexample
29275 -> -rubbish
29276 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
29277 <- (gdb)
29278 @end smallexample
29279
29280
29281 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29282 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
29283 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
29284
29285 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
29286 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
29287
29288 @subheading Motivation
29289
29290 The motivation for this collection of commands.
29291
29292 @subheading Introduction
29293
29294 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
29295
29296 @subheading Commands
29297
29298 For each command in the block, the following is described:
29299
29300 @subsubheading Synopsis
29301
29302 @smallexample
29303 -command @var{args}@dots{}
29304 @end smallexample
29305
29306 @subsubheading Result
29307
29308 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29309
29310 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
29311
29312 @subsubheading Example
29313
29314 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
29315 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
29316
29317
29318 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29319 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
29320 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
29321
29322 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
29323 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
29324 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
29325 breakpoints.
29326
29327 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
29328 @findex -break-after
29329
29330 @subsubheading Synopsis
29331
29332 @smallexample
29333 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
29334 @end smallexample
29335
29336 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
29337 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
29338 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
29339 @samp{-break-list} command below.
29340
29341 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29342
29343 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
29344
29345 @subsubheading Example
29346
29347 @smallexample
29348 (gdb)
29349 -break-insert main
29350 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29351 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
29352 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
29353 times="0"@}
29354 (gdb)
29355 -break-after 1 3
29356 ~
29357 ^done
29358 (gdb)
29359 -break-list
29360 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29361 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29362 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29363 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29364 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29365 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29366 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29367 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29368 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29369 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
29370 (gdb)
29371 @end smallexample
29372
29373 @ignore
29374 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
29375 @findex -break-catch
29376 @end ignore
29377
29378 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
29379 @findex -break-commands
29380
29381 @subsubheading Synopsis
29382
29383 @smallexample
29384 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
29385 @end smallexample
29386
29387 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
29388 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
29389 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
29390 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
29391 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
29392 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
29393
29394 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29395
29396 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
29397
29398 @subsubheading Example
29399
29400 @smallexample
29401 (gdb)
29402 -break-insert main
29403 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29404 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
29405 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
29406 times="0"@}
29407 (gdb)
29408 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
29409 ^done
29410 (gdb)
29411 @end smallexample
29412
29413 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
29414 @findex -break-condition
29415
29416 @subsubheading Synopsis
29417
29418 @smallexample
29419 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
29420 @end smallexample
29421
29422 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
29423 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
29424 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
29425 command below).
29426
29427 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29428
29429 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
29430
29431 @subsubheading Example
29432
29433 @smallexample
29434 (gdb)
29435 -break-condition 1 1
29436 ^done
29437 (gdb)
29438 -break-list
29439 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29440 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29441 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29442 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29443 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29444 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29445 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29446 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29447 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29448 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
29449 (gdb)
29450 @end smallexample
29451
29452 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
29453 @findex -break-delete
29454
29455 @subsubheading Synopsis
29456
29457 @smallexample
29458 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
29459 @end smallexample
29460
29461 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
29462 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
29463
29464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29465
29466 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
29467
29468 @subsubheading Example
29469
29470 @smallexample
29471 (gdb)
29472 -break-delete 1
29473 ^done
29474 (gdb)
29475 -break-list
29476 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
29477 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29478 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29479 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29480 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29481 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29482 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29483 body=[]@}
29484 (gdb)
29485 @end smallexample
29486
29487 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
29488 @findex -break-disable
29489
29490 @subsubheading Synopsis
29491
29492 @smallexample
29493 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
29494 @end smallexample
29495
29496 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
29497 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
29498
29499 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29500
29501 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
29502
29503 @subsubheading Example
29504
29505 @smallexample
29506 (gdb)
29507 -break-disable 2
29508 ^done
29509 (gdb)
29510 -break-list
29511 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29512 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29513 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29514 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29515 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29516 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29517 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29518 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
29519 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29520 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29521 (gdb)
29522 @end smallexample
29523
29524 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
29525 @findex -break-enable
29526
29527 @subsubheading Synopsis
29528
29529 @smallexample
29530 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
29531 @end smallexample
29532
29533 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
29534
29535 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29536
29537 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
29538
29539 @subsubheading Example
29540
29541 @smallexample
29542 (gdb)
29543 -break-enable 2
29544 ^done
29545 (gdb)
29546 -break-list
29547 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29548 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29549 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29550 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29551 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29552 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29553 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29554 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29555 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29556 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29557 (gdb)
29558 @end smallexample
29559
29560 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
29561 @findex -break-info
29562
29563 @subsubheading Synopsis
29564
29565 @smallexample
29566 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
29567 @end smallexample
29568
29569 @c REDUNDANT???
29570 Get information about a single breakpoint.
29571
29572 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
29573 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
29574 table.
29575
29576 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29577
29578 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
29579
29580 @subsubheading Example
29581 N.A.
29582
29583 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
29584 @findex -break-insert
29585 @anchor{-break-insert}
29586
29587 @subsubheading Synopsis
29588
29589 @smallexample
29590 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
29591 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
29592 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
29593 @end smallexample
29594
29595 @noindent
29596 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
29597
29598 @table @var
29599 @item linespec location
29600 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
29601
29602 @item explicit location
29603 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
29604 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
29605 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
29606
29607 @table @samp
29608 @item --source @var{filename}
29609 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
29610 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
29611
29612 @item --function @var{function}
29613 The name of a function or method.
29614
29615 @item --label @var{label}
29616 The name of a label.
29617
29618 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
29619 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
29620 @end table
29621
29622 @item address location
29623 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
29624 @end table
29625
29626 @noindent
29627 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
29628
29629 @table @samp
29630 @item -t
29631 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
29632 @item -h
29633 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
29634 @item -f
29635 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
29636 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
29637 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
29638 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
29639 cannot be parsed.
29640 @item -d
29641 Create a disabled breakpoint.
29642 @item -a
29643 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
29644 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
29645 @item -c @var{condition}
29646 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29647 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
29648 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
29649 @item -p @var{thread-id}
29650 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
29651 @var{thread-id}.
29652 @end table
29653
29654 @subsubheading Result
29655
29656 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
29657 resulting breakpoint.
29658
29659 Note: this format is open to change.
29660 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
29661
29662 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29663
29664 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
29665 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
29666
29667 @subsubheading Example
29668
29669 @smallexample
29670 (gdb)
29671 -break-insert main
29672 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
29673 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
29674 times="0"@}
29675 (gdb)
29676 -break-insert -t foo
29677 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
29678 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
29679 times="0"@}
29680 (gdb)
29681 -break-list
29682 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29683 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29684 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29685 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29686 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29687 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29688 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29689 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29690 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
29691 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
29692 times="0"@},
29693 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
29694 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
29695 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
29696 times="0"@}]@}
29697 (gdb)
29698 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
29699 @c ~int foo(int, int);
29700 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
29701 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
29702 @c times="0"@}
29703 @c (gdb)
29704 @end smallexample
29705
29706 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
29707 @findex -dprintf-insert
29708
29709 @subsubheading Synopsis
29710
29711 @smallexample
29712 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
29713 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
29714 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
29715 [ @var{argument} ]
29716 @end smallexample
29717
29718 @noindent
29719 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
29720 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
29721
29722 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
29723
29724 @table @samp
29725 @item -t
29726 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
29727 @item -f
29728 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
29729 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
29730 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
29731 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
29732 cannot be parsed.
29733 @item -d
29734 Create a disabled breakpoint.
29735 @item -c @var{condition}
29736 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29737 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
29738 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
29739 to @var{ignore-count}.
29740 @item -p @var{thread-id}
29741 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
29742 @var{thread-id}.
29743 @end table
29744
29745 @subsubheading Result
29746
29747 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
29748 resulting breakpoint.
29749
29750 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
29751
29752 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29753
29754 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
29755
29756 @subsubheading Example
29757
29758 @smallexample
29759 (gdb)
29760 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
29761 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29762 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
29763 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
29764 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
29765 original-location="foo"@}
29766 (gdb)
29767 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
29768 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29769 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
29770 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
29771 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
29772 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
29773 (gdb)
29774 @end smallexample
29775
29776 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
29777 @findex -break-list
29778
29779 @subsubheading Synopsis
29780
29781 @smallexample
29782 -break-list
29783 @end smallexample
29784
29785 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
29786
29787 @table @samp
29788 @item Number
29789 number of the breakpoint
29790 @item Type
29791 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
29792 @item Disposition
29793 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
29794 or @samp{nokeep}
29795 @item Enabled
29796 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
29797 @item Address
29798 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
29799 @item What
29800 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
29801 name, line number
29802 @item Thread-groups
29803 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
29804 @item Times
29805 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
29806 @end table
29807
29808 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
29809 @code{body} field is an empty list.
29810
29811 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29812
29813 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
29814
29815 @subsubheading Example
29816
29817 @smallexample
29818 (gdb)
29819 -break-list
29820 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29821 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29822 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29823 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29824 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29825 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29826 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29827 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29828 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
29829 times="0"@},
29830 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29831 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29832 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29833 (gdb)
29834 @end smallexample
29835
29836 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
29837
29838 @smallexample
29839 (gdb)
29840 -break-list
29841 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
29842 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29843 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29844 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29845 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29846 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29847 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29848 body=[]@}
29849 (gdb)
29850 @end smallexample
29851
29852 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
29853 @findex -break-passcount
29854
29855 @subsubheading Synopsis
29856
29857 @smallexample
29858 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
29859 @end smallexample
29860
29861 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
29862 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
29863 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
29864 command @samp{passcount}.
29865
29866 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
29867 @findex -break-watch
29868
29869 @subsubheading Synopsis
29870
29871 @smallexample
29872 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
29873 @end smallexample
29874
29875 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
29876 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
29877 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
29878 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
29879 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
29880 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
29881 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
29882 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
29883
29884 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
29885 breakpoints inserted.
29886
29887 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29888
29889 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
29890 @samp{rwatch}.
29891
29892 @subsubheading Example
29893
29894 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
29895
29896 @smallexample
29897 (gdb)
29898 -break-watch x
29899 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
29900 (gdb)
29901 -exec-continue
29902 ^running
29903 (gdb)
29904 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
29905 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
29906 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29907 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29908 (gdb)
29909 @end smallexample
29910
29911 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
29912 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
29913 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
29914
29915 @smallexample
29916 (gdb)
29917 -break-watch C
29918 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
29919 (gdb)
29920 -exec-continue
29921 ^running
29922 (gdb)
29923 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
29924 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29925 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29926 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29927 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29928 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29929 (gdb)
29930 -exec-continue
29931 ^running
29932 (gdb)
29933 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
29934 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29935 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29936 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29937 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29938 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29939 (gdb)
29940 @end smallexample
29941
29942 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
29943 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
29944 deleted.
29945
29946 @smallexample
29947 (gdb)
29948 -break-watch C
29949 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
29950 (gdb)
29951 -break-list
29952 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29953 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29954 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29955 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29956 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29957 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29958 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29959 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29960 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29961 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29962 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
29963 times="1"@},
29964 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
29965 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29966 (gdb)
29967 -exec-continue
29968 ^running
29969 (gdb)
29970 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
29971 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29972 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29973 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29974 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29975 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29976 (gdb)
29977 -break-list
29978 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29979 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29980 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29981 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29982 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29983 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29984 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29985 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29986 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29987 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29988 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
29989 times="1"@},
29990 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
29991 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
29992 (gdb)
29993 -exec-continue
29994 ^running
29995 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
29996 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29997 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29998 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29999 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
30000 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30001 (gdb)
30002 -break-list
30003 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
30004 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30005 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30006 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30007 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30008 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30009 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30010 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30011 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30012 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30013 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30014 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
30015 (gdb)
30016 @end smallexample
30017
30018
30019 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30020 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30021 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
30022
30023 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
30024 catchpoints.
30025
30026 @menu
30027 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
30028 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
30029 * C++ Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
30030 @end menu
30031
30032 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30033 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
30034
30035 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
30036 @findex -catch-load
30037
30038 @subsubheading Synopsis
30039
30040 @smallexample
30041 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
30042 @end smallexample
30043
30044 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
30045 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
30046 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
30047 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
30048 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
30049
30050
30051 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30052
30053 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
30054
30055 @subsubheading Example
30056
30057 @smallexample
30058 -catch-load -t foo.so
30059 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
30060 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
30061 (gdb)
30062 @end smallexample
30063
30064
30065 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
30066 @findex -catch-unload
30067
30068 @subsubheading Synopsis
30069
30070 @smallexample
30071 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
30072 @end smallexample
30073
30074 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
30075 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
30076 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
30077 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
30078 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
30079
30080 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30081
30082 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
30083
30084 @subsubheading Example
30085
30086 @smallexample
30087 -catch-unload -d bar.so
30088 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
30089 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
30090 (gdb)
30091 @end smallexample
30092
30093 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30094 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
30095
30096 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
30097 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
30098
30099 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
30100 @findex -catch-assert
30101
30102 @subsubheading Synopsis
30103
30104 @smallexample
30105 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
30106 @end smallexample
30107
30108 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
30109
30110 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
30111
30112 @table @samp
30113 @item -c @var{condition}
30114 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30115 @item -d
30116 Create a disabled catchpoint.
30117 @item -t
30118 Create a temporary catchpoint.
30119 @end table
30120
30121 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30122
30123 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
30124
30125 @subsubheading Example
30126
30127 @smallexample
30128 -catch-assert
30129 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30130 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
30131 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
30132 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
30133 (gdb)
30134 @end smallexample
30135
30136 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
30137 @findex -catch-exception
30138
30139 @subsubheading Synopsis
30140
30141 @smallexample
30142 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
30143 [ -t ] [ -u ]
30144 @end smallexample
30145
30146 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
30147 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
30148 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
30149 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
30150 catchpoints.
30151
30152 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
30153
30154 @table @samp
30155 @item -c @var{condition}
30156 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30157 @item -d
30158 Create a disabled catchpoint.
30159 @item -e @var{exception-name}
30160 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
30161 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
30162 @item -t
30163 Create a temporary catchpoint.
30164 @item -u
30165 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
30166 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
30167 @end table
30168
30169 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30170
30171 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
30172 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
30173
30174 @subsubheading Example
30175
30176 @smallexample
30177 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
30178 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30179 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
30180 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
30181 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
30182 (gdb)
30183 @end smallexample
30184
30185 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
30186 @findex -catch-handlers
30187
30188 @subsubheading Synopsis
30189
30190 @smallexample
30191 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
30192 [ -t ]
30193 @end smallexample
30194
30195 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
30196 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
30197 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
30198 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
30199 catchpoints.
30200
30201 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
30202
30203 @table @samp
30204 @item -c @var{condition}
30205 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30206 @item -d
30207 Create a disabled catchpoint.
30208 @item -e @var{exception-name}
30209 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
30210 @item -t
30211 Create a temporary catchpoint.
30212 @end table
30213
30214 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30215
30216 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
30217
30218 @subsubheading Example
30219
30220 @smallexample
30221 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
30222 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30223 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
30224 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
30225 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
30226 (gdb)
30227 @end smallexample
30228
30229 @node C++ Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30230 @subsection C@t{++} Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
30231
30232 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
30233 that stop the execution when C@t{++} exceptions are being throw, rethrown,
30234 or caught.
30235
30236 @subheading The @code{-catch-throw} Command
30237 @findex -catch-throw
30238
30239 @subsubheading Synopsis
30240
30241 @smallexample
30242 -catch-throw [ -t ] [ -r @var{regexp}]
30243 @end smallexample
30244
30245 Stop when the debuggee throws a C@t{++} exception. If @var{regexp} is
30246 given, then only exceptions whose type matches the regular expression
30247 will be caught.
30248
30249 If @samp{-t} is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one
30250 stop, the catchpoint is automatically deleted after stopping once for
30251 the event.
30252
30253 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30254
30255 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch throw}
30256 and @samp{tcatch throw} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
30257
30258 @subsubheading Example
30259
30260 @smallexample
30261 -catch-throw -r exception_type
30262 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30263 what="exception throw",catch-type="throw",
30264 thread-groups=["i1"],
30265 regexp="exception_type",times="0"@}
30266 (gdb)
30267 -exec-run
30268 ^running
30269 (gdb)
30270 ~"\n"
30271 ~"Catchpoint 1 (exception thrown), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
30272 in __cxa_throw () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
30273 *stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
30274 frame=@{addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_throw",
30275 args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"@},
30276 thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
30277 (gdb)
30278 @end smallexample
30279
30280 @subheading The @code{-catch-rethrow} Command
30281 @findex -catch-rethrow
30282
30283 @subsubheading Synopsis
30284
30285 @smallexample
30286 -catch-rethrow [ -t ] [ -r @var{regexp}]
30287 @end smallexample
30288
30289 Stop when a C@t{++} exception is re-thrown. If @var{regexp} is given,
30290 then only exceptions whose type matches the regular expression will be
30291 caught.
30292
30293 If @samp{-t} is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one
30294 stop, the catchpoint is automatically deleted after the first event is
30295 caught.
30296
30297 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30298
30299 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch rethrow}
30300 and @samp{tcatch rethrow} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
30301
30302 @subsubheading Example
30303
30304 @smallexample
30305 -catch-rethrow -r exception_type
30306 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30307 what="exception rethrow",catch-type="rethrow",
30308 thread-groups=["i1"],
30309 regexp="exception_type",times="0"@}
30310 (gdb)
30311 -exec-run
30312 ^running
30313 (gdb)
30314 ~"\n"
30315 ~"Catchpoint 1 (exception rethrown), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
30316 in __cxa_rethrow () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
30317 *stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
30318 frame=@{addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_rethrow",
30319 args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"@},
30320 thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
30321 (gdb)
30322 @end smallexample
30323
30324 @subheading The @code{-catch-catch} Command
30325 @findex -catch-catch
30326
30327 @subsubheading Synopsis
30328
30329 @smallexample
30330 -catch-catch [ -t ] [ -r @var{regexp}]
30331 @end smallexample
30332
30333 Stop when the debuggee catches a C@t{++} exception. If @var{regexp}
30334 is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the regular
30335 expression will be caught.
30336
30337 If @samp{-t} is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one
30338 stop, the catchpoint is automatically deleted after the first event is
30339 caught.
30340
30341 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30342
30343 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch catch}
30344 and @samp{tcatch catch} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
30345
30346 @subsubheading Example
30347
30348 @smallexample
30349 -catch-catch -r exception_type
30350 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30351 what="exception catch",catch-type="catch",
30352 thread-groups=["i1"],
30353 regexp="exception_type",times="0"@}
30354 (gdb)
30355 -exec-run
30356 ^running
30357 (gdb)
30358 ~"\n"
30359 ~"Catchpoint 1 (exception caught), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
30360 in __cxa_begin_catch () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
30361 *stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
30362 frame=@{addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_begin_catch",
30363 args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"@},
30364 thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
30365 (gdb)
30366 @end smallexample
30367
30368 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30369 @node GDB/MI Program Context
30370 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
30371
30372 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
30373 @findex -exec-arguments
30374
30375
30376 @subsubheading Synopsis
30377
30378 @smallexample
30379 -exec-arguments @var{args}
30380 @end smallexample
30381
30382 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
30383 @samp{-exec-run}.
30384
30385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30386
30387 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
30388
30389 @subsubheading Example
30390
30391 @smallexample
30392 (gdb)
30393 -exec-arguments -v word
30394 ^done
30395 (gdb)
30396 @end smallexample
30397
30398
30399 @ignore
30400 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
30401 @findex -exec-show-arguments
30402
30403 @subsubheading Synopsis
30404
30405 @smallexample
30406 -exec-show-arguments
30407 @end smallexample
30408
30409 Print the arguments of the program.
30410
30411 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30412
30413 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
30414
30415 @subsubheading Example
30416 N.A.
30417 @end ignore
30418
30419
30420 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
30421 @findex -environment-cd
30422
30423 @subsubheading Synopsis
30424
30425 @smallexample
30426 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
30427 @end smallexample
30428
30429 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
30430
30431 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30432
30433 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
30434
30435 @subsubheading Example
30436
30437 @smallexample
30438 (gdb)
30439 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
30440 ^done
30441 (gdb)
30442 @end smallexample
30443
30444
30445 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
30446 @findex -environment-directory
30447
30448 @subsubheading Synopsis
30449
30450 @smallexample
30451 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
30452 @end smallexample
30453
30454 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
30455 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
30456 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
30457 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
30458 occurs as normal.
30459 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
30460 multiple directories in a single command
30461 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
30462 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
30463 If blanks are needed as
30464 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
30465 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
30466 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
30467 character must not be used
30468 in any directory name.
30469 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
30470
30471 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30472
30473 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
30474
30475 @subsubheading Example
30476
30477 @smallexample
30478 (gdb)
30479 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
30480 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
30481 (gdb)
30482 -environment-directory ""
30483 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
30484 (gdb)
30485 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
30486 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
30487 (gdb)
30488 -environment-directory -r
30489 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
30490 (gdb)
30491 @end smallexample
30492
30493
30494 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
30495 @findex -environment-path
30496
30497 @subsubheading Synopsis
30498
30499 @smallexample
30500 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
30501 @end smallexample
30502
30503 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
30504 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
30505 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
30506 supplied in addition to the
30507 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
30508 occurs as normal.
30509 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
30510 multiple directories in a single command
30511 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
30512 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
30513 If blanks are needed as
30514 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
30515 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
30516 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
30517 character must not be used
30518 in any directory name.
30519 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
30520
30521
30522 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30523
30524 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
30525
30526 @subsubheading Example
30527
30528 @smallexample
30529 (gdb)
30530 -environment-path
30531 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
30532 (gdb)
30533 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
30534 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
30535 (gdb)
30536 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
30537 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
30538 (gdb)
30539 @end smallexample
30540
30541
30542 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
30543 @findex -environment-pwd
30544
30545 @subsubheading Synopsis
30546
30547 @smallexample
30548 -environment-pwd
30549 @end smallexample
30550
30551 Show the current working directory.
30552
30553 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30554
30555 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
30556
30557 @subsubheading Example
30558
30559 @smallexample
30560 (gdb)
30561 -environment-pwd
30562 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
30563 (gdb)
30564 @end smallexample
30565
30566 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30567 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
30568 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
30569
30570
30571 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
30572 @findex -thread-info
30573
30574 @subsubheading Synopsis
30575
30576 @smallexample
30577 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
30578 @end smallexample
30579
30580 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
30581 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
30582 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
30583 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
30584 current thread.
30585
30586 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30587
30588 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
30589 about all threads.
30590
30591 @subsubheading Result
30592
30593 The result contains the following attributes:
30594
30595 @table @samp
30596 @item threads
30597 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
30598 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
30599
30600 @item current-thread-id
30601 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
30602 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
30603 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
30604 the command.
30605
30606 @end table
30607
30608 @subsubheading Example
30609
30610 @smallexample
30611 -thread-info
30612 ^done,threads=[
30613 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
30614 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
30615 args=[]@},state="running"@},
30616 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
30617 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
30618 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
30619 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30620 state="running"@}],
30621 current-thread-id="1"
30622 (gdb)
30623 @end smallexample
30624
30625 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
30626 @findex -thread-list-ids
30627
30628 @subsubheading Synopsis
30629
30630 @smallexample
30631 -thread-list-ids
30632 @end smallexample
30633
30634 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
30635 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
30636 threads.
30637
30638 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
30639 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
30640
30641 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30642
30643 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
30644
30645 @subsubheading Example
30646
30647 @smallexample
30648 (gdb)
30649 -thread-list-ids
30650 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
30651 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
30652 (gdb)
30653 @end smallexample
30654
30655
30656 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
30657 @findex -thread-select
30658
30659 @subsubheading Synopsis
30660
30661 @smallexample
30662 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
30663 @end smallexample
30664
30665 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
30666 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
30667 topmost frame for that thread.
30668
30669 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
30670 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
30671
30672 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30673
30674 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
30675
30676 @subsubheading Example
30677
30678 @smallexample
30679 (gdb)
30680 -exec-next
30681 ^running
30682 (gdb)
30683 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
30684 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
30685 (gdb)
30686 -thread-list-ids
30687 ^done,
30688 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
30689 number-of-threads="3"
30690 (gdb)
30691 -thread-select 3
30692 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
30693 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
30694 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
30695 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30696 (gdb)
30697 @end smallexample
30698
30699 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30700 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
30701 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
30702
30703 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
30704 @findex -ada-task-info
30705
30706 @subsubheading Synopsis
30707
30708 @smallexample
30709 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
30710 @end smallexample
30711
30712 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
30713 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
30714
30715 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30716
30717 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
30718 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
30719
30720 @subsubheading Result
30721
30722 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
30723 defined for each Ada task:
30724
30725 @table @samp
30726 @item current
30727 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
30728
30729 @item id
30730 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
30731
30732 @item task-id
30733 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
30734
30735 @item thread-id
30736 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
30737 task.
30738
30739 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
30740 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
30741 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
30742
30743 @item parent-id
30744 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
30745 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
30746
30747 @item priority
30748 The base priority of the task.
30749
30750 @item state
30751 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
30752 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
30753
30754 @item name
30755 The name of the task.
30756
30757 @end table
30758
30759 @subsubheading Example
30760
30761 @smallexample
30762 -ada-task-info
30763 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
30764 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
30765 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
30766 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
30767 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
30768 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
30769 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
30770 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
30771 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
30772 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
30773 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
30774 (gdb)
30775 @end smallexample
30776
30777 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30778 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
30779 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
30780
30781 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
30782 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
30783 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
30784 other cases.
30785
30786 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
30787 @findex -exec-continue
30788
30789 @subsubheading Synopsis
30790
30791 @smallexample
30792 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
30793 @end smallexample
30794
30795 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
30796 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
30797 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
30798 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
30799 @itemize @bullet
30800 @item
30801 breakpoints or watchpoints
30802 @item
30803 signals or exceptions
30804 @item
30805 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
30806 @item
30807 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
30808 @end itemize
30809 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
30810 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
30811 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
30812 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
30813 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
30814 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
30815
30816 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30817
30818 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
30819
30820 @subsubheading Example
30821
30822 @smallexample
30823 -exec-continue
30824 ^running
30825 (gdb)
30826 @@Hello world
30827 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
30828 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
30829 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30830 (gdb)
30831 @end smallexample
30832
30833
30834 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
30835 @findex -exec-finish
30836
30837 @subsubheading Synopsis
30838
30839 @smallexample
30840 -exec-finish [--reverse]
30841 @end smallexample
30842
30843 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
30844 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
30845 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
30846 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
30847 function was called.
30848
30849 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30850
30851 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
30852
30853 @subsubheading Example
30854
30855 Function returning @code{void}.
30856
30857 @smallexample
30858 -exec-finish
30859 ^running
30860 (gdb)
30861 @@hello from foo
30862 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
30863 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30864 (gdb)
30865 @end smallexample
30866
30867 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
30868 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
30869 value itself.
30870
30871 @smallexample
30872 -exec-finish
30873 ^running
30874 (gdb)
30875 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
30876 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
30877 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30878 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30879 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
30880 (gdb)
30881 @end smallexample
30882
30883
30884 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
30885 @findex -exec-interrupt
30886
30887 @subsubheading Synopsis
30888
30889 @smallexample
30890 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
30891 @end smallexample
30892
30893 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
30894 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
30895 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
30896 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
30897 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
30898
30899 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
30900 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
30901 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
30902 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
30903
30904 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
30905 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
30906 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
30907 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
30908
30909 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30910
30911 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
30912
30913 @subsubheading Example
30914
30915 @smallexample
30916 (gdb)
30917 111-exec-continue
30918 111^running
30919
30920 (gdb)
30921 222-exec-interrupt
30922 222^done
30923 (gdb)
30924 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
30925 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30926 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30927 (gdb)
30928
30929 (gdb)
30930 -exec-interrupt
30931 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
30932 (gdb)
30933 @end smallexample
30934
30935 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
30936 @findex -exec-jump
30937
30938 @subsubheading Synopsis
30939
30940 @smallexample
30941 -exec-jump @var{location}
30942 @end smallexample
30943
30944 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
30945 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
30946 different forms of @var{location}.
30947
30948 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30949
30950 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
30951
30952 @subsubheading Example
30953
30954 @smallexample
30955 -exec-jump foo.c:10
30956 *running,thread-id="all"
30957 ^running
30958 @end smallexample
30959
30960
30961 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
30962 @findex -exec-next
30963
30964 @subsubheading Synopsis
30965
30966 @smallexample
30967 -exec-next [--reverse]
30968 @end smallexample
30969
30970 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
30971 of the next source line is reached.
30972
30973 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
30974 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
30975 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
30976 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
30977 source line where the function was called.
30978
30979
30980 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30981
30982 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
30983
30984 @subsubheading Example
30985
30986 @smallexample
30987 -exec-next
30988 ^running
30989 (gdb)
30990 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
30991 (gdb)
30992 @end smallexample
30993
30994
30995 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
30996 @findex -exec-next-instruction
30997
30998 @subsubheading Synopsis
30999
31000 @smallexample
31001 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
31002 @end smallexample
31003
31004 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
31005 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
31006 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
31007 printed as well.
31008
31009 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
31010 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
31011 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
31012 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
31013 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
31014
31015 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31016
31017 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
31018
31019 @subsubheading Example
31020
31021 @smallexample
31022 (gdb)
31023 -exec-next-instruction
31024 ^running
31025
31026 (gdb)
31027 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31028 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
31029 (gdb)
31030 @end smallexample
31031
31032
31033 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
31034 @findex -exec-return
31035
31036 @subsubheading Synopsis
31037
31038 @smallexample
31039 -exec-return
31040 @end smallexample
31041
31042 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
31043 Displays the new current frame.
31044
31045 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31046
31047 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
31048
31049 @subsubheading Example
31050
31051 @smallexample
31052 (gdb)
31053 200-break-insert callee4
31054 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
31055 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
31056 (gdb)
31057 000-exec-run
31058 000^running
31059 (gdb)
31060 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
31061 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
31062 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31063 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
31064 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31065 (gdb)
31066 205-break-delete
31067 205^done
31068 (gdb)
31069 111-exec-return
31070 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
31071 args=[@{name="strarg",
31072 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
31073 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31074 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
31075 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31076 (gdb)
31077 @end smallexample
31078
31079
31080 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
31081 @findex -exec-run
31082
31083 @subsubheading Synopsis
31084
31085 @smallexample
31086 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
31087 @end smallexample
31088
31089 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
31090 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
31091 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
31092 the program has exited exceptionally.
31093
31094 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
31095 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
31096 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
31097 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
31098 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
31099
31100 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
31101 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
31102 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
31103 (@pxref{Starting}).
31104
31105 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31106
31107 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
31108
31109 @subsubheading Examples
31110
31111 @smallexample
31112 (gdb)
31113 -break-insert main
31114 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
31115 (gdb)
31116 -exec-run
31117 ^running
31118 (gdb)
31119 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
31120 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
31121 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31122 (gdb)
31123 @end smallexample
31124
31125 @noindent
31126 Program exited normally:
31127
31128 @smallexample
31129 (gdb)
31130 -exec-run
31131 ^running
31132 (gdb)
31133 x = 55
31134 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
31135 (gdb)
31136 @end smallexample
31137
31138 @noindent
31139 Program exited exceptionally:
31140
31141 @smallexample
31142 (gdb)
31143 -exec-run
31144 ^running
31145 (gdb)
31146 x = 55
31147 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
31148 (gdb)
31149 @end smallexample
31150
31151 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
31152 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
31153
31154 @smallexample
31155 (gdb)
31156 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
31157 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
31158 @end smallexample
31159
31160
31161 @c @subheading -exec-signal
31162
31163
31164 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
31165 @findex -exec-step
31166
31167 @subsubheading Synopsis
31168
31169 @smallexample
31170 -exec-step [--reverse]
31171 @end smallexample
31172
31173 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
31174 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
31175 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
31176 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
31177 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
31178 previously executed source line.
31179
31180 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31181
31182 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
31183
31184 @subsubheading Example
31185
31186 Stepping into a function:
31187
31188 @smallexample
31189 -exec-step
31190 ^running
31191 (gdb)
31192 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31193 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
31194 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
31195 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31196 (gdb)
31197 @end smallexample
31198
31199 Regular stepping:
31200
31201 @smallexample
31202 -exec-step
31203 ^running
31204 (gdb)
31205 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
31206 (gdb)
31207 @end smallexample
31208
31209
31210 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
31211 @findex -exec-step-instruction
31212
31213 @subsubheading Synopsis
31214
31215 @smallexample
31216 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
31217 @end smallexample
31218
31219 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
31220 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
31221 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
31222 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
31223 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
31224 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
31225 as well.
31226
31227 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31228
31229 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
31230
31231 @subsubheading Example
31232
31233 @smallexample
31234 (gdb)
31235 -exec-step-instruction
31236 ^running
31237
31238 (gdb)
31239 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31240 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
31241 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31242 (gdb)
31243 -exec-step-instruction
31244 ^running
31245
31246 (gdb)
31247 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31248 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
31249 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31250 (gdb)
31251 @end smallexample
31252
31253
31254 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
31255 @findex -exec-until
31256
31257 @subsubheading Synopsis
31258
31259 @smallexample
31260 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
31261 @end smallexample
31262
31263 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
31264 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
31265 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
31266 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
31267
31268 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31269
31270 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
31271
31272 @subsubheading Example
31273
31274 @smallexample
31275 (gdb)
31276 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
31277 ^running
31278 (gdb)
31279 x = 55
31280 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
31281 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
31282 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31283 (gdb)
31284 @end smallexample
31285
31286 @ignore
31287 @subheading -file-clear
31288 Is this going away????
31289 @end ignore
31290
31291 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31292 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
31293 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
31294
31295 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
31296 @findex -enable-frame-filters
31297
31298 @smallexample
31299 -enable-frame-filters
31300 @end smallexample
31301
31302 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
31303 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
31304 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
31305 request that this functionality be enabled.
31306
31307 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
31308
31309 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
31310 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
31311
31312 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
31313 @findex -stack-info-frame
31314
31315 @subsubheading Synopsis
31316
31317 @smallexample
31318 -stack-info-frame
31319 @end smallexample
31320
31321 Get info on the selected frame.
31322
31323 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31324
31325 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
31326 (without arguments).
31327
31328 @subsubheading Example
31329
31330 @smallexample
31331 (gdb)
31332 -stack-info-frame
31333 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
31334 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31335 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
31336 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31337 (gdb)
31338 @end smallexample
31339
31340 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
31341 @findex -stack-info-depth
31342
31343 @subsubheading Synopsis
31344
31345 @smallexample
31346 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
31347 @end smallexample
31348
31349 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
31350 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
31351
31352 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31353
31354 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31355
31356 @subsubheading Example
31357
31358 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
31359
31360 @smallexample
31361 (gdb)
31362 -stack-info-depth
31363 ^done,depth="12"
31364 (gdb)
31365 -stack-info-depth 4
31366 ^done,depth="4"
31367 (gdb)
31368 -stack-info-depth 12
31369 ^done,depth="12"
31370 (gdb)
31371 -stack-info-depth 11
31372 ^done,depth="11"
31373 (gdb)
31374 -stack-info-depth 13
31375 ^done,depth="12"
31376 (gdb)
31377 @end smallexample
31378
31379 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
31380 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
31381 @findex -stack-list-arguments
31382
31383 @subsubheading Synopsis
31384
31385 @smallexample
31386 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
31387 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
31388 @end smallexample
31389
31390 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
31391 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
31392 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
31393 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
31394 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
31395 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
31396 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
31397 which case only existing frames will be returned.
31398
31399 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
31400 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
31401 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
31402 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
31403 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
31404 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
31405
31406 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
31407 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
31408 are still displayed, however.
31409
31410 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
31411 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
31412
31413 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31414
31415 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
31416 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
31417 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
31418
31419 @subsubheading Example
31420
31421 @smallexample
31422 (gdb)
31423 -stack-list-frames
31424 ^done,
31425 stack=[
31426 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
31427 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31428 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
31429 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31430 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
31431 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31432 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
31433 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31434 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
31435 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31436 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
31437 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31438 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
31439 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31440 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
31441 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31442 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
31443 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31444 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
31445 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
31446 (gdb)
31447 -stack-list-arguments 0
31448 ^done,
31449 stack-args=[
31450 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
31451 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
31452 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
31453 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
31454 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
31455 (gdb)
31456 -stack-list-arguments 1
31457 ^done,
31458 stack-args=[
31459 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
31460 frame=@{level="1",
31461 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
31462 frame=@{level="2",args=[
31463 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
31464 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
31465 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
31466 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
31467 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
31468 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
31469 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
31470 (gdb)
31471 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
31472 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
31473 (gdb)
31474 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
31475 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
31476 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
31477 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
31478 (gdb)
31479 @end smallexample
31480
31481 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
31482
31483
31484 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
31485 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
31486 @findex -stack-list-frames
31487
31488 @subsubheading Synopsis
31489
31490 @smallexample
31491 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
31492 @end smallexample
31493
31494 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
31495 following info:
31496
31497 @table @samp
31498 @item @var{level}
31499 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
31500 @item @var{addr}
31501 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
31502 @item @var{func}
31503 Function name.
31504 @item @var{file}
31505 File name of the source file where the function lives.
31506 @item @var{fullname}
31507 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
31508 @item @var{line}
31509 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
31510 @item @var{from}
31511 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
31512 if the frame's function is not known.
31513 @item @var{arch}
31514 Frame's architecture.
31515 @end table
31516
31517 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
31518 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
31519 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
31520 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
31521 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
31522 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
31523 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
31524 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
31525 Python frame filters will not be executed.
31526
31527 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31528
31529 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
31530
31531 @subsubheading Example
31532
31533 Full stack backtrace:
31534
31535 @smallexample
31536 (gdb)
31537 -stack-list-frames
31538 ^done,stack=
31539 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
31540 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
31541 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31542 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31543 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31544 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31545 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31546 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31547 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31548 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31549 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31550 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31551 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31552 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31553 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31554 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31555 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31556 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31557 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31558 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31559 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31560 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31561 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31562 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31563 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31564 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31565 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31566 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31567 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31568 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31569 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31570 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31571 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31572 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
31573 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
31574 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
31575 (gdb)
31576 @end smallexample
31577
31578 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
31579
31580 @smallexample
31581 (gdb)
31582 -stack-list-frames 3 5
31583 ^done,stack=
31584 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31585 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31586 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31587 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31588 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31589 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31590 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31591 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31592 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
31593 (gdb)
31594 @end smallexample
31595
31596 Show a single frame:
31597
31598 @smallexample
31599 (gdb)
31600 -stack-list-frames 3 3
31601 ^done,stack=
31602 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31603 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31604 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
31605 (gdb)
31606 @end smallexample
31607
31608
31609 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
31610 @findex -stack-list-locals
31611 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
31612
31613 @subsubheading Synopsis
31614
31615 @smallexample
31616 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
31617 @end smallexample
31618
31619 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
31620 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
31621 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
31622 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
31623 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
31624 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
31625 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
31626 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
31627 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
31628 Python frame filters will not be executed.
31629
31630 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
31631 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
31632 variables are still displayed, however.
31633
31634 This command is deprecated in favor of the
31635 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
31636
31637 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31638
31639 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
31640
31641 @subsubheading Example
31642
31643 @smallexample
31644 (gdb)
31645 -stack-list-locals 0
31646 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
31647 (gdb)
31648 -stack-list-locals --all-values
31649 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
31650 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
31651 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
31652 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
31653 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
31654 (gdb)
31655 @end smallexample
31656
31657 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
31658 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
31659 @findex -stack-list-variables
31660
31661 @subsubheading Synopsis
31662
31663 @smallexample
31664 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
31665 @end smallexample
31666
31667 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
31668 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
31669 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
31670 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
31671 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
31672 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
31673 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
31674
31675 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
31676 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
31677 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
31678
31679 @subsubheading Example
31680
31681 @smallexample
31682 (gdb)
31683 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
31684 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
31685 (gdb)
31686 @end smallexample
31687
31688
31689 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
31690 @findex -stack-select-frame
31691
31692 @subsubheading Synopsis
31693
31694 @smallexample
31695 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
31696 @end smallexample
31697
31698 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
31699 the stack.
31700
31701 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
31702 option to every command.
31703
31704 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31705
31706 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
31707 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
31708
31709 @subsubheading Example
31710
31711 @smallexample
31712 (gdb)
31713 -stack-select-frame 2
31714 ^done
31715 (gdb)
31716 @end smallexample
31717
31718 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31719 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
31720 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
31721
31722 @ignore
31723
31724 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
31725
31726 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
31727 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
31728 used by @code{Insight}.
31729
31730 The two main reasons for that are:
31731
31732 @enumerate 1
31733 @item
31734 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
31735
31736 @item
31737 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
31738 now).
31739 @end enumerate
31740
31741 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
31742 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
31743 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
31744 hints about their use.
31745
31746 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
31747 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
31748 least, the following operations:
31749
31750 @itemize @bullet
31751 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
31752 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
31753 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
31754 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
31755 @end itemize
31756
31757 @end ignore
31758
31759 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
31760
31761 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
31762
31763 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
31764 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
31765 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
31766 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
31767 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
31768 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
31769 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
31770 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
31771 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
31772 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
31773 object, or to change display format.
31774
31775 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
31776 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
31777 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
31778 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
31779 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
31780 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
31781 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
31782 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
31783 child will be created.
31784
31785 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
31786 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
31787 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
31788 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
31789 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
31790
31791 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
31792 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
31793 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
31794 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
31795 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
31796 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
31797 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
31798 variables that frontend has created.
31799
31800 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
31801 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
31802 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
31803 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
31804 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
31805 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
31806 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
31807 implicitly updated.
31808
31809 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
31810 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
31811 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
31812 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
31813 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
31814 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
31815 frame. Consider this example:
31816
31817 @smallexample
31818 void do_work(...)
31819 @{
31820 struct work_state state;
31821
31822 if (...)
31823 do_work(...);
31824 @}
31825 @end smallexample
31826
31827 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
31828 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
31829 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
31830 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
31831 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
31832
31833 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
31834 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
31835 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
31836 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
31837 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
31838 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
31839
31840 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
31841 access this functionality:
31842
31843 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
31844 @item @strong{Operation}
31845 @tab @strong{Description}
31846
31847 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
31848 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
31849 @item @code{-var-create}
31850 @tab create a variable object
31851 @item @code{-var-delete}
31852 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
31853 @item @code{-var-set-format}
31854 @tab set the display format of this variable
31855 @item @code{-var-show-format}
31856 @tab show the display format of this variable
31857 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
31858 @tab tells how many children this object has
31859 @item @code{-var-list-children}
31860 @tab return a list of the object's children
31861 @item @code{-var-info-type}
31862 @tab show the type of this variable object
31863 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
31864 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
31865 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
31866 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
31867 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
31868 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
31869 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
31870 @tab get the value of this variable
31871 @item @code{-var-assign}
31872 @tab set the value of this variable
31873 @item @code{-var-update}
31874 @tab update the variable and its children
31875 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
31876 @tab set frozeness attribute
31877 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
31878 @tab set range of children to display on update
31879 @end multitable
31880
31881 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
31882 how it can be used.
31883
31884 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
31885
31886 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
31887 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
31888
31889 @smallexample
31890 -enable-pretty-printing
31891 @end smallexample
31892
31893 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
31894 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
31895 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
31896 request that this functionality be enabled.
31897
31898 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
31899
31900 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
31901 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
31902
31903 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
31904 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
31905
31906 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
31907 @findex -var-create
31908
31909 @subsubheading Synopsis
31910
31911 @smallexample
31912 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
31913 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
31914 @end smallexample
31915
31916 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
31917 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
31918 register.
31919
31920 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
31921 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
31922 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
31923 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
31924 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
31925
31926 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
31927 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
31928 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
31929 object must be created.
31930
31931 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
31932 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
31933
31934 @itemize @bullet
31935 @item
31936 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
31937
31938 @item
31939 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
31940
31941 @item
31942 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
31943 @end itemize
31944
31945 @cindex dynamic varobj
31946 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
31947 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
31948 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
31949 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
31950 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
31951 compatibility for existing clients.
31952
31953 @subsubheading Result
31954
31955 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
31956 are:
31957
31958 @table @samp
31959 @item name
31960 The name of the varobj.
31961
31962 @item numchild
31963 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
31964 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
31965 @samp{has_more} attribute.
31966
31967 @item value
31968 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
31969 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
31970 will not be interesting.
31971
31972 @item type
31973 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
31974 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
31975 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
31976 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
31977 @emph{declared} one.
31978
31979 @item thread-id
31980 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
31981 thread's global identifier.
31982
31983 @item has_more
31984 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
31985 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
31986
31987 @item dynamic
31988 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31989 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31990 then this attribute will not be present.
31991
31992 @item displayhint
31993 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
31994 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
31995 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
31996 @end table
31997
31998 Typical output will look like this:
31999
32000 @smallexample
32001 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
32002 has_more="@var{has_more}"
32003 @end smallexample
32004
32005
32006 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
32007 @findex -var-delete
32008
32009 @subsubheading Synopsis
32010
32011 @smallexample
32012 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
32013 @end smallexample
32014
32015 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
32016 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
32017
32018 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
32019
32020
32021 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
32022 @findex -var-set-format
32023
32024 @subsubheading Synopsis
32025
32026 @smallexample
32027 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
32028 @end smallexample
32029
32030 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
32031 @var{format-spec}.
32032
32033 @anchor{-var-set-format}
32034 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
32035
32036 @smallexample
32037 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
32038 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
32039 @end smallexample
32040
32041 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
32042 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
32043 for pointers, etc.).
32044
32045 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
32046 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
32047 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
32048 zero-hexadecimal format.
32049
32050 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
32051 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
32052
32053 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
32054 @findex -var-show-format
32055
32056 @subsubheading Synopsis
32057
32058 @smallexample
32059 -var-show-format @var{name}
32060 @end smallexample
32061
32062 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
32063
32064 @smallexample
32065 @var{format} @expansion{}
32066 @var{format-spec}
32067 @end smallexample
32068
32069
32070 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
32071 @findex -var-info-num-children
32072
32073 @subsubheading Synopsis
32074
32075 @smallexample
32076 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
32077 @end smallexample
32078
32079 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
32080
32081 @smallexample
32082 numchild=@var{n}
32083 @end smallexample
32084
32085 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
32086 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
32087 be available.
32088
32089
32090 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
32091 @findex -var-list-children
32092
32093 @subsubheading Synopsis
32094
32095 @smallexample
32096 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
32097 @end smallexample
32098 @anchor{-var-list-children}
32099
32100 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
32101 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
32102 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
32103 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
32104 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
32105 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
32106 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
32107 and unions.
32108
32109 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
32110 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
32111 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
32112 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
32113 reported.
32114
32115 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
32116 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
32117 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
32118 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
32119 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
32120 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
32121 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
32122 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
32123 the visible items.
32124
32125 For each child the following results are returned:
32126
32127 @table @var
32128
32129 @item name
32130 Name of the variable object created for this child.
32131
32132 @item exp
32133 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
32134 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
32135
32136 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
32137 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
32138
32139 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
32140 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
32141 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
32142 type and value are not present.
32143
32144 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
32145 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
32146 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
32147
32148 @item numchild
32149 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
32150 0.
32151
32152 @item type
32153 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
32154 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
32155 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
32156 @emph{declared} one.
32157
32158 @item value
32159 If values were requested, this is the value.
32160
32161 @item thread-id
32162 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
32163 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
32164
32165 @item frozen
32166 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
32167
32168 @item displayhint
32169 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
32170 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
32171 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
32172
32173 @item dynamic
32174 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
32175 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
32176 then this attribute will not be present.
32177
32178 @end table
32179
32180 The result may have its own attributes:
32181
32182 @table @samp
32183 @item displayhint
32184 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
32185 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
32186 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
32187
32188 @item has_more
32189 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
32190 remaining after the end of the selected range.
32191 @end table
32192
32193 @subsubheading Example
32194
32195 @smallexample
32196 (gdb)
32197 -var-list-children n
32198 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
32199 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
32200 (gdb)
32201 -var-list-children --all-values n
32202 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
32203 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
32204 @end smallexample
32205
32206
32207 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
32208 @findex -var-info-type
32209
32210 @subsubheading Synopsis
32211
32212 @smallexample
32213 -var-info-type @var{name}
32214 @end smallexample
32215
32216 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
32217 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
32218 @value{GDBN} CLI:
32219
32220 @smallexample
32221 type=@var{typename}
32222 @end smallexample
32223
32224
32225 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
32226 @findex -var-info-expression
32227
32228 @subsubheading Synopsis
32229
32230 @smallexample
32231 -var-info-expression @var{name}
32232 @end smallexample
32233
32234 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
32235 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
32236 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
32237
32238 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
32239 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
32240
32241 @smallexample
32242 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
32243 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
32244 @end smallexample
32245
32246 @noindent
32247 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
32248 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
32249
32250 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
32251 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
32252 is of limited use.
32253
32254 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
32255 @findex -var-info-path-expression
32256
32257 @subsubheading Synopsis
32258
32259 @smallexample
32260 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
32261 @end smallexample
32262
32263 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
32264 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
32265 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
32266 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
32267 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
32268 watchpoint from a variable object.
32269
32270 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
32271 and will give an error when invoked on one.
32272
32273 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
32274 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
32275 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
32276 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
32277 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
32278 @smallexample
32279 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
32280 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
32281 @end smallexample
32282
32283 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
32284 @findex -var-show-attributes
32285
32286 @subsubheading Synopsis
32287
32288 @smallexample
32289 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
32290 @end smallexample
32291
32292 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
32293
32294 @smallexample
32295 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
32296 @end smallexample
32297
32298 @noindent
32299 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
32300
32301 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
32302 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
32303
32304 @subsubheading Synopsis
32305
32306 @smallexample
32307 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
32308 @end smallexample
32309
32310 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
32311 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
32312 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
32313 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
32314 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
32315 the current display format will be used. The current display format
32316 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
32317
32318 @smallexample
32319 value=@var{value}
32320 @end smallexample
32321
32322 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
32323 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
32324
32325 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
32326 @findex -var-assign
32327
32328 @subsubheading Synopsis
32329
32330 @smallexample
32331 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
32332 @end smallexample
32333
32334 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
32335 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
32336 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
32337 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
32338
32339 @subsubheading Example
32340
32341 @smallexample
32342 (gdb)
32343 -var-assign var1 3
32344 ^done,value="3"
32345 (gdb)
32346 -var-update *
32347 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
32348 (gdb)
32349 @end smallexample
32350
32351 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
32352 @findex -var-update
32353
32354 @subsubheading Synopsis
32355
32356 @smallexample
32357 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
32358 @end smallexample
32359
32360 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
32361 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
32362 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
32363 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
32364 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
32365 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
32366 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
32367 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
32368 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
32369 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
32370 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
32371 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
32372 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
32373
32374 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
32375 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
32376 diagnostic.
32377
32378 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
32379 only the selected range of children will be reported.
32380
32381 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
32382 @samp{changelist}.
32383
32384 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
32385
32386 @table @samp
32387 @item name
32388 The name of the varobj.
32389
32390 @item value
32391 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
32392 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
32393
32394 @item in_scope
32395 @anchor{-var-update}
32396 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
32397
32398 @table @code
32399 @item "true"
32400 The variable object's current value is valid.
32401
32402 @item "false"
32403 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
32404 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
32405 scope.
32406
32407 @item "invalid"
32408 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
32409 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
32410 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
32411 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
32412 objects.
32413 @end table
32414
32415 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
32416 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
32417
32418 @item type_changed
32419 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
32420 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
32421 be @samp{false}.
32422
32423 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
32424 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
32425 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
32426 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
32427 unset.
32428
32429 @item new_type
32430 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
32431 hold the new type.
32432
32433 @item new_num_children
32434 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
32435 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
32436
32437 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
32438 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
32439 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
32440 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
32441 children which may be available.
32442
32443 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
32444 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
32445 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
32446 only happen at the end of the update range).
32447
32448 @item displayhint
32449 The display hint, if any.
32450
32451 @item has_more
32452 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
32453 available outside the varobj's update range.
32454
32455 @item dynamic
32456 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
32457 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
32458 then this attribute will not be present.
32459
32460 @item new_children
32461 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
32462 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
32463 be listed in this attribute.
32464 @end table
32465
32466 @subsubheading Example
32467
32468 @smallexample
32469 (gdb)
32470 -var-assign var1 3
32471 ^done,value="3"
32472 (gdb)
32473 -var-update --all-values var1
32474 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
32475 type_changed="false"@}]
32476 (gdb)
32477 @end smallexample
32478
32479 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
32480 @findex -var-set-frozen
32481 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
32482
32483 @subsubheading Synopsis
32484
32485 @smallexample
32486 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
32487 @end smallexample
32488
32489 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
32490 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
32491 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
32492 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
32493 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
32494 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
32495 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
32496 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
32497 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
32498 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
32499 @code{-var-update} does.
32500
32501 @subsubheading Example
32502
32503 @smallexample
32504 (gdb)
32505 -var-set-frozen V 1
32506 ^done
32507 (gdb)
32508 @end smallexample
32509
32510 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
32511 @findex -var-set-update-range
32512 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
32513
32514 @subsubheading Synopsis
32515
32516 @smallexample
32517 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
32518 @end smallexample
32519
32520 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
32521 @code{-var-update}.
32522
32523 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
32524 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
32525 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
32526 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
32527
32528 @subsubheading Example
32529
32530 @smallexample
32531 (gdb)
32532 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
32533 ^done
32534 @end smallexample
32535
32536 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
32537 @findex -var-set-visualizer
32538 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
32539
32540 @subsubheading Synopsis
32541
32542 @smallexample
32543 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
32544 @end smallexample
32545
32546 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
32547
32548 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
32549 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
32550
32551 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
32552 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
32553 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
32554 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
32555 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
32556 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
32557 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
32558
32559 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
32560 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
32561 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
32562 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
32563
32564 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
32565 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
32566 can be used to check this.
32567
32568 @subsubheading Example
32569
32570 Resetting the visualizer:
32571
32572 @smallexample
32573 (gdb)
32574 -var-set-visualizer V None
32575 ^done
32576 @end smallexample
32577
32578 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
32579
32580 @smallexample
32581 (gdb)
32582 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
32583 ^done
32584 @end smallexample
32585
32586 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
32587 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
32588
32589 @smallexample
32590 (gdb)
32591 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
32592 ^done
32593 @end smallexample
32594
32595 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32596 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
32597 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
32598
32599 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
32600 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
32601 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
32602 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
32603
32604 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
32605 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
32606
32607 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
32608 @c @subheading -data-assign
32609 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
32610 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
32611 @c set variable
32612 @c @subsubheading Example
32613 @c N.A.
32614
32615 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
32616 @findex -data-disassemble
32617
32618 @subsubheading Synopsis
32619
32620 @smallexample
32621 -data-disassemble
32622 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
32623 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
32624 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
32625 -- @var{mode}
32626 @end smallexample
32627
32628 @noindent
32629 Where:
32630
32631 @table @samp
32632 @item @var{start-addr}
32633 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
32634 @item @var{end-addr}
32635 is the end address
32636 @item @var{addr}
32637 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
32638 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
32639 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
32640 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
32641 @item @var{filename}
32642 is the name of the file to disassemble
32643 @item @var{linenum}
32644 is the line number to disassemble around
32645 @item @var{lines}
32646 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
32647 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
32648 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
32649 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
32650 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
32651 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
32652 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
32653 are displayed.
32654 @item @var{mode}
32655 is one of:
32656 @itemize @bullet
32657 @item 0 disassembly only
32658 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
32659 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
32660 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
32661 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
32662 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
32663 @end itemize
32664
32665 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
32666 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
32667 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
32668 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
32669 @end table
32670
32671 @subsubheading Result
32672
32673 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
32674 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
32675 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
32676
32677 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
32678 following fields:
32679
32680 @table @code
32681 @item address
32682 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
32683
32684 @item func-name
32685 The name of the function this instruction is within.
32686
32687 @item offset
32688 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
32689
32690 @item inst
32691 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
32692
32693 @item opcodes
32694 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
32695 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
32696
32697 @end table
32698
32699 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
32700 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
32701
32702 @table @code
32703 @item line
32704 The line number within @samp{file}.
32705
32706 @item file
32707 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
32708 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
32709 used.
32710
32711 @item fullname
32712 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
32713 using the source file search path
32714 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
32715 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
32716
32717 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
32718 present in the debug information.
32719
32720 @item line_asm_insn
32721 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
32722 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
32723 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
32724 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
32725 @samp{opcodes}.
32726
32727 @end table
32728
32729 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
32730 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
32731 adjust its format.
32732
32733 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32734
32735 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
32736
32737 @subsubheading Example
32738
32739 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
32740
32741 @smallexample
32742 (gdb)
32743 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
32744 ^done,
32745 asm_insns=[
32746 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
32747 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32748 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32749 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
32750 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
32751 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
32752 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
32753 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
32754 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
32755 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
32756 (gdb)
32757 @end smallexample
32758
32759 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
32760 @code{main}.
32761
32762 @smallexample
32763 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
32764 ^done,asm_insns=[
32765 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
32766 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
32767 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
32768 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32769 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32770 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
32771 [@dots{}]
32772 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
32773 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
32774 (gdb)
32775 @end smallexample
32776
32777 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
32778
32779 @smallexample
32780 (gdb)
32781 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
32782 ^done,asm_insns=[
32783 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
32784 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
32785 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
32786 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32787 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32788 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
32789 (gdb)
32790 @end smallexample
32791
32792 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
32793
32794 @smallexample
32795 (gdb)
32796 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
32797 ^done,asm_insns=[
32798 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
32799 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32800 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32801 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
32802 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
32803 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
32804 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32805 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32806 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
32807 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32808 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32809 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
32810 (gdb)
32811 @end smallexample
32812
32813
32814 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
32815 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
32816
32817 @subsubheading Synopsis
32818
32819 @smallexample
32820 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
32821 @end smallexample
32822
32823 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
32824 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
32825 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
32826
32827 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32828
32829 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
32830 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
32831 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
32832
32833 @subsubheading Example
32834
32835 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
32836 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
32837 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
32838 output.
32839
32840 @smallexample
32841 211-data-evaluate-expression A
32842 211^done,value="1"
32843 (gdb)
32844 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
32845 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
32846 (gdb)
32847 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
32848 411^done,value="4"
32849 (gdb)
32850 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
32851 511^done,value="4"
32852 (gdb)
32853 @end smallexample
32854
32855
32856 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
32857 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
32858
32859 @subsubheading Synopsis
32860
32861 @smallexample
32862 -data-list-changed-registers
32863 @end smallexample
32864
32865 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
32866
32867 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32868
32869 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
32870 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
32871
32872 @subsubheading Example
32873
32874 On a PPC MBX board:
32875
32876 @smallexample
32877 (gdb)
32878 -exec-continue
32879 ^running
32880
32881 (gdb)
32882 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
32883 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
32884 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
32885 (gdb)
32886 -data-list-changed-registers
32887 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
32888 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
32889 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
32890 (gdb)
32891 @end smallexample
32892
32893
32894 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
32895 @findex -data-list-register-names
32896
32897 @subsubheading Synopsis
32898
32899 @smallexample
32900 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
32901 @end smallexample
32902
32903 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
32904 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
32905 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
32906 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
32907 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
32908 include empty register names.
32909
32910 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32911
32912 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
32913 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
32914 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
32915
32916 @subsubheading Example
32917
32918 For the PPC MBX board:
32919 @smallexample
32920 (gdb)
32921 -data-list-register-names
32922 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
32923 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
32924 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
32925 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
32926 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
32927 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
32928 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
32929 (gdb)
32930 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
32931 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
32932 (gdb)
32933 @end smallexample
32934
32935 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
32936 @findex -data-list-register-values
32937
32938 @subsubheading Synopsis
32939
32940 @smallexample
32941 -data-list-register-values
32942 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
32943 @end smallexample
32944
32945 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
32946 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
32947 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
32948 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
32949 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
32950 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
32951
32952 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
32953
32954 @table @code
32955 @item x
32956 Hexadecimal
32957 @item o
32958 Octal
32959 @item t
32960 Binary
32961 @item d
32962 Decimal
32963 @item r
32964 Raw
32965 @item N
32966 Natural
32967 @end table
32968
32969 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32970
32971 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
32972 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
32973
32974 @subsubheading Example
32975
32976 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
32977 don't appear in the actual output):
32978
32979 @smallexample
32980 (gdb)
32981 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
32982 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
32983 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
32984 (gdb)
32985 -data-list-register-values x
32986 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
32987 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
32988 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
32989 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
32990 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
32991 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
32992 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
32993 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
32994 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
32995 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
32996 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
32997 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
32998 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
32999 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
33000 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
33001 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
33002 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
33003 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
33004 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
33005 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
33006 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
33007 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
33008 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
33009 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
33010 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
33011 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
33012 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
33013 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
33014 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
33015 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
33016 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
33017 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
33018 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
33019 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
33020 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
33021 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
33022 (gdb)
33023 @end smallexample
33024
33025
33026 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
33027 @findex -data-read-memory
33028
33029 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
33030
33031 @subsubheading Synopsis
33032
33033 @smallexample
33034 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
33035 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
33036 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
33037 @end smallexample
33038
33039 @noindent
33040 where:
33041
33042 @table @samp
33043 @item @var{address}
33044 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
33045 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
33046 quoted using the C convention.
33047
33048 @item @var{word-format}
33049 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
33050 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
33051 ,Output Formats}).
33052
33053 @item @var{word-size}
33054 The size of each memory word in bytes.
33055
33056 @item @var{nr-rows}
33057 The number of rows in the output table.
33058
33059 @item @var{nr-cols}
33060 The number of columns in the output table.
33061
33062 @item @var{aschar}
33063 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
33064 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
33065 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
33066 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
33067
33068 @item @var{byte-offset}
33069 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
33070 @end table
33071
33072 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
33073 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
33074 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
33075 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
33076 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
33077 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
33078 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
33079 @samp{addr}.
33080
33081 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
33082 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
33083 @samp{prev-page}.
33084
33085 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33086
33087 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
33088 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
33089
33090 @subsubheading Example
33091
33092 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
33093 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
33094 word. Display each word in hex.
33095
33096 @smallexample
33097 (gdb)
33098 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
33099 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
33100 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
33101 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
33102 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
33103 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
33104 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
33105 (gdb)
33106 @end smallexample
33107
33108 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
33109 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
33110
33111 @smallexample
33112 (gdb)
33113 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
33114 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
33115 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
33116 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
33117 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
33118 (gdb)
33119 @end smallexample
33120
33121 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
33122 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
33123 used as the non-printable character.
33124
33125 @smallexample
33126 (gdb)
33127 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
33128 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
33129 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
33130 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
33131 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33132 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33133 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33134 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33135 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
33136 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
33137 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
33138 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
33139 (gdb)
33140 @end smallexample
33141
33142 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
33143 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
33144
33145 @subsubheading Synopsis
33146
33147 @smallexample
33148 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
33149 @var{address} @var{count}
33150 @end smallexample
33151
33152 @noindent
33153 where:
33154
33155 @table @samp
33156 @item @var{address}
33157 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
33158 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
33159 quoted using the C convention.
33160
33161 @item @var{count}
33162 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
33163 literal.
33164
33165 @item @var{offset}
33166 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
33167 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
33168 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
33169 arithmetics itself.
33170
33171 @end table
33172
33173 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
33174 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
33175 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
33176 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
33177 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
33178 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
33179
33180 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
33181 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
33182 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
33183 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
33184 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
33185 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
33186 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
33187 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
33188
33189 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
33190 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
33191 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
33192 and has the following fields:
33193
33194 @table @code
33195 @item begin
33196 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
33197
33198 @item end
33199 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
33200
33201 @item offset
33202 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
33203 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
33204
33205 @item contents
33206 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
33207
33208 @end table
33209
33210
33211
33212 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33213
33214 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
33215
33216 @subsubheading Example
33217
33218 @smallexample
33219 (gdb)
33220 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
33221 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
33222 end="0xbffff15e",
33223 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
33224 (gdb)
33225 @end smallexample
33226
33227
33228 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
33229 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
33230
33231 @subsubheading Synopsis
33232
33233 @smallexample
33234 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
33235 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
33236 @end smallexample
33237
33238 @noindent
33239 where:
33240
33241 @table @samp
33242 @item @var{address}
33243 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
33244 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
33245 be quoted using the C convention.
33246
33247 @item @var{contents}
33248 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
33249 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
33250
33251 @item @var{count}
33252 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
33253 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
33254 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
33255 @var{count} memory units.
33256
33257 @end table
33258
33259 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33260
33261 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33262
33263 @subsubheading Example
33264
33265 @smallexample
33266 (gdb)
33267 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
33268 ^done
33269 (gdb)
33270 @end smallexample
33271
33272 @smallexample
33273 (gdb)
33274 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
33275 ^done
33276 (gdb)
33277 @end smallexample
33278
33279 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33280 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
33281 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
33282
33283 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
33284 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
33285
33286 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
33287 @findex -trace-find
33288
33289 @subsubheading Synopsis
33290
33291 @smallexample
33292 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
33293 @end smallexample
33294
33295 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
33296 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
33297 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
33298
33299 @table @samp
33300
33301 @item none
33302 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
33303
33304 @item frame-number
33305 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
33306 that index.
33307
33308 @item tracepoint-number
33309 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
33310 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
33311
33312 @item pc
33313 An address is required as parameter. Finds
33314 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
33315 address.
33316
33317 @item pc-inside-range
33318 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
33319 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
33320 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
33321
33322 @item pc-outside-range
33323 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
33324 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
33325 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
33326
33327 @item line
33328 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
33329 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
33330 the specified location.
33331
33332 @end table
33333
33334 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
33335 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
33336
33337 @table @samp
33338 @item found
33339 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
33340 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
33341
33342 @item traceframe
33343 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
33344 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
33345
33346 @item tracepoint
33347 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
33348 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
33349
33350 @item frame
33351 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
33352 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
33353 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
33354
33355 @end table
33356
33357 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33358
33359 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
33360
33361 @subheading -trace-define-variable
33362 @findex -trace-define-variable
33363
33364 @subsubheading Synopsis
33365
33366 @smallexample
33367 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
33368 @end smallexample
33369
33370 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
33371 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
33372 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
33373 with the @samp{$} character.
33374
33375 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33376
33377 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
33378
33379 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
33380 @findex -trace-frame-collected
33381
33382 @subsubheading Synopsis
33383
33384 @smallexample
33385 -trace-frame-collected
33386 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
33387 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
33388 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
33389 [--memory-contents]
33390 @end smallexample
33391
33392 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
33393 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
33394 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
33395 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
33396 See the output description table below for more details.
33397
33398 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
33399 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
33400 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
33401 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
33402 memory range and which is a computed expression.
33403
33404 For instance, if the actions were
33405 @smallexample
33406 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
33407 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
33408 @end smallexample
33409
33410 @noindent
33411 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
33412 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
33413 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
33414 objects would be computed expressions.
33415
33416 An example output would be:
33417
33418 @smallexample
33419 (gdb)
33420 -trace-frame-collected
33421 ^done,
33422 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
33423 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
33424 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
33425 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
33426 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
33427 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
33428 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
33429 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
33430 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
33431 ...
33432 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
33433 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
33434 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
33435 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
33436 (gdb)
33437 @end smallexample
33438
33439 Where:
33440
33441 @table @code
33442 @item explicit-variables
33443 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
33444 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
33445 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
33446 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
33447 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
33448 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
33449 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
33450 arrays, structures and unions.
33451
33452 @item computed-expressions
33453 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
33454 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
33455 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
33456 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
33457
33458 @item registers
33459 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
33460 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
33461 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
33462 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
33463 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
33464
33465 @item tvars
33466 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
33467 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
33468 current value are returned.
33469
33470 @item memory
33471 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
33472 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
33473 collected memory range and has the following fields:
33474
33475 @table @code
33476 @item address
33477 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
33478
33479 @item length
33480 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
33481
33482 @item contents
33483 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
33484 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
33485
33486 @end table
33487
33488 @end table
33489
33490 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33491
33492 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33493
33494 @subsubheading Example
33495
33496 @subheading -trace-list-variables
33497 @findex -trace-list-variables
33498
33499 @subsubheading Synopsis
33500
33501 @smallexample
33502 -trace-list-variables
33503 @end smallexample
33504
33505 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
33506 table has the following fields:
33507
33508 @table @samp
33509 @item name
33510 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
33511
33512 @item initial
33513 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
33514 field is always present.
33515
33516 @item current
33517 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
33518 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
33519 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
33520 presently running.
33521
33522 @end table
33523
33524 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33525
33526 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
33527
33528 @subsubheading Example
33529
33530 @smallexample
33531 (gdb)
33532 -trace-list-variables
33533 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
33534 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33535 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
33536 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
33537 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
33538 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
33539 (gdb)
33540 @end smallexample
33541
33542 @subheading -trace-save
33543 @findex -trace-save
33544
33545 @subsubheading Synopsis
33546
33547 @smallexample
33548 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
33549 @end smallexample
33550
33551 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
33552 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
33553 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
33554 to perform the save.
33555
33556 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
33557 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
33558 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
33559
33560 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33561
33562 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
33563
33564
33565 @subheading -trace-start
33566 @findex -trace-start
33567
33568 @subsubheading Synopsis
33569
33570 @smallexample
33571 -trace-start
33572 @end smallexample
33573
33574 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
33575 have any fields.
33576
33577 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33578
33579 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
33580
33581 @subheading -trace-status
33582 @findex -trace-status
33583
33584 @subsubheading Synopsis
33585
33586 @smallexample
33587 -trace-status
33588 @end smallexample
33589
33590 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
33591 the following fields:
33592
33593 @table @samp
33594
33595 @item supported
33596 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
33597 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
33598 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
33599 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
33600 started. This field is always present.
33601
33602 @item running
33603 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
33604 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
33605 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
33606
33607 @item stop-reason
33608 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
33609 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
33610 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
33611 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
33612 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
33613 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
33614 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
33615 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
33616 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
33617
33618 @item stopping-tracepoint
33619 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
33620 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
33621 @samp{passcount}.
33622
33623 @item frames
33624 @itemx frames-created
33625 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
33626 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
33627 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
33628 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
33629
33630 @item buffer-size
33631 @itemx buffer-free
33632 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
33633 remaining space. These fields are optional.
33634
33635 @item circular
33636 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
33637 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
33638 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
33639 and may fill up.
33640
33641 @item disconnected
33642 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
33643 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
33644 that the trace run will stop.
33645
33646 @item trace-file
33647 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
33648 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
33649
33650 @end table
33651
33652 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33653
33654 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
33655
33656 @subheading -trace-stop
33657 @findex -trace-stop
33658
33659 @subsubheading Synopsis
33660
33661 @smallexample
33662 -trace-stop
33663 @end smallexample
33664
33665 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
33666 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
33667 @samp{running} fields are not output.
33668
33669 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33670
33671 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
33672
33673
33674 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33675 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
33676 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
33677
33678
33679 @ignore
33680 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
33681 @findex -symbol-info-address
33682
33683 @subsubheading Synopsis
33684
33685 @smallexample
33686 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
33687 @end smallexample
33688
33689 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
33690
33691 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33692
33693 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
33694
33695 @subsubheading Example
33696 N.A.
33697
33698
33699 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
33700 @findex -symbol-info-file
33701
33702 @subsubheading Synopsis
33703
33704 @smallexample
33705 -symbol-info-file
33706 @end smallexample
33707
33708 Show the file for the symbol.
33709
33710 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33711
33712 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
33713 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
33714
33715 @subsubheading Example
33716 N.A.
33717
33718
33719 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
33720 @findex -symbol-info-function
33721
33722 @subsubheading Synopsis
33723
33724 @smallexample
33725 -symbol-info-function
33726 @end smallexample
33727
33728 Show which function the symbol lives in.
33729
33730 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33731
33732 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
33733
33734 @subsubheading Example
33735 N.A.
33736
33737
33738 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
33739 @findex -symbol-info-line
33740
33741 @subsubheading Synopsis
33742
33743 @smallexample
33744 -symbol-info-line
33745 @end smallexample
33746
33747 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
33748
33749 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33750
33751 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
33752 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
33753
33754 @subsubheading Example
33755 N.A.
33756
33757
33758 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
33759 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
33760
33761 @subsubheading Synopsis
33762
33763 @smallexample
33764 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
33765 @end smallexample
33766
33767 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
33768
33769 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33770
33771 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
33772
33773 @subsubheading Example
33774 N.A.
33775
33776
33777 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
33778 @findex -symbol-list-functions
33779
33780 @subsubheading Synopsis
33781
33782 @smallexample
33783 -symbol-list-functions
33784 @end smallexample
33785
33786 List the functions in the executable.
33787
33788 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33789
33790 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
33791 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
33792
33793 @subsubheading Example
33794 N.A.
33795 @end ignore
33796
33797
33798 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
33799 @findex -symbol-list-lines
33800
33801 @subsubheading Synopsis
33802
33803 @smallexample
33804 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
33805 @end smallexample
33806
33807 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
33808 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
33809 ascending PC order.
33810
33811 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33812
33813 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33814
33815 @subsubheading Example
33816 @smallexample
33817 (gdb)
33818 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
33819 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
33820 (gdb)
33821 @end smallexample
33822
33823
33824 @ignore
33825 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
33826 @findex -symbol-list-types
33827
33828 @subsubheading Synopsis
33829
33830 @smallexample
33831 -symbol-list-types
33832 @end smallexample
33833
33834 List all the type names.
33835
33836 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33837
33838 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
33839 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
33840
33841 @subsubheading Example
33842 N.A.
33843
33844
33845 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
33846 @findex -symbol-list-variables
33847
33848 @subsubheading Synopsis
33849
33850 @smallexample
33851 -symbol-list-variables
33852 @end smallexample
33853
33854 List all the global and static variable names.
33855
33856 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33857
33858 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
33859
33860 @subsubheading Example
33861 N.A.
33862
33863
33864 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
33865 @findex -symbol-locate
33866
33867 @subsubheading Synopsis
33868
33869 @smallexample
33870 -symbol-locate
33871 @end smallexample
33872
33873 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33874
33875 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
33876
33877 @subsubheading Example
33878 N.A.
33879
33880
33881 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
33882 @findex -symbol-type
33883
33884 @subsubheading Synopsis
33885
33886 @smallexample
33887 -symbol-type @var{variable}
33888 @end smallexample
33889
33890 Show type of @var{variable}.
33891
33892 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33893
33894 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
33895 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
33896
33897 @subsubheading Example
33898 N.A.
33899 @end ignore
33900
33901
33902 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33903 @node GDB/MI File Commands
33904 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
33905
33906 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
33907 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
33908
33909 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
33910 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
33911
33912 @subsubheading Synopsis
33913
33914 @smallexample
33915 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
33916 @end smallexample
33917
33918 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
33919 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
33920 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
33921 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
33922 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
33923 notification.
33924
33925 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33926
33927 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
33928
33929 @subsubheading Example
33930
33931 @smallexample
33932 (gdb)
33933 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33934 ^done
33935 (gdb)
33936 @end smallexample
33937
33938
33939 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
33940 @findex -file-exec-file
33941
33942 @subsubheading Synopsis
33943
33944 @smallexample
33945 -file-exec-file @var{file}
33946 @end smallexample
33947
33948 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
33949 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
33950 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
33951 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
33952 notification.
33953
33954 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33955
33956 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
33957
33958 @subsubheading Example
33959
33960 @smallexample
33961 (gdb)
33962 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33963 ^done
33964 (gdb)
33965 @end smallexample
33966
33967
33968 @ignore
33969 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
33970 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
33971
33972 @subsubheading Synopsis
33973
33974 @smallexample
33975 -file-list-exec-sections
33976 @end smallexample
33977
33978 List the sections of the current executable file.
33979
33980 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33981
33982 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
33983 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
33984 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
33985
33986 @subsubheading Example
33987 N.A.
33988 @end ignore
33989
33990
33991 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
33992 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
33993
33994 @subsubheading Synopsis
33995
33996 @smallexample
33997 -file-list-exec-source-file
33998 @end smallexample
33999
34000 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
34001 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
34002 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
34003 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
34004
34005 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34006
34007 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
34008
34009 @subsubheading Example
34010
34011 @smallexample
34012 (gdb)
34013 123-file-list-exec-source-file
34014 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
34015 (gdb)
34016 @end smallexample
34017
34018
34019 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
34020 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
34021
34022 @subsubheading Synopsis
34023
34024 @smallexample
34025 -file-list-exec-source-files
34026 @end smallexample
34027
34028 List the source files for the current executable.
34029
34030 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
34031 name) of a source file.
34032
34033 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34034
34035 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
34036 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
34037
34038 @subsubheading Example
34039 @smallexample
34040 (gdb)
34041 -file-list-exec-source-files
34042 ^done,files=[
34043 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
34044 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
34045 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
34046 (gdb)
34047 @end smallexample
34048
34049 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
34050 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
34051
34052 @subsubheading Synopsis
34053
34054 @smallexample
34055 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
34056 @end smallexample
34057
34058 List the shared libraries in the program.
34059 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
34060 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
34061
34062 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34063
34064 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
34065 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
34066 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
34067 library. Each range has the following fields:
34068
34069 @table @samp
34070 @item from
34071 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
34072 @item to
34073 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
34074 @end table
34075
34076 @subsubheading Example
34077 @smallexample
34078 (gdb)
34079 -file-list-exec-source-files
34080 ^done,shared-libraries=[
34081 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
34082 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
34083 (gdb)
34084 @end smallexample
34085
34086
34087 @ignore
34088 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
34089 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
34090
34091 @subsubheading Synopsis
34092
34093 @smallexample
34094 -file-list-symbol-files
34095 @end smallexample
34096
34097 List symbol files.
34098
34099 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34100
34101 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
34102
34103 @subsubheading Example
34104 N.A.
34105 @end ignore
34106
34107
34108 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
34109 @findex -file-symbol-file
34110
34111 @subsubheading Synopsis
34112
34113 @smallexample
34114 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
34115 @end smallexample
34116
34117 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
34118 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
34119 produced, except for a completion notification.
34120
34121 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34122
34123 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
34124
34125 @subsubheading Example
34126
34127 @smallexample
34128 (gdb)
34129 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
34130 ^done
34131 (gdb)
34132 @end smallexample
34133
34134 @ignore
34135 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34136 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
34137 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
34138
34139 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
34140
34141 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
34142
34143 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
34144
34145 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
34146
34147 @c @subheading -overlay-map
34148
34149 @c @subheading -overlay-off
34150
34151 @c @subheading -overlay-on
34152
34153 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
34154
34155 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34156 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
34157 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
34158
34159 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
34160
34161 @c @subheading -signal-handle
34162
34163 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
34164
34165 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
34166 @end ignore
34167
34168
34169 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34170 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
34171 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
34172
34173
34174 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
34175 @findex -target-attach
34176
34177 @subsubheading Synopsis
34178
34179 @smallexample
34180 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
34181 @end smallexample
34182
34183 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
34184 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
34185 group, the id previously returned by
34186 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
34187
34188 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34189
34190 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
34191
34192 @subsubheading Example
34193 @smallexample
34194 (gdb)
34195 -target-attach 34
34196 =thread-created,id="1"
34197 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
34198 ^done
34199 (gdb)
34200 @end smallexample
34201
34202 @ignore
34203 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
34204 @findex -target-compare-sections
34205
34206 @subsubheading Synopsis
34207
34208 @smallexample
34209 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
34210 @end smallexample
34211
34212 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
34213 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
34214
34215 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34216
34217 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
34218
34219 @subsubheading Example
34220 N.A.
34221 @end ignore
34222
34223
34224 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
34225 @findex -target-detach
34226
34227 @subsubheading Synopsis
34228
34229 @smallexample
34230 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
34231 @end smallexample
34232
34233 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
34234 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
34235 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
34236
34237 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34238
34239 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
34240
34241 @subsubheading Example
34242
34243 @smallexample
34244 (gdb)
34245 -target-detach
34246 ^done
34247 (gdb)
34248 @end smallexample
34249
34250
34251 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
34252 @findex -target-disconnect
34253
34254 @subsubheading Synopsis
34255
34256 @smallexample
34257 -target-disconnect
34258 @end smallexample
34259
34260 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
34261 generally not resumed.
34262
34263 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34264
34265 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
34266
34267 @subsubheading Example
34268
34269 @smallexample
34270 (gdb)
34271 -target-disconnect
34272 ^done
34273 (gdb)
34274 @end smallexample
34275
34276
34277 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
34278 @findex -target-download
34279
34280 @subsubheading Synopsis
34281
34282 @smallexample
34283 -target-download
34284 @end smallexample
34285
34286 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
34287 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
34288
34289 @table @samp
34290 @item section
34291 The name of the section.
34292 @item section-sent
34293 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
34294 @item section-size
34295 The size of the section.
34296 @item total-sent
34297 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
34298 @item total-size
34299 The size of the overall executable to download.
34300 @end table
34301
34302 @noindent
34303 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
34304 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
34305
34306 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
34307 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
34308
34309 @table @samp
34310 @item section
34311 The name of the section.
34312 @item section-size
34313 The size of the section.
34314 @item total-size
34315 The size of the overall executable to download.
34316 @end table
34317
34318 @noindent
34319 At the end, a summary is printed.
34320
34321 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34322
34323 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
34324
34325 @subsubheading Example
34326
34327 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
34328 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
34329
34330 @smallexample
34331 (gdb)
34332 -target-download
34333 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
34334 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
34335 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
34336 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
34337 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
34338 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
34339 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
34340 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
34341 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
34342 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
34343 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
34344 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
34345 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
34346 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
34347 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
34348 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
34349 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
34350 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
34351 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
34352 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
34353 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
34354 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
34355 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
34356 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
34357 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
34358 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
34359 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
34360 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
34361 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
34362 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
34363 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
34364 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
34365 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
34366 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
34367 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
34368 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
34369 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
34370 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
34371 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
34372 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
34373 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
34374 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
34375 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
34376 write-rate="429"
34377 (gdb)
34378 @end smallexample
34379
34380
34381 @ignore
34382 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
34383 @findex -target-exec-status
34384
34385 @subsubheading Synopsis
34386
34387 @smallexample
34388 -target-exec-status
34389 @end smallexample
34390
34391 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
34392 not, for instance).
34393
34394 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34395
34396 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
34397
34398 @subsubheading Example
34399 N.A.
34400
34401
34402 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
34403 @findex -target-list-available-targets
34404
34405 @subsubheading Synopsis
34406
34407 @smallexample
34408 -target-list-available-targets
34409 @end smallexample
34410
34411 List the possible targets to connect to.
34412
34413 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34414
34415 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
34416
34417 @subsubheading Example
34418 N.A.
34419
34420
34421 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
34422 @findex -target-list-current-targets
34423
34424 @subsubheading Synopsis
34425
34426 @smallexample
34427 -target-list-current-targets
34428 @end smallexample
34429
34430 Describe the current target.
34431
34432 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34433
34434 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
34435 other things).
34436
34437 @subsubheading Example
34438 N.A.
34439
34440
34441 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
34442 @findex -target-list-parameters
34443
34444 @subsubheading Synopsis
34445
34446 @smallexample
34447 -target-list-parameters
34448 @end smallexample
34449
34450 @c ????
34451 @end ignore
34452
34453 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34454
34455 No equivalent.
34456
34457 @subsubheading Example
34458 N.A.
34459
34460 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
34461 @findex -target-flash-erase
34462
34463 @subsubheading Synopsis
34464
34465 @smallexample
34466 -target-flash-erase
34467 @end smallexample
34468
34469 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
34470
34471 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
34472
34473 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
34474 addresses and memory region sizes.
34475
34476 @smallexample
34477 (gdb)
34478 -target-flash-erase
34479 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
34480 (gdb)
34481 @end smallexample
34482
34483 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
34484 @findex -target-select
34485
34486 @subsubheading Synopsis
34487
34488 @smallexample
34489 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
34490 @end smallexample
34491
34492 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
34493
34494 @table @samp
34495 @item @var{type}
34496 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
34497 @item @var{parameters}
34498 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
34499 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
34500 @end table
34501
34502 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
34503 which the target program is, in the following form:
34504
34505 @smallexample
34506 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
34507 args=[@var{arg list}]
34508 @end smallexample
34509
34510 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34511
34512 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
34513
34514 @subsubheading Example
34515
34516 @smallexample
34517 (gdb)
34518 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
34519 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
34520 (gdb)
34521 @end smallexample
34522
34523 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34524 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
34525 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
34526
34527
34528 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
34529 @findex -target-file-put
34530
34531 @subsubheading Synopsis
34532
34533 @smallexample
34534 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
34535 @end smallexample
34536
34537 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
34538 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
34539
34540 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34541
34542 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
34543
34544 @subsubheading Example
34545
34546 @smallexample
34547 (gdb)
34548 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
34549 ^done
34550 (gdb)
34551 @end smallexample
34552
34553
34554 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
34555 @findex -target-file-get
34556
34557 @subsubheading Synopsis
34558
34559 @smallexample
34560 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
34561 @end smallexample
34562
34563 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
34564 on the host system.
34565
34566 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34567
34568 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
34569
34570 @subsubheading Example
34571
34572 @smallexample
34573 (gdb)
34574 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
34575 ^done
34576 (gdb)
34577 @end smallexample
34578
34579
34580 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
34581 @findex -target-file-delete
34582
34583 @subsubheading Synopsis
34584
34585 @smallexample
34586 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
34587 @end smallexample
34588
34589 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
34590
34591 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34592
34593 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
34594
34595 @subsubheading Example
34596
34597 @smallexample
34598 (gdb)
34599 -target-file-delete remotefile
34600 ^done
34601 (gdb)
34602 @end smallexample
34603
34604
34605 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34606 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
34607 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
34608
34609 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
34610 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
34611
34612 @subsubheading Synopsis
34613
34614 @smallexample
34615 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
34616 @end smallexample
34617
34618 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
34619 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
34620 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
34621
34622 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34623
34624 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
34625
34626 @subsubheading Result
34627
34628 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
34629 defined for each exception:
34630
34631 @table @samp
34632 @item name
34633 The name of the exception.
34634
34635 @item address
34636 The address of the exception.
34637
34638 @end table
34639
34640 @subsubheading Example
34641
34642 @smallexample
34643 -info-ada-exceptions aint
34644 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
34645 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
34646 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
34647 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
34648 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
34649 @end smallexample
34650
34651 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
34652
34653 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
34654 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
34655 Catchpoint Commands}.
34656
34657
34658 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34659 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
34660 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
34661
34662 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
34663 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
34664 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
34665 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
34666
34667 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
34668 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
34669 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
34670
34671 @subsubheading Synopsis
34672
34673 @smallexample
34674 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
34675 @end smallexample
34676
34677 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
34678
34679 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
34680 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
34681 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
34682 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
34683 dash.
34684
34685 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34686
34687 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
34688
34689 @subsubheading Result
34690
34691 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
34692
34693 @table @samp
34694 @item exists
34695 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
34696 @code{"false"} otherwise.
34697
34698 @end table
34699
34700 @subsubheading Example
34701
34702 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
34703
34704 @smallexample
34705 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
34706 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
34707 @end smallexample
34708
34709 @noindent
34710 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
34711 to the debugger:
34712
34713 @smallexample
34714 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
34715 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
34716 @end smallexample
34717
34718 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
34719 @findex -list-features
34720 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
34721
34722 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
34723 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
34724 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
34725 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
34726 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
34727 startup.
34728
34729 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
34730 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
34731 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
34732 is given below.
34733
34734 Example output:
34735
34736 @smallexample
34737 (gdb) -list-features
34738 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
34739 @end smallexample
34740
34741 The current list of features is:
34742
34743 @ftable @samp
34744 @item frozen-varobjs
34745 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
34746 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
34747 of @code{-varobj-create}.
34748 @item pending-breakpoints
34749 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
34750 command.
34751 @item python
34752 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
34753 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
34754 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
34755 @item thread-info
34756 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
34757 @item data-read-memory-bytes
34758 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
34759 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
34760 @item breakpoint-notifications
34761 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
34762 CLI will be announced via async records.
34763 @item ada-task-info
34764 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
34765 @item language-option
34766 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
34767 option (@pxref{Context management}).
34768 @item info-gdb-mi-command
34769 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
34770 @item undefined-command-error-code
34771 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
34772 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
34773 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
34774 @item exec-run-start-option
34775 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
34776 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
34777 @item data-disassemble-a-option
34778 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
34779 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
34780 @end ftable
34781
34782 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
34783 @findex -list-target-features
34784
34785 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
34786 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
34787 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
34788 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
34789 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
34790 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
34791 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
34792 Example output:
34793
34794 @smallexample
34795 (gdb) -list-target-features
34796 ^done,result=["async"]
34797 @end smallexample
34798
34799 The current list of features is:
34800
34801 @table @samp
34802 @item async
34803 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
34804 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
34805 while the target is running.
34806
34807 @item reverse
34808 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
34809 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34810
34811 @end table
34812
34813 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34814 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
34815 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
34816
34817 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
34818
34819 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
34820 @findex -gdb-exit
34821
34822 @subsubheading Synopsis
34823
34824 @smallexample
34825 -gdb-exit
34826 @end smallexample
34827
34828 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
34829
34830 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34831
34832 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
34833
34834 @subsubheading Example
34835
34836 @smallexample
34837 (gdb)
34838 -gdb-exit
34839 ^exit
34840 @end smallexample
34841
34842
34843 @ignore
34844 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
34845 @findex -exec-abort
34846
34847 @subsubheading Synopsis
34848
34849 @smallexample
34850 -exec-abort
34851 @end smallexample
34852
34853 Kill the inferior running program.
34854
34855 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34856
34857 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
34858
34859 @subsubheading Example
34860 N.A.
34861 @end ignore
34862
34863
34864 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
34865 @findex -gdb-set
34866
34867 @subsubheading Synopsis
34868
34869 @smallexample
34870 -gdb-set
34871 @end smallexample
34872
34873 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
34874 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
34875
34876 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34877
34878 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
34879
34880 @subsubheading Example
34881
34882 @smallexample
34883 (gdb)
34884 -gdb-set $foo=3
34885 ^done
34886 (gdb)
34887 @end smallexample
34888
34889
34890 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
34891 @findex -gdb-show
34892
34893 @subsubheading Synopsis
34894
34895 @smallexample
34896 -gdb-show
34897 @end smallexample
34898
34899 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
34900
34901 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34902
34903 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
34904
34905 @subsubheading Example
34906
34907 @smallexample
34908 (gdb)
34909 -gdb-show annotate
34910 ^done,value="0"
34911 (gdb)
34912 @end smallexample
34913
34914 @c @subheading -gdb-source
34915
34916
34917 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
34918 @findex -gdb-version
34919
34920 @subsubheading Synopsis
34921
34922 @smallexample
34923 -gdb-version
34924 @end smallexample
34925
34926 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
34927
34928 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34929
34930 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
34931 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
34932
34933 @subsubheading Example
34934
34935 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
34936 @c box in TeX.
34937 @smallexample
34938 (gdb)
34939 -gdb-version
34940 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
34941 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34942 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
34943 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
34944 ~ certain conditions.
34945 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34946 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
34947 ~ details.
34948 ~This GDB was configured as
34949 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
34950 ^done
34951 (gdb)
34952 @end smallexample
34953
34954 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
34955 @findex -list-thread-groups
34956
34957 @subheading Synopsis
34958
34959 @smallexample
34960 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
34961 @end smallexample
34962
34963 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
34964 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
34965 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
34966 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
34967 top-level thread groups.
34968
34969 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
34970 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
34971 available on the target.
34972
34973 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
34974 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
34975 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
34976 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
34977 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
34978 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
34979 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
34980 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
34981
34982 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
34983 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
34984 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
34985 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
34986 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
34987 @samp{threads} field.
34988
34989 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
34990 the following caveats:
34991
34992 @itemize @bullet
34993 @item
34994 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
34995 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
34996 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
34997
34998 @item
34999 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
35000 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
35001 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
35002 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
35003 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
35004 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
35005
35006 @end itemize
35007
35008 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
35009 have the following fields:
35010
35011 @table @code
35012 @item id
35013 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
35014 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
35015 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
35016
35017 @item type
35018 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
35019 valid type.
35020
35021 @item pid
35022 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
35023 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
35024
35025 @item exit-code
35026 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
35027 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
35028 only if the process is not running.
35029
35030 @item num_children
35031 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
35032 absent for an available thread group.
35033
35034 @item threads
35035 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
35036 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
35037 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
35038
35039 @item cores
35040 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
35041 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
35042 such information is not available.
35043
35044 @item executable
35045 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
35046 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
35047 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
35048
35049 @end table
35050
35051 @subheading Example
35052
35053 @smallexample
35054 @value{GDBP}
35055 -list-thread-groups
35056 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
35057 -list-thread-groups 17
35058 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
35059 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
35060 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
35061 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
35062 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
35063 -list-thread-groups --available
35064 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
35065 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
35066 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
35067 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
35068 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
35069 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
35070 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
35071 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
35072 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
35073 @end smallexample
35074
35075 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
35076 @findex -info-os
35077
35078 @subsubheading Synopsis
35079
35080 @smallexample
35081 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
35082 @end smallexample
35083
35084 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
35085 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
35086 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
35087 of data of that type.
35088
35089 The types of information available depend on the target operating
35090 system.
35091
35092 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35093
35094 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
35095
35096 @subsubheading Example
35097
35098 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
35099 like this:
35100
35101 @smallexample
35102 @value{GDBP}
35103 -info-os
35104 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
35105 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
35106 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
35107 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
35108 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
35109 col2="CPUs"@},
35110 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
35111 col2="File descriptors"@},
35112 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
35113 col2="Kernel modules"@},
35114 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
35115 col2="Message queues"@},
35116 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
35117 col2="Processes"@},
35118 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
35119 col2="Process groups"@},
35120 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
35121 col2="Semaphores"@},
35122 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
35123 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
35124 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
35125 col2="Sockets"@},
35126 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
35127 col2="Threads"@}]
35128 @value{GDBP}
35129 -info-os processes
35130 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
35131 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
35132 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
35133 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
35134 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
35135 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
35136 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
35137 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
35138 ...
35139 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
35140 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
35141 (gdb)
35142 @end smallexample
35143
35144 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
35145 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
35146 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
35147 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
35148 @code{info os} omits it.)
35149
35150 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
35151 @findex -add-inferior
35152
35153 @subheading Synopsis
35154
35155 @smallexample
35156 -add-inferior
35157 @end smallexample
35158
35159 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
35160 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
35161 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
35162 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
35163 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
35164 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
35165
35166 @subheading Example
35167
35168 @smallexample
35169 @value{GDBP}
35170 -add-inferior
35171 ^done,inferior="i3"
35172 @end smallexample
35173
35174 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
35175 @findex -interpreter-exec
35176
35177 @subheading Synopsis
35178
35179 @smallexample
35180 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
35181 @end smallexample
35182 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
35183
35184 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
35185
35186 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35187
35188 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
35189
35190 @subheading Example
35191
35192 @smallexample
35193 (gdb)
35194 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
35195 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
35196 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
35197 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
35198 ^done
35199 (gdb)
35200 @end smallexample
35201
35202 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
35203 @findex -inferior-tty-set
35204
35205 @subheading Synopsis
35206
35207 @smallexample
35208 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
35209 @end smallexample
35210
35211 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
35212
35213 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35214
35215 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
35216
35217 @subheading Example
35218
35219 @smallexample
35220 (gdb)
35221 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
35222 ^done
35223 (gdb)
35224 @end smallexample
35225
35226 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
35227 @findex -inferior-tty-show
35228
35229 @subheading Synopsis
35230
35231 @smallexample
35232 -inferior-tty-show
35233 @end smallexample
35234
35235 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
35236
35237 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35238
35239 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
35240
35241 @subheading Example
35242
35243 @smallexample
35244 (gdb)
35245 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
35246 ^done
35247 (gdb)
35248 -inferior-tty-show
35249 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
35250 (gdb)
35251 @end smallexample
35252
35253 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
35254 @findex -enable-timings
35255
35256 @subheading Synopsis
35257
35258 @smallexample
35259 -enable-timings [yes | no]
35260 @end smallexample
35261
35262 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
35263 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
35264 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
35265 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
35266
35267 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35268
35269 No equivalent.
35270
35271 @subheading Example
35272
35273 @smallexample
35274 (gdb)
35275 -enable-timings
35276 ^done
35277 (gdb)
35278 -break-insert main
35279 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
35280 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
35281 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
35282 times="0"@},
35283 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
35284 (gdb)
35285 -enable-timings no
35286 ^done
35287 (gdb)
35288 -exec-run
35289 ^running
35290 (gdb)
35291 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
35292 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
35293 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
35294 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
35295 (gdb)
35296 @end smallexample
35297
35298 @subheading The @code{-complete} Command
35299 @findex -complete
35300
35301 @subheading Synopsis
35302
35303 @smallexample
35304 -complete @var{command}
35305 @end smallexample
35306
35307 Show a list of completions for partially typed CLI @var{command}.
35308
35309 This command is intended for @sc{gdb/mi} frontends that cannot use two separate
35310 CLI and MI channels --- for example: because of lack of PTYs like on Windows or
35311 because @value{GDBN} is used remotely via a SSH connection.
35312
35313 @subheading Result
35314
35315 The result consists of two or three fields:
35316
35317 @table @samp
35318 @item completion
35319 This field contains the completed @var{command}. If @var{command}
35320 has no known completions, this field is omitted.
35321
35322 @item matches
35323 This field contains a (possibly empty) array of matches. It is always present.
35324
35325 @item max_completions_reached
35326 This field contains @code{1} if number of known completions is above
35327 @code{max-completions} limit (@pxref{Completion}), otherwise it contains
35328 @code{0}. It is always present.
35329
35330 @end table
35331
35332 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35333
35334 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{complete}.
35335
35336 @subheading Example
35337
35338 @smallexample
35339 (gdb)
35340 -complete br
35341 ^done,completion="break",
35342 matches=["break","break-range"],
35343 max_completions_reached="0"
35344 (gdb)
35345 -complete "b ma"
35346 ^done,completion="b ma",
35347 matches=["b madvise","b main"],max_completions_reached="0"
35348 (gdb)
35349 -complete "b push_b"
35350 ^done,completion="b push_back(",
35351 matches=[
35352 "b A::push_back(void*)",
35353 "b std::string::push_back(char)",
35354 "b std::vector<int, std::allocator<int> >::push_back(int&&)"],
35355 max_completions_reached="0"
35356 (gdb)
35357 -complete "nonexist"
35358 ^done,matches=[],max_completions_reached="0"
35359 (gdb)
35360
35361 @end smallexample
35362
35363 @node Annotations
35364 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
35365
35366 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
35367 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
35368 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
35369 relatively high level.
35370
35371 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
35372 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
35373
35374 @ignore
35375 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
35376 @end ignore
35377
35378 @menu
35379 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
35380 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
35381 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
35382 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
35383 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
35384 * Annotations for Running::
35385 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
35386 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
35387 @end menu
35388
35389 @node Annotations Overview
35390 @section What is an Annotation?
35391 @cindex annotations
35392
35393 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
35394 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
35395 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
35396 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
35397 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
35398 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
35399 cannot contain newline characters.
35400
35401 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
35402 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
35403 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
35404 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
35405 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
35406 means those three characters as output.
35407
35408 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
35409 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
35410 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
35411 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
35412 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
35413 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
35414 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
35415 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
35416 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
35417
35418 @table @code
35419 @kindex set annotate
35420 @item set annotate @var{level}
35421 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
35422 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
35423
35424 @item show annotate
35425 @kindex show annotate
35426 Show the current annotation level.
35427 @end table
35428
35429 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
35430
35431 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
35432
35433 @smallexample
35434 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
35435 GNU gdb 6.0
35436 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
35437 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
35438 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
35439 under certain conditions.
35440 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
35441 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
35442 for details.
35443 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
35444
35445 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
35446 (@value{GDBP})
35447 ^Z^Zprompt
35448 @kbd{quit}
35449
35450 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
35451 $
35452 @end smallexample
35453
35454 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
35455 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
35456 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
35457 output from @value{GDBN}.
35458
35459 @node Server Prefix
35460 @section The Server Prefix
35461 @cindex server prefix
35462
35463 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
35464 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
35465 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
35466 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
35467 a transparent manner.
35468
35469 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
35470 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
35471 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
35472 @code{print} command.
35473
35474 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
35475 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
35476
35477 @node Prompting
35478 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
35479
35480 @cindex annotations for prompts
35481 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
35482 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
35483 over, etc.
35484
35485 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
35486 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
35487 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
35488 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
35489 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
35490 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
35491 features the following annotations:
35492
35493 @smallexample
35494 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
35495 ^Z^Zprompt
35496 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
35497 @end smallexample
35498
35499 The input types are
35500
35501 @table @code
35502 @findex pre-prompt annotation
35503 @findex prompt annotation
35504 @findex post-prompt annotation
35505 @item prompt
35506 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
35507
35508 @findex pre-commands annotation
35509 @findex commands annotation
35510 @findex post-commands annotation
35511 @item commands
35512 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
35513 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
35514
35515 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
35516 @findex overload-choice annotation
35517 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
35518 @item overload-choice
35519 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
35520
35521 @findex pre-query annotation
35522 @findex query annotation
35523 @findex post-query annotation
35524 @item query
35525 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
35526
35527 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
35528 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
35529 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
35530 @item prompt-for-continue
35531 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
35532 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
35533 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
35534 presence of annotations.
35535 @end table
35536
35537 @node Errors
35538 @section Errors
35539 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
35540
35541 @findex quit annotation
35542 @smallexample
35543 ^Z^Zquit
35544 @end smallexample
35545
35546 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
35547
35548 @findex error annotation
35549 @smallexample
35550 ^Z^Zerror
35551 @end smallexample
35552
35553 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
35554
35555 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
35556 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
35557 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
35558 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
35559 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
35560 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
35561 to the top level.
35562
35563 @findex error-begin annotation
35564 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
35565
35566 @smallexample
35567 ^Z^Zerror-begin
35568 @end smallexample
35569
35570 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
35571 message.
35572
35573 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
35574 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
35575 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
35576
35577 @node Invalidation
35578 @section Invalidation Notices
35579
35580 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
35581 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
35582 changed.
35583
35584 @table @code
35585 @findex frames-invalid annotation
35586 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
35587
35588 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
35589 have changed.
35590
35591 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
35592 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
35593
35594 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
35595 deleted a breakpoint.
35596 @end table
35597
35598 @node Annotations for Running
35599 @section Running the Program
35600 @cindex annotations for running programs
35601
35602 @findex starting annotation
35603 @findex stopping annotation
35604 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
35605 @code{step} or @code{continue},
35606
35607 @smallexample
35608 ^Z^Zstarting
35609 @end smallexample
35610
35611 is output. When the program stops,
35612
35613 @smallexample
35614 ^Z^Zstopped
35615 @end smallexample
35616
35617 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
35618 annotations describe how the program stopped.
35619
35620 @table @code
35621 @findex exited annotation
35622 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
35623 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
35624 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
35625
35626 @findex signalled annotation
35627 @findex signal-name annotation
35628 @findex signal-name-end annotation
35629 @findex signal-string annotation
35630 @findex signal-string-end annotation
35631 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
35632 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
35633 annotation continues:
35634
35635 @smallexample
35636 @var{intro-text}
35637 ^Z^Zsignal-name
35638 @var{name}
35639 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
35640 @var{middle-text}
35641 ^Z^Zsignal-string
35642 @var{string}
35643 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
35644 @var{end-text}
35645 @end smallexample
35646
35647 @noindent
35648 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
35649 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
35650 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
35651 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
35652 user's benefit and have no particular format.
35653
35654 @findex signal annotation
35655 @item ^Z^Zsignal
35656 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
35657 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
35658 terminated with it.
35659
35660 @findex breakpoint annotation
35661 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
35662 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
35663
35664 @findex watchpoint annotation
35665 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
35666 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
35667 @end table
35668
35669 @node Source Annotations
35670 @section Displaying Source
35671 @cindex annotations for source display
35672
35673 @findex source annotation
35674 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
35675
35676 @smallexample
35677 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
35678 @end smallexample
35679
35680 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
35681 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
35682 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
35683 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
35684 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
35685 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
35686 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
35687 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
35688 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
35689 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
35690 depend on the language).
35691
35692 @node JIT Interface
35693 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
35694 @cindex just-in-time compilation
35695 @cindex JIT compilation interface
35696
35697 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
35698 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
35699 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
35700 performance while maintaining platform independence.
35701
35702 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
35703 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
35704 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
35705 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
35706 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
35707 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
35708
35709 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
35710 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
35711 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
35712 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
35713 LLVM JIT.
35714
35715 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
35716 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
35717 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
35718 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
35719 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
35720 out about additional code.
35721
35722 @menu
35723 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
35724 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
35725 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
35726 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
35727 @end menu
35728
35729 @node Declarations
35730 @section JIT Declarations
35731
35732 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
35733 implement the interface:
35734
35735 @smallexample
35736 typedef enum
35737 @{
35738 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
35739 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
35740 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
35741 @} jit_actions_t;
35742
35743 struct jit_code_entry
35744 @{
35745 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
35746 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
35747 const char *symfile_addr;
35748 uint64_t symfile_size;
35749 @};
35750
35751 struct jit_descriptor
35752 @{
35753 uint32_t version;
35754 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
35755 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
35756 uint32_t action_flag;
35757 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
35758 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
35759 @};
35760
35761 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
35762 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
35763
35764 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
35765 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
35766 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
35767 @end smallexample
35768
35769 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
35770 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
35771 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
35772
35773 @node Registering Code
35774 @section Registering Code
35775
35776 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
35777
35778 @itemize @bullet
35779 @item
35780 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
35781 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
35782
35783 @item
35784 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
35785 file.
35786
35787 @item
35788 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
35789
35790 @item
35791 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
35792
35793 @item
35794 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
35795 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
35796 @end itemize
35797
35798 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
35799 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
35800 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
35801 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
35802
35803 @node Unregistering Code
35804 @section Unregistering Code
35805
35806 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
35807
35808 @itemize @bullet
35809 @item
35810 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
35811
35812 @item
35813 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
35814
35815 @item
35816 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
35817 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
35818 @end itemize
35819
35820 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
35821 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
35822
35823 @node Custom Debug Info
35824 @section Custom Debug Info
35825 @cindex custom JIT debug info
35826 @cindex JIT debug info reader
35827
35828 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
35829 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
35830 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
35831 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
35832 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
35833 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
35834 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
35835 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
35836 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
35837
35838 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
35839 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
35840 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
35841 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
35842 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
35843 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
35844 compiler.
35845
35846 @menu
35847 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
35848 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
35849 @end menu
35850
35851 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
35852 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
35853 @kindex jit-reader-load
35854 @kindex jit-reader-unload
35855
35856 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
35857 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
35858
35859 @table @code
35860 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
35861 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
35862 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
35863 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
35864 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
35865 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
35866 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
35867
35868 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
35869 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
35870 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
35871 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
35872 @code{jit-reader-load}.
35873
35874 @item jit-reader-unload
35875 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
35876
35877 @end table
35878
35879 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
35880 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
35881 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
35882
35883 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
35884 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
35885
35886 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
35887 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
35888 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
35889 the system include directory.
35890
35891 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
35892 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
35893 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
35894
35895 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
35896 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
35897
35898 @findex gdb_init_reader
35899 @smallexample
35900 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
35901 @end smallexample
35902
35903 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
35904
35905 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
35906 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
35907 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
35908 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
35909 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
35910 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
35911
35912 @smallexample
35913 struct gdb_reader_funcs
35914 @{
35915 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
35916 int reader_version;
35917
35918 /* For use by the reader. */
35919 void *priv_data;
35920
35921 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
35922 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
35923 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
35924 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
35925 @};
35926 @end smallexample
35927
35928 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
35929 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
35930
35931 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
35932 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
35933 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
35934 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
35935 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
35936 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
35937 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
35938 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
35939 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
35940 target's address space.
35941
35942 @node In-Process Agent
35943 @chapter In-Process Agent
35944 @cindex debugging agent
35945 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
35946 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
35947 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
35948 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
35949 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
35950 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
35951 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
35952 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
35953 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
35954 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
35955 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
35956 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
35957 behavior without interrupting it.
35958
35959 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
35960 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
35961 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
35962 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
35963 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
35964 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
35965 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
35966 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
35967 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
35968
35969 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
35970 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
35971 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
35972 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
35973
35974 @anchor{Control Agent}
35975 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
35976 debugging with the following commands:
35977
35978 @table @code
35979 @kindex set agent on
35980 @item set agent on
35981 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
35982 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
35983 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
35984 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
35985 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
35986 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
35987
35988 @kindex set agent off
35989 @item set agent off
35990 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
35991 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
35992
35993 @kindex show agent
35994 @item show agent
35995 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
35996 the in-process agent.
35997 @end table
35998
35999 @menu
36000 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
36001 @end menu
36002
36003 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
36004 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
36005 @cindex in-process agent protocol
36006
36007 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
36008 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
36009 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
36010 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
36011 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
36012 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
36013 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
36014 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
36015 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
36016
36017 @menu
36018 * IPA Protocol Objects::
36019 * IPA Protocol Commands::
36020 @end menu
36021
36022 @node IPA Protocol Objects
36023 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
36024 @cindex ipa protocol objects
36025
36026 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
36027 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
36028
36029 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
36030 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
36031 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
36032 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
36033
36034 @enumerate
36035 @item
36036 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
36037 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
36038 @item
36039 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
36040 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
36041 the other one.
36042 @end enumerate
36043
36044 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
36045
36046 @enumerate
36047 @item
36048 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
36049 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
36050 @anchor{agent expression object}
36051 @item
36052 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
36053 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
36054 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
36055 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
36056 @item
36057 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36058 @anchor{tracepoint object}
36059
36060 @end enumerate
36061
36062 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
36063 object:
36064
36065 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
36066 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
36067 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
36068 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
36069 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
36070 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
36071 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
36072 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
36073 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
36074 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
36075 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
36076 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
36077 memory address for collecting.
36078 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
36079 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
36080 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
36081 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
36082 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
36083 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
36084 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
36085 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
36086 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
36087 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
36088 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
36089 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
36090 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
36091 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
36092 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
36093 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
36094 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
36095 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
36096 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
36097 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
36098 @ref{agent expression object}
36099 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
36100 @ref{agent expression object}
36101 @item actions @tab variable
36102 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
36103 @end multitable
36104
36105 @node IPA Protocol Commands
36106 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
36107 @cindex ipa protocol commands
36108
36109 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
36110 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
36111
36112 @table @samp
36113
36114 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
36115 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
36116 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
36117 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
36118 in IPA finally.
36119
36120 Replies:
36121 @table @samp
36122 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
36123 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
36124 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
36125 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
36126 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
36127 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
36128 @item E @var{NN}
36129 for an error
36130
36131 @end table
36132
36133 @item close
36134 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
36135 is about to kill inferiors.
36136
36137 @item qTfSTM
36138 @xref{qTfSTM}.
36139 @item qTsSTM
36140 @xref{qTsSTM}.
36141 @item qTSTMat
36142 @xref{qTSTMat}.
36143 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
36144 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
36145
36146 Replies:
36147 @table @samp
36148 @item E @var{NN}
36149 for an error
36150 @end table
36151 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
36152 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
36153 @end table
36154
36155 @node GDB Bugs
36156 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
36157 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
36158 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
36159
36160 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
36161
36162 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
36163 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
36164 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
36165 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
36166
36167 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
36168 information that enables us to fix the bug.
36169
36170 @menu
36171 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
36172 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
36173 @end menu
36174
36175 @node Bug Criteria
36176 @section Have You Found a Bug?
36177 @cindex bug criteria
36178
36179 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
36180
36181 @itemize @bullet
36182 @cindex fatal signal
36183 @cindex debugger crash
36184 @cindex crash of debugger
36185 @item
36186 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
36187 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
36188
36189 @cindex error on valid input
36190 @item
36191 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
36192 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
36193 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
36194
36195 @cindex invalid input
36196 @item
36197 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
36198 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
36199 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
36200 for traditional practice''.
36201
36202 @item
36203 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
36204 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
36205 @end itemize
36206
36207 @node Bug Reporting
36208 @section How to Report Bugs
36209 @cindex bug reports
36210 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
36211
36212 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
36213 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
36214 contact that organization first.
36215
36216 You can find contact information for many support companies and
36217 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
36218 distribution.
36219 @c should add a web page ref...
36220
36221 @ifset BUGURL
36222 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
36223 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
36224 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
36225 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
36226 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
36227 be used.
36228
36229 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
36230 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
36231 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
36232 @samp{bug-gdb}.
36233
36234 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
36235 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
36236 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
36237 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
36238 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
36239 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
36240 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
36241 bug reports to the mailing list.
36242 @end ifset
36243 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
36244 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
36245 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
36246 @end ifclear
36247 @end ifset
36248
36249 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
36250 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
36251 fact or leave it out, state it!
36252
36253 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
36254 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
36255 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
36256 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
36257 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
36258 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
36259 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
36260 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
36261 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
36262
36263 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
36264 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
36265 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
36266 self-contained.
36267
36268 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36269 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
36270 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
36271 bugs properly.
36272
36273 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
36274
36275 @itemize @bullet
36276 @item
36277 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
36278 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
36279 version}.
36280
36281 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
36282 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
36283
36284 @item
36285 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
36286 version number.
36287
36288 @item
36289 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
36290 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
36291 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
36292 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
36293
36294 @item
36295 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
36296 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
36297
36298 @item
36299 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
36300 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
36301 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
36302 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
36303 those compilers.
36304
36305 @item
36306 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
36307 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
36308 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
36309 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
36310
36311 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
36312 and then we might not encounter the bug.
36313
36314 @item
36315 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
36316 reproduce the bug.
36317
36318 @item
36319 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
36320 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
36321
36322 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
36323 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
36324 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
36325 a chance to make a mistake.
36326
36327 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
36328 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
36329 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
36330 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
36331 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
36332 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
36333 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
36334 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
36335
36336 @pindex script
36337 @cindex recording a session script
36338 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
36339 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
36340 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
36341 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
36342
36343 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
36344 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
36345
36346 @item
36347 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
36348 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
36349 it by context, not by line number.
36350
36351 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
36352 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
36353
36354 @end itemize
36355
36356 Here are some things that are not necessary:
36357
36358 @itemize @bullet
36359 @item
36360 A description of the envelope of the bug.
36361
36362 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
36363 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
36364 changes will not affect it.
36365
36366 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
36367 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
36368 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
36369 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
36370
36371 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
36372 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
36373 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
36374 less time, and so on.
36375
36376 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
36377 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
36378
36379 @item
36380 A patch for the bug.
36381
36382 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
36383 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
36384 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
36385 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
36386
36387 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
36388 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
36389 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
36390 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
36391
36392 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
36393 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
36394 help us to understand.
36395
36396 @item
36397 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
36398
36399 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
36400 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
36401 @end itemize
36402
36403 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
36404 @c and consists of the two following files:
36405 @c rluser.texi
36406 @c hsuser.texi
36407 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
36408 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
36409 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
36410 @include rluser.texi
36411 @include hsuser.texi
36412 @end ifclear
36413
36414 @node In Memoriam
36415 @appendix In Memoriam
36416
36417 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
36418 contributors:
36419
36420 @table @code
36421 @item Fred Fish
36422 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
36423 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
36424 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
36425
36426 @item Michael Snyder
36427 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
36428 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
36429 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
36430 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
36431 @end table
36432
36433 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
36434 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
36435
36436 @node Formatting Documentation
36437 @appendix Formatting Documentation
36438
36439 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
36440 @cindex reference card
36441 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
36442 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
36443 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
36444 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
36445 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
36446 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
36447
36448 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
36449 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
36450
36451 @smallexample
36452 make refcard.dvi
36453 @end smallexample
36454
36455 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
36456 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
36457 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
36458 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
36459 your @sc{dvi} output program.
36460
36461 @cindex documentation
36462
36463 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
36464 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
36465 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
36466 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
36467 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
36468 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
36469
36470 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
36471 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
36472 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
36473 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
36474 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
36475 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
36476 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
36477 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
36478
36479 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
36480 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
36481 @code{makeinfo}.
36482
36483 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
36484 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
36485 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
36486
36487 @smallexample
36488 cd gdb
36489 make gdb.info
36490 @end smallexample
36491
36492 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
36493 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
36494 Texinfo definitions file.
36495
36496 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
36497 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
36498 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
36499 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
36500 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
36501 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
36502 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
36503
36504 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
36505 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
36506 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
36507 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
36508 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
36509 directory.
36510
36511 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
36512 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
36513 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
36514 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
36515
36516 @smallexample
36517 make gdb.dvi
36518 @end smallexample
36519
36520 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
36521
36522 @node Installing GDB
36523 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
36524 @cindex installation
36525
36526 @menu
36527 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
36528 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
36529 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
36530 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
36531 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
36532 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
36533 @end menu
36534
36535 @node Requirements
36536 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
36537 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
36538
36539 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
36540 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
36541
36542 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
36543 @table @asis
36544 @item C@t{++}11 compiler
36545 @value{GDBN} is written in C@t{++}11. It should be buildable with any
36546 recent C@t{++}11 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
36547
36548 @item GNU make
36549 @value{GDBN}'s build system relies on features only found in the GNU
36550 make program. Other variants of @code{make} will not work.
36551 @end table
36552
36553 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
36554 @table @asis
36555 @item Expat
36556 @anchor{Expat}
36557 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
36558 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
36559 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
36560 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
36561 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
36562 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
36563
36564 Expat is used for:
36565
36566 @itemize @bullet
36567 @item
36568 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
36569 @item
36570 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
36571 @item
36572 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
36573 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
36574 @item
36575 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
36576 @item
36577 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
36578 @item
36579 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
36580 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
36581 @end itemize
36582
36583 @item Guile
36584 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using GNU Guile. @xref{Guile}. By
36585 default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Guile libraries are
36586 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
36587 @code{--with-guile} option to request Guile, and pass either the Guile
36588 version number or the file name of the relevant @code{pkg-config}
36589 program to choose a particular version of Guile.
36590
36591 @item iconv
36592 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
36593 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
36594 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
36595 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
36596
36597 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
36598 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to
36599 find it. This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies
36600 the directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. This program is
36601 run in order to make a list of the available character sets.
36602
36603 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If
36604 Libiconv is installed in a standard place, @value{GDBN} will
36605 automatically use it if it is needed. If you have previously
36606 installed Libiconv in a non-standard place, you can use the
36607 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to @file{configure}.
36608
36609 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
36610 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
36611 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
36612 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
36613 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
36614 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
36615 Libiconv, unpack it inside the top-level directory of the @value{GDBN}
36616 source tree, and then rename the directory holding the Libiconv source
36617 code to @samp{libiconv}.
36618
36619 @item lzma
36620 @value{GDBN} can support debugging sections that are compressed with
36621 the LZMA library. @xref{MiniDebugInfo}. If this library is not
36622 included with your operating system, you can find it in the xz package
36623 at @url{http://tukaani.org/xz/}. If the LZMA library is available in
36624 the usual place, then the @file{configure} script will use it
36625 automatically. If it is installed in an unusual path, you can use the
36626 @option{--with-lzma-prefix} option to specify its location.
36627
36628 @item MPFR
36629 @anchor{MPFR}
36630 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
36631 library. This library may be included with your operating system
36632 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
36633 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
36634 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
36635 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
36636 option to specify its location.
36637
36638 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
36639 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
36640 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
36641 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
36642
36643 @item Python
36644 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using Python language. @xref{Python}.
36645 By default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Python libraries are
36646 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
36647 @code{--with-python} option to request Python, and pass either the
36648 file name of the relevant @code{python} executable, or the name of the
36649 directory in which Python is installed, to choose a particular
36650 installation of Python.
36651
36652 @item zlib
36653 @cindex compressed debug sections
36654 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
36655 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
36656 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
36657 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
36658 information in such binaries.
36659
36660 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
36661 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
36662 @url{http://zlib.net}.
36663 @end table
36664
36665 @node Running Configure
36666 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
36667 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
36668 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
36669 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
36670 build the @code{gdb} program.
36671 @iftex
36672 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
36673 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
36674 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
36675 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
36676 @end iftex
36677
36678 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
36679 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
36680 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
36681
36682 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
36683 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
36684
36685 @table @code
36686 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
36687 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
36688
36689 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
36690 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
36691
36692 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
36693 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
36694
36695 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
36696 @sc{gnu} include files
36697
36698 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
36699 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
36700
36701 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
36702 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
36703
36704 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
36705 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
36706 @end table
36707
36708 There may be other subdirectories as well.
36709
36710 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
36711 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
36712 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
36713
36714 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
36715 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
36716 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
36717 argument.
36718
36719 For example:
36720
36721 @smallexample
36722 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
36723 ./configure
36724 make
36725 @end smallexample
36726
36727 Running @samp{configure} and then running @code{make} builds the
36728 included supporting libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured
36729 source files, and the binaries, are left in the corresponding source
36730 directories.
36731
36732 @need 750
36733 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
36734 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
36735 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
36736
36737 @smallexample
36738 sh configure
36739 @end smallexample
36740
36741 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
36742 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
36743 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
36744 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
36745 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
36746 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
36747 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
36748 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
36749 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
36750
36751 You can install @code{@value{GDBN}} anywhere. The best way to do this
36752 is to pass the @code{--prefix} option to @code{configure}, and then
36753 install it with @code{make install}.
36754
36755 @node Separate Objdir
36756 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
36757
36758 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
36759 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
36760 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
36761 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
36762 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
36763 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
36764 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
36765 program specified there.
36766
36767 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
36768 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
36769 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
36770 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
36771 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
36772 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
36773
36774 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
36775 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
36776
36777 @smallexample
36778 @group
36779 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
36780 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
36781 cd ../gdb-sun4
36782 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure
36783 make
36784 @end group
36785 @end smallexample
36786
36787 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
36788 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
36789 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
36790 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
36791 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
36792 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
36793
36794 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
36795 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
36796 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
36797 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
36798 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
36799
36800 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
36801 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
36802 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
36803 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
36804 You specify a cross-debugging target by
36805 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
36806
36807 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
36808 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
36809 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
36810
36811 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
36812 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
36813 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
36814 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
36815 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
36816
36817 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
36818 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
36819 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
36820 with each other.
36821
36822 @node Config Names
36823 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
36824
36825 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
36826 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
36827 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
36828 of information in the following pattern:
36829
36830 @smallexample
36831 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
36832 @end smallexample
36833
36834 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
36835 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
36836 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
36837
36838 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
36839 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
36840 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
36841 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
36842 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
36843 abbreviations---for example:
36844
36845 @smallexample
36846 % sh config.sub i386-linux
36847 i386-pc-linux-gnu
36848 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
36849 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
36850 % sh config.sub hp9k700
36851 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
36852 % sh config.sub sun4
36853 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
36854 % sh config.sub sun3
36855 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
36856 % sh config.sub i986v
36857 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
36858 @end smallexample
36859
36860 @noindent
36861 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
36862 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
36863
36864 @node Configure Options
36865 @section @file{configure} Options
36866
36867 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
36868 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure}
36869 also has several other options not listed here. @inforef{Running
36870 configure scripts,,autoconf.info}, for a full
36871 explanation of @file{configure}.
36872
36873 @smallexample
36874 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
36875 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
36876 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
36877 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
36878 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
36879 @end smallexample
36880
36881 @noindent
36882 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
36883 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
36884 @samp{--}.
36885
36886 @table @code
36887 @item --help
36888 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
36889
36890 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
36891 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
36892 @file{@var{dir}}.
36893
36894 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
36895 Configure the source to install programs under directory
36896 @file{@var{dir}}.
36897
36898 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
36899 @need 2000
36900 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
36901 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
36902 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
36903 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
36904 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
36905 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
36906 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
36907 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
36908 @var{dirname}.
36909
36910 @item --target=@var{target}
36911 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
36912 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
36913 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
36914
36915 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available
36916 targets. Also see the @code{--enable-targets} option, below.
36917 @end table
36918
36919 There are many other options that are specific to @value{GDBN}. This
36920 lists just the most common ones; there are some very specialized
36921 options not described here.
36922
36923 @table @code
36924 @item --enable-targets=@r{[}@var{target}@r{]}@dots{}
36925 @itemx --enable-targets=all
36926 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the
36927 specified list of targets. The special value @samp{all} configures
36928 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs running on any target it supports.
36929
36930 @item --with-gdb-datadir=@var{path}
36931 Set the @value{GDBN}-specific data directory. @value{GDBN} will look
36932 here for certain supporting files or scripts. This defaults to the
36933 @file{gdb} subdirectory of @samp{datadi} (which can be set using
36934 @code{--datadir}).
36935
36936 @item --with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}
36937 Sets up the default source path substitution rule so that directory
36938 names recorded in debug information will be automatically adjusted for
36939 any directory under @var{dir}. @var{dir} should be a subdirectory of
36940 @value{GDBN}'s configured prefix, the one mentioned in the
36941 @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix} options to configure. This
36942 option is useful if GDB is supposed to be moved to a different place
36943 after it is built.
36944
36945 @item --enable-64-bit-bfd
36946 Enable 64-bit support in BFD on 32-bit hosts.
36947
36948 @item --disable-gdbmi
36949 Build @value{GDBN} without the GDB/MI machine interface
36950 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
36951
36952 @item --enable-tui
36953 Build @value{GDBN} with the text-mode full-screen user interface
36954 (TUI). Requires a curses library (ncurses and cursesX are also
36955 supported).
36956
36957 @item --with-curses
36958 Use the curses library instead of the termcap library, for text-mode
36959 terminal operations.
36960
36961 @item --with-libunwind-ia64
36962 Use the libunwind library for unwinding function call stack on ia64
36963 target platforms. See http://www.nongnu.org/libunwind/index.html for
36964 details.
36965
36966 @item --with-system-readline
36967 Use the readline library installed on the host, rather than the
36968 library supplied as part of @value{GDBN}. Readline 7 or newer is
36969 required; this is enforced by the build system.
36970
36971 @item --with-system-zlib
36972 Use the zlib library installed on the host, rather than the library
36973 supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
36974
36975 @item --with-expat
36976 Build @value{GDBN} with Expat, a library for XML parsing. (Done by
36977 default if libexpat is installed and found at configure time.) This
36978 library is used to read XML files supplied with @value{GDBN}. If it
36979 is unavailable, some features, such as remote protocol memory maps,
36980 target descriptions, and shared library lists, that are based on XML
36981 files, will not be available in @value{GDBN}. If your host does not
36982 have libexpat installed, you can get the latest version from
36983 `http://expat.sourceforge.net'.
36984
36985 @item --with-libiconv-prefix@r{[}=@var{dir}@r{]}
36986
36987 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU libiconv, a character set encoding
36988 conversion library. This is not done by default, as on GNU systems
36989 the @code{iconv} that is built in to the C library is sufficient. If
36990 your host does not have a working @code{iconv}, you can get the latest
36991 version of GNU iconv from `https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/'.
36992
36993 @value{GDBN}'s build system also supports building GNU libiconv as
36994 part of the overall build. @xref{Requirements}.
36995
36996 @item --with-lzma
36997 Build @value{GDBN} with LZMA, a compression library. (Done by default
36998 if liblzma is installed and found at configure time.) LZMA is used by
36999 @value{GDBN}'s "mini debuginfo" feature, which is only useful on
37000 platforms using the ELF object file format. If your host does not
37001 have liblzma installed, you can get the latest version from
37002 `https://tukaani.org/xz/'.
37003
37004 @item --with-mpfr
37005 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU MPFR, a library for multiple-precision
37006 floating-point computation with correct rounding. (Done by default if
37007 GNU MPFR is installed and found at configure time.) This library is
37008 used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during expression
37009 evaluation when the target uses different floating-point formats than
37010 the host. If GNU MPFR is not available, @value{GDBN} will fall back
37011 to using host floating-point arithmetic. If your host does not have
37012 GNU MPFR installed, you can get the latest version from
37013 `http://www.mpfr.org'.
37014
37015 @item --with-python@r{[}=@var{python}@r{]}
37016 Build @value{GDBN} with Python scripting support. (Done by default if
37017 libpython is present and found at configure time.) Python makes
37018 @value{GDBN} scripting much more powerful than the restricted CLI
37019 scripting language. If your host does not have Python installed, you
37020 can find it on `http://www.python.org/download/'. The oldest version
37021 of Python supported by GDB is 2.6. The optional argument @var{python}
37022 is used to find the Python headers and libraries. It can be either
37023 the name of a Python executable, or the name of the directory in which
37024 Python is installed.
37025
37026 @item --with-guile[=GUILE]'
37027 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU Guile scripting support. (Done by default
37028 if libguile is present and found at configure time.) If your host
37029 does not have Guile installed, you can find it at
37030 `https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/'. The optional argument GUILE
37031 can be a version number, which will cause @code{configure} to try to
37032 use that version of Guile; or the file name of a @code{pkg-config}
37033 executable, which will be queried to find the information needed to
37034 compile and link against Guile.
37035
37036 @item --without-included-regex
37037 Don't use the regex library included with @value{GDBN} (as part of the
37038 libiberty library). This is the default on hosts with version 2 of
37039 the GNU C library.
37040
37041 @item --with-sysroot=@var{dir}
37042 Use @var{dir} as the default system root directory for libraries whose
37043 file names begin with @file{/lib}' or @file{/usr/lib'}. (The value of
37044 @var{dir} can be modified at run time by using the @command{set
37045 sysroot} command.) If @var{dir} is under the @value{GDBN} configured
37046 prefix (set with @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix options}, the
37047 default system root will be automatically adjusted if and when
37048 @value{GDBN} is moved to a different location.
37049
37050 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
37051 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load a system-wide init file.
37052 @var{file} should be an absolute file name. If @var{file} is in a
37053 directory under the configured prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to
37054 another location after being built, the location of the system-wide
37055 init file will be adjusted accordingly.
37056
37057 @item --enable-build-warnings
37058 When building the @value{GDBN} sources, ask the compiler to warn about
37059 any code which looks even vaguely suspicious. It passes many
37060 different warning flags, depending on the exact version of the
37061 compiler you are using.
37062
37063 @item --enable-werror
37064 Treat compiler warnings as werrors. It adds the @code{-Werror} flag
37065 to the compiler, which will fail the compilation if the compiler
37066 outputs any warning messages.
37067
37068 @item --enable-ubsan
37069 Enable the GCC undefined behavior sanitizer. This is disabled by
37070 default, but passing @code{--enable-ubsan=yes} or
37071 @code{--enable-ubsan=auto} to @code{configure} will enable it. The
37072 undefined behavior sanitizer checks for C@t{++} undefined behavior.
37073 It has a performance cost, so if you are looking at @value{GDBN}'s
37074 performance, you should disable it. The undefined behavior sanitizer
37075 was first introduced in GCC 4.9.
37076 @end table
37077
37078 @node System-wide configuration
37079 @section System-wide configuration and settings
37080 @cindex system-wide init file
37081
37082 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
37083 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
37084 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
37085
37086 Here is the corresponding configure option:
37087
37088 @table @code
37089 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
37090 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
37091 @var{file}.
37092 @end table
37093
37094 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
37095 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
37096
37097 @itemize @bullet
37098 @item
37099 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
37100 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
37101 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
37102 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
37103 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
37104 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
37105
37106 @item
37107 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
37108 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
37109 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
37110 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
37111 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
37112 @end itemize
37113
37114 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
37115 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
37116 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
37117 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
37118 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
37119 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
37120 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
37121 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
37122 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
37123 reread.
37124
37125 @menu
37126 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
37127 @end menu
37128
37129 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
37130 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
37131 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
37132
37133 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
37134 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
37135 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
37136 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
37137 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
37138 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
37139
37140 The following scripts are currently available:
37141 @itemize @bullet
37142
37143 @item @file{elinos.py}
37144 @pindex elinos.py
37145 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
37146 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
37147 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
37148 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
37149 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
37150 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
37151
37152 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
37153 @pindex wrs-linux.py
37154 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
37155 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
37156 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
37157 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
37158
37159 @end itemize
37160
37161 @node Maintenance Commands
37162 @appendix Maintenance Commands
37163 @cindex maintenance commands
37164 @cindex internal commands
37165
37166 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
37167 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
37168 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
37169 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
37170 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
37171
37172 @table @code
37173 @kindex maint agent
37174 @kindex maint agent-eval
37175 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
37176 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
37177 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
37178 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
37179 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
37180 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
37181 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
37182 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
37183 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
37184 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
37185 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
37186 addition and return the sum.
37187 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
37188 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
37189
37190 @kindex maint agent-printf
37191 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
37192 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
37193 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
37194 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
37195 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
37196
37197 @kindex maint info breakpoints
37198 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
37199 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
37200 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
37201 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
37202 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
37203 is shown:
37204
37205 @table @code
37206 @item breakpoint
37207 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
37208
37209 @item watchpoint
37210 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
37211
37212 @item longjmp
37213 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
37214 @code{longjmp} calls.
37215
37216 @item longjmp resume
37217 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
37218
37219 @item until
37220 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
37221
37222 @item finish
37223 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
37224
37225 @item shlib events
37226 Shared library events.
37227
37228 @end table
37229
37230 @kindex maint info btrace
37231 @item maint info btrace
37232 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
37233
37234 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
37235 @item maint btrace packet-history
37236 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
37237 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
37238 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
37239 recording format.
37240
37241 @table @code
37242 @item bts
37243 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
37244 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
37245
37246 @table @asis
37247 @item Block number
37248 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
37249 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
37250 @item Highest @samp{PC}
37251 @end table
37252
37253 @item pt
37254 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
37255 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
37256 information is printed:
37257
37258 @table @asis
37259 @item Packet number
37260 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
37261 @item Trace offset
37262 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
37263 @item Packet opcode and payload
37264 @end table
37265 @end table
37266
37267 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
37268 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
37269 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
37270 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
37271 needed.
37272
37273 @kindex maint btrace clear
37274 @item maint btrace clear
37275 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
37276 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
37277
37278 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
37279 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
37280 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
37281 buffer.
37282
37283 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
37284 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
37285 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
37286 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
37287 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
37288 packet history.
37289
37290 @kindex set displaced-stepping
37291 @kindex show displaced-stepping
37292 @cindex displaced stepping support
37293 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
37294 @item set displaced-stepping
37295 @itemx show displaced-stepping
37296 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
37297 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
37298 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
37299 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
37300 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
37301
37302 @table @code
37303 @item set displaced-stepping on
37304 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
37305 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
37306
37307 @item set displaced-stepping off
37308 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
37309 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
37310
37311 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
37312 @item set displaced-stepping auto
37313 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
37314 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
37315 architecture supports displaced stepping.
37316 @end table
37317
37318 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
37319 @item maint check-psymtabs
37320 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
37321 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
37322
37323 @kindex maint check-symtabs
37324 @item maint check-symtabs
37325 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
37326
37327 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
37328 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
37329 Expand symbol tables.
37330 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
37331 names matching @var{regexp}.
37332
37333 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
37334 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
37335 @cindex demangler crashes
37336 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
37337 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
37338 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
37339 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
37340 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
37341 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
37342 option to terminate the current session.
37343
37344 @kindex maint cplus first_component
37345 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
37346 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
37347
37348 @kindex maint cplus namespace
37349 @item maint cplus namespace
37350 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
37351
37352 @kindex maint deprecate
37353 @kindex maint undeprecate
37354 @cindex deprecated commands
37355 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
37356 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
37357 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
37358 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
37359 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
37360 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
37361 the replacement as part of the warning.
37362
37363 @kindex maint dump-me
37364 @item maint dump-me
37365 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
37366 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
37367 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
37368 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
37369
37370 @kindex maint internal-error
37371 @kindex maint internal-warning
37372 @kindex maint demangler-warning
37373 @cindex demangler crashes
37374 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
37375 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
37376 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
37377
37378 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
37379 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
37380 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
37381 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
37382 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
37383 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
37384 @value{GDBN} session.
37385
37386 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
37387 used as the text of the error or warning message.
37388
37389 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
37390
37391 @smallexample
37392 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
37393 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
37394 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
37395 debugging may prove unreliable.
37396 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
37397 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
37398 (@value{GDBP})
37399 @end smallexample
37400
37401 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
37402 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
37403 @cindex demangler crashes
37404
37405 @kindex maint set internal-error
37406 @kindex maint show internal-error
37407 @kindex maint set internal-warning
37408 @kindex maint show internal-warning
37409 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
37410 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
37411 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
37412 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
37413 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
37414 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
37415 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
37416 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
37417 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
37418 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
37419 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
37420 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
37421 described in the table below.
37422
37423 @table @samp
37424 @item quit
37425 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
37426 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
37427
37428 @item corefile
37429 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
37430 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
37431 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
37432 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
37433 disabled.
37434 @end table
37435
37436 @kindex maint packet
37437 @item maint packet @var{text}
37438 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
37439 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
37440 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
37441 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
37442 checksum.
37443
37444 @kindex maint print architecture
37445 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37446 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
37447 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
37448
37449 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37450 @item maint print c-tdesc
37451 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
37452 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
37453 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
37454 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
37455 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
37456 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
37457 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
37458 modify XML target descriptions.
37459
37460 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
37461 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
37462 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
37463 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
37464
37465 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
37466 @kindex maint check libthread-db
37467 @item maint check libthread-db
37468 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
37469 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
37470 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
37471 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
37472 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
37473 on some platforms when debugging core files.
37474
37475 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
37476 @item maint print dummy-frames
37477 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
37478
37479 @smallexample
37480 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
37481 @dots{}
37482 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
37483 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
37484 58 return (a + b);
37485 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
37486 @dots{}
37487 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
37488 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
37489 (@value{GDBP})
37490 @end smallexample
37491
37492 Takes an optional file parameter.
37493
37494 @kindex maint print registers
37495 @kindex maint print raw-registers
37496 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
37497 @kindex maint print register-groups
37498 @kindex maint print remote-registers
37499 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37500 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37501 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37502 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37503 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37504 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
37505
37506 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
37507 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
37508 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
37509 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
37510 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
37511 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
37512 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
37513 and offsets in the `G' packets.
37514
37515 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
37516 write the information.
37517
37518 @kindex maint print reggroups
37519 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37520 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
37521 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
37522 information.
37523
37524 The register groups info looks like this:
37525
37526 @smallexample
37527 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
37528 Group Type
37529 general user
37530 float user
37531 all user
37532 vector user
37533 system user
37534 save internal
37535 restore internal
37536 @end smallexample
37537
37538 @kindex flushregs
37539 @item flushregs
37540 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
37541
37542 @kindex maint print objfiles
37543 @cindex info for known object files
37544 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
37545 Print a dump of all known object files.
37546 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
37547 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
37548 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
37549
37550 @kindex maint print user-registers
37551 @cindex user registers
37552 @item maint print user-registers
37553 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
37554 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
37555 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
37556 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
37557 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
37558 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
37559 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
37560
37561 @kindex maint print section-scripts
37562 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
37563 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
37564 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
37565 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
37566 matching @var{regexp}.
37567 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
37568 and the full path if known.
37569 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
37570
37571 @kindex maint print statistics
37572 @cindex bcache statistics
37573 @item maint print statistics
37574 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
37575 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
37576 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
37577 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
37578 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
37579 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
37580 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
37581 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
37582 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
37583 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
37584 lengths.
37585
37586 @kindex maint print target-stack
37587 @cindex target stack description
37588 @item maint print target-stack
37589 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
37590 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
37591 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
37592 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
37593 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
37594 address.
37595
37596 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
37597 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
37598
37599 @kindex maint print type
37600 @cindex type chain of a data type
37601 @item maint print type @var{expr}
37602 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
37603 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
37604 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
37605 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
37606 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
37607
37608 @kindex maint selftest
37609 @cindex self tests
37610 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
37611 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
37612 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
37613 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
37614 name will by ran.
37615
37616 @kindex maint info selftests
37617 @cindex self tests
37618 @item maint info selftests
37619 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
37620
37621 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
37622 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
37623 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
37624 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
37625 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
37626 information.
37627
37628 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
37629 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
37630 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
37631 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
37632 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
37633 always see the disassembly form.
37634
37635 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
37636
37637 @smallexample
37638 (gdb) info addr argc
37639 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
37640 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
37641 @end smallexample
37642
37643 For more information on these expressions, see
37644 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
37645
37646 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
37647 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
37648 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
37649 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
37650 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
37651
37652 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
37653 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
37654 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
37655 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
37656 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
37657 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
37658 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
37659 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
37660 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
37661
37662 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
37663 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
37664 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
37665 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
37666 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
37667
37668 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
37669 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
37670 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
37671 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
37672 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
37673 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
37674
37675 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
37676 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
37677 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
37678
37679 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
37680 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
37681 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
37682 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
37683
37684 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
37685 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
37686 @kindex maint set profile
37687 @kindex maint show profile
37688 @cindex profiling GDB
37689 @item maint set profile
37690 @itemx maint show profile
37691 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
37692
37693 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
37694 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
37695 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
37696 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
37697 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
37698 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
37699 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
37700
37701 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
37702 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
37703
37704 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
37705 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
37706 @cindex hardware debug registers
37707 @item maint set show-debug-regs
37708 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
37709 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
37710 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
37711 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
37712 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
37713 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
37714
37715 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
37716 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
37717 @item maint set show-all-tib
37718 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
37719 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
37720 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
37721 command.
37722
37723 @kindex maint set target-async
37724 @kindex maint show target-async
37725 @item maint set target-async
37726 @itemx maint show target-async
37727 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
37728 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
37729 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
37730 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
37731
37732 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
37733 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
37734 @item maint set target-non-stop
37735 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
37736
37737 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
37738 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
37739 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
37740 if supported by the target.
37741
37742 @table @code
37743 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
37744 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
37745 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
37746
37747 @item maint set target-non-stop on
37748 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
37749 does not indicate support.
37750
37751 @item maint set target-non-stop off
37752 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
37753 target supports it.
37754 @end table
37755
37756 @kindex maint set per-command
37757 @kindex maint show per-command
37758 @item maint set per-command
37759 @itemx maint show per-command
37760 @cindex resources used by commands
37761
37762 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
37763 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
37764
37765 @table @code
37766 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
37767 @itemx maint show per-command space
37768 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
37769 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
37770 took, following the command's own output.
37771 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
37772 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
37773
37774 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
37775 @itemx maint show per-command time
37776 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
37777 for each command.
37778 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
37779 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
37780 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
37781 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
37782 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
37783 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
37784 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
37785 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
37786 spent by the program been debugged.
37787 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
37788 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
37789
37790 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
37791 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
37792 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
37793 for each command.
37794 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
37795
37796 @enumerate a
37797 @item
37798 number of symbol tables
37799 @item
37800 number of primary symbol tables
37801 @item
37802 number of blocks in the blockvector
37803 @end enumerate
37804 @end table
37805
37806 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
37807 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
37808 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
37809 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
37810 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
37811 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
37812 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
37813 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
37814 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
37815 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
37816
37817 @kindex maint space
37818 @cindex memory used by commands
37819 @item maint space @var{value}
37820 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
37821 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
37822
37823 @kindex maint time
37824 @cindex time of command execution
37825 @item maint time @var{value}
37826 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
37827 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
37828
37829 @kindex maint translate-address
37830 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
37831 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
37832 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
37833 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
37834 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
37835 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
37836 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
37837
37838 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
37839 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
37840 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
37841
37842 @kindex maint test-options
37843 @item maint test-options require-delimiter
37844 @itemx maint test-options unknown-is-error
37845 @itemx maint test-options unknown-is-operand
37846 These commands are used by the testsuite to validate the command
37847 options framework. The @code{require-delimiter} variant requires a
37848 double-dash delimiter to indicate end of options. The
37849 @code{unknown-is-error} and @code{unknown-is-operand} do not. The
37850 @code{unknown-is-error} variant throws an error on unknown option,
37851 while @code{unknown-is-operand} treats unknown options as the start of
37852 the command's operands. When run, the commands output the result of
37853 the processed options. When completed, the commands store the
37854 internal result of completion in a variable exposed by the @code{maint
37855 show test-options-completion-result} command.
37856
37857 @kindex maint show test-options-completion-result
37858 @item maint show test-options-completion-result
37859 Shows the result of completing the @code{maint test-options}
37860 subcommands. This is used by the testsuite to validate completion
37861 support in the command options framework.
37862
37863 @kindex maint set test-settings
37864 @kindex maint show test-settings
37865 @item maint set test-settings @var{kind}
37866 @itemx maint show test-settings @var{kind}
37867 These are representative commands for each @var{kind} of setting type
37868 @value{GDBN} supports. They are used by the testsuite for exercising
37869 the settings infrastructure.
37870
37871 @kindex maint with
37872 @item maint with @var{setting} [@var{value}] [-- @var{command}]
37873 Like the @code{with} command, but works with @code{maintenance set}
37874 variables. This is used by the testsuite to exercise the @code{with}
37875 command's infrastructure.
37876
37877 @end table
37878
37879 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
37880 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
37881
37882 @table @code
37883 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
37884 @kindex set watchdog
37885 @cindex watchdog timer
37886 @cindex timeout for commands
37887 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
37888 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
37889 reports and error and the command is aborted.
37890
37891 @item show watchdog
37892 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
37893 @end table
37894
37895 @node Remote Protocol
37896 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
37897
37898 @menu
37899 * Overview::
37900 * Packets::
37901 * Stop Reply Packets::
37902 * General Query Packets::
37903 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
37904 * Tracepoint Packets::
37905 * Host I/O Packets::
37906 * Interrupts::
37907 * Notification Packets::
37908 * Remote Non-Stop::
37909 * Packet Acknowledgment::
37910 * Examples::
37911 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
37912 * Library List Format::
37913 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
37914 * Memory Map Format::
37915 * Thread List Format::
37916 * Traceframe Info Format::
37917 * Branch Trace Format::
37918 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
37919 @end menu
37920
37921 @node Overview
37922 @section Overview
37923
37924 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
37925 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
37926 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
37927 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
37928
37929 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
37930 transmitted and received data, respectively.
37931
37932 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
37933 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
37934 @cindex remote serial protocol
37935 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
37936 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
37937 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
37938 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
37939 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
37940
37941 @smallexample
37942 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
37943 @end smallexample
37944 @noindent
37945
37946 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
37947 @noindent
37948 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
37949 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
37950 eight bit unsigned checksum).
37951
37952 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
37953 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
37954
37955 @smallexample
37956 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
37957 @end smallexample
37958
37959 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
37960 @noindent
37961 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
37962 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
37963 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
37964
37965 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
37966 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
37967 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
37968 retransmission):
37969
37970 @smallexample
37971 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
37972 <- @code{+}
37973 @end smallexample
37974 @noindent
37975
37976 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
37977 once a connection is established.
37978 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
37979
37980 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
37981 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
37982 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
37983 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
37984 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
37985 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
37986 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
37987
37988 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
37989 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
37990 exceptions).
37991
37992 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
37993 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
37994 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
37995 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
37996
37997 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
37998 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
37999 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
38000
38001 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
38002 @anchor{Binary Data}
38003 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
38004 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
38005 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
38006 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
38007 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
38008 binary data.
38009
38010 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
38011 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
38012 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
38013 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
38014 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
38015 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
38016 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
38017 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
38018 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
38019 (described next).
38020
38021 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
38022 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
38023 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
38024 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
38025 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
38026 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
38027 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
38028 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
38029 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
38030 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
38031 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
38032 3}} more times.
38033
38034 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
38035 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
38036 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
38037 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
38038 @samp{0*"00}.
38039
38040 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
38041 error number. That number is not well defined.
38042
38043 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
38044 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
38045 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
38046 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
38047 on that response.
38048
38049 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
38050 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
38051 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
38052 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
38053 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
38054 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
38055
38056 @node Packets
38057 @section Packets
38058
38059 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
38060 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
38061 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
38062 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
38063
38064 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
38065 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
38066 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
38067 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
38068 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
38069 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
38070 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
38071 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
38072 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
38073 @var{baz}.
38074
38075 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
38076 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
38077 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
38078 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
38079 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
38080 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
38081 pick any thread.
38082
38083 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
38084 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
38085 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
38086 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
38087 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
38088 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
38089 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
38090 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
38091 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
38092 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
38093 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
38094 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
38095 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
38096
38097 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
38098 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
38099 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
38100 more information.
38101
38102 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
38103 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
38104
38105 Here are the packet descriptions.
38106
38107 @table @samp
38108
38109 @item !
38110 @cindex @samp{!} packet
38111 @anchor{extended mode}
38112 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
38113 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
38114 debugged.
38115
38116 Reply:
38117 @table @samp
38118 @item OK
38119 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
38120 @end table
38121
38122 @item ?
38123 @cindex @samp{?} packet
38124 @anchor{? packet}
38125 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
38126 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
38127 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
38128
38129 Reply:
38130 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38131
38132 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
38133 @cindex @samp{A} packet
38134 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
38135 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
38136 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
38137
38138 Reply:
38139 @table @samp
38140 @item OK
38141 The arguments were set.
38142 @item E @var{NN}
38143 An error occurred.
38144 @end table
38145
38146 @item b @var{baud}
38147 @cindex @samp{b} packet
38148 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
38149 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
38150
38151 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
38152 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
38153 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
38154
38155 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
38156 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
38157 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
38158 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
38159 of view, nothing actually happened.}
38160
38161 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
38162 @cindex @samp{B} packet
38163 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
38164 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
38165
38166 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
38167 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
38168
38169 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
38170 @anchor{bc}
38171 @item bc
38172 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
38173 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
38174
38175 Reply:
38176 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38177
38178 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
38179 @anchor{bs}
38180 @item bs
38181 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
38182 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
38183
38184 Reply:
38185 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38186
38187 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
38188 @cindex @samp{c} packet
38189 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
38190 is omitted, resume at current address.
38191
38192 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
38193 packet}.
38194
38195 Reply:
38196 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38197
38198 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
38199 @cindex @samp{C} packet
38200 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
38201 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
38202
38203 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
38204 packet}.
38205
38206 Reply:
38207 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38208
38209 @item d
38210 @cindex @samp{d} packet
38211 Toggle debug flag.
38212
38213 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
38214 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
38215
38216 @item D
38217 @itemx D;@var{pid}
38218 @cindex @samp{D} packet
38219 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
38220 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
38221 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
38222
38223 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
38224 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
38225 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
38226 big-endian hex string.
38227
38228 Reply:
38229 @table @samp
38230 @item OK
38231 for success
38232 @item E @var{NN}
38233 for an error
38234 @end table
38235
38236 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
38237 @cindex @samp{F} packet
38238 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
38239 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
38240 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
38241
38242 @item g
38243 @anchor{read registers packet}
38244 @cindex @samp{g} packet
38245 Read general registers.
38246
38247 Reply:
38248 @table @samp
38249 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
38250 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
38251 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
38252 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
38253 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
38254 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
38255
38256 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
38257 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
38258 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
38259 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
38260 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
38261 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
38262 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
38263 have been collected, and both have zero value:
38264
38265 @smallexample
38266 -> @code{g}
38267 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
38268 @end smallexample
38269
38270 @item E @var{NN}
38271 for an error.
38272 @end table
38273
38274 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
38275 @cindex @samp{G} packet
38276 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
38277 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
38278
38279 Reply:
38280 @table @samp
38281 @item OK
38282 for success
38283 @item E @var{NN}
38284 for an error
38285 @end table
38286
38287 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
38288 @cindex @samp{H} packet
38289 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
38290 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
38291 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
38292 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
38293 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
38294 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
38295 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38296
38297 Reply:
38298 @table @samp
38299 @item OK
38300 for success
38301 @item E @var{NN}
38302 for an error
38303 @end table
38304
38305 @c FIXME: JTC:
38306 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
38307 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
38308 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
38309 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
38310 @c described. For example:
38311 @c
38312 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
38313 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
38314 @c otherwise returns current registers.
38315 @c
38316 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
38317 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
38318 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
38319
38320 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
38321 @anchor{cycle step packet}
38322 @cindex @samp{i} packet
38323 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
38324 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
38325 step starting at that address.
38326
38327 @item I
38328 @cindex @samp{I} packet
38329 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
38330 step packet}.
38331
38332 @item k
38333 @cindex @samp{k} packet
38334 Kill request.
38335
38336 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
38337
38338 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
38339 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
38340
38341 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
38342
38343 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
38344 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
38345 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
38346
38347 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
38348 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
38349 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
38350
38351 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
38352 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
38353 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
38354 (@pxref{? packet}).
38355
38356 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
38357 @cindex @samp{m} packet
38358 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
38359 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
38360 any particular boundary.
38361
38362 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
38363 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
38364 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
38365 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
38366 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
38367 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
38368 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
38369 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
38370
38371 Reply:
38372 @table @samp
38373 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
38374 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
38375 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
38376 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
38377 @item E @var{NN}
38378 @var{NN} is errno
38379 @end table
38380
38381 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
38382 @cindex @samp{M} packet
38383 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
38384 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
38385 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
38386
38387 Reply:
38388 @table @samp
38389 @item OK
38390 for success
38391 @item E @var{NN}
38392 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
38393 written).
38394 @end table
38395
38396 @item p @var{n}
38397 @cindex @samp{p} packet
38398 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
38399 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
38400 register value is encoded.
38401
38402 Reply:
38403 @table @samp
38404 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
38405 the register's value
38406 @item E @var{NN}
38407 for an error
38408 @item @w{}
38409 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
38410 @end table
38411
38412 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
38413 @anchor{write register packet}
38414 @cindex @samp{P} packet
38415 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
38416 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
38417 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
38418
38419 Reply:
38420 @table @samp
38421 @item OK
38422 for success
38423 @item E @var{NN}
38424 for an error
38425 @end table
38426
38427 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
38428 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
38429 @cindex @samp{q} packet
38430 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
38431 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
38432 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
38433
38434 @item r
38435 @cindex @samp{r} packet
38436 Reset the entire system.
38437
38438 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
38439
38440 @item R @var{XX}
38441 @cindex @samp{R} packet
38442 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
38443 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38444
38445 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
38446
38447 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
38448 @cindex @samp{s} packet
38449 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
38450 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
38451
38452 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
38453 packet}.
38454
38455 Reply:
38456 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38457
38458 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
38459 @anchor{step with signal packet}
38460 @cindex @samp{S} packet
38461 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
38462 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
38463
38464 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
38465 packet}.
38466
38467 Reply:
38468 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38469
38470 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
38471 @cindex @samp{t} packet
38472 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
38473 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
38474 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
38475
38476 @item T @var{thread-id}
38477 @cindex @samp{T} packet
38478 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
38479
38480 Reply:
38481 @table @samp
38482 @item OK
38483 thread is still alive
38484 @item E @var{NN}
38485 thread is dead
38486 @end table
38487
38488 @item v
38489 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
38490 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
38491
38492 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
38493 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
38494 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
38495 The process ID is a
38496 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
38497 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
38498 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
38499
38500 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
38501 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
38502 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
38503 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
38504 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
38505 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
38506 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
38507 @c stopping or restarting threads.
38508
38509 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38510
38511 Reply:
38512 @table @samp
38513 @item E @var{nn}
38514 for an error
38515 @item @r{Any stop packet}
38516 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
38517 @item OK
38518 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
38519 @end table
38520
38521 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
38522 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
38523 @anchor{vCont packet}
38524 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
38525
38526 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
38527 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
38528 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
38529 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
38530 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
38531 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
38532 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
38533 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
38534 error.
38535
38536 Currently supported actions are:
38537
38538 @table @samp
38539 @item c
38540 Continue.
38541 @item C @var{sig}
38542 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
38543 @item s
38544 Step.
38545 @item S @var{sig}
38546 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
38547 @item t
38548 Stop.
38549 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
38550 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
38551 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
38552 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
38553 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
38554 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
38555
38556 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
38557 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
38558 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
38559 jumps to @var{start}).
38560
38561 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
38562 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
38563 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
38564
38565 @end table
38566
38567 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
38568 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
38569 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
38570
38571 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
38572 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
38573 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
38574 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
38575 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
38576 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
38577 as an implementation detail.
38578
38579 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
38580 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
38581 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
38582 stopped.
38583
38584 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
38585 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
38586 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
38587
38588 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
38589 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
38590
38591 Reply:
38592 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38593
38594 @item vCont?
38595 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
38596 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
38597
38598 Reply:
38599 @table @samp
38600 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
38601 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
38602 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
38603 @item @w{}
38604 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
38605 @end table
38606
38607 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
38608 @item vCtrlC
38609 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
38610 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
38611 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
38612 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
38613 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
38614 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
38615 variant.
38616
38617 Reply:
38618 @table @samp
38619 @item E @var{nn}
38620 for an error
38621 @item OK
38622 for success
38623 @end table
38624
38625 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
38626 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
38627 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
38628 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
38629
38630 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
38631 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
38632 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
38633 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
38634 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
38635 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
38636 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
38637 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
38638 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
38639 packet is received.
38640
38641 Reply:
38642 @table @samp
38643 @item OK
38644 for success
38645 @item E @var{NN}
38646 for an error
38647 @end table
38648
38649 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
38650 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
38651 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
38652 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
38653 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
38654 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
38655 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
38656 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
38657 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
38658 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
38659 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
38660 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
38661
38662
38663 Reply:
38664 @table @samp
38665 @item OK
38666 for success
38667 @item E.memtype
38668 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
38669 @item E @var{NN}
38670 for an error
38671 @end table
38672
38673 @item vFlashDone
38674 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
38675 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
38676 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
38677 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
38678 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
38679 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
38680 request is completed.
38681
38682 @item vKill;@var{pid}
38683 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
38684 @anchor{vKill packet}
38685 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
38686 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
38687 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
38688 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
38689
38690 Reply:
38691 @table @samp
38692 @item E @var{nn}
38693 for an error
38694 @item OK
38695 for success
38696 @end table
38697
38698 @item vMustReplyEmpty
38699 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
38700 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
38701 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
38702 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
38703
38704 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
38705 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
38706 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
38707 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
38708 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
38709 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
38710
38711 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
38712 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
38713 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
38714 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
38715 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
38716 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
38717 state.
38718
38719 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
38720
38721 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38722
38723 Reply:
38724 @table @samp
38725 @item E @var{nn}
38726 for an error
38727 @item @r{Any stop packet}
38728 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
38729 @end table
38730
38731 @item vStopped
38732 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
38733 @xref{Notification Packets}.
38734
38735 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
38736 @anchor{X packet}
38737 @cindex @samp{X} packet
38738 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
38739 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
38740 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
38741 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38742
38743 Reply:
38744 @table @samp
38745 @item OK
38746 for success
38747 @item E @var{NN}
38748 for an error
38749 @end table
38750
38751 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
38752 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
38753 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
38754 @cindex @samp{z} packet
38755 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
38756 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
38757 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
38758
38759 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
38760 separately.
38761
38762 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
38763 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
38764 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
38765 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
38766 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
38767 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
38768
38769 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38770 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
38771 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
38772 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
38773 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
38774 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
38775
38776 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
38777 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
38778 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
38779 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
38780 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
38781 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
38782 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
38783 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
38784 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
38785 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
38786 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
38787 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
38788 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
38789
38790 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
38791 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
38792
38793 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
38794 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
38795
38796 @table @samp
38797
38798 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38799 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
38800 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
38801
38802 @end table
38803
38804 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
38805 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
38806 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
38807 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
38808 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
38809 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
38810 separators. Each expression has the following form:
38811
38812 @table @samp
38813
38814 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38815 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
38816 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
38817
38818 @end table
38819
38820 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
38821 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
38822 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
38823 target, is not defined.}
38824
38825 Reply:
38826 @table @samp
38827 @item OK
38828 success
38829 @item @w{}
38830 not supported
38831 @item E @var{NN}
38832 for an error
38833 @end table
38834
38835 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38836 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
38837 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
38838 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
38839 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
38840 address @var{addr}.
38841
38842 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
38843 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
38844 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
38845 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
38846
38847 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
38848 movement.}
38849
38850 Reply:
38851 @table @samp
38852 @item OK
38853 success
38854 @item @w{}
38855 not supported
38856 @item E @var{NN}
38857 for an error
38858 @end table
38859
38860 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38861 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38862 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
38863 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
38864 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
38865 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
38866
38867 Reply:
38868 @table @samp
38869 @item OK
38870 success
38871 @item @w{}
38872 not supported
38873 @item E @var{NN}
38874 for an error
38875 @end table
38876
38877 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38878 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38879 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
38880 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
38881 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
38882 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
38883
38884 Reply:
38885 @table @samp
38886 @item OK
38887 success
38888 @item @w{}
38889 not supported
38890 @item E @var{NN}
38891 for an error
38892 @end table
38893
38894 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38895 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38896 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
38897 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
38898 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
38899 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
38900
38901 Reply:
38902 @table @samp
38903 @item OK
38904 success
38905 @item @w{}
38906 not supported
38907 @item E @var{NN}
38908 for an error
38909 @end table
38910
38911 @end table
38912
38913 @node Stop Reply Packets
38914 @section Stop Reply Packets
38915 @cindex stop reply packets
38916
38917 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
38918 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
38919 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
38920 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
38921 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
38922 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
38923 @value{GDBN} source code.
38924
38925 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
38926 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
38927 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
38928
38929 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
38930 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
38931 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
38932 components.
38933
38934 @table @samp
38935
38936 @item S @var{AA}
38937 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
38938 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
38939 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
38940
38941 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
38942 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
38943 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
38944 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
38945 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
38946 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
38947 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
38948 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
38949
38950 @itemize @bullet
38951 @item
38952 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
38953 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
38954 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
38955 two-digit hex number.
38956
38957 @item
38958 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
38959 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38960
38961 @item
38962 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
38963 the core on which the stop event was detected.
38964
38965 @item
38966 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
38967 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
38968 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
38969 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
38970
38971 @item
38972 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
38973 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
38974 future.
38975 @end itemize
38976
38977 The currently defined stop reasons are:
38978
38979 @table @samp
38980 @item watch
38981 @itemx rwatch
38982 @itemx awatch
38983 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
38984 hex.
38985
38986 @item syscall_entry
38987 @itemx syscall_return
38988 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
38989 syscall number, in hex.
38990
38991 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
38992 @item library
38993 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
38994 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
38995 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
38996
38997 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
38998 @item replaylog
38999 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
39000 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
39001 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
39002 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
39003 for more information.
39004
39005 @item swbreak
39006 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
39007 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
39008 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
39009 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
39010 part must be left empty.
39011
39012 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
39013 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
39014 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
39015 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
39016 address.
39017
39018 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
39019 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
39020 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
39021 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
39022 indicating support.
39023
39024 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
39025
39026 @item hwbreak
39027 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
39028 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
39029
39030 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
39031 apply.
39032
39033 @cindex fork events, remote reply
39034 @item fork
39035 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
39036 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
39037 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
39038 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
39039 fork events.
39040
39041 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
39042 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
39043 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
39044 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
39045 indicating support.
39046
39047 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
39048 @item vfork
39049 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
39050 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
39051 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
39052 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
39053 vfork events.
39054
39055 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
39056 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
39057 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
39058 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
39059 indicating support.
39060
39061 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
39062 @item vforkdone
39063 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
39064 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
39065 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
39066 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
39067 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
39068
39069 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
39070 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
39071 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
39072 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
39073 indicating support.
39074
39075 @cindex exec events, remote reply
39076 @item exec
39077 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
39078 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
39079 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
39080
39081 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
39082 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
39083 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
39084 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
39085 indicating support.
39086
39087 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
39088 @anchor{thread create event}
39089 @item create
39090 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
39091 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
39092 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
39093 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
39094 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
39095 @var{r} part is ignored.
39096
39097 @end table
39098
39099 @item W @var{AA}
39100 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
39101 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
39102 applicable to certain targets.
39103
39104 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
39105 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
39106 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
39107 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
39108 hex strings.
39109
39110 @item X @var{AA}
39111 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
39112 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
39113
39114 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
39115 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
39116 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
39117 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
39118 hex strings.
39119
39120 @anchor{thread exit event}
39121 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
39122 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
39123
39124 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
39125 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
39126 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
39127 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
39128
39129 @item N
39130 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
39131 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
39132 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
39133 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
39134 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
39135 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
39136 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
39137 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
39138 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
39139 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
39140 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
39141 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
39142 support.
39143
39144 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
39145 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
39146 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
39147 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
39148 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
39149
39150 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
39151 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
39152 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
39153 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
39154 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
39155 system calls.
39156
39157 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
39158 this very system call.
39159
39160 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
39161 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
39162 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
39163 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
39164 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
39165 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
39166
39167 @end table
39168
39169 @node General Query Packets
39170 @section General Query Packets
39171 @cindex remote query requests
39172
39173 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
39174 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
39175 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
39176 sending information to and from the stub.
39177
39178 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
39179 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
39180 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
39181 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
39182 conventions:
39183
39184 @itemize @bullet
39185 @item
39186 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
39187 @item
39188 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
39189 letter.
39190 @item
39191 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
39192 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
39193 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
39194 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
39195 @end itemize
39196
39197 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
39198 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
39199 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
39200 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
39201 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
39202 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
39203 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
39204 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
39205 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
39206 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
39207 packet.}.
39208
39209 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
39210 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
39211 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
39212 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
39213 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
39214
39215 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
39216
39217 @table @samp
39218
39219 @item QAgent:1
39220 @itemx QAgent:0
39221 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
39222 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
39223
39224 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
39225 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
39226 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
39227 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
39228 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
39229 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
39230 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
39231 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
39232 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
39233 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
39234 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
39235
39236 @item qC
39237 @cindex current thread, remote request
39238 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
39239 Return the current thread ID.
39240
39241 Reply:
39242 @table @samp
39243 @item QC @var{thread-id}
39244 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
39245 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
39246 @item @r{(anything else)}
39247 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
39248 @end table
39249
39250 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
39251 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
39252 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
39253 @anchor{qCRC packet}
39254 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
39255 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
39256 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
39257 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
39258
39259 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
39260 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
39261 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
39262 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
39263 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
39264 detect trailing zeros.
39265
39266 Reply:
39267 @table @samp
39268 @item E @var{NN}
39269 An error (such as memory fault)
39270 @item C @var{crc32}
39271 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
39272 @end table
39273
39274 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
39275 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
39276 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
39277 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
39278 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
39279 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
39280 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
39281 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
39282 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
39283 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
39284 randomization.
39285
39286 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
39287
39288 Reply:
39289 @table @samp
39290 @item OK
39291 The request succeeded.
39292
39293 @item E @var{nn}
39294 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39295
39296 @item @w{}
39297 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
39298 by the stub.
39299 @end table
39300
39301 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39302 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39303 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
39304 address space randomization.
39305
39306 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
39307 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
39308 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
39309 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
39310 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
39311 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
39312 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
39313 inferior using a shell or not.
39314
39315 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
39316 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
39317 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
39318 values are considered an error.
39319
39320 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
39321 mode}).
39322
39323 Reply:
39324 @table @samp
39325 @item OK
39326 The request succeeded.
39327
39328 @item E @var{nn}
39329 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39330 @end table
39331
39332 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39333 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39334 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
39335 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
39336
39337 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
39338 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
39339
39340 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
39341 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
39342 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
39343 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
39344 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
39345 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
39346 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
39347 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
39348 environment}).
39349
39350 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
39351 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
39352 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
39353 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
39354 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
39355 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
39356 not be present.
39357
39358 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
39359 mode}).
39360
39361 Reply:
39362 @table @samp
39363 @item OK
39364 The request succeeded.
39365 @end table
39366
39367 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39368 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39369 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
39370 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
39371 inferior.
39372
39373 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
39374 @pxref{set environment}.
39375
39376 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
39377 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
39378 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
39379 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
39380 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
39381 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
39382 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
39383 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
39384
39385 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
39386 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
39387
39388 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
39389 mode}).
39390
39391 Reply:
39392 @table @samp
39393 @item OK
39394 The request succeeded.
39395 @end table
39396
39397 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39398 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39399 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
39400 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
39401 inferior.
39402
39403 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
39404 @pxref{unset environment}.
39405
39406 @item QEnvironmentReset
39407 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
39408 @cindex reset environment, remote request
39409 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
39410 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
39411 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
39412 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
39413 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
39414 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
39415 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
39416 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
39417 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
39418
39419 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
39420 mode}).
39421
39422 Reply:
39423 @table @samp
39424 @item OK
39425 The request succeeded.
39426 @end table
39427
39428 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39429 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39430 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
39431 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
39432 inferior.
39433
39434 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
39435 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
39436 @cindex set working directory, remote request
39437 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
39438 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
39439 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
39440
39441 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
39442 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
39443 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
39444 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
39445 directory to its original, empty value.
39446
39447 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
39448 mode}).
39449
39450 Reply:
39451 @table @samp
39452 @item OK
39453 The request succeeded.
39454 @end table
39455
39456 @item qfThreadInfo
39457 @itemx qsThreadInfo
39458 @cindex list active threads, remote request
39459 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
39460 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
39461 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
39462 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
39463 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
39464 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
39465 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
39466 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
39467
39468 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
39469
39470 Reply:
39471 @table @samp
39472 @item m @var{thread-id}
39473 A single thread ID
39474 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
39475 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
39476 @item l
39477 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
39478 @end table
39479
39480 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
39481 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
39482 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
39483 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
39484 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
39485 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
39486 fields.
39487
39488 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
39489 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
39490 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
39491 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
39492 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
39493
39494 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
39495 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
39496 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
39497 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
39498 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
39499
39500 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
39501 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
39502
39503 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
39504 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
39505 information associated with the variable.)
39506
39507 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
39508 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
39509 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
39510 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
39511 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
39512 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
39513
39514 Reply:
39515 @table @samp
39516 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39517 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
39518 local storage requested.
39519
39520 @item E @var{nn}
39521 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39522
39523 @item @w{}
39524 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
39525 @end table
39526
39527 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
39528 @cindex get thread information block address
39529 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
39530 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
39531
39532 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
39533
39534 Reply:
39535 @table @samp
39536 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39537 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
39538 thread information block.
39539
39540 @item E @var{nn}
39541 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
39542 address could not be retrieved.
39543
39544 @item @w{}
39545 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
39546 @end table
39547
39548 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
39549 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
39550 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
39551 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
39552 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
39553 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
39554 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
39555
39556 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
39557
39558 Reply:
39559 @table @samp
39560 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
39561 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
39562 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
39563 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
39564 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
39565 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
39566 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
39567 @end table
39568
39569 @item qOffsets
39570 @cindex section offsets, remote request
39571 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
39572 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
39573 image.
39574
39575 Reply:
39576 @table @samp
39577 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
39578 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
39579 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
39580 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
39581 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
39582 segments by the supplied offsets.
39583
39584 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
39585 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
39586 to the @code{Bss} section.}
39587
39588 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
39589 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
39590 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
39591 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
39592 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
39593 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
39594 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
39595 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
39596 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
39597 @end table
39598
39599 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
39600 @cindex thread information, remote request
39601 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
39602 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
39603 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
39604 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
39605
39606 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
39607 (see below).
39608
39609 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
39610
39611 @item QNonStop:1
39612 @itemx QNonStop:0
39613 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
39614 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
39615 @anchor{QNonStop}
39616 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
39617 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
39618
39619 Reply:
39620 @table @samp
39621 @item OK
39622 The request succeeded.
39623
39624 @item E @var{nn}
39625 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39626
39627 @item @w{}
39628 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
39629 the stub.
39630 @end table
39631
39632 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39633 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39634 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
39635 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
39636
39637 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
39638 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
39639 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
39640 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
39641 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
39642 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
39643 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
39644
39645 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
39646 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
39647 is listed, every system call should be reported.
39648
39649 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
39650 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
39651 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
39652 report the requested syscalls.
39653
39654 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
39655 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
39656
39657 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
39658 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
39659 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
39660 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
39661
39662 Reply:
39663 @table @samp
39664 @item OK
39665 The request succeeded.
39666
39667 @item E @var{nn}
39668 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
39669
39670 @item @w{}
39671 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
39672 the stub.
39673 @end table
39674
39675 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
39676 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
39677 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39678 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39679
39680 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
39681 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
39682 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
39683 @anchor{QPassSignals}
39684 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
39685 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
39686 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
39687 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
39688 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
39689 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
39690 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
39691 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
39692 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
39693
39694 Reply:
39695 @table @samp
39696 @item OK
39697 The request succeeded.
39698
39699 @item E @var{nn}
39700 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39701
39702 @item @w{}
39703 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
39704 the stub.
39705 @end table
39706
39707 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
39708 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
39709 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39710 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39711
39712 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
39713 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
39714 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
39715 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
39716 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
39717 Others should be silently discarded.
39718
39719 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
39720 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
39721 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
39722 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
39723 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
39724 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
39725 signals.
39726
39727 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
39728 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
39729
39730 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
39731 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
39732 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
39733 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
39734 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
39735
39736 Reply:
39737 @table @samp
39738 @item OK
39739 The request succeeded.
39740
39741 @item E @var{nn}
39742 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39743
39744 @item @w{}
39745 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
39746 by the stub.
39747 @end table
39748
39749 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
39750 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
39751 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39752 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39753
39754 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
39755 @item QThreadEvents:1
39756 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
39757 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
39758 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
39759
39760 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
39761 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
39762 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
39763 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
39764 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
39765 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
39766 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
39767 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
39768 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
39769 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39770
39771 Reply:
39772 @table @samp
39773 @item OK
39774 The request succeeded.
39775
39776 @item E @var{nn}
39777 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39778
39779 @item @w{}
39780 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
39781 the stub.
39782 @end table
39783
39784 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
39785 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
39786
39787 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
39788 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
39789 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
39790 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
39791 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
39792 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
39793 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
39794 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
39795 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
39796
39797 Reply:
39798 @table @samp
39799 @item OK
39800 A command response with no output.
39801 @item @var{OUTPUT}
39802 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
39803 @item E @var{NN}
39804 Indicate a badly formed request.
39805 @item @w{}
39806 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
39807 @end table
39808
39809 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
39810 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
39811 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
39812 packets.)
39813
39814 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
39815 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
39816 @ifnotinfo
39817 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
39818 @end ifnotinfo
39819 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
39820 @anchor{qSearch memory}
39821 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
39822 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
39823 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
39824
39825 Reply:
39826 @table @samp
39827 @item 0
39828 The pattern was not found.
39829 @item 1,address
39830 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
39831 @item E @var{NN}
39832 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
39833 @item @w{}
39834 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
39835 @end table
39836
39837 @item QStartNoAckMode
39838 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
39839 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
39840 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
39841 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
39842
39843 Reply:
39844 @table @samp
39845 @item OK
39846 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
39847 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
39848 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
39849 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
39850 @item @w{}
39851 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
39852 @end table
39853
39854 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
39855 @cindex supported packets, remote query
39856 @cindex features of the remote protocol
39857 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
39858 @anchor{qSupported}
39859 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
39860 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
39861 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
39862 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
39863 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
39864 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
39865 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
39866 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
39867 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
39868 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
39869 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
39870 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
39871 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
39872 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
39873
39874 Reply:
39875 @table @samp
39876 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
39877 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
39878 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
39879 possible forms).
39880 @item @w{}
39881 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
39882 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
39883 @end table
39884
39885 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
39886 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
39887 are:
39888
39889 @table @samp
39890 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
39891 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
39892 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
39893 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
39894 @item @var{name}+
39895 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
39896 need an associated value.
39897 @item @var{name}-
39898 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
39899 @item @var{name}?
39900 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
39901 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
39902 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
39903 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
39904 @end table
39905
39906 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
39907 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
39908 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
39909 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
39910 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
39911
39912 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
39913 are defined:
39914
39915 @table @samp
39916 @item multiprocess
39917 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
39918 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
39919 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39920 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39921 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
39922
39923 @item xmlRegisters
39924 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
39925 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
39926 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
39927 description.
39928
39929 @item qRelocInsn
39930 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
39931 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
39932 instruction reply packet}).
39933
39934 @item swbreak
39935 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
39936 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
39937
39938 @item hwbreak
39939 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
39940 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
39941
39942 @item fork-events
39943 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
39944 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
39945 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39946 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39947
39948 @item vfork-events
39949 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
39950 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
39951 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39952 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39953
39954 @item exec-events
39955 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
39956 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
39957 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39958 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39959
39960 @item vContSupported
39961 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
39962 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
39963 @end table
39964
39965 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
39966 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
39967 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
39968 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
39969 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
39970 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
39971 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
39972 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
39973 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
39974 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
39975 all the features it supports.
39976
39977 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
39978 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
39979
39980 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
39981 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
39982 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
39983 form response.
39984
39985 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
39986 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
39987 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
39988 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
39989
39990 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
39991 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
39992 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
39993 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
39994 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
39995
39996 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
39997
39998 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
39999 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
40000 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
40001 @item Feature Name
40002 @tab Value Required
40003 @tab Default
40004 @tab Probe Allowed
40005
40006 @item @samp{PacketSize}
40007 @tab Yes
40008 @tab @samp{-}
40009 @tab No
40010
40011 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
40012 @tab No
40013 @tab @samp{-}
40014 @tab Yes
40015
40016 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40017 @tab No
40018 @tab @samp{-}
40019 @tab Yes
40020
40021 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40022 @tab No
40023 @tab @samp{-}
40024 @tab Yes
40025
40026 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
40027 @tab No
40028 @tab @samp{-}
40029 @tab Yes
40030
40031 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
40032 @tab No
40033 @tab @samp{-}
40034 @tab Yes
40035
40036 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
40037 @tab No
40038 @tab @samp{-}
40039 @tab Yes
40040
40041 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
40042 @tab No
40043 @tab @samp{-}
40044 @tab Yes
40045
40046 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
40047 @tab No
40048 @tab @samp{-}
40049 @tab No
40050
40051 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40052 @tab No
40053 @tab @samp{-}
40054 @tab Yes
40055
40056 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
40057 @tab No
40058 @tab @samp{-}
40059 @tab Yes
40060
40061 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
40062 @tab No
40063 @tab @samp{-}
40064 @tab Yes
40065
40066 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
40067 @tab No
40068 @tab @samp{-}
40069 @tab Yes
40070
40071 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
40072 @tab No
40073 @tab @samp{-}
40074 @tab Yes
40075
40076 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40077 @tab No
40078 @tab @samp{-}
40079 @tab Yes
40080
40081 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
40082 @tab No
40083 @tab @samp{-}
40084 @tab Yes
40085
40086 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
40087 @tab No
40088 @tab @samp{-}
40089 @tab Yes
40090
40091 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
40092 @tab Yes
40093 @tab @samp{-}
40094 @tab Yes
40095
40096 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
40097 @tab Yes
40098 @tab @samp{-}
40099 @tab Yes
40100
40101 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
40102 @tab Yes
40103 @tab @samp{-}
40104 @tab Yes
40105
40106 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
40107 @tab Yes
40108 @tab @samp{-}
40109 @tab Yes
40110
40111 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
40112 @tab Yes
40113 @tab @samp{-}
40114 @tab Yes
40115
40116 @item @samp{QNonStop}
40117 @tab No
40118 @tab @samp{-}
40119 @tab Yes
40120
40121 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
40122 @tab No
40123 @tab @samp{-}
40124 @tab Yes
40125
40126 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
40127 @tab No
40128 @tab @samp{-}
40129 @tab Yes
40130
40131 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
40132 @tab No
40133 @tab @samp{-}
40134 @tab Yes
40135
40136 @item @samp{multiprocess}
40137 @tab No
40138 @tab @samp{-}
40139 @tab No
40140
40141 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
40142 @tab No
40143 @tab @samp{-}
40144 @tab No
40145
40146 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
40147 @tab No
40148 @tab @samp{-}
40149 @tab No
40150
40151 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
40152 @tab No
40153 @tab @samp{-}
40154 @tab No
40155
40156 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
40157 @tab No
40158 @tab @samp{-}
40159 @tab No
40160
40161 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
40162 @tab No
40163 @tab @samp{-}
40164 @tab No
40165
40166 @item @samp{QAgent}
40167 @tab No
40168 @tab @samp{-}
40169 @tab No
40170
40171 @item @samp{QAllow}
40172 @tab No
40173 @tab @samp{-}
40174 @tab No
40175
40176 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
40177 @tab No
40178 @tab @samp{-}
40179 @tab No
40180
40181 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
40182 @tab No
40183 @tab @samp{-}
40184 @tab No
40185
40186 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
40187 @tab No
40188 @tab @samp{-}
40189 @tab No
40190
40191 @item @samp{tracenz}
40192 @tab No
40193 @tab @samp{-}
40194 @tab No
40195
40196 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
40197 @tab No
40198 @tab @samp{-}
40199 @tab No
40200
40201 @item @samp{swbreak}
40202 @tab No
40203 @tab @samp{-}
40204 @tab No
40205
40206 @item @samp{hwbreak}
40207 @tab No
40208 @tab @samp{-}
40209 @tab No
40210
40211 @item @samp{fork-events}
40212 @tab No
40213 @tab @samp{-}
40214 @tab No
40215
40216 @item @samp{vfork-events}
40217 @tab No
40218 @tab @samp{-}
40219 @tab No
40220
40221 @item @samp{exec-events}
40222 @tab No
40223 @tab @samp{-}
40224 @tab No
40225
40226 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
40227 @tab No
40228 @tab @samp{-}
40229 @tab No
40230
40231 @item @samp{no-resumed}
40232 @tab No
40233 @tab @samp{-}
40234 @tab No
40235
40236 @end multitable
40237
40238 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
40239
40240 @table @samp
40241 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
40242 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
40243 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
40244 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
40245 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
40246 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
40247 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
40248 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
40249 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
40250 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
40251
40252 @item qXfer:auxv:read
40253 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
40254 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
40255
40256 @item qXfer:btrace:read
40257 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40258 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
40259
40260 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
40261 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40262 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
40263
40264 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
40265 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
40266 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
40267
40268 @item qXfer:features:read
40269 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
40270 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
40271
40272 @item qXfer:libraries:read
40273 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
40274 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
40275
40276 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
40277 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
40278 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
40279
40280 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
40281 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
40282 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
40283 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
40284
40285 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
40286 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
40287 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
40288
40289 @item qXfer:sdata:read
40290 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
40291 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
40292
40293 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
40294 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
40295 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
40296
40297 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
40298 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
40299 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
40300
40301 @item qXfer:threads:read
40302 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40303 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
40304
40305 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
40306 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40307 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
40308
40309 @item qXfer:uib:read
40310 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
40311 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
40312
40313 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
40314 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
40315 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
40316
40317 @item QNonStop
40318 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
40319 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
40320
40321 @item QCatchSyscalls
40322 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
40323 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
40324
40325 @item QPassSignals
40326 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
40327 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
40328
40329 @item QStartNoAckMode
40330 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
40331 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
40332
40333 @item multiprocess
40334 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
40335 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
40336 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
40337 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
40338 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
40339 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
40340 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
40341 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
40342 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
40343 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
40344 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
40345
40346 @item qXfer:osdata:read
40347 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
40348 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
40349
40350 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
40351 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
40352 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
40353 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
40354
40355 @item ConditionalTracepoints
40356 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
40357 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
40358
40359 @item ReverseContinue
40360 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
40361 (@pxref{bc}).
40362
40363 @item ReverseStep
40364 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
40365 (@pxref{bs}).
40366
40367 @item TracepointSource
40368 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
40369 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
40370
40371 @item QAgent
40372 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
40373
40374 @item QAllow
40375 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
40376
40377 @item QDisableRandomization
40378 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
40379
40380 @item StaticTracepoint
40381 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
40382 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
40383
40384 @item InstallInTrace
40385 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
40386 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
40387
40388 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
40389 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
40390 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
40391 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
40392
40393 @item QTBuffer:size
40394 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
40395 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
40396
40397 @item tracenz
40398 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
40399 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
40400 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
40401
40402 @item BreakpointCommands
40403 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
40404 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
40405 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
40406
40407 @item Qbtrace:off
40408 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
40409
40410 @item Qbtrace:bts
40411 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
40412
40413 @item Qbtrace:pt
40414 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
40415
40416 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
40417 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
40418
40419 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
40420 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
40421
40422 @item swbreak
40423 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
40424 breakpoints.
40425
40426 @item hwbreak
40427 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
40428 breakpoints.
40429
40430 @item fork-events
40431 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
40432
40433 @item vfork-events
40434 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
40435 and vforkdone events.
40436
40437 @item exec-events
40438 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
40439
40440 @item vContSupported
40441 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
40442 @samp{vCont?} packet.
40443
40444 @item QThreadEvents
40445 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
40446
40447 @item no-resumed
40448 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
40449
40450 @end table
40451
40452 @item qSymbol::
40453 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
40454 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
40455 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
40456 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
40457
40458 Reply:
40459 @table @samp
40460 @item OK
40461 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
40462 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
40463 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
40464 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
40465 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
40466 below.
40467 @end table
40468
40469 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
40470 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
40471
40472 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
40473 target has previously requested.
40474
40475 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
40476 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
40477 will be empty.
40478
40479 Reply:
40480 @table @samp
40481 @item OK
40482 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
40483 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
40484 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
40485 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
40486 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
40487 @end table
40488
40489 @item qTBuffer
40490 @itemx QTBuffer
40491 @itemx QTDisconnected
40492 @itemx QTDP
40493 @itemx QTDPsrc
40494 @itemx QTDV
40495 @itemx qTfP
40496 @itemx qTfV
40497 @itemx QTFrame
40498 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
40499
40500 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
40501
40502 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
40503 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
40504 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
40505 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
40506 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
40507 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
40508 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
40509 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
40510 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
40511 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
40512 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
40513
40514 Reply:
40515 @table @samp
40516 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
40517 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
40518 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
40519 the thread's attributes.
40520 @end table
40521
40522 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
40523 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
40524 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
40525 packets.)
40526
40527 @item QTNotes
40528 @itemx qTP
40529 @itemx QTSave
40530 @itemx qTsP
40531 @itemx qTsV
40532 @itemx QTStart
40533 @itemx QTStop
40534 @itemx QTEnable
40535 @itemx QTDisable
40536 @itemx QTinit
40537 @itemx QTro
40538 @itemx qTStatus
40539 @itemx qTV
40540 @itemx qTfSTM
40541 @itemx qTsSTM
40542 @itemx qTSTMat
40543 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
40544
40545 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40546 @cindex read special object, remote request
40547 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
40548 @anchor{qXfer read}
40549 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
40550 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
40551 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
40552 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
40553 additional details about what data to access.
40554
40555 Reply:
40556 @table @samp
40557 @item m @var{data}
40558 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
40559 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
40560 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
40561 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
40562 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
40563 request.
40564
40565 @item l @var{data}
40566 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
40567 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
40568 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
40569
40570 @item l
40571 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
40572 There is no more data to be read.
40573
40574 @item E00
40575 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
40576
40577 @item E @var{nn}
40578 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
40579 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
40580
40581 @item @w{}
40582 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
40583 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
40584 @end table
40585
40586 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
40587 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
40588 formats, listed above.
40589
40590 @table @samp
40591 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40592 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
40593 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
40594 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
40595
40596 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40597 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40598
40599 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40600 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
40601
40602 Return a description of the current branch trace.
40603 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
40604 packet may have one of the following values:
40605
40606 @table @code
40607 @item all
40608 Returns all available branch trace.
40609
40610 @item new
40611 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
40612 the last read request.
40613
40614 @item delta
40615 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
40616 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
40617 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
40618 used to stitch traces together.
40619
40620 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
40621 @end table
40622
40623 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
40624 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40625
40626 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40627 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
40628
40629 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
40630 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
40631
40632 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
40633 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40634
40635 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40636 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
40637 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
40638 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
40639 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
40640 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
40641 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
40642
40643 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40644 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40645
40646 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40647 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
40648 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
40649 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
40650 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
40651
40652 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40653 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40654
40655 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40656 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
40657 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
40658 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
40659 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40660
40661 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
40662 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
40663 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
40664
40665 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40666 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40667
40668 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40669 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
40670 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
40671 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
40672 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
40673 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
40674 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40675 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
40676
40677 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
40678 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
40679
40680 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40681 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40682
40683 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
40684 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
40685 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
40686 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
40687
40688 @table @code
40689 @item start=@var{address}
40690 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
40691 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
40692 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
40693 chosen as the starting point.
40694
40695 @item prev=@var{address}
40696 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
40697 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
40698 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
40699 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
40700 exists prior to the starting point.
40701
40702 @end table
40703
40704 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
40705 ignored.
40706
40707 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40708 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
40709 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
40710 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
40711 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40712
40713 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40714 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40715
40716 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40717 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
40718
40719 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
40720 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
40721 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
40722 Action Lists}.
40723
40724 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40725 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40726 (@pxref{qSupported}).
40727
40728 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40729 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
40730 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
40731 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
40732 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40733
40734 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40735 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40736 (@pxref{qSupported}).
40737
40738 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40739 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
40740 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
40741 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
40742 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40743
40744 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40745 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40746
40747 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40748 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
40749
40750 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
40751 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
40752 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40753
40754 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40755 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40756
40757 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40758 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
40759
40760 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
40761 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
40762
40763 This packet is not probed by default.
40764
40765 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40766 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
40767 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
40768 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
40769 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
40770
40771 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40772 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40773
40774 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40775 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
40776 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
40777 @xref{Operating System Information}.
40778
40779 @end table
40780
40781 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
40782 @cindex write data into object, remote request
40783 @anchor{qXfer write}
40784 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
40785 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
40786 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
40787 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
40788 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
40789 to access.
40790
40791 Reply:
40792 @table @samp
40793 @item @var{nn}
40794 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
40795 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
40796
40797 @item E00
40798 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
40799
40800 @item E @var{nn}
40801 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
40802 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
40803
40804 @item @w{}
40805 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
40806 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
40807 @end table
40808
40809 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
40810 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
40811 formats, listed above.
40812
40813 @table @samp
40814 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
40815 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
40816 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
40817 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
40818 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
40819
40820 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40821 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40822 (@pxref{qSupported}).
40823 @end table
40824
40825 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
40826 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
40827 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
40828 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
40829 must respond with an empty packet.
40830
40831 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
40832 @cindex query attached, remote request
40833 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
40834 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
40835 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
40836 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
40837 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
40838 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
40839 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
40840
40841 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
40842 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
40843 the @code{quit} command.
40844
40845 Reply:
40846 @table @samp
40847 @item 1
40848 The remote server attached to an existing process.
40849 @item 0
40850 The remote server created a new process.
40851 @item E @var{NN}
40852 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40853 @end table
40854
40855 @item Qbtrace:bts
40856 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
40857
40858 Reply:
40859 @table @samp
40860 @item OK
40861 Branch tracing has been enabled.
40862 @item E.errtext
40863 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40864 @end table
40865
40866 @item Qbtrace:pt
40867 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
40868
40869 Reply:
40870 @table @samp
40871 @item OK
40872 Branch tracing has been enabled.
40873 @item E.errtext
40874 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40875 @end table
40876
40877 @item Qbtrace:off
40878 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
40879
40880 Reply:
40881 @table @samp
40882 @item OK
40883 Branch tracing has been disabled.
40884 @item E.errtext
40885 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40886 @end table
40887
40888 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
40889 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
40890 btrace recording method in bts format.
40891
40892 Reply:
40893 @table @samp
40894 @item OK
40895 The ring buffer size has been set.
40896 @item E.errtext
40897 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40898 @end table
40899
40900 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
40901 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
40902 btrace recording method in pt format.
40903
40904 Reply:
40905 @table @samp
40906 @item OK
40907 The ring buffer size has been set.
40908 @item E.errtext
40909 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40910 @end table
40911
40912 @end table
40913
40914 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
40915 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
40916
40917 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
40918 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
40919 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
40920
40921 @menu
40922 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
40923 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
40924 @end menu
40925
40926 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
40927 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
40928
40929 @menu
40930 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
40931 @end menu
40932
40933 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
40934 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
40935 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
40936
40937 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
40938
40939 @table @r
40940
40941 @item 2
40942 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
40943
40944 @item 3
40945 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
40946
40947 @item 4
40948 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
40949
40950 @end table
40951
40952 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
40953 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
40954
40955 @menu
40956 * MIPS Register packet Format::
40957 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
40958 @end menu
40959
40960 @node MIPS Register packet Format
40961 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
40962 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
40963
40964 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
40965 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
40966 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
40967 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
40968 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
40969 most-significant -- least-significant.
40970
40971 @table @r
40972
40973 @item MIPS32
40974 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
40975 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
40976 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
40977
40978 @item MIPS64
40979 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
40980 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
40981 as @code{MIPS32}.
40982
40983 @end table
40984
40985 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
40986 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
40987 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
40988
40989 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
40990
40991 @table @r
40992
40993 @item 2
40994 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
40995
40996 @item 3
40997 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
40998
40999 @item 4
41000 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
41001
41002 @item 5
41003 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
41004
41005 @end table
41006
41007 @node Tracepoint Packets
41008 @section Tracepoint Packets
41009 @cindex tracepoint packets
41010 @cindex packets, tracepoint
41011
41012 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
41013 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
41014
41015 @table @samp
41016
41017 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
41018 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
41019 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
41020 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
41021 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
41022 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
41023 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
41024 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
41025 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
41026 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
41027 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
41028 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
41029 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
41030 actions.
41031
41032 Replies:
41033 @table @samp
41034 @item OK
41035 The packet was understood and carried out.
41036 @item qRelocInsn
41037 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
41038 @item @w{}
41039 The packet was not recognized.
41040 @end table
41041
41042 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
41043 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
41044 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
41045 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
41046 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
41047 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
41048 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
41049
41050 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
41051 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
41052 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
41053 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
41054 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
41055 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
41056 tracepoint actions.
41057
41058 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
41059 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
41060 following forms:
41061
41062 @table @samp
41063
41064 @item R @var{mask}
41065 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
41066 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
41067 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
41068 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
41069 not fit in a 32-bit word.
41070
41071 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
41072 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
41073 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
41074 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
41075 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
41076 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
41077 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
41078
41079 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
41080 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
41081 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
41082 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
41083 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
41084 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
41085 packet).
41086
41087 @end table
41088
41089 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
41090 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
41091 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
41092 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
41093 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
41094 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
41095 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
41096 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
41097
41098 Replies:
41099 @table @samp
41100 @item OK
41101 The packet was understood and carried out.
41102 @item qRelocInsn
41103 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
41104 @item @w{}
41105 The packet was not recognized.
41106 @end table
41107
41108 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
41109 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
41110 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
41111 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
41112 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
41113 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
41114 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
41115 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
41116
41117 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
41118 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
41119 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
41120 fit in a single packet.
41121 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
41122 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
41123
41124 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
41125 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
41126 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
41127 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
41128
41129 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
41130 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
41131 query packets.
41132
41133 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
41134 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
41135 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
41136 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
41137 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
41138 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
41139 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
41140 be found.
41141
41142 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
41143 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
41144 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
41145 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
41146 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
41147 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
41148 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
41149 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
41150 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
41151 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
41152 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
41153 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
41154 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
41155 variable.
41156
41157 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
41158 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
41159 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
41160 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
41161 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
41162
41163 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
41164 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
41165 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
41166 one of the following forms:
41167
41168 @table @samp
41169 @item F @var{f}
41170 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
41171 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
41172 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
41173
41174 @item T @var{t}
41175 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
41176 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
41177
41178 @end table
41179
41180 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
41181 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
41182 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
41183 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
41184
41185 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
41186 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
41187 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
41188 is a hexadecimal number.
41189
41190 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
41191 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
41192 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
41193 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
41194 numbers.
41195
41196 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
41197 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
41198 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
41199
41200 @item qTMinFTPILen
41201 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
41202 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
41203 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
41204 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
41205 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
41206 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
41207 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
41208 arrange for that.
41209
41210 Replies:
41211
41212 @table @samp
41213 @item 0
41214 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
41215 @item @var{length}
41216 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
41217 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
41218 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
41219 regardless of size.
41220 @item E
41221 An error has occurred.
41222 @item @w{}
41223 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
41224 @end table
41225
41226 @item QTStart
41227 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
41228 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
41229 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
41230 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
41231 instruction reply packet}).
41232
41233 @item QTStop
41234 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
41235 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
41236
41237 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
41238 @anchor{QTEnable}
41239 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
41240 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
41241 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
41242 of data from it will resume.
41243
41244 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
41245 @anchor{QTDisable}
41246 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
41247 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
41248 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
41249 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
41250
41251 @item QTinit
41252 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
41253 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
41254
41255 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
41256 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
41257 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
41258 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
41259 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
41260
41261 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
41262 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
41263 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
41264 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
41265
41266 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
41267 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
41268 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
41269 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
41270 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
41271 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
41272
41273 @item qTStatus
41274 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
41275 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
41276
41277 The reply has the form:
41278
41279 @table @samp
41280
41281 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
41282 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
41283 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
41284 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
41285
41286 @end table
41287
41288 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
41289 explanations as one of the optional fields:
41290
41291 @table @samp
41292
41293 @item tnotrun:0
41294 No trace has been run yet.
41295
41296 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
41297 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
41298 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
41299 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
41300 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
41301
41302 @item tfull:0
41303 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
41304
41305 @item tdisconnected:0
41306 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
41307
41308 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
41309 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
41310
41311 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
41312 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
41313 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
41314 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
41315 is hex encoded.
41316
41317 @item tunknown:0
41318 The trace stopped for some other reason.
41319
41320 @end table
41321
41322 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
41323 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
41324 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
41325 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
41326 trace.
41327
41328 @table @samp
41329
41330 @item tframes:@var{n}
41331 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
41332
41333 @item tcreated:@var{n}
41334 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
41335 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
41336
41337 @item tsize:@var{n}
41338 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
41339
41340 @item tfree:@var{n}
41341 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
41342
41343 @item circular:@var{n}
41344 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
41345 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
41346 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
41347 and may fill up.
41348
41349 @item disconn:@var{n}
41350 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
41351 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
41352 that the trace run will stop.
41353
41354 @end table
41355
41356 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
41357 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
41358 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
41359 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
41360 address @var{addr}.
41361
41362 Replies:
41363 @table @samp
41364 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
41365 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
41366 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
41367 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
41368 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
41369
41370 @end table
41371
41372 @item qTV:@var{var}
41373 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
41374 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
41375 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
41376
41377 Replies:
41378 @table @samp
41379 @item V@var{value}
41380 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
41381 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
41382 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
41383 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
41384 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
41385 program is running.
41386
41387 @item U
41388 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
41389 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
41390 was not collected.
41391 @end table
41392
41393 @item qTfP
41394 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
41395 @itemx qTsP
41396 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
41397 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
41398 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
41399 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
41400 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
41401 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
41402
41403 @item qTfV
41404 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
41405 @itemx qTsV
41406 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
41407 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
41408 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
41409 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
41410 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
41411 trace state variables.
41412
41413 @item qTfSTM
41414 @itemx qTsSTM
41415 @anchor{qTfSTM}
41416 @anchor{qTsSTM}
41417 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
41418 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
41419 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
41420 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
41421 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
41422 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
41423
41424 Reply:
41425 @table @samp
41426 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
41427 A single marker
41428 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
41429 a comma-separated list of markers
41430 @item l
41431 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
41432 @item E @var{nn}
41433 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
41434 @item @w{}
41435 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
41436 stub.
41437 @end table
41438
41439 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
41440 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
41441
41442 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
41443 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
41444 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
41445 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
41446 @dfn{last}).
41447
41448 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
41449 @anchor{qTSTMat}
41450 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
41451 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
41452 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
41453 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
41454 tracepoint markers.
41455
41456 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
41457 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
41458 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
41459 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
41460 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
41461 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
41462
41463 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
41464 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
41465 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
41466 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
41467 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
41468 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
41469 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
41470 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
41471 available.
41472
41473 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
41474 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
41475 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
41476
41477 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
41478 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
41479 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
41480 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
41481 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
41482 use whatever size it prefers.
41483
41484 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
41485 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
41486 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
41487 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
41488 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
41489
41490 @end table
41491
41492 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
41493 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
41494 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
41495 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
41496 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
41497 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
41498 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
41499 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
41500 it had executed in the original location.
41501
41502 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
41503 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
41504 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
41505 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
41506 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
41507 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
41508 format of the request is:
41509
41510 @table @samp
41511 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
41512
41513 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
41514 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
41515 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
41516 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
41517 memory starting at @var{to}.
41518 @end table
41519
41520 Replies:
41521 @table @samp
41522 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
41523 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
41524 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
41525 @item E @var{NN}
41526 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
41527 relocating the instruction.
41528 @end table
41529
41530 @node Host I/O Packets
41531 @section Host I/O Packets
41532 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
41533 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
41534
41535 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
41536 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
41537 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
41538 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
41539 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
41540 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
41541 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
41542 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
41543 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
41544 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
41545
41546 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
41547 its arguments. They have this format:
41548
41549 @table @samp
41550
41551 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
41552 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
41553 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
41554 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
41555 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
41556 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
41557 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
41558 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
41559 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
41560
41561 @end table
41562
41563 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
41564
41565 @table @samp
41566
41567 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
41568 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
41569 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
41570 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
41571 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
41572 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
41573 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
41574 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
41575 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
41576 @var{attachment}.
41577
41578 @item @w{}
41579 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
41580
41581 @end table
41582
41583 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
41584
41585 @table @samp
41586 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
41587 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
41588 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
41589 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
41590 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
41591 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
41592 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
41593
41594 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
41595 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
41596 -1 if an error occurs.
41597
41598 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
41599 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
41600 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
41601 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
41602 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
41603 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
41604 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
41605 @var{count} was zero.
41606
41607 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
41608 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
41609 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
41610 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
41611 some characters were escaped.
41612
41613 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
41614 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
41615 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
41616 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
41617 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
41618 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
41619 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
41620 error occurred.
41621
41622 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
41623 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
41624 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
41625 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
41626 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
41627 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
41628
41629 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
41630 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
41631 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
41632
41633 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
41634 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
41635 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
41636
41637 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
41638 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
41639 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
41640 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
41641 some characters were escaped.
41642
41643 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
41644 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
41645 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
41646 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
41647 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
41648 inferior(s).
41649
41650 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
41651 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
41652 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
41653 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
41654 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
41655 operation.
41656
41657 @end table
41658
41659 @node Interrupts
41660 @section Interrupts
41661 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
41662 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
41663
41664 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
41665 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
41666 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
41667 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
41668
41669 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
41670 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
41671 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
41672 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
41673 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
41674
41675 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
41676 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
41677 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
41678 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
41679 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
41680 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
41681 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
41682 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
41683
41684 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
41685 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
41686 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
41687
41688 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
41689 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
41690 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
41691 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
41692 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
41693 @code{0x03}.
41694
41695 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
41696 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
41697 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
41698 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
41699 currently-executing threads and processes.
41700 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
41701 running program, it should send one of the stop
41702 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
41703 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
41704 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
41705 Interrupts received while the
41706 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
41707 it is resumed next time.
41708
41709 @node Notification Packets
41710 @section Notification Packets
41711 @cindex notification packets
41712 @cindex packets, notification
41713
41714 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
41715 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
41716 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
41717 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
41718 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
41719 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
41720 is not a problem.
41721
41722 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
41723 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
41724 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
41725 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
41726 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
41727 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
41728 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
41729
41730 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
41731 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
41732
41733 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
41734 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
41735 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
41736 not they understand it.
41737
41738 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
41739 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
41740 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
41741 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
41742 recipients.
41743
41744 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
41745 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
41746 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
41747 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
41748 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
41749
41750 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
41751 @table @samp
41752 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
41753 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
41754 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
41755 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
41756 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
41757 @item @var{ack}
41758 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
41759 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
41760 @end table
41761
41762 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
41763 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
41764
41765 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
41766 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
41767 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
41768 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
41769 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
41770 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
41771 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
41772 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
41773 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
41774 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
41775
41776 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
41777 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
41778 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
41779 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
41780 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
41781 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
41782
41783 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
41784 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
41785 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
41786 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
41787 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
41788
41789 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
41790 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
41791 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
41792 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
41793 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
41794 normally.
41795
41796 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
41797 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
41798 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
41799 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
41800 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
41801 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
41802 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
41803 the process shall be repeated.
41804
41805 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
41806 following example:
41807 @smallexample
41808 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
41809 @code{...}
41810 -> @code{vStopped}
41811 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
41812 -> @code{vStopped}
41813 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
41814 -> @code{vStopped}
41815 <- @code{OK}
41816 @end smallexample
41817
41818 The following notifications are defined:
41819 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
41820
41821 @item Notification
41822 @tab Ack
41823 @tab Event
41824 @tab Description
41825
41826 @item Stop
41827 @tab vStopped
41828 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
41829 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
41830 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
41831 @value{GDBN}.
41832 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
41833
41834 @end multitable
41835
41836 @node Remote Non-Stop
41837 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
41838
41839 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
41840 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
41841 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
41842 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
41843
41844 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
41845 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
41846 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
41847 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
41848 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
41849 probe the target state after a mode change.
41850
41851 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
41852 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
41853 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
41854 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
41855 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
41856 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
41857 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
41858 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
41859 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
41860 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
41861 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
41862
41863 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
41864 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
41865 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
41866 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
41867 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
41868 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
41869 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
41870 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
41871 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
41872 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
41873 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
41874 @samp{OK}.
41875
41876 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
41877 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
41878 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
41879 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
41880 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
41881 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
41882 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
41883 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
41884 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
41885 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
41886 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
41887 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
41888 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
41889
41890 @node Packet Acknowledgment
41891 @section Packet Acknowledgment
41892
41893 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
41894 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
41895 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
41896 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
41897 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
41898 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
41899 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
41900
41901 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
41902 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
41903 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
41904 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
41905 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
41906
41907 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
41908 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
41909 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
41910 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
41911
41912 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
41913 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
41914 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
41915 @pxref{qSupported}.
41916 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
41917 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
41918 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
41919 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
41920 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
41921 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
41922 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
41923
41924 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
41925 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
41926 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
41927 connection.
41928 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
41929 new connection is established,
41930 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
41931 for the current connection, once disabled.
41932
41933 @node Examples
41934 @section Examples
41935
41936 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
41937 does not get any direct output:
41938
41939 @smallexample
41940 -> @code{R00}
41941 <- @code{+}
41942 @emph{target restarts}
41943 -> @code{?}
41944 <- @code{+}
41945 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
41946 -> @code{+}
41947 @end smallexample
41948
41949 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
41950
41951 @smallexample
41952 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
41953 <- @code{+}
41954 -> @code{s}
41955 <- @code{+}
41956 @emph{time passes}
41957 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
41958 -> @code{+}
41959 -> @code{g}
41960 <- @code{+}
41961 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
41962 -> @code{+}
41963 @end smallexample
41964
41965 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
41966 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
41967 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
41968
41969 @menu
41970 * File-I/O Overview::
41971 * Protocol Basics::
41972 * The F Request Packet::
41973 * The F Reply Packet::
41974 * The Ctrl-C Message::
41975 * Console I/O::
41976 * List of Supported Calls::
41977 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
41978 * Constants::
41979 * File-I/O Examples::
41980 @end menu
41981
41982 @node File-I/O Overview
41983 @subsection File-I/O Overview
41984 @cindex file-i/o overview
41985
41986 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
41987 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
41988 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
41989 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
41990 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
41991 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
41992
41993 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
41994 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
41995 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
41996 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
41997 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
41998
41999 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
42000 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
42001 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
42002 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
42003 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
42004 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
42005 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
42006
42007 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
42008 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
42009 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
42010 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
42011 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
42012
42013 @smallexample
42014 (@value{GDBP}) continue
42015 <- target requests 'system call X'
42016 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
42017 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
42018 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
42019 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
42020 @end smallexample
42021
42022 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
42023 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
42024 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
42025 system are not supported by this protocol.
42026
42027 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
42028
42029 @node Protocol Basics
42030 @subsection Protocol Basics
42031 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
42032
42033 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
42034 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
42035 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
42036 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
42037 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
42038 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
42039 to call the appropriate host system call:
42040
42041 @itemize @bullet
42042 @item
42043 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
42044
42045 @item
42046 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
42047 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
42048 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
42049 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
42050
42051 @end itemize
42052
42053 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
42054
42055 @itemize @bullet
42056 @item
42057 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
42058 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
42059 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
42060 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
42061 packet.
42062
42063 @item
42064 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
42065 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
42066
42067 @item
42068 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
42069
42070 @item
42071 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
42072
42073 @item
42074 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
42075 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
42076 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
42077 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
42078 packet.
42079
42080 @end itemize
42081
42082 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
42083 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
42084
42085 @itemize @bullet
42086 @item
42087 Return value.
42088
42089 @item
42090 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
42091
42092 @item
42093 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
42094
42095 @end itemize
42096
42097 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
42098 the latest continue or step action.
42099
42100 @node The F Request Packet
42101 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
42102 @cindex file-i/o request packet
42103 @cindex @code{F} request packet
42104
42105 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
42106
42107 @table @samp
42108 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
42109
42110 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
42111 This is just the name of the function.
42112
42113 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
42114 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
42115 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
42116 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
42117 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
42118 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
42119 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
42120
42121 @end table
42122
42123
42124
42125 @node The F Reply Packet
42126 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
42127 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
42128 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
42129
42130 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
42131
42132 @table @samp
42133
42134 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
42135
42136 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
42137
42138 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
42139 representation.
42140 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
42141
42142 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
42143 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
42144 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
42145
42146 @smallexample
42147 F0,0,C
42148 @end smallexample
42149
42150 @noindent
42151 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
42152
42153 @smallexample
42154 F-1,4,C
42155 @end smallexample
42156
42157 @noindent
42158 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
42159
42160 @end table
42161
42162
42163 @node The Ctrl-C Message
42164 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
42165 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
42166
42167 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
42168 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
42169 the target should behave as if it had
42170 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
42171 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
42172 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
42173 packet.
42174
42175 It's important for the target to know in which
42176 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
42177
42178 @itemize @bullet
42179 @item
42180 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
42181
42182 @item
42183 The system call on the host has been finished.
42184
42185 @end itemize
42186
42187 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
42188 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
42189 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
42190 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
42191 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
42192 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
42193
42194 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
42195 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
42196 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
42197 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
42198 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
42199 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
42200 or the full action has been completed.
42201
42202 @node Console I/O
42203 @subsection Console I/O
42204 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
42205
42206 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
42207 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
42208 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
42209 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
42210 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
42211 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
42212 conditions is met:
42213
42214 @itemize @bullet
42215 @item
42216 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
42217 @code{read}
42218 system call is treated as finished.
42219
42220 @item
42221 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
42222 newline.
42223
42224 @item
42225 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
42226 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
42227
42228 @end itemize
42229
42230 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
42231 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
42232 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
42233 is stopped at the user's request.
42234
42235
42236 @node List of Supported Calls
42237 @subsection List of Supported Calls
42238 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
42239
42240 @menu
42241 * open::
42242 * close::
42243 * read::
42244 * write::
42245 * lseek::
42246 * rename::
42247 * unlink::
42248 * stat/fstat::
42249 * gettimeofday::
42250 * isatty::
42251 * system::
42252 @end menu
42253
42254 @node open
42255 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
42256 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
42257
42258 @table @asis
42259 @item Synopsis:
42260 @smallexample
42261 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
42262 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
42263 @end smallexample
42264
42265 @item Request:
42266 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
42267
42268 @noindent
42269 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
42270
42271 @table @code
42272 @item O_CREAT
42273 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
42274 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
42275 are concerned.
42276
42277 @item O_EXCL
42278 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
42279 an error and open() fails.
42280
42281 @item O_TRUNC
42282 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
42283 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
42284 truncated to zero length.
42285
42286 @item O_APPEND
42287 The file is opened in append mode.
42288
42289 @item O_RDONLY
42290 The file is opened for reading only.
42291
42292 @item O_WRONLY
42293 The file is opened for writing only.
42294
42295 @item O_RDWR
42296 The file is opened for reading and writing.
42297 @end table
42298
42299 @noindent
42300 Other bits are silently ignored.
42301
42302
42303 @noindent
42304 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
42305
42306 @table @code
42307 @item S_IRUSR
42308 User has read permission.
42309
42310 @item S_IWUSR
42311 User has write permission.
42312
42313 @item S_IRGRP
42314 Group has read permission.
42315
42316 @item S_IWGRP
42317 Group has write permission.
42318
42319 @item S_IROTH
42320 Others have read permission.
42321
42322 @item S_IWOTH
42323 Others have write permission.
42324 @end table
42325
42326 @noindent
42327 Other bits are silently ignored.
42328
42329
42330 @item Return value:
42331 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
42332 occurred.
42333
42334 @item Errors:
42335
42336 @table @code
42337 @item EEXIST
42338 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
42339
42340 @item EISDIR
42341 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
42342
42343 @item EACCES
42344 The requested access is not allowed.
42345
42346 @item ENAMETOOLONG
42347 @var{pathname} was too long.
42348
42349 @item ENOENT
42350 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
42351
42352 @item ENODEV
42353 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
42354
42355 @item EROFS
42356 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
42357 write access was requested.
42358
42359 @item EFAULT
42360 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
42361
42362 @item ENOSPC
42363 No space on device to create the file.
42364
42365 @item EMFILE
42366 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
42367
42368 @item ENFILE
42369 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
42370 has been reached.
42371
42372 @item EINTR
42373 The call was interrupted by the user.
42374 @end table
42375
42376 @end table
42377
42378 @node close
42379 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
42380 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
42381
42382 @table @asis
42383 @item Synopsis:
42384 @smallexample
42385 int close(int fd);
42386 @end smallexample
42387
42388 @item Request:
42389 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
42390
42391 @item Return value:
42392 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
42393
42394 @item Errors:
42395
42396 @table @code
42397 @item EBADF
42398 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
42399
42400 @item EINTR
42401 The call was interrupted by the user.
42402 @end table
42403
42404 @end table
42405
42406 @node read
42407 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
42408 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
42409
42410 @table @asis
42411 @item Synopsis:
42412 @smallexample
42413 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
42414 @end smallexample
42415
42416 @item Request:
42417 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
42418
42419 @item Return value:
42420 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
42421 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
42422 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
42423
42424 @item Errors:
42425
42426 @table @code
42427 @item EBADF
42428 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
42429 reading.
42430
42431 @item EFAULT
42432 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
42433
42434 @item EINTR
42435 The call was interrupted by the user.
42436 @end table
42437
42438 @end table
42439
42440 @node write
42441 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
42442 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
42443
42444 @table @asis
42445 @item Synopsis:
42446 @smallexample
42447 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
42448 @end smallexample
42449
42450 @item Request:
42451 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
42452
42453 @item Return value:
42454 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
42455 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
42456 is returned.
42457
42458 @item Errors:
42459
42460 @table @code
42461 @item EBADF
42462 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
42463 writing.
42464
42465 @item EFAULT
42466 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
42467
42468 @item EFBIG
42469 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
42470 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
42471
42472 @item ENOSPC
42473 No space on device to write the data.
42474
42475 @item EINTR
42476 The call was interrupted by the user.
42477 @end table
42478
42479 @end table
42480
42481 @node lseek
42482 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
42483 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
42484
42485 @table @asis
42486 @item Synopsis:
42487 @smallexample
42488 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
42489 @end smallexample
42490
42491 @item Request:
42492 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
42493
42494 @var{flag} is one of:
42495
42496 @table @code
42497 @item SEEK_SET
42498 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
42499
42500 @item SEEK_CUR
42501 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
42502 bytes.
42503
42504 @item SEEK_END
42505 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
42506 bytes.
42507 @end table
42508
42509 @item Return value:
42510 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
42511 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
42512 value of -1 is returned.
42513
42514 @item Errors:
42515
42516 @table @code
42517 @item EBADF
42518 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
42519
42520 @item ESPIPE
42521 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
42522
42523 @item EINVAL
42524 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
42525
42526 @item EINTR
42527 The call was interrupted by the user.
42528 @end table
42529
42530 @end table
42531
42532 @node rename
42533 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
42534 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
42535
42536 @table @asis
42537 @item Synopsis:
42538 @smallexample
42539 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
42540 @end smallexample
42541
42542 @item Request:
42543 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
42544
42545 @item Return value:
42546 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
42547
42548 @item Errors:
42549
42550 @table @code
42551 @item EISDIR
42552 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
42553 directory.
42554
42555 @item EEXIST
42556 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
42557
42558 @item EBUSY
42559 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
42560 process.
42561
42562 @item EINVAL
42563 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
42564 of itself.
42565
42566 @item ENOTDIR
42567 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
42568 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
42569 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
42570
42571 @item EFAULT
42572 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
42573
42574 @item EACCES
42575 No access to the file or the path of the file.
42576
42577 @item ENAMETOOLONG
42578
42579 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
42580
42581 @item ENOENT
42582 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
42583
42584 @item EROFS
42585 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
42586
42587 @item ENOSPC
42588 The device containing the file has no room for the new
42589 directory entry.
42590
42591 @item EINTR
42592 The call was interrupted by the user.
42593 @end table
42594
42595 @end table
42596
42597 @node unlink
42598 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
42599 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
42600
42601 @table @asis
42602 @item Synopsis:
42603 @smallexample
42604 int unlink(const char *pathname);
42605 @end smallexample
42606
42607 @item Request:
42608 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
42609
42610 @item Return value:
42611 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
42612
42613 @item Errors:
42614
42615 @table @code
42616 @item EACCES
42617 No access to the file or the path of the file.
42618
42619 @item EPERM
42620 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
42621
42622 @item EBUSY
42623 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
42624 being used by another process.
42625
42626 @item EFAULT
42627 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
42628
42629 @item ENAMETOOLONG
42630 @var{pathname} was too long.
42631
42632 @item ENOENT
42633 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
42634
42635 @item ENOTDIR
42636 A component of the path is not a directory.
42637
42638 @item EROFS
42639 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
42640
42641 @item EINTR
42642 The call was interrupted by the user.
42643 @end table
42644
42645 @end table
42646
42647 @node stat/fstat
42648 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
42649 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
42650 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
42651
42652 @table @asis
42653 @item Synopsis:
42654 @smallexample
42655 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
42656 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
42657 @end smallexample
42658
42659 @item Request:
42660 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
42661 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
42662
42663 @item Return value:
42664 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
42665
42666 @item Errors:
42667
42668 @table @code
42669 @item EBADF
42670 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
42671
42672 @item ENOENT
42673 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
42674 path is an empty string.
42675
42676 @item ENOTDIR
42677 A component of the path is not a directory.
42678
42679 @item EFAULT
42680 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
42681
42682 @item EACCES
42683 No access to the file or the path of the file.
42684
42685 @item ENAMETOOLONG
42686 @var{pathname} was too long.
42687
42688 @item EINTR
42689 The call was interrupted by the user.
42690 @end table
42691
42692 @end table
42693
42694 @node gettimeofday
42695 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
42696 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
42697
42698 @table @asis
42699 @item Synopsis:
42700 @smallexample
42701 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
42702 @end smallexample
42703
42704 @item Request:
42705 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
42706
42707 @item Return value:
42708 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
42709
42710 @item Errors:
42711
42712 @table @code
42713 @item EINVAL
42714 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
42715
42716 @item EFAULT
42717 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
42718 @end table
42719
42720 @end table
42721
42722 @node isatty
42723 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
42724 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
42725
42726 @table @asis
42727 @item Synopsis:
42728 @smallexample
42729 int isatty(int fd);
42730 @end smallexample
42731
42732 @item Request:
42733 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
42734
42735 @item Return value:
42736 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
42737
42738 @item Errors:
42739
42740 @table @code
42741 @item EINTR
42742 The call was interrupted by the user.
42743 @end table
42744
42745 @end table
42746
42747 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
42748 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
42749 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
42750 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
42751 needed.
42752
42753
42754 @node system
42755 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
42756 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
42757
42758 @table @asis
42759 @item Synopsis:
42760 @smallexample
42761 int system(const char *command);
42762 @end smallexample
42763
42764 @item Request:
42765 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
42766
42767 @item Return value:
42768 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
42769 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
42770 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
42771 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
42772 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
42773 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
42774 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
42775
42776 @item Errors:
42777
42778 @table @code
42779 @item EINTR
42780 The call was interrupted by the user.
42781 @end table
42782
42783 @end table
42784
42785 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
42786 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
42787 the host is simplified before it's returned
42788 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
42789 is discarded, and the return value consists
42790 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
42791
42792 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
42793 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
42794 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
42795
42796 @table @code
42797 @item set remote system-call-allowed
42798 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
42799 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
42800 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
42801
42802 @item show remote system-call-allowed
42803 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
42804 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
42805 protocol.
42806 @end table
42807
42808 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
42809 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
42810 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
42811
42812 @menu
42813 * Integral Datatypes::
42814 * Pointer Values::
42815 * Memory Transfer::
42816 * struct stat::
42817 * struct timeval::
42818 @end menu
42819
42820 @node Integral Datatypes
42821 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
42822 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
42823
42824 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
42825 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
42826 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
42827
42828 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
42829 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
42830
42831 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
42832
42833 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
42834 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
42835
42836 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
42837
42838 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
42839 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
42840 byte order.
42841
42842 @node Pointer Values
42843 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
42844 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
42845
42846 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
42847 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
42848 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
42849 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
42850
42851 @smallexample
42852 @code{1aaf/12}
42853 @end smallexample
42854
42855 @noindent
42856 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
42857 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
42858 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
42859 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
42860
42861 @smallexample
42862 @code{123456/d}
42863 @end smallexample
42864
42865 @node Memory Transfer
42866 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
42867 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
42868
42869 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
42870 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
42871 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
42872 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
42873 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
42874 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
42875 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
42876
42877
42878 @node struct stat
42879 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
42880 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
42881
42882 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
42883 is defined as follows:
42884
42885 @smallexample
42886 struct stat @{
42887 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
42888 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
42889 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
42890 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
42891 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
42892 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
42893 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
42894 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
42895 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
42896 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
42897 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
42898 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
42899 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
42900 @};
42901 @end smallexample
42902
42903 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
42904 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
42905 structure is of size 64 bytes.
42906
42907 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
42908 range of values.
42909
42910 @table @code
42911
42912 @item st_dev
42913 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
42914
42915 @item st_ino
42916 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
42917
42918 @item st_mode
42919 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
42920 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
42921
42922 @item st_uid
42923 @itemx st_gid
42924 @itemx st_rdev
42925 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
42926
42927 @item st_atime
42928 @itemx st_mtime
42929 @itemx st_ctime
42930 These values have a host and file system dependent
42931 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
42932 support exact timing values.
42933 @end table
42934
42935 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
42936 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
42937 continuing.
42938
42939 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
42940 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
42941 get truncated on the target.
42942
42943 @node struct timeval
42944 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
42945 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
42946
42947 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
42948 is defined as follows:
42949
42950 @smallexample
42951 struct timeval @{
42952 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
42953 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
42954 @};
42955 @end smallexample
42956
42957 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
42958 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
42959 structure is of size 8 bytes.
42960
42961 @node Constants
42962 @subsection Constants
42963 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
42964
42965 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
42966 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
42967 values before and after the call as needed.
42968
42969 @menu
42970 * Open Flags::
42971 * mode_t Values::
42972 * Errno Values::
42973 * Lseek Flags::
42974 * Limits::
42975 @end menu
42976
42977 @node Open Flags
42978 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
42979 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
42980
42981 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
42982
42983 @smallexample
42984 O_RDONLY 0x0
42985 O_WRONLY 0x1
42986 O_RDWR 0x2
42987 O_APPEND 0x8
42988 O_CREAT 0x200
42989 O_TRUNC 0x400
42990 O_EXCL 0x800
42991 @end smallexample
42992
42993 @node mode_t Values
42994 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
42995 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
42996
42997 All values are given in octal representation.
42998
42999 @smallexample
43000 S_IFREG 0100000
43001 S_IFDIR 040000
43002 S_IRUSR 0400
43003 S_IWUSR 0200
43004 S_IXUSR 0100
43005 S_IRGRP 040
43006 S_IWGRP 020
43007 S_IXGRP 010
43008 S_IROTH 04
43009 S_IWOTH 02
43010 S_IXOTH 01
43011 @end smallexample
43012
43013 @node Errno Values
43014 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
43015 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
43016
43017 All values are given in decimal representation.
43018
43019 @smallexample
43020 EPERM 1
43021 ENOENT 2
43022 EINTR 4
43023 EBADF 9
43024 EACCES 13
43025 EFAULT 14
43026 EBUSY 16
43027 EEXIST 17
43028 ENODEV 19
43029 ENOTDIR 20
43030 EISDIR 21
43031 EINVAL 22
43032 ENFILE 23
43033 EMFILE 24
43034 EFBIG 27
43035 ENOSPC 28
43036 ESPIPE 29
43037 EROFS 30
43038 ENAMETOOLONG 91
43039 EUNKNOWN 9999
43040 @end smallexample
43041
43042 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
43043 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
43044
43045 @node Lseek Flags
43046 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
43047 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
43048
43049 @smallexample
43050 SEEK_SET 0
43051 SEEK_CUR 1
43052 SEEK_END 2
43053 @end smallexample
43054
43055 @node Limits
43056 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
43057 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
43058
43059 All values are given in decimal representation.
43060
43061 @smallexample
43062 INT_MIN -2147483648
43063 INT_MAX 2147483647
43064 UINT_MAX 4294967295
43065 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
43066 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
43067 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
43068 @end smallexample
43069
43070 @node File-I/O Examples
43071 @subsection File-I/O Examples
43072 @cindex file-i/o examples
43073
43074 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
43075 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
43076
43077 @smallexample
43078 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
43079 @emph{request memory read from target}
43080 -> @code{m1234,6}
43081 <- XXXXXX
43082 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
43083 -> @code{F6}
43084 @end smallexample
43085
43086 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
43087 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
43088
43089 @smallexample
43090 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
43091 @emph{request memory write to target}
43092 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
43093 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
43094 -> @code{F6}
43095 @end smallexample
43096
43097 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
43098 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
43099
43100 @smallexample
43101 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
43102 -> @code{F-1,9}
43103 @end smallexample
43104
43105 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
43106 host is called:
43107
43108 @smallexample
43109 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
43110 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
43111 <- @code{T02}
43112 @end smallexample
43113
43114 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
43115 host is called:
43116
43117 @smallexample
43118 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
43119 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
43120 <- @code{T02}
43121 @end smallexample
43122
43123 @node Library List Format
43124 @section Library List Format
43125 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
43126
43127 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
43128 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
43129 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
43130 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
43131 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
43132 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
43133 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
43134 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
43135 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
43136 are loaded.
43137
43138 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
43139 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
43140 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
43141 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
43142
43143 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
43144 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
43145 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
43146 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
43147 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
43148 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
43149
43150 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43151 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
43152
43153 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
43154 offset, looks like this:
43155
43156 @smallexample
43157 <library-list>
43158 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
43159 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
43160 </library>
43161 </library-list>
43162 @end smallexample
43163
43164 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
43165 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
43166
43167 @smallexample
43168 <library-list>
43169 <library name="sharedlib.o">
43170 <section address="0x10000000"/>
43171 <section address="0x20000000"/>
43172 <section address="0x30000000"/>
43173 </library>
43174 </library-list>
43175 @end smallexample
43176
43177 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
43178
43179 @smallexample
43180 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
43181 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
43182 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
43183 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
43184 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
43185 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
43186 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
43187 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
43188 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
43189 @end smallexample
43190
43191 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
43192 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
43193 section for each library.
43194
43195 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
43196 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
43197 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
43198
43199 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
43200 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
43201 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
43202 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
43203
43204 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
43205 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
43206 target, the following parameters are reported:
43207
43208 @itemize @minus
43209 @item
43210 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
43211 @code{struct link_map}.
43212 @item
43213 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
43214 (Thread Local Storage) access.
43215 @item
43216 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
43217 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
43218 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
43219 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
43220 @item
43221 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
43222 @end itemize
43223
43224 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
43225 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
43226 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
43227
43228 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43229 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
43230
43231 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
43232 looks like this:
43233
43234 @smallexample
43235 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
43236 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
43237 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
43238 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
43239 l_ld="0x152350"/>
43240 </library-list-svr>
43241 @end smallexample
43242
43243 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
43244
43245 @smallexample
43246 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
43247 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
43248 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
43249 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
43250 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
43251 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
43252 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
43253 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
43254 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
43255 @end smallexample
43256
43257 @node Memory Map Format
43258 @section Memory Map Format
43259 @cindex memory map format
43260
43261 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
43262 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
43263 memory map.
43264
43265 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
43266 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
43267 lists memory regions.
43268
43269 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43270 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
43271
43272 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
43273
43274 @smallexample
43275 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43276 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
43277 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
43278 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
43279 <memory-map>
43280 region...
43281 </memory-map>
43282 @end smallexample
43283
43284 Each region can be either:
43285
43286 @itemize
43287
43288 @item
43289 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
43290 bytes from there:
43291
43292 @smallexample
43293 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
43294 @end smallexample
43295
43296
43297 @item
43298 A region of read-only memory:
43299
43300 @smallexample
43301 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
43302 @end smallexample
43303
43304
43305 @item
43306 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
43307 bytes in length:
43308
43309 @smallexample
43310 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
43311 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
43312 </memory>
43313 @end smallexample
43314
43315 @end itemize
43316
43317 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
43318 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
43319 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
43320
43321 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
43322
43323 @smallexample
43324 <!-- ................................................... -->
43325 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
43326 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
43327 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
43328 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
43329 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
43330 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
43331 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
43332 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
43333 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
43334 and its type, or device. -->
43335 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
43336 start CDATA #REQUIRED
43337 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
43338 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
43339 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
43340 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
43341 @end smallexample
43342
43343 @node Thread List Format
43344 @section Thread List Format
43345 @cindex thread list format
43346
43347 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
43348 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
43349 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
43350 the following structure:
43351
43352 @smallexample
43353 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43354 <threads>
43355 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
43356 ... description ...
43357 </thread>
43358 </threads>
43359 @end smallexample
43360
43361 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
43362 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
43363 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
43364 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
43365 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
43366 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
43367 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
43368 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
43369
43370
43371 @node Traceframe Info Format
43372 @section Traceframe Info Format
43373 @cindex traceframe info format
43374
43375 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
43376 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
43377 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
43378 collected in a traceframe.
43379
43380 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
43381 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
43382
43383 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43384 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
43385
43386 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
43387
43388 @smallexample
43389 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43390 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
43391 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
43392 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
43393 <traceframe-info>
43394 block...
43395 </traceframe-info>
43396 @end smallexample
43397
43398 Each traceframe block can be either:
43399
43400 @itemize
43401
43402 @item
43403 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
43404 @var{length} bytes from there:
43405
43406 @smallexample
43407 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
43408 @end smallexample
43409
43410 @item
43411 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
43412 collected:
43413
43414 @smallexample
43415 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
43416 @end smallexample
43417
43418 @end itemize
43419
43420 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
43421
43422 @smallexample
43423 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
43424 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
43425
43426 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
43427 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
43428 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
43429 <!ELEMENT tvar>
43430 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
43431 @end smallexample
43432
43433 @node Branch Trace Format
43434 @section Branch Trace Format
43435 @cindex branch trace format
43436
43437 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
43438 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
43439 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
43440 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
43441
43442 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
43443 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
43444
43445 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43446 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
43447
43448 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
43449
43450 @smallexample
43451 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43452 <!DOCTYPE btrace
43453 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
43454 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
43455 <btrace>
43456 block...
43457 </btrace>
43458 @end smallexample
43459
43460 @itemize
43461
43462 @item
43463 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
43464 and ending at @var{end}:
43465
43466 @smallexample
43467 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
43468 @end smallexample
43469
43470 @end itemize
43471
43472 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
43473
43474 @smallexample
43475 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
43476 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
43477
43478 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
43479 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
43480 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
43481
43482 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
43483
43484 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
43485
43486 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
43487 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
43488 family CDATA #REQUIRED
43489 model CDATA #REQUIRED
43490 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
43491
43492 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
43493 @end smallexample
43494
43495 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
43496 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
43497 @cindex branch trace configuration format
43498
43499 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
43500 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
43501 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
43502
43503 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
43504 settings for that format. The following information is described:
43505
43506 @table @code
43507 @item bts
43508 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
43509 @table @code
43510 @item size
43511 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
43512 @end table
43513 @item pt
43514 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
43515 PT}) format.
43516 @table @code
43517 @item size
43518 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
43519 @end table
43520 @end table
43521
43522 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43523 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
43524
43525 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
43526
43527 @smallexample
43528 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
43529 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
43530
43531 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
43532 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
43533
43534 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
43535 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
43536 @end smallexample
43537
43538 @include agentexpr.texi
43539
43540 @node Target Descriptions
43541 @appendix Target Descriptions
43542 @cindex target descriptions
43543
43544 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
43545 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
43546 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
43547 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
43548 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
43549 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
43550 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
43551
43552 @itemize @bullet
43553 @item
43554 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
43555 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
43556 @item
43557 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
43558 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
43559 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
43560 @item
43561 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
43562 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
43563 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
43564 @end itemize
43565
43566 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
43567 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
43568 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
43569 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
43570 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
43571
43572 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43573 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
43574
43575 @menu
43576 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
43577 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
43578 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
43579 descriptions.
43580 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
43581 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
43582 @end menu
43583
43584 @node Retrieving Descriptions
43585 @section Retrieving Descriptions
43586
43587 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
43588 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
43589 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
43590 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
43591 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
43592 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
43593 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
43594 Format}.
43595
43596 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
43597 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
43598 specify a file are:
43599
43600 @table @code
43601 @cindex set tdesc filename
43602 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
43603 Read the target description from @var{path}.
43604
43605 @cindex unset tdesc filename
43606 @item unset tdesc filename
43607 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
43608 will use the description supplied by the current target.
43609
43610 @cindex show tdesc filename
43611 @item show tdesc filename
43612 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
43613 @end table
43614
43615
43616 @node Target Description Format
43617 @section Target Description Format
43618 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
43619
43620 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
43621 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
43622 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
43623 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
43624 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
43625 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
43626 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
43627
43628 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
43629 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
43630 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
43631 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
43632 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
43633
43634 Here is a simple target description:
43635
43636 @smallexample
43637 <target version="1.0">
43638 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
43639 </target>
43640 @end smallexample
43641
43642 @noindent
43643 This minimal description only says that the target uses
43644 the x86-64 architecture.
43645
43646 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
43647 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
43648 are explained further below.
43649
43650 @smallexample
43651 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43652 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
43653 <target version="1.0">
43654 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
43655 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
43656 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
43657 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
43658 </target>
43659 @end smallexample
43660
43661 @noindent
43662 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
43663 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
43664 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
43665 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
43666 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
43667 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
43668 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
43669 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
43670 the version mismatch.
43671
43672 @subsection Inclusion
43673 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
43674 @cindex XInclude
43675 @ifnotinfo
43676 @cindex <xi:include>
43677 @end ifnotinfo
43678
43679 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
43680 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
43681 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
43682 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
43683 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
43684
43685 @smallexample
43686 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
43687 @end smallexample
43688
43689 @noindent
43690 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
43691 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
43692 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
43693 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
43694 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
43695 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
43696 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
43697 original description.
43698
43699 @subsection Architecture
43700 @cindex <architecture>
43701
43702 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
43703
43704 @smallexample
43705 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
43706 @end smallexample
43707
43708 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
43709 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
43710
43711 @subsection OS ABI
43712 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
43713
43714 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
43715 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
43716
43717 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
43718
43719 @smallexample
43720 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
43721 @end smallexample
43722
43723 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
43724 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
43725
43726 @subsection Compatible Architecture
43727 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
43728
43729 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
43730 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
43731
43732 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
43733
43734 @smallexample
43735 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
43736 @end smallexample
43737
43738 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
43739 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
43740
43741 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
43742 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
43743 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
43744 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
43745 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
43746 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
43747 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
43748
43749 @smallexample
43750 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
43751 <compatible>spu</compatible>
43752 @end smallexample
43753
43754 @subsection Features
43755 @cindex <feature>
43756
43757 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
43758 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
43759 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
43760 has this form:
43761
43762 @smallexample
43763 <feature name="@var{name}">
43764 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
43765 @var{reg}@dots{}
43766 </feature>
43767 @end smallexample
43768
43769 @noindent
43770 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
43771 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
43772 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
43773 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
43774
43775 @subsection Types
43776
43777 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
43778 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
43779 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
43780 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
43781 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
43782 and enum types.
43783
43784 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
43785 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
43786 Types must be defined before they are used.
43787
43788 @cindex <vector>
43789 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
43790 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
43791 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
43792 @var{count}:
43793
43794 @smallexample
43795 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
43796 @end smallexample
43797
43798 @cindex <union>
43799 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
43800 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
43801 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
43802 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
43803
43804 @smallexample
43805 <union id="@var{id}">
43806 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
43807 @dots{}
43808 </union>
43809 @end smallexample
43810
43811 @cindex <struct>
43812 @cindex <flags>
43813 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
43814 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
43815 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
43816 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
43817 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
43818 specified.
43819
43820 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
43821
43822 @smallexample
43823 <struct id="@var{id}">
43824 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
43825 @dots{}
43826 </struct>
43827 @end smallexample
43828
43829 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
43830 No implicit padding is added.
43831
43832 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
43833
43834 @smallexample
43835 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
43836 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
43837 @dots{}
43838 </struct>
43839 @end smallexample
43840
43841 @smallexample
43842 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
43843 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
43844 @dots{}
43845 </flags>
43846 @end smallexample
43847
43848 The @var{name} value is required.
43849 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
43850 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
43851 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
43852
43853 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
43854 is optional.
43855 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
43856 and zero represents the least significant bit.
43857
43858 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
43859 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
43860
43861 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
43862
43863 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
43864 defining them with @samp{struct}:
43865
43866 @itemize @bullet
43867 @item
43868 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
43869 @item
43870 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
43871 @end itemize
43872
43873 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
43874 defining them with @samp{flags}:
43875
43876 @itemize @bullet
43877 @item
43878 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
43879
43880 @smallexample
43881 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
43882 $1 = 42
43883 @end smallexample
43884
43885 @end itemize
43886
43887 @subsection Registers
43888 @cindex <reg>
43889
43890 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
43891
43892 @smallexample
43893 <reg name="@var{name}"
43894 bitsize="@var{size}"
43895 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
43896 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
43897 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
43898 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
43899 @end smallexample
43900
43901 @noindent
43902 The components are as follows:
43903
43904 @table @var
43905
43906 @item name
43907 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
43908
43909 @item bitsize
43910 The register's size, in bits.
43911
43912 @item regnum
43913 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
43914 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
43915 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
43916 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
43917 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
43918 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
43919 in order of increasing register number.
43920
43921 @item save-restore
43922 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
43923 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
43924 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
43925 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
43926 ABI.
43927
43928 @item type
43929 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
43930 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
43931 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
43932 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
43933 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
43934 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
43935
43936 @item group
43937 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
43938 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
43939 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
43940 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
43941 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
43942 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
43943 @code{info registers}.
43944
43945 @end table
43946
43947 @node Predefined Target Types
43948 @section Predefined Target Types
43949 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
43950
43951 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
43952 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
43953 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
43954 types. The currently supported types are:
43955
43956 @table @code
43957
43958 @item bool
43959 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
43960
43961 @item int8
43962 @itemx int16
43963 @itemx int24
43964 @itemx int32
43965 @itemx int64
43966 @itemx int128
43967 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
43968
43969 @item uint8
43970 @itemx uint16
43971 @itemx uint24
43972 @itemx uint32
43973 @itemx uint64
43974 @itemx uint128
43975 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
43976
43977 @item code_ptr
43978 @itemx data_ptr
43979 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
43980 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
43981 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
43982 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
43983 may be marked as data pointers.
43984
43985 @item ieee_single
43986 Single precision IEEE floating point.
43987
43988 @item ieee_double
43989 Double precision IEEE floating point.
43990
43991 @item arm_fpa_ext
43992 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
43993
43994 @item i387_ext
43995 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
43996
43997 @item i386_eflags
43998 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
43999
44000 @item i386_mxcsr
44001 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
44002
44003 @end table
44004
44005 @node Enum Target Types
44006 @section Enum Target Types
44007 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
44008
44009 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
44010 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
44011
44012 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
44013
44014 @smallexample
44015 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
44016 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
44017 @dots{}
44018 </enum>
44019 @end smallexample
44020
44021 Enums must be defined before they are used.
44022
44023 @smallexample
44024 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
44025 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
44026 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
44027 </enum>
44028 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
44029 <field name="X" start="0"/>
44030 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
44031 </flags>
44032 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
44033 @end smallexample
44034
44035 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
44036 would be printed as:
44037
44038 @smallexample
44039 (gdb) info register flags
44040 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
44041 @end smallexample
44042
44043 @node Standard Target Features
44044 @section Standard Target Features
44045 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
44046
44047 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
44048 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
44049 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
44050 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
44051 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
44052 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
44053 can recognize them.
44054
44055 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
44056 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
44057 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
44058 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
44059 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
44060 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
44061 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
44062 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
44063
44064 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
44065 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
44066 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
44067
44068 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
44069 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
44070 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
44071 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
44072
44073 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
44074 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
44075 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
44076
44077 @menu
44078 * AArch64 Features::
44079 * ARC Features::
44080 * ARM Features::
44081 * i386 Features::
44082 * MicroBlaze Features::
44083 * MIPS Features::
44084 * M68K Features::
44085 * NDS32 Features::
44086 * Nios II Features::
44087 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
44088 * PowerPC Features::
44089 * RISC-V Features::
44090 * RX Features::
44091 * S/390 and System z Features::
44092 * Sparc Features::
44093 * TIC6x Features::
44094 @end menu
44095
44096
44097 @node AArch64 Features
44098 @subsection AArch64 Features
44099 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
44100
44101 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
44102 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
44103 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
44104
44105 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
44106 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
44107 and @samp{fpcr}.
44108
44109 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
44110 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
44111 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
44112
44113 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.pauth} feature is optional. If present,
44114 it should contain registers @samp{pauth_dmask} and @samp{pauth_cmask}.
44115
44116 @node ARC Features
44117 @subsection ARC Features
44118 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
44119
44120 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
44121 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
44122 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
44123 that one of the core registers features is present.
44124 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
44125
44126 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
44127 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
44128 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
44129 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
44130 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
44131 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
44132 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
44133
44134 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
44135 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
44136 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
44137 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
44138 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
44139 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
44140
44141 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
44142 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
44143 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
44144 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
44145 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
44146 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
44147 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
44148 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
44149 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
44150 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
44151
44152 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
44153 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
44154
44155 @node ARM Features
44156 @subsection ARM Features
44157 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
44158
44159 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
44160 ARM targets.
44161 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
44162 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
44163
44164 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
44165 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
44166 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
44167 and @samp{xpsr}.
44168
44169 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
44170 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
44171
44172 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
44173 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
44174 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
44175 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
44176
44177 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
44178 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
44179 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
44180 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
44181 halves of the double-precision registers.
44182
44183 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
44184 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
44185 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
44186 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
44187 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
44188 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
44189
44190 @node i386 Features
44191 @subsection i386 Features
44192 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
44193
44194 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
44195 targets. It should describe the following registers:
44196
44197 @itemize @minus
44198 @item
44199 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
44200 @item
44201 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
44202 @item
44203 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
44204 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
44205 @item
44206 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
44207 @item
44208 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
44209 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
44210 @end itemize
44211
44212 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
44213
44214 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
44215 describe registers:
44216
44217 @itemize @minus
44218 @item
44219 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
44220 @item
44221 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
44222 @item
44223 @samp{mxcsr}
44224 @end itemize
44225
44226 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
44227 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
44228 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
44229
44230 @itemize @minus
44231 @item
44232 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
44233 @item
44234 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
44235 @end itemize
44236
44237 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
44238 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
44239
44240 @itemize @minus
44241 @item
44242 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
44243 @item
44244 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
44245 @end itemize
44246
44247 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
44248 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
44249
44250 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
44251 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
44252
44253 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
44254 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
44255 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
44256
44257 @itemize @minus
44258 @item
44259 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
44260 @end itemize
44261
44262 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
44263
44264 @itemize @minus
44265 @item
44266 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
44267 @end itemize
44268
44269 It should
44270 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
44271
44272 @itemize @minus
44273 @item
44274 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
44275 @item
44276 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
44277 @end itemize
44278
44279 It should
44280 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
44281
44282 @itemize @minus
44283 @item
44284 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
44285 @end itemize
44286
44287 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
44288 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
44289 valid for i386 and amd64.
44290
44291 @node MicroBlaze Features
44292 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
44293 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
44294
44295 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
44296 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
44297 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
44298 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
44299 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
44300
44301 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
44302 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
44303
44304 @node MIPS Features
44305 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
44306 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
44307
44308 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
44309 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
44310 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
44311 on the target.
44312
44313 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
44314 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
44315 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
44316
44317 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
44318 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
44319 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
44320 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
44321
44322 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
44323 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
44324 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
44325 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
44326
44327 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
44328 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
44329 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
44330
44331 @node M68K Features
44332 @subsection M68K Features
44333 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
44334
44335 @table @code
44336 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
44337 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
44338 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
44339 One of those features must be always present.
44340 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
44341 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
44342 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
44343 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
44344
44345 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
44346 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
44347 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
44348 @samp{fpiaddr}.
44349 @end table
44350
44351 @node NDS32 Features
44352 @subsection NDS32 Features
44353 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
44354
44355 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
44356 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
44357 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
44358 and @samp{pc}.
44359
44360 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
44361 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
44362 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
44363 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
44364
44365 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
44366 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
44367 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
44368 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
44369 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
44370 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
44371 support to it could be totally removed some day.
44372
44373 @node Nios II Features
44374 @subsection Nios II Features
44375 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
44376
44377 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
44378 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
44379 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
44380 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
44381 @samp{mpuacc}).
44382
44383 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
44384 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
44385 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
44386
44387 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
44388 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
44389 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
44390
44391 @node PowerPC Features
44392 @subsection PowerPC Features
44393 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
44394
44395 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
44396 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
44397 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
44398 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
44399
44400 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
44401 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
44402
44403 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
44404 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr}, and
44405 @samp{vrsave}. @value{GDBN} will define pseudo-registers @samp{v0}
44406 through @samp{v31} as aliases for the corresponding @samp{vrX}
44407 registers.
44408
44409 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
44410 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN} will
44411 combine these registers with the floating point registers (@samp{f0}
44412 through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0} through
44413 @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0} through
44414 @samp{vs63}, the set of vector-scalar registers for POWER7.
44415 Therefore, this feature requires both @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} and
44416 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec}.
44417
44418 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
44419 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
44420 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
44421 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
44422 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
44423 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
44424 user.
44425
44426 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ppr} feature is optional. It should
44427 contain the 64-bit register @samp{ppr}.
44428
44429 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.dscr} feature is optional. It should
44430 contain the 64-bit register @samp{dscr}.
44431
44432 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.tar} feature is optional. It should
44433 contain the 64-bit register @samp{tar}.
44434
44435 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ebb} feature is optional. It should
44436 contain registers @samp{bescr}, @samp{ebbhr} and @samp{ebbrr}, all
44437 64-bit wide.
44438
44439 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.linux.pmu} feature is optional. It should
44440 contain registers @samp{mmcr0}, @samp{mmcr2}, @samp{siar}, @samp{sdar}
44441 and @samp{sier}, all 64-bit wide. This is the subset of the isa 2.07
44442 server PMU registers provided by @sc{gnu}/Linux.
44443
44444 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.spr} feature is optional. It should
44445 contain registers @samp{tfhar}, @samp{texasr} and @samp{tfiar}, all
44446 64-bit wide.
44447
44448 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.core} feature is optional. It should
44449 contain the checkpointed general-purpose registers @samp{cr0} through
44450 @samp{cr31}, as well as the checkpointed registers @samp{clr} and
44451 @samp{cctr}. These registers may all be either 32-bit or 64-bit
44452 depending on the target. It should also contain the checkpointed
44453 registers @samp{ccr} and @samp{cxer}, which should both be 32-bit
44454 wide.
44455
44456 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu} feature is optional. It should
44457 contain the checkpointed 64-bit floating-point registers @samp{cf0}
44458 through @samp{cf31}, as well as the checkpointed 64-bit register
44459 @samp{cfpscr}.
44460
44461 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} feature is optional. It
44462 should contain the checkpointed altivec registers @samp{cvr0} through
44463 @samp{cvr31}, all 128-bit wide. It should also contain the
44464 checkpointed registers @samp{cvscr} and @samp{cvrsave}, both 32-bit
44465 wide.
44466
44467 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.vsx} feature is optional. It should
44468 contain registers @samp{cvs0h} through @samp{cvs31h}. @value{GDBN}
44469 will combine these registers with the checkpointed floating point
44470 registers (@samp{cf0} through @samp{cf31}) and the checkpointed
44471 altivec registers (@samp{cvr0} through @samp{cvr31}) to present the
44472 128-bit wide checkpointed vector-scalar registers @samp{cvs0} through
44473 @samp{cvs63}. Therefore, this feature requires both
44474 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} and
44475 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu}.
44476
44477 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.ppr} feature is optional. It should
44478 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cppr}.
44479
44480 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.dscr} feature is optional. It should
44481 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cdscr}.
44482
44483 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.tar} feature is optional. It should
44484 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{ctar}.
44485
44486
44487 @node RISC-V Features
44488 @subsection RISC-V Features
44489 @cindex target descriptions, RISC-V Features
44490
44491 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.cpu} feature is required for RISC-V
44492 targets. It should contain the registers @samp{x0} through
44493 @samp{x31}, and @samp{pc}. Either the architectural names (@samp{x0},
44494 @samp{x1}, etc) can be used, or the ABI names (@samp{zero}, @samp{ra},
44495 etc).
44496
44497 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.fpu} feature is optional. If present, it
44498 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fflags},
44499 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr}. As with the cpu feature, either the
44500 architectural register names, or the ABI names can be used.
44501
44502 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.virtual} feature is optional. If present,
44503 it should contain registers that are not backed by real registers on
44504 the target, but are instead virtual, where the register value is
44505 derived from other target state. In many ways these are like
44506 @value{GDBN}s pseudo-registers, except implemented by the target.
44507 Currently the only register expected in this set is the one byte
44508 @samp{priv} register that contains the target's privilege level in the
44509 least significant two bits.
44510
44511 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.csr} feature is optional. If present, it
44512 should contain all of the target's standard CSRs. Standard CSRs are
44513 those defined in the RISC-V specification documents. There is some
44514 overlap between this feature and the fpu feature; the @samp{fflags},
44515 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr} registers could be in either feature. The
44516 expectation is that these registers will be in the fpu feature if the
44517 target has floating point hardware, but can be moved into the csr
44518 feature if the target has the floating point control registers, but no
44519 other floating point hardware.
44520
44521 @node RX Features
44522 @subsection RX Features
44523 @cindex target descriptions, RX Features
44524
44525 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.rx.core} feature is required for RX
44526 targets. It should contain the registers @samp{r0} through
44527 @samp{r15}, @samp{usp}, @samp{isp}, @samp{psw}, @samp{pc}, @samp{intb},
44528 @samp{bpsw}, @samp{bpc}, @samp{fintv}, @samp{fpsw}, and @samp{acc}.
44529
44530 @node S/390 and System z Features
44531 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
44532 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
44533 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
44534
44535 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
44536 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
44537 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
44538 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
44539 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
44540 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
44541 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
44542 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
44543 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
44544
44545 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
44546 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
44547 @samp{fpc}.
44548
44549 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
44550 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
44551
44552 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
44553 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
44554 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
44555 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
44556 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
44557 32-bit wide.
44558
44559 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
44560 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
44561 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
44562
44563 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
44564 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
44565 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
44566 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
44567 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
44568 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
44569 @samp{v31}.
44570
44571 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
44572 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
44573 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
44574
44575 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
44576 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
44577 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
44578
44579 @node Sparc Features
44580 @subsection Sparc Features
44581 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
44582 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
44583 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
44584 targets. It should describe the following registers:
44585
44586 @itemize @minus
44587 @item
44588 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
44589 @item
44590 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
44591 @item
44592 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
44593 @item
44594 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
44595 @end itemize
44596
44597 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
44598
44599 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
44600 targets. It should describe the following registers:
44601
44602 @itemize @minus
44603 @item
44604 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
44605 @item
44606 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
44607 @end itemize
44608
44609 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
44610 targets. It should describe the following registers:
44611
44612 @itemize @minus
44613 @item
44614 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
44615 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
44616 @item
44617 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
44618 for sparc64
44619 @end itemize
44620
44621 @node TIC6x Features
44622 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
44623 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
44624 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
44625 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
44626 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
44627 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
44628
44629 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
44630 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
44631 through @samp{B31}.
44632
44633 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
44634 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
44635
44636 @node Operating System Information
44637 @appendix Operating System Information
44638 @cindex operating system information
44639
44640 @menu
44641 * Process list::
44642 @end menu
44643
44644 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
44645 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
44646 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
44647 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
44648 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
44649 on a different aspect of target.
44650
44651 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
44652 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
44653 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
44654 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
44655
44656 @node Process list
44657 @appendixsection Process list
44658 @cindex operating system information, process list
44659
44660 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
44661 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
44662 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
44663 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
44664
44665 An example document is:
44666
44667 @smallexample
44668 <?xml version="1.0"?>
44669 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
44670 <osdata type="processes">
44671 <item>
44672 <column name="pid">1</column>
44673 <column name="user">root</column>
44674 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
44675 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
44676 </item>
44677 </osdata>
44678 @end smallexample
44679
44680 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
44681 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
44682 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
44683 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
44684 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
44685 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
44686 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
44687
44688 @node Trace File Format
44689 @appendix Trace File Format
44690 @cindex trace file format
44691
44692 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
44693 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
44694
44695 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
44696 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
44697 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
44698 in the future.
44699
44700 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
44701 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
44702 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
44703 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
44704 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
44705 of this section.
44706
44707 @table @code
44708 @item R @var{size}
44709 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
44710 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
44711 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
44712 a single trace file.
44713
44714 @item status @var{status}
44715 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
44716 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
44717 file.
44718
44719 @item tp @var{payload}
44720 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
44721 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
44722 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
44723 reply packets.
44724
44725 @item tsv @var{payload}
44726 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
44727 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
44728 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
44729 reply packets.
44730
44731 @item tdesc @var{payload}
44732 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
44733 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
44734 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
44735 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
44736 file. Includes are not allowed.
44737
44738 @end table
44739
44740 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
44741 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
44742 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
44743 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
44744 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
44745 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
44746 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
44747 endianness.
44748
44749 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
44750
44751 @table @code
44752 @item R @var{bytes}
44753 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
44754 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
44755 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
44756
44757 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
44758 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
44759 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
44760 @var{length} bytes.
44761
44762 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
44763 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
44764 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
44765
44766 @end table
44767
44768 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
44769 of blocks.
44770
44771 @node Index Section Format
44772 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
44773 @cindex .gdb_index section format
44774 @cindex index section format
44775
44776 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
44777 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
44778 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
44779 description.
44780
44781 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
44782 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
44783 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
44784 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
44785 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
44786 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
44787
44788 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
44789
44790 @enumerate
44791 @item
44792 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
44793 unless otherwise noted:
44794
44795 @enumerate
44796 @item
44797 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
44798 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
44799 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
44800 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
44801 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
44802 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
44803 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
44804
44805 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
44806 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
44807 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
44808 currently not flagged as deprecated.
44809
44810 @item
44811 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
44812
44813 @item
44814 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
44815 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
44816 to the next offset.
44817
44818 @item
44819 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
44820
44821 @item
44822 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
44823
44824 @item
44825 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
44826 @end enumerate
44827
44828 @item
44829 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
44830 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
44831 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
44832 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
44833 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
44834 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
44835 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
44836 CU indices.
44837
44838 @item
44839 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
44840 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
44841 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
44842 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
44843
44844 @item
44845 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
44846 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
44847
44848 @enumerate
44849 @item
44850 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
44851
44852 @item
44853 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
44854 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
44855
44856 @item
44857 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
44858 @end enumerate
44859
44860 @item
44861 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
44862 the hash table is always a power of 2.
44863
44864 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
44865 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
44866 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
44867 constant pool.
44868
44869 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
44870 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
44871 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
44872
44873 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
44874 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
44875 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
44876 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
44877 index version:
44878
44879 @table @asis
44880 @item Version 4
44881 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
44882
44883 @item Versions 5 to 7
44884 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
44885 @end table
44886
44887 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
44888
44889 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
44890 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
44891 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
44892 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
44893 collision.
44894
44895 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
44896 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
44897 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
44898 the code.
44899
44900 @item
44901 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
44902 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
44903 strings.
44904
44905 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
44906 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
44907 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
44908 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
44909 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
44910 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
44911
44912 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
44913 @end enumerate
44914
44915 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
44916 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
44917 CU index+attributes value for each use.
44918
44919 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
44920 (bit 0 = LSB):
44921
44922 @table @asis
44923
44924 @item Bits 0-23
44925 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
44926 @item Bits 24-27
44927 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
44928 @item Bits 28-30
44929 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
44930
44931 @table @asis
44932 @item 0
44933 This value is reserved and should not be used.
44934 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
44935 with previous versions of the index.
44936 @item 1
44937 The symbol is a type.
44938 @item 2
44939 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
44940 @item 3
44941 The symbol is a function.
44942 @item 4
44943 Any other kind of symbol.
44944 @item 5,6,7
44945 These values are reserved.
44946 @end table
44947
44948 @item Bit 31
44949 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
44950
44951 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
44952 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
44953 @value{GDBN} sources.
44954
44955 @end table
44956
44957 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
44958 global/static attributes in the index.
44959
44960 @smallexample
44961 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
44962 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
44963 switch (die->tag)
44964 @{
44965 case DW_TAG_typedef:
44966 case DW_TAG_base_type:
44967 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
44968 kind = TYPE;
44969 is_static = 1;
44970 break;
44971 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
44972 kind = VARIABLE;
44973 is_static = language != CPLUS;
44974 break;
44975 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
44976 kind = FUNCTION;
44977 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
44978 break;
44979 case DW_TAG_constant:
44980 kind = VARIABLE;
44981 is_static = ! is_external;
44982 break;
44983 case DW_TAG_variable:
44984 kind = VARIABLE;
44985 is_static = ! is_external;
44986 break;
44987 case DW_TAG_namespace:
44988 kind = TYPE;
44989 is_static = 0;
44990 break;
44991 case DW_TAG_class_type:
44992 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
44993 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
44994 case DW_TAG_union_type:
44995 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
44996 kind = TYPE;
44997 is_static = language != CPLUS;
44998 break;
44999 default:
45000 assert (0);
45001 @}
45002 @end smallexample
45003
45004 @node Man Pages
45005 @appendix Manual pages
45006 @cindex Man pages
45007
45008 @menu
45009 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
45010 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
45011 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
45012 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
45013 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
45014 @end menu
45015
45016 @node gdb man
45017 @heading gdb man
45018
45019 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
45020
45021 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
45022 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
45023 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
45024 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
45025 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
45026 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
45027 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
45028 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
45029 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
45030 @c man end
45031
45032 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
45033 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
45034 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
45035 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
45036
45037 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
45038 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
45039
45040 @itemize @bullet
45041 @item
45042 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
45043
45044 @item
45045 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
45046
45047 @item
45048 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
45049
45050 @item
45051 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
45052 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
45053 @end itemize
45054
45055 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
45056 Modula-2.
45057
45058 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
45059 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
45060 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
45061 by using the command @code{help}.
45062
45063 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
45064 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
45065 executable program as the argument:
45066
45067 @smallexample
45068 gdb program
45069 @end smallexample
45070
45071 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
45072
45073 @smallexample
45074 gdb program core
45075 @end smallexample
45076
45077 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument or use option
45078 @code{-p}, if you want to debug a running process:
45079
45080 @smallexample
45081 gdb program 1234
45082 gdb -p 1234
45083 @end smallexample
45084
45085 @noindent
45086 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234}. With option @option{-p} you
45087 can omit the @var{program} filename.
45088
45089 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
45090
45091 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
45092 @table @env
45093 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
45094 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
45095
45096 @item run [@var{arglist}]
45097 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
45098
45099 @item bt
45100 Backtrace: display the program stack.
45101
45102 @item print @var{expr}
45103 Display the value of an expression.
45104
45105 @item c
45106 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
45107
45108 @item next
45109 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
45110 function calls in the line.
45111
45112 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
45113 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
45114
45115 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
45116 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
45117
45118 @item step
45119 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
45120 function calls in the line.
45121
45122 @item help [@var{name}]
45123 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
45124 about using @value{GDBN}.
45125
45126 @item quit
45127 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
45128 @end table
45129
45130 @ifset man
45131 For full details on @value{GDBN},
45132 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45133 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
45134 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
45135 @end ifset
45136 @c man end
45137
45138 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
45139 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
45140 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
45141 encountered with no
45142 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
45143 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
45144 Many options have
45145 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
45146 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
45147 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
45148 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
45149 more usual convention.)
45150
45151 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
45152 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
45153 option is used.
45154
45155 @table @env
45156 @item -help
45157 @itemx -h
45158 List all options, with brief explanations.
45159
45160 @item -symbols=@var{file}
45161 @itemx -s @var{file}
45162 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
45163
45164 @item -write
45165 Enable writing into executable and core files.
45166
45167 @item -exec=@var{file}
45168 @itemx -e @var{file}
45169 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
45170 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
45171 dump.
45172
45173 @item -se=@var{file}
45174 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
45175 file.
45176
45177 @item -core=@var{file}
45178 @itemx -c @var{file}
45179 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
45180
45181 @item -command=@var{file}
45182 @itemx -x @var{file}
45183 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
45184
45185 @item -ex @var{command}
45186 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
45187
45188 @item -directory=@var{directory}
45189 @itemx -d @var{directory}
45190 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
45191
45192 @item -nh
45193 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
45194
45195 @item -nx
45196 @itemx -n
45197 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
45198
45199 @item -quiet
45200 @itemx -q
45201 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
45202 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
45203
45204 @item -batch
45205 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
45206 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
45207 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
45208 commands in the command files.
45209
45210 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
45211 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
45212 more useful, the message
45213
45214 @smallexample
45215 Program exited normally.
45216 @end smallexample
45217
45218 @noindent
45219 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
45220 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
45221
45222 @item -cd=@var{directory}
45223 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
45224 instead of the current directory.
45225
45226 @item -fullname
45227 @itemx -f
45228 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
45229 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
45230 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
45231 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
45232 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
45233 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
45234 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
45235 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
45236
45237 @item -b @var{bps}
45238 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
45239 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
45240
45241 @item -tty=@var{device}
45242 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
45243 @end table
45244 @c man end
45245
45246 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
45247 @ifset man
45248 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
45249 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
45250 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
45251
45252 @smallexample
45253 info gdb
45254 @end smallexample
45255
45256 @noindent
45257 should give you access to the complete manual.
45258
45259 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45260 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
45261 @end ifset
45262 @c man end
45263
45264 @node gdbserver man
45265 @heading gdbserver man
45266
45267 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
45268 @format
45269 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
45270 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
45271
45272 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
45273
45274 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
45275 @c man end
45276 @end format
45277
45278 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
45279 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
45280 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
45281
45282 @ifclear man
45283 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
45284 @end ifclear
45285 @ifset man
45286 Usage (server (target) side):
45287 @end ifset
45288
45289 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
45290 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
45291 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
45292 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
45293
45294 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
45295 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
45296 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
45297
45298 @smallexample
45299 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
45300 @end smallexample
45301
45302 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
45303
45304 @smallexample
45305 @ifset man
45306 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
45307 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
45308 @end ifset
45309 @ifclear man
45310 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
45311 @end ifclear
45312 @end smallexample
45313
45314 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
45315 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
45316 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
45317
45318 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
45319
45320 @smallexample
45321 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
45322 @end smallexample
45323
45324 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
45325 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
45326 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
45327 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
45328 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
45329 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
45330 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
45331 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
45332 print an error message and exit.
45333
45334 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
45335 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
45336
45337 @smallexample
45338 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
45339 @end smallexample
45340
45341 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
45342 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
45343
45344 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
45345 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
45346 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
45347 the program you want to debug.
45348
45349 @smallexample
45350 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
45351 @end smallexample
45352
45353 @ifclear man
45354 @subheading Usage (host side)
45355 @end ifclear
45356 @ifset man
45357 Usage (host side):
45358 @end ifset
45359
45360 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
45361 @value{GDBN} needs to examine its symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
45362 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
45363 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
45364 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
45365 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
45366 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
45367 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
45368 descriptor. For example:
45369
45370 @smallexample
45371 @ifset man
45372 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
45373 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
45374 @end ifset
45375 @ifclear man
45376 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
45377 @end ifclear
45378 @end smallexample
45379
45380 @noindent
45381 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
45382
45383 @smallexample
45384 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
45385 @end smallexample
45386
45387 @noindent
45388 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
45389 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
45390 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
45391 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
45392 `Connection refused'.
45393
45394 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
45395 described in
45396 @ifset man
45397 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
45398 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
45399 @end ifset
45400 @ifclear man
45401 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
45402 @end ifclear
45403 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
45404
45405 @smallexample
45406 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
45407 @end smallexample
45408
45409 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
45410 case.
45411 @c man end
45412
45413 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
45414 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
45415
45416 @itemize @bullet
45417
45418 @item
45419 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
45420
45421 @smallexample
45422 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
45423 @end smallexample
45424
45425 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
45426 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
45427 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
45428 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
45429 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
45430 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
45431 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
45432
45433 @item
45434 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
45435 program:
45436
45437 @smallexample
45438 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
45439 @end smallexample
45440
45441 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
45442 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
45443 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
45444 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
45445
45446 @item
45447 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
45448
45449 @smallexample
45450 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
45451 @end smallexample
45452
45453 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
45454 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
45455 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
45456 debug several processes in the same session.
45457 @end itemize
45458
45459 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
45460
45461 @table @env
45462
45463 @item --help
45464 List all options, with brief explanations.
45465
45466 @item --version
45467 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
45468
45469 @item --attach
45470 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
45471
45472 @smallexample
45473 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
45474 @end smallexample
45475
45476 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
45477 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
45478
45479 @item --multi
45480 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
45481 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
45482 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
45483 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
45484
45485 @smallexample
45486 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
45487 @end smallexample
45488
45489 @item --debug
45490 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
45491 process.
45492 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
45493 the developers.
45494
45495 @item --remote-debug
45496 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
45497 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
45498 the developers.
45499
45500 @item --debug-file=@var{filename}
45501 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to send any debug output to the given @var{filename}.
45502 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
45503 the developers.
45504
45505 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
45506 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
45507 of debugging output.
45508 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
45509
45510 @item --wrapper
45511 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
45512 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
45513 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
45514 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
45515
45516 @item --once
45517 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
45518 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
45519 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
45520 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
45521
45522 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
45523
45524 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
45525 @c QDisableRandomization.
45526
45527 @end table
45528 @c man end
45529
45530 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
45531 @ifset man
45532 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
45533 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
45534 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
45535
45536 @smallexample
45537 info gdb
45538 @end smallexample
45539
45540 should give you access to the complete manual.
45541
45542 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45543 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
45544 @end ifset
45545 @c man end
45546
45547 @node gcore man
45548 @heading gcore
45549
45550 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
45551
45552 @format
45553 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
45554 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
45555 @c man end
45556 @end format
45557
45558 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
45559 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
45560 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
45561 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
45562 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
45563 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
45564 its job the program remains running without any change.
45565 @c man end
45566
45567 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
45568 @table @env
45569 @item -a
45570 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
45571 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
45572 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
45573 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
45574 dump-excluded-mappings}).
45575
45576 @item -o @var{prefix}
45577 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
45578 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
45579 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
45580 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
45581 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
45582 @end table
45583 @c man end
45584
45585 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
45586 @ifset man
45587 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
45588 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
45589 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
45590
45591 @smallexample
45592 info gdb
45593 @end smallexample
45594
45595 @noindent
45596 should give you access to the complete manual.
45597
45598 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45599 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
45600 @end ifset
45601 @c man end
45602
45603 @node gdbinit man
45604 @heading gdbinit
45605
45606 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
45607
45608 @format
45609 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
45610 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
45611 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
45612 @end ifset
45613
45614 ~/.gdbinit
45615
45616 ./.gdbinit
45617 @c man end
45618 @end format
45619
45620 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
45621 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
45622 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
45623 described in
45624 @ifset man
45625 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
45626 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
45627 @end ifset
45628 @ifclear man
45629 @ref{Sequences}.
45630 @end ifclear
45631
45632 Please read more in
45633 @ifset man
45634 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
45635 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
45636 @end ifset
45637 @ifclear man
45638 @ref{Startup}.
45639 @end ifclear
45640
45641 @table @env
45642 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
45643 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
45644 @end ifset
45645 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
45646 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
45647 @end ifclear
45648 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
45649 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
45650 See more in
45651 @ifset man
45652 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
45653 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
45654 @end ifset
45655 @ifclear man
45656 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
45657 @end ifclear
45658
45659 @item ~/.gdbinit
45660 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
45661 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
45662
45663 @item ./.gdbinit
45664 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
45665 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
45666 See more in
45667 @ifset man
45668 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
45669 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
45670 @end ifset
45671 @ifclear man
45672 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
45673 @end ifclear
45674 @end table
45675 @c man end
45676
45677 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
45678 @ifset man
45679 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
45680
45681 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
45682 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
45683 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
45684
45685 @smallexample
45686 info gdb
45687 @end smallexample
45688
45689 should give you access to the complete manual.
45690
45691 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45692 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
45693 @end ifset
45694 @c man end
45695
45696 @node gdb-add-index man
45697 @heading gdb-add-index
45698 @pindex gdb-add-index
45699 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
45700
45701 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
45702
45703 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
45704 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
45705 @c man end
45706
45707 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
45708 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
45709 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
45710 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
45711 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
45712 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
45713
45714 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
45715 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
45716 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
45717 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
45718 named @code{.debug_*}).
45719
45720 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
45721 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
45722 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
45723 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
45724
45725 See more in
45726 @ifset man
45727 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
45728 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
45729 @end ifset
45730 @ifclear man
45731 @ref{Index Files}.
45732 @end ifclear
45733 @c man end
45734
45735 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
45736 @ifset man
45737 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
45738 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
45739 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
45740
45741 @smallexample
45742 info gdb
45743 @end smallexample
45744
45745 should give you access to the complete manual.
45746
45747 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45748 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
45749 @end ifset
45750 @c man end
45751
45752 @include gpl.texi
45753
45754 @node GNU Free Documentation License
45755 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
45756 @include fdl.texi
45757
45758 @node Concept Index
45759 @unnumbered Concept Index
45760
45761 @printindex cp
45762
45763 @node Command and Variable Index
45764 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
45765
45766 @printindex fn
45767
45768 @tex
45769 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
45770 % meantime:
45771 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
45772 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
45773 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
45774 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
45775 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
45776 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
45777 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
45778 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
45779 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
45780 \page\colophon
45781 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
45782 @end tex
45783
45784 @bye